summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
authornfenwick <nfenwick@pglaf.org>2025-02-06 16:13:45 -0800
committernfenwick <nfenwick@pglaf.org>2025-02-06 16:13:45 -0800
commita42ab763f14b271b9a49b0401e3066a90b31a09f (patch)
tree8dea1bb1ec3ce929ef74e98bca6547e862f7d39a
parent5f1ea9023e7be4f29009efe7b6c9ac28a28a3540 (diff)
NormalizeHEADmain
-rw-r--r--.gitattributes4
-rw-r--r--LICENSE.txt11
-rw-r--r--README.md2
-rw-r--r--old/53382-0.txt7155
-rw-r--r--old/53382-0.zipbin144609 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/53382-h.zipbin499968 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/53382-h/53382-h.htm10100
-rw-r--r--old/53382-h/images/cover.jpgbin110674 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/53382-h/images/frontis.jpgbin72801 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/53382-h/images/p008.jpgbin39933 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/53382-h/images/p122.jpgbin83693 -> 0 bytes
-rw-r--r--old/53382-h/images/p240.jpgbin39858 -> 0 bytes
12 files changed, 17 insertions, 17255 deletions
diff --git a/.gitattributes b/.gitattributes
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d7b82bc
--- /dev/null
+++ b/.gitattributes
@@ -0,0 +1,4 @@
+*.txt text eol=lf
+*.htm text eol=lf
+*.html text eol=lf
+*.md text eol=lf
diff --git a/LICENSE.txt b/LICENSE.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6312041
--- /dev/null
+++ b/LICENSE.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,11 @@
+This eBook, including all associated images, markup, improvements,
+metadata, and any other content or labor, has been confirmed to be
+in the PUBLIC DOMAIN IN THE UNITED STATES.
+
+Procedures for determining public domain status are described in
+the "Copyright How-To" at https://www.gutenberg.org.
+
+No investigation has been made concerning possible copyrights in
+jurisdictions other than the United States. Anyone seeking to utilize
+this eBook outside of the United States should confirm copyright
+status under the laws that apply to them.
diff --git a/README.md b/README.md
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..acf756d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/README.md
@@ -0,0 +1,2 @@
+Project Gutenberg (https://www.gutenberg.org) public repository for
+eBook #53382 (https://www.gutenberg.org/ebooks/53382)
diff --git a/old/53382-0.txt b/old/53382-0.txt
deleted file mode 100644
index 8b098ce..0000000
--- a/old/53382-0.txt
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,7155 +0,0 @@
-The Project Gutenberg EBook of From Farm Boy to Senator, by Horatio Alger Jr.
-
-This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and most
-other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no restrictions
-whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it under the terms of
-the Project Gutenberg License included with this eBook or online at
-www.gutenberg.org. If you are not located in the United States, you'll have
-to check the laws of the country where you are located before using this ebook.
-
-
-
-Title: From Farm Boy to Senator
- Being the History of the Boyhood and Manhood of Daniel Webter
-
-Author: Horatio Alger Jr.
-
-Release Date: October 27, 2016 [EBook #53382]
-
-Language: English
-
-Character set encoding: UTF-8
-
-*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK FROM FARM BOY TO SENATOR ***
-
-
-
-
-Produced by David Edwards, Les Galloway and the Online
-Distributed Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net (This
-file was produced from images generously made available
-by The Internet Archive)
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-[Illustration: Two boys in a general store]
-
-
- FROM
-
- FARM BOY TO SENATOR;
-
-
- BEING THE HISTORY OF THE
-
- BOYHOOD AND MANHOOD
-
- OF
-
- DANIEL WEBSTER.
-
-
- BY HORATIO ALGER, JR.,
-
- _Author of “From Canal Boy to President,” “Ragged Dick
- Series,” “Tattered Tom Series,” etc., etc._
-
-
- NEW YORK:
- J. S. OGILVIE & COMPANY,
- NO. 31 ROSE STREET.
-
-
- COPYRIGHT, 1882,
- BY STREET & SMITH.
-
-
-
-
- TO
-
- MY FRIEND AND COLLEGE CLASSMATE,
-
- JUDGE ADDISON BROWN,
-
- OF NEW YORK,
-
- THIS VOLUME IS CORDIALLY INSCRIBED.
-
-
-
-
-CONTENTS.
-
-
- CHAPTER PAGE
-
- I. The Cotton Handkerchief 9
- II. Daniel and his Father 17
- III. A Memorable Battle 25
- IV. An Important Step 33
- V. Daniel at Exeter Academy 41
- VI. Preparing for College 49
- VII. Daniel’s College Life 59
- VIII. Daniel Receives some Valuable Advice 67
- IX. Brotherly Love 71
- X. The Two Brothers 76
- XI. Daniel as an Orator 84
- XII. Studying Law 92
- XIII. How Daniel went to Fryeburg 97
- XIV. The Preceptor of Fryeburg Academy 101
- XV. The Next Two Years 109
- XVI. A Great Temptation 117
- XVII. Daniel Refuses a Clerkship 125
- XVIII. D. Webster, Attorney 133
- XIX. Daniel Overcomes a Bramble 141
- XX. “The Little Black Stable-Boy.” 150
- XXI. Why Daniel was sent to Congress 158
- XXII. Mr. Webster as a Member of Congress 166
- XXIII. John Randolph and William Pinkney 174
- XXIV. Mr. Webster in Boston 184
- XXV. The Oration at Plymouth 190
- XXVI. The Bunker Hill Oration 199
- XXVII. Adams and Jefferson 207
- XXVIII. Home Life and Domestic Sorrows 218
- XXIX. Called to the Senate 225
- XXX. The Beginning of a Great Battle 232
- XXXI. The Reply to Hayne 240
- XXXII. The Secret of Webster’s Power 256
- XXXIII. Honors Received in England 267
- XXXIV. Called to the Cabinet 275
- XXXV. Life at Marshfield 283
- XXXVI. The Seventh of March Speech 289
- XXXVII. Closing Scenes 296
- XXXVIII. Centennial Tributes 301
-
-
-
-
-PREFACE.
-
-
-But thirty years have elapsed since the death of Daniel Webster, and
-there is already danger that, so far as young people are concerned,
-he will become an historic reminiscence. Schoolboys, who declaim
-the eloquent extracts from his speeches which are included in all
-the school speakers, are indeed able to form some idea of his great
-oratorical powers and the themes which called them forth; but I have
-found that young classical students, as a rule, know more of Cicero’s
-life than of his. It seems to me eminently fitting that the leading
-incidents in the life of our great countryman, his struggles for an
-education, the steps by which he rose to professional and political
-distinction, should be made familiar to American boys. I have therefore
-essayed a “story biography,” which I have tried to write in such a
-manner as to make it attractive to young people, who are apt to turn
-away from ordinary biographies, in the fear that they may prove dull.
-
-I have not found my task an easy one. Webster’s life is so crowded
-with great services and events, it is so interwoven with the history
-of the nation, that to give a fair idea of him in a volume of ordinary
-size is almost impossible. I have found it necessary to leave out some
-things, and to refer briefly to others, lest my book should expand to
-undue proportions. Let me acknowledge then, with the utmost frankness,
-that my work is incomplete, and necessarily so. This causes me less
-regret, because those whom I may be fortunate enough to interest in my
-subject will readily find all that they wish to know in the noble Life
-of Webster, by George Ticknor Curtis, the captivating Reminiscences, by
-Peter Harvey, the Private Correspondence, edited by Fletcher Webster,
-and the collection of Mr. Webster’s speeches, edited by Mr. Everett.
-They will also find interesting views of Mr. Webster’s senatorial
-career in the Reminiscences of Congress, by Charles W. March.
-
-If this unpretending volume shall contribute in any way to extend the
-study of Mr. Webster’s life and works, I shall feel that my labor has
-been well bestowed.
-
- HORATIO ALGER, JR.
-
- March 28, 1882.
-
-
-[Illustration: DANIEL WEBSTER AT THE AGE OF SIXTEEN.]
-
-
-
-
- FROM FARM BOY TO SENATOR.
-
- A BOYS’ LIFE OF
-
- DANIEL WEBSTER.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER I.
-
-THE COTTON HANDKERCHIEF.
-
-
-“Where are you going, Daniel?”
-
-“To Mr. Hoyt’s store.”
-
-“I’ll go in with you. Where is ’Zekiel this morning?”
-
-“I left him at work on the farm.”
-
-“I suppose you will both be farmers when you grow up?”
-
-“I don’t know,” answered Daniel, thoughtfully. “I don’t think I shall
-like it, but there isn’t anything else to do in Salisbury.”
-
-“You might keep a store, and teach school like Master Hoyt.”
-
-“Perhaps so. I should like it better than farming.”
-
-Daniel was but eight years old, a boy of striking appearance, with
-black hair and eyes, and a swarthy complexion. He was of slender frame,
-and his large dark eyes, deep set beneath an overhanging brow, gave a
-singular appearance to the thin face of the delicate looking boy.
-
-He was a farmer’s son, and lived in a plain, old-fashioned house,
-shaded by fine elms, and separated from the broad, quiet street by a
-fence. It was situated in a valley, at the bend of the Merrimac, on
-both sides of which rose high hills, which the boy climbed many a time
-for the more extended view they commanded. From a high sheep-pasture on
-his father’s farm, through a wide opening in the hills, he could see on
-a clear day Brentney Mountain in Vermont, and in a different direction
-the snowy top of Mount Washington, far away to the northeast.
-
-He entered the humble store with his companion.
-
-Behind the counter stood Master Hoyt, a tall man, of stern aspect,
-which could strike terror into the hearts of delinquent scholars when
-in the winter they came to receive instruction from him.
-
-“Good morning, Daniel,” said Master Hoyt, who was waiting upon a
-customer.
-
-“Good morning, sir,” answered Daniel, respectfully.
-
-“I hope you won’t forget what you learned at school last winter.”
-
-“No, sir, I will try not to.”
-
-“You mustn’t forget your reading and writing.”
-
-“No, sir; I read whatever I can find, but I don’t like writing much.”
-
-“You’ll never make much of a hand at writing, Daniel. Ezekiel writes
-far better than you. But you won’t need writing much when you’re
-following the plough.”
-
-“I hope I shan’t have to do that, Master Hoyt.”
-
-“Ay, you’re hardly strong enough, you may find something else to do in
-time. You may keep school like me—who knows?—but you’ll have to get
-some one else to set the copies,” and Master Hoyt laughed, as if he
-thought it a good joke.
-
-Daniel listened gravely to the master’s prediction, but it seemed
-to him he should hardly care to be a teacher like Mr. Hoyt, for the
-latter, though he was a good reader, wrote an excellent hand, and had
-a slight knowledge of grammar, could carry his pupils no further. No
-pupil was likely to wonder that “one small head could carry all he
-knew.” Yet the boys respected him, and in his limited way he did them
-good.
-
-Master Hoyt had by this time finished waiting upon his customer, and
-was at leisure to pay attention to his two young callers. He regarded
-them rather as pupils than as customers, for it is quite the custom in
-sparsely settled neighborhoods to “drop in” at the store for a chat.
-
-Meanwhile Daniel’s roving eyes had been attracted by a cotton
-pocket-handkerchief, which appeared to have something printed upon it.
-
-Master Hoyt noticed the direction of the boy’s gaze.
-
-“I see you are looking at the handkerchief,” he said. “Would you like
-to see what is printed on it?”
-
-“Yes, sir.”
-
-The handkerchief was taken down and placed in the boy’s hands. It was
-quite customary in those days, when books and papers were comparatively
-rare and difficult to obtain, to combine literature with plain homely
-utility, by printing reading matter of some kind on cheap cotton
-handkerchiefs. Nowadays boys would probably object to such a custom,
-but the boy, Daniel who was fond of reading, was attracted.
-
-“Is it a story?” he asked.
-
-“No, Daniel; it is the Constitution of the United States—the government
-we live under.”
-
-Daniel’s interest was excited. Of the government he knew something,
-but not much, and up to that moment he had not known that there was a
-constitution, and indeed he couldn’t tell what a constitution was, but
-he thought he would like to know.
-
-“What is the price?” he asked.
-
-“Twenty-five cents.”
-
-Daniel felt in his pocket, and drew out a quarter of a dollar. It
-represented all his worldly wealth. It had not come to him all at once,
-but was the accumulation of pennies saved. He may have had other plans
-for spending it, but now when there was a chance of securing something
-to read he could not resist the temptation, so he passed over his
-precious coin, and the handkerchief became his.
-
-“It’s a good purchase,” said Master Hoyt, approvingly. “Take it home,
-Daniel, and read it, and you’ll know something of the government we’re
-living under. I suppose you’ve heard your father talk of the days when
-he was a soldier, and fought against the British?”
-
-“Yes, sir.”
-
-“When soldiers were called for, Captain Webster was one of the first to
-answer the call. But of course you are too young to remember that time.”
-
-“Yes, sir; but I have heard father talk about it.”
-
-“Ay, ay; your father was selected to stand guard before General
-Washington’s headquarters on the night after Arnold’s treason. The
-general knew he could depend upon him.”
-
-“Yes, sir; I am sure of that,” said the boy proudly, for he had a high
-reverence and respect for his soldier father, who on his side was
-devoted to the best interests of his sons, and was ready when the time
-came to make sacrifices for them such as would have made most fathers
-hesitate.
-
-“Ah, those were dark days, Daniel. You are lucky to live in peaceful
-times, under a free government, but you must never forget how your
-father and other brave men fought to secure the blessings we now enjoy.
-Now General Washington is President, and we are no longer a subject
-colony, but we have a free and independent government.”
-
-It is doubtful how far Daniel and his young companion understood the
-remarks of Master Hoyt, but doubtless a time came further on when the
-words recurred to him, and in the light of his father’s conversations,
-which from time to time he held with his neighbors, gave him a more
-adequate idea of the character of that government in which in after
-years he was to take so prominent a part.
-
-“Are you going, Daniel?” asked William Hoyt, as the boys turned to
-leave his humble store.
-
-“Yes, sir; father may want me at home.”
-
-“Don’t forget your learning, my lad. You must be ready to take up your
-studies next winter. Soon you will know as much as I do.”
-
-It was meant for an encouraging remark, but the prospect it held out
-was not one to dazzle the imagination even of a boy of eight, for as I
-have already said the good man’s acquirements were of the most limited
-character.
-
-Daniel went home with his precious handkerchief snugly stowed away in
-his pocket. He was saving it till evening when he promised himself the
-pleasure of reading it.
-
-After supper by the light of the open log fire he brought out his new
-possession.
-
-“What have you there, my son?” asked his father.
-
-“It is a handkerchief, father, with the Constitution of the United
-States printed on it.”
-
-“Where did you get it?”
-
-“At Master Hoyt’s store.”
-
-“Dan spent all his money for it,” said Ezekiel.
-
-“Well, well, he might have done worse. It will do him no harm to read
-the Constitution of his country,” said the father, gravely.
-
-Thus assured of his father’s approval, the boy devoted himself to
-the reading of that famous document, of which in after years he was
-to become the staunch supporter and defender. For this boy was in his
-manhood to rank among the great men of the earth, and to leave a name
-and a fame to which his countrymen for centuries to come will point
-with just and patriotic pride.
-
-This boy with slender form, swarthy face, and dark eyes, was Daniel
-Webster.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER II.
-
-DANIEL AND HIS FATHER.
-
-
-Daniel’s family had not lived many years at Elms Farm. Captain Webster
-first occupied a log house which he had himself built, and in this
-humble dwelling Ezekiel and one of his sisters were born. He was poor
-in worldly goods, but rich in children, having had ten born to him,
-five by the second marriage. Daniel was the youngest but one, and Sarah
-the youngest of all.
-
-When the war of the American Revolution broke out Daniel’s father was
-one of the first to take up arms. He himself drew up, and induced
-eighty-four of his townsmen to sign, the following patriotic pledge:
-
-“We do solemnly engage and promise that we will, to the utmost of our
-power, at the risk of our lives and fortunes, with arms, oppose the
-hostile proceedings of the British fleets and armies against the United
-American Colonies.”
-
-Daniel was proud of his descent from such a man, and in the last year
-of his life declared that “this is sufficient emblazonry for my arms;
-enough of heraldry for me.”
-
-Ebenezer Webster, Daniel’s father, is described as “a man of great
-firmness, whose bearing and manner were decisive; tall and erect, with
-a full chest, black hair and eyes, and rather large and prominent
-features.” He had never attended school, but his natural powers,
-supplemented by his own persistent efforts for education, qualified
-him for a high and influential place in the community in which he
-lived. But in one thing he was lacking, the ability to make money, and
-was obliged to practise the utmost frugality in his household. Though
-he filled various important positions, his compensation was of the
-smallest. He charged the town for important services but three or four
-shillings a day—a sum which even the most modest of office-holders
-nowadays would regard as quite beneath their acceptance.
-
-How he succeeded in wresting a subsistence for his large family from
-his sterile acres must remain a mystery. He was willing to live poorly,
-but there was one subject which cost him anxious thought. How was he
-to provide his family, and especially the two youngest boys, with the
-educational advantages which had been denied to him? There were no good
-schools near home, and without money he could not send his boys out of
-town to school.
-
-Help came in an unexpected way.
-
-One day the stalwart farmer entered his house with a look of
-satisfaction on his dark and rugged features.
-
-“Wife,” he said, “I have been appointed Judge of the Court of Common
-Pleas for the county.”
-
-“Indeed!” said his wife, naturally pleased at the honor which had been
-conferred upon her husband.
-
-“It will bring me three to four hundred dollars a year,” said Mr.
-Webster, “and now I can hope to educate my boys.”
-
-This was his first thought, and hers. It was not proposed to improve
-their style of living, to buy new furniture or new clothes, but to
-spend it in such a way as would best promote the interests of those
-whom God had committed to their keeping.
-
-Three or four hundred dollars! It was a very small sum, so most of my
-boy readers will think; and so it was, but in a farmer’s household on
-the bleak acres of New Hampshire it would go a considerable way. Every
-dollar in Ebenezer Webster’s hands brought its money’s worth, and as we
-shall see hereafter it brought rich interest to the investor.
-
-But Daniel was still too young for any immediate steps to be taken in
-the desired direction. He was sent to the small town schools, where he
-learned what the master was able to teach him. Sometimes he had two and
-a half and three miles to walk to school, but the farmer’s boy, though
-delicate, was not thought too delicate for such a walk. Indeed the
-boy’s delicacy was in his favor, for he was thought not robust enough
-to work on the farm steadily, and was sent to school, as an elder
-half-brother, Joseph, laughingly said, “to make him equal with the rest
-of the boys.” It was hard for those who saw him in later years, in his
-majestic proportions, to believe that he had been a delicate boy. The
-tender sapling had become a stately oak, with not a trace of feebleness
-or lack of strength.
-
-One day when Daniel was at work in the hayfield, about the middle of
-the forenoon, Judge Webster, for this was his designation now, saw a
-carriage approaching.
-
-“Some one to see you, father,” suggested Daniel.
-
-“Yes,” said his father, preparing to leave his work; “it is the
-Congressman from our district.”
-
-“What is his name?”
-
-“Hon. Abiel Foster, my son. He lives in Canterbury.”
-
-But the Congressman descended from his carriage and entered the field
-where Daniel and his father were at work. “Don’t let me interrupt you,
-Judge Webster,” said the visitor. “I merely wished to exchange a few
-words on public affairs.”
-
-Daniel was old enough to have some notion of the office of a
-Congressman and his duties, and he regarded the honorable gentleman
-with attention, and perhaps with reverent respect, though he is
-said not to have been endowed with more than average ability,
-notwithstanding he had been educated at college, and had once been a
-minister.
-
-When the conversation was over the Congressman got into his carriage
-and rode away. Judge Webster looked thoughtfully after him.
-
-Then he said to Daniel, “My son, that is a worthy man; he is a Member
-of Congress; he goes to Philadelphia, and gets six dollars a day, while
-I toil here. It is because he had an education which I never had. If I
-had had his early education I should have been in Philadelphia in his
-place. I came near it as it was. But I missed it, and now I must work
-here.”
-
-“My dear father,” answered Daniel, not without emotion, “you shall not
-work. Brother and I will work for you, and will wear our hands out, and
-you shall rest.”
-
-The boy was much moved, and his breast heaved, for he knew well how
-hard his father had toiled for him and for all the family.
-
-“My child,” said Judge Webster, “it is of no importance to me. I
-now live but for my children. I could not give your elder brothers
-the advantages of knowledge, but I can do something for you. Exert
-yourself, improve your opportunities, learn, learn, and when I am gone
-you will not need to go through the hardships which I have undergone,
-and which have made me an old man before my time.”
-
-These words made a profound impression upon the boy. A man’s character
-and life add weight to the words which he utters, and wise and
-judicious advice coming from a trifler or a shallow person falls often
-unheeded, and with reason. But Daniel knew how much his father had
-accomplished without education—he knew how high his rank was among his
-neighbors, and no man ever probably received from him a tithe of that
-reverence which he felt for his plain, unlettered parent.
-
-By this time he knew that his father had been largely instrumental in
-inducing New Hampshire to ratify that Constitution of which he obtained
-his first knowledge from the cheap cotton handkerchief which he had
-purchased at Master Hoyt’s store. The acceptance was by no means a
-foregone conclusion. Many of the delegates to the convention had been
-instructed to vote against acceptance, and among them Ebenezer Webster
-himself. But he obtained permission later to vote according to his
-own judgment, and the speech which he made in favor of this important
-action has been preserved. Just before the vote was taken, he rose and
-said:
-
-“Mr. President, I have listened to the arguments for and against the
-Constitution. I am convinced such a government as that Constitution
-will establish, if adopted—a government acting directly on the people
-of the States—is necessary for the common defence and the public
-welfare. It is the only government which will enable us to pay off
-the national debt—the debt which we owe for the Revolution, and which
-we are bound in honor fully and fairly to discharge. Besides, I have
-followed the lead of Washington through seven years of war, and I have
-never been misled. His name is subscribed to this Constitution. He will
-not mislead us now. I shall vote for its adoption.”
-
-No wonder that Daniel inherited from his father a reverent attachment
-for that Constitution which Judge Webster by word and deed had helped
-to secure and establish. His father was a grave and earnest man, but
-he was not stern nor ascetic. His strength was softened by good humor,
-and his massive features were often lighted up by a contagious laugh
-which endeared him to his family, who loved no less than they respected
-him.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER III.
-
-A MEMORABLE BATTLE.
-
-
-Daniel, as well as his father, had a love of fun, and a sportive humor,
-which he always preserved. It is said that “all work and no play makes
-Jack a dull boy.” It is certainly a mistake when a boy is shut out
-from the innocent sports which boys delight in. John Stuart Mill, who
-was set to learning while little more than an infant, and who actually
-began to study Greek at four years of age—lamented in after years that
-he had never known what boyhood was.
-
-It was not so with Daniel. Though his father’s poverty made it
-necessary for all to work, Daniel, partly because of his early
-delicacy, had plenty of time allowed him for amusement. The favorite
-companion of his leisure hours was not a boy, but a veteran soldier
-and near neighbor, named Robert Wise. He had built a little cottage
-in the corner of the Webster farm, and there with his wife he lived
-till extreme old age. He was born in Yorkshire, had fought on both
-sides in the Revolutionary struggle, had travelled in various parts
-of Europe, and had a thousand stories to tell, to all of which the
-boy listened with avidity. Though he had twice deserted from the
-English king, his heart still thrilled with pride when Daniel read
-to him from the newspaper accounts of battles in which the English
-arms were victorious. He had never learned to read, and Daniel became
-his favorite because he was always ready to read to him as they sat
-together at nightfall at the cottage door.
-
-“Why don’t you learn to read yourself, Robert?” asked Daniel one day.
-
-“It’s too late, Dan. I’m gettin’ an old man now, and I couldn’t do it.”
-
-“What will you do when I am grown up, and gone away?”
-
-“I don’t know, Dan. It will be dull times for me.”
-
-When that time came the old man picked up a fatherless boy, and gave
-him a home and a chance to secure an education, in order that he might
-have some one to read the newspaper to him.
-
-Whenever Daniel had a day or a few hours to himself he ran across the
-fields to his humble neighbor’s house.
-
-“Come, Robert,” he would say, “I’ve got nothing to do. Let us go
-fishing.”
-
-So the two would go down to the banks of the Merrimac, and embark in a
-boat which belonged to the old man, and paddle up and down the river,
-sometimes for an entire day. Daniel never lost his love of fishing, but
-in after years, when the cares of statesmanship were upon him, dressed
-in suitable style he would take his fishing pole and lie in wait for
-his finny victims, while perhaps he was mentally composing some one
-of his famous speeches, destined to thrill the hearts of thousands,
-or direct the policy of the government. These happy days spent in the
-open air corrected his native delicacy, and gradually imparted physical
-strength and vigor, and in time knit the vigorous frame which seemed a
-fitting temple for his massive intellect.
-
-Even the most trivial circumstances in the boyhood of such a man as
-Daniel Webster are noteworthy, and I am sure my boy-readers will read
-with interest and sympathy the account of a signal victory which the
-boy gained, though it was only over a feathered bully.
-
-Belonging to a neighbor was a cock of redoubtable prowess, a champion
-whose fame was in all the farmyards for miles around. One day Daniel,
-coming home from school, beheld with mortification the finish of
-a contest in which a favorite fowl of his own came off decidedly
-second best. The victorious rooster strutted about in conscious and
-complacent triumph.
-
-“It’s too bad, Zeke!” said Daniel in genuine vexation, as he saw the
-crestfallen look of his own vanquished fowl. “I should like to see that
-impudent bully get well whipped.”
-
-“There isn’t a rooster about here that can whip him, Dan.”
-
-“I know that, but he will meet his match some time.”
-
-“At any rate I’ll drive him away. He’ll have to run from me.”
-
-Dan picked up a stone, and pelted the victor out of the yard, but the
-feathered bully, even in his flight, raised a crow of victory which
-vexed the boy.
-
-“I’d give all the money I’ve got, Zeke, for a rooster that would whip
-him,” said Dan.
-
-There came a time when Daniel had his wish.
-
-He was visiting a relation at some distance when mention was made
-casually of a famous fighting cock who had never been beaten.
-
-“Where is he to be found?” asked the boy eagerly.
-
-“Why do you ask?”
-
-“I would like to see him,” said Dan.
-
-“Oh, well, he belongs to Mr.——.”
-
-“Where does he live?”
-
-The desired information was given.
-
-Shortly after Daniel was missed. He found his way to the farm where the
-pugnacious fowl resided. In the yard he saw the owner, a farmer.
-
-“Good morning, sir,” said Dan.
-
-“Good morning, boy. What can I do for you?” was the reply.
-
-“I hear you have a cock who is a famous fighter.”
-
-“Yes, he’s never been beaten yet!” said the farmer complacently.
-
-“Can I see him?”
-
-“There he is,” said the owner, pointing out the feathered champion.
-
-Daniel surveyed the rooster with great interest.
-
-“Will you sell him?” he asked.
-
-“I don’t know. Why do you want to buy him?”
-
-Daniel explained his object frankly.
-
-“How much are you willing to give?” asked the farmer, for he was a
-Yankee, and ready for a trade.
-
-Daniel drew from his pocket half a dollar. It represented his entire
-cash capital.
-
-“Here is half a dollar,” he said. “I’ll give you that.”
-
-“Haven’t you got anymore money?” asked the farmer, who had a keen scent
-for a bargain.
-
-“No, sir; it is all I have. I’d give you more if I had it.”
-
-Half a dollar in those days was a considerable sum of money,
-particularly in the eyes of a farmer, who handled very little money,
-his income being for the most part in the shape of corn, hay and
-vegetables. Having satisfied himself that it was all he could get, he
-gave a favorable answer to the boy’s application.
-
-Daniel’s eyes sparkled with delight, and he promptly handed over his
-fifty cent piece.
-
-“When do you want to take it?” asked the farmer.
-
-“Now,” answered Dan.
-
-“Very well.”
-
-The fowl was caught, and Daniel carried it back to the house of his
-relative in triumph.
-
-“I’m going home,” he said abruptly.
-
-“Going home? Why, you have only just come.”
-
-“I’ll come again soon, but I want to take this cock home, and see if he
-can’t whip Mr. ——-’s. I want to teach the little bully a lesson.”
-
-So in spite of all that could be said Daniel started on his way home.
-
-When he had gone a short distance he passed a yard stocked with
-poultry, where a large cock was strutting about defiantly, as if
-throwing down the gage of battle to any new comers.
-
-A boy was standing near the fence.
-
-“Will your cock fight?” asked Dan.
-
-“He can whip yours,” was the reply.
-
-“Are you willing to try it?”
-
-“Yes, come along.”
-
-The trial was made, and Dan’s new purchase maintained his reputation,
-by giving a sound drubbing to his feathered rival.
-
-Dan surveyed the result with satisfaction.
-
-“I guess he’ll do,” he said to himself.
-
-He kept on his way till he got within sight of home.
-
-“What brings you home so soon, Dan?” asked Zeke.
-
-“See here, Zeke!” said Dan eagerly.” Here is a cock that will whip Mr.
-——’s all to pieces.”
-
-“Don’t be too sure of it!”
-
-“I’ve tried him once, and he’s game.”
-
-The boys did not have long to wait for the trial.
-
-Over came the haughty intruder, strutting about with his usual boastful
-air.
-
-Dan let loose his new fowl, and a battle royal commenced. Soon the
-tyrant of the barnyard found that he had met a foe worthy of his
-spur. For a time the contest was an open one, but in ten minutes the
-feathered bully was ignominiously defeated, and led about by the comb
-in a manner as humiliating as had ever happened when he was himself the
-victor.
-
-Daniel witnessed the defeat of the whilom tyrant with unbounded
-delight, and felt abundantly repaid for his investment of all his spare
-cash, as well as the cutting short of his visit. Probably in the famous
-passage at arms which he had many years after with Mr. Hayne, of South
-Carolina, his victory afforded him less satisfaction than this boyish
-triumph.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER IV.
-
-AN IMPORTANT STEP.
-
-
-“What are you thinking about, Dan?” asked his mother one evening as the
-boy sat thoughtfully gazing at the logs blazing in the fireplace.
-
-“I was wishing for something to read,” answered the boy.
-
-Indeed that was his chief trouble in those early days. Libraries were
-scarce, and private collections equally scarce, especially in small
-country places. So the boy’s appetite for books was not likely to be
-satisfied.
-
-Daniel’s words attracted the attention of his father.
-
-“I have been speaking to some of our neighbors to-day,” he said, “about
-establishing a small circulating library which we could all use. I
-think we shall do something about it soon.”
-
-“I hope you will, father,” said Dan eagerly.
-
-“If we all contribute a little, we can make a beginning. Besides we can
-put in some books we have already.”
-
-A week or two later Judge Webster announced that the library had been
-established, and it may be easily supposed that Daniel was one of the
-first to patronize it. It was a small and, many of my boy friends
-would think, an unattractive collection. But in the collection was
-the “Spectator,” in reading which Daniel unconsciously did something
-towards forming a desirable style of his own. He was fond of poetry,
-and at an early age could repeat many of the psalms and hymns of Dr.
-Watts.
-
-There was another poem which so impressed him that he learned to repeat
-the whole of it. This was Pope’s “Essay on Man,” a poem which I fear
-is going out of fashion, which is certainly a pity, for apart from its
-literary merits it contains a great deal of sensible advice as to the
-conduct of life. As it is not of so much importance how much we read as
-how thoroughly, and how much we remember, there is reason to think that
-Daniel got more benefit from his four books than most of the boys of
-to-day from their multitude of books.
-
-Once, however, Daniel’s literary enthusiasm came near having serious
-consequences. A new almanac had been received, and as usual each of
-the months was provided with a couplet of poetry. After going to bed
-Daniel and Ezekiel got into a dispute about the couplet at the head
-of the April page, and in order to ascertain which was correct Dan
-got out of bed, went down stairs, and groped his way to the kitchen,
-where he lighted a candle and went in search of the almanac. He found
-it, and on referring to it ascertained that Ezekiel was right. His
-eagerness made him careless, and an unlucky spark from the candle set
-some cotton clothes on fire. The house would have been consumed but for
-the exertions and presence of mind of his father. It may be a comfort
-to some of my careless young readers to learn that so great a man as
-Daniel Webster occasionally got into mischief when he was a boy.
-
-Somewhere about this time a young lawyer, Mr. Thomas W. Thompson, came
-to Daniel’s native town and set up an office.
-
-As he was obliged to be absent at times, and yet did not wish to close
-his office, he proposed to Daniel to sit in his office and receive
-callers in his absence. Though boys do not generally take kindly to
-confinement, the office contained one attraction for the boy in a
-collection of books, probably of a miscellaneous character such as a
-young man is likely to pick up.
-
-Daniel’s time was not otherwise occupied, for he had no service to
-render, except to stay in the office and inform callers when Mr.
-Thompson would be back, and he was therefore at liberty to make use
-of the books. He made a selection unusual for a boy. There was an old
-Latin grammar, which the young lawyer had probably used himself in his
-preparatory course. This book Daniel selected, and began to study by
-himself. His employer offered to hear him recite in it, and soon had
-occasion to be surprised at the strong and retentive memory of his
-office boy. Probably none of the law books attracted the future lawyer.
-It would have been surprising if they had.
-
-“Judge Webster,” said Thompson, on meeting the father of his young
-employee, “Dan will make a fine scholar if he has the chance.”
-
-“I think the boy has ability.”
-
-“He certainly has. He ought to go to college.”
-
-Judge Webster shook his head.
-
-“I should like it above all things,” he said, “but I can’t see my way
-clear. I am a poor man, as you know, and it would cost a great deal of
-money to carry Dan through college even after he were prepared.”
-
-This was true, and the young lawyer was unprepared with any suggestion
-as to how the difficult matter was to be arranged. But Judge Webster
-did not forget the conversation. He was considering what could be
-done towards giving his promising son an education. He was willing to
-sacrifice his comfort, even, if thereby he could give him a good start
-in life.
-
-Finally he made up his mind to start him on the way, even if he were
-obliged to stop short before reaching the desired goal.
-
-Not far away was an institution which has since become famous, Exeter
-Academy, which has now for a century been doing an important work
-in preparing boys for our best colleges, and has always maintained
-a high standard of scholarship. Thither Judge Webster determined to
-take Daniel, and provide for his expenses by domestic self-denial.
-It was not till he had fully made up his mind that he announced his
-determination to the boy.
-
-“Dan,” he said one evening, “you must be up early to-morrow.”
-
-“Why, father?”
-
-Daniel supposed he was to be set at some farm work.
-
-“We are going to make a journey,” answered Judge Webster.
-
-“A journey!” repeated the boy in surprise. “Where are we going?”
-
-“I am going to take you to Exeter, to put you at school there.”
-
-The boy listened with breathless interest and delight, mingled perhaps
-with a little apprehension, for he did not know he would succeed in the
-untried scenes which awaited him.
-
-“Won’t it be expensive, father?” he asked after a pause, for he knew
-well his father’s circumstances, and was unusually considerate for a
-boy.
-
-“Yes, my son, but I look to you to improve your time, so that I may
-find my investment a wise one.”
-
-“How are we to go, father?”
-
-“On horseback.”
-
-Dan was a little puzzled, not knowing whether he and his father were
-to ride on one horse or not, as was a frequent custom at that time. It
-would have been hard upon any horse, for the judge was a man of weight,
-and the boy though light would have considerably increased the burden.
-
-The next morning Daniel’s curiosity was gratified. In front of the
-farmhouse stood two horses, one belonging to his father, the other
-filled out with a side-saddle.
-
-“Is that horse for me?” asked Daniel in surprise.
-
-“Yes, my son.”
-
-“What do I want of a side-saddle? I am not a lady.”
-
-“Neighbor —— is sending the horse to Exeter for the use of a lady who
-is to return here. I agreed to take charge of it, and it happens just
-right, as you can use it.”
-
-“I don’t know how I can get along with it. It will look strange for me
-to be riding on a lady’s saddle.”
-
-“If a lady can ride on it probably you can.”
-
-So Dan and his father set out on their journey from the quiet country
-town to Exeter, the boy mounted on a lady’s horse. When in his later
-life he had occasion to refer to this journey, Mr. Webster recalled
-with great merriment the figure he must have cut as he rode meekly
-behind his father.
-
-No doubt as they rode along father and son conversed together about the
-important step which had been taken. Judge Webster already had formed
-the plan of sending Daniel to college, after he should have completed a
-course of preparation at Exeter, but upon this part of his plan he did
-not think it best yet to speak to his son, very probably because he had
-not yet made up his mind as to whether his circumstances would allow
-him to incur so heavy an expense.
-
-“My son,” said the father gravely, “I hope you will improve to the
-utmost the advantages I am securing for you. You must remember how much
-depends upon yourself. A boy’s future is largely in his own hands.”
-
-“Yes, father, I will do the best I can.”
-
-“Mr. Thompson thinks you can make a good scholar.”
-
-“I will try, father.”
-
-“I shall have no money to leave you, Daniel, but I hope to give you an
-education, which is better than a fortune.”
-
-How would the father have been gratified if he could have foreseen the
-brilliant future in store for the boy of fourteen who was about to take
-his first important step in life.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER V.
-
-DANIEL AT EXETER ACADEMY.
-
-
-The principal of Exeter Academy at that time was Benjamin Abbot, LL.D.,
-a man of high repute in letters as well as in the educational field. He
-was a man of dignified presence, who exacted and received deference not
-only from his pupils but from all with whom he came in contact.
-
-“Dr. Abbot,” said Judge Webster, when the two were admitted to his
-presence, “I have brought my son Daniel to study in your institution,
-if you find him qualified.”
-
-The dignified principal turned towards the bashful boy, and said, “What
-is your age, sir?”
-
-“Fourteen,” answered Daniel.
-
-“I will examine you first in reading. Take this Bible, my lad, and read
-that chapter.”
-
-It was the twenty-second chapter of St. Luke’s Gospel, and was very
-well adapted as a test of the boy’s ability in reading.
-
-Now if there was anything Dan could do well it was this. He never
-could remember the time when he could not read. Probably he had learned
-from his mother, and his first text-book was the Bible. He was endowed
-with reverence, and his grave, sonorous voice was especially well
-fitted for sacred reading.
-
-The boy took the book and commenced the task prescribed. Usually a
-few verses are considered sufficient, but in this case the dignified
-listener became absorbed in the boy’s reading, and he listened, half
-forgetful of the object he had in view. It is a good deal to say that
-he actually enjoyed it. He had seldom listened to a voice at once so
-rich, deep and sonorous as belonged to this young boy of fourteen.
-Daniel, too, forgot that he was on trial, and read with his whole soul
-intent upon the words before him.
-
-When he had completed the chapter Dr. Abbot said, abruptly, “You are
-qualified to enter this institution.”
-
-This was all the examination which in his case was required.
-
-It was no common school that Daniel had entered, as is shown by the
-list of eminent men who have gone forth from it. George Bancroft,
-Edward Everett, Alexander H. Everett, Lewis Cass, Levi Woodbury, John
-E. Palfrey and others received here the first rudiments of their
-classical education, and all of them looked back with affection to
-their Alma Mater. But without derogating from the fame of any of these
-eminent men, it may surely be said that in Daniel Webster not only
-Exeter but Dartmouth College boasts its greatest alumnus.
-
-Daniel soon vindicated the good judgment of Dr. Abbot in admitting him
-as a pupil. As to the manner in which he improved the advantages which
-his father’s self-denial had secured to him, I quote the testimony of
-Dr. Tefft in his interesting life of Webster:
-
-“During the nine months of his stay at Exeter he accomplished as much
-for himself, according to every account, as most young gentlemen could
-have accomplished in two years. When he left he had as thoroughly
-mastered grammar, arithmetic, geography and rhetoric, as the majority
-of college graduates usually have done after a full collegiate course.
-He had also made rapid progress in the study of the Latin language. Dr.
-Abbot, fully appreciating the capacity of his most remarkable pupil,
-did not tie him down to the ordinary routine of study, nor compel him
-to lag behind with the other pupils, but gave him free scope and a
-loose rein, that he might do his utmost; and the venerable preceptor,
-after the lapse of more than half a century, during all which time he
-continued to be a teacher, declared on a public occasion that Daniel
-Webster’s equal in the power of amassing knowledge he had never seen,
-and never expected to see again.
-
-“It is not enough to say of him, according to Dr. Abbot’s description
-of him at this time, that he had a quick perception and a memory
-of great tenacity and strength. He did not seem barely to read and
-remember, as other people do. He appeared, rather, to grasp the
-thoughts and facts given by his author with a peculiar force, to
-incorporate them into his mental being, and thus make them a part of
-himself. It is said of Sir Isaac Newton, after reading for the first
-time the geometry of Euclid, and on being asked what he thought of
-it, that he knew it all before. He understood geometry, it seems, by
-intuition, or by a perception so rapid that it seems like intuition;
-but it was also true of the great astronomer that he had great
-difficulty in remembering even his own calculations after he had gone
-through with them. Daniel Webster, on the other hand, though endowed
-with a very extraordinary quickness of insight, worked harder for
-his knowledge than did Newton; but when once he had gained a point,
-or learned a fact, it remained with him, a part of his own essence,
-forever afterwards. His mind was also wonderfully fertile. A single
-truth, which, with most boys of his age, would have remained a single
-truth, in him became at once a starting-point for a remarkable series
-of ideas, original and striking, growing up out of the seed sown by
-that mighty power of reflection, in which no youth of his years,
-probably, was ever his superior.”
-
-At that time an assistant in the school was Joseph S. Buckminster,
-who later became an eminent preacher in Boston, and died while yet a
-young man. He was very young at the time, a mere boy, yet such were
-his attainments, and such was the confidence reposed in him by his old
-teachers, that he was selected to fill the position of tutor. He it
-was who first directed the studies of the new scholar, and encouraged
-the bashful boy to do his best. In after life Webster never displayed
-timidity or awkwardness; but, fresh from the farm, thrown among a
-hundred boys, most of whom were better dressed and more used to society
-than he, he felt at times awkward and distrustful. One thing he found
-it hard to do was to declaim. This is certainly singular, considering
-how he excelled in reading, and considering moreover what an orator he
-afterwards became.
-
-It was not because he did not try. He committed more than one piece
-to memory, and recited it to himself out loud in the solitude of his
-own room, but when the time came to get up and declaim it before the
-teacher and his schoolmates he was obliged to give it up. Here is his
-own account of it:
-
-“Many a piece did I commit to memory, and rehearse in my own room over
-and over again; but when the day came, when the school collected, when
-my name was called, and I saw all eyes turned upon my seat, I could not
-raise myself from it. Sometimes the masters frowned, sometimes they
-smiled. Mr. Buckminster always pressed and entreated with the most
-winning kindness that I would venture only _once_; but I could not
-command sufficient resolution, and when the occasion was over I went
-home and wept tears of bitter mortification.”
-
-This is certainly encouraging for bashful boys. Here was a man who
-became one of the greatest orators—perhaps _the_ greatest—and yet as a
-boy he made an ignominious failure in the very department in which he
-afterwards excelled. It is a lesson for parents also. Don’t too hastily
-conclude that your boys are dunces, and destined to failure, because
-they develop late, or are hindered from making a creditable figure by
-timidity or nervous self-consciousness.
-
-In this connection I am tempted to repeat an anecdote of Sir Walter
-Scott. It was not till comparatively late that he discovered his
-poetical ability. It is related of him that when already a young man
-he was rowing with a friend on a Scotch lake, when they mutually
-challenged each other to produce a few lines of poetry. Both made
-the trial, and both failed. Thereupon Scott said good-humoredly to
-his companion, “It’s clear neither of us was cut out for a poet.”
-Yet within ten years appeared the first of those Border poems which
-thrilled the hearts of his countrymen, and have lent a charm to the
-hills and lakes of Scotland which they will never lose.
-
-Daniel remained nine months at Exeter. Though he did not win reputation
-as a declaimer, he made his mark as a scholar. When he was approaching
-the end of his first term the usher said one day, “Webster, you may
-stop a few minutes after school; I wish to speak to you.”
-
-Daniel stopped, wondering whether in any way he had incurred censure.
-
-When they were alone the usher said, “The term is nearly over. Are you
-coming back next term?”
-
-Daniel hesitated. He enjoyed the advantages which the school afforded,
-but his feelings had been hurt at times by the looks of amusement
-directed at his rustic manners and ill-fitting garments.
-
-The usher noticed his hesitation, and said, “You are doing yourself
-great credit. You are a better scholar than any in your class. If you
-come back next term I shall put you into a higher class.”
-
-These encouraging words made the boy resolve to return, and regardless
-of ridicule pursue with diligence the path which had been marked out
-for him.
-
-It would be rather interesting to read the thoughts of Daniel’s
-schoolmates when years afterwards they saw the boy whom they had
-ridiculed moving forward with rapid strides to the foremost place in
-the councils of state, as well as in the legal profession.
-
-I am tempted to insert here, on the authority of an Exeter
-correspondent of the Chicago _Advance_, an anecdote of Daniel at this
-period which will interest my young readers:
-
-“When Daniel Webster’s father found that his son was not robust enough
-to make a successful farmer, he sent him to Exeter to prepare for
-college, and found a home for him among a number of other students in
-the family of ‘old Squire Clifford,’ as we of a younger generation
-had always heard him called. Daniel had up to this time led only the
-secular life of a country farmer’s boy, and, though the New Hampshire
-farmers have sent out many heroes as firm and true as the granite rocks
-in the pasture, there cannot be among the hard and homely work which
-such a life implies the little finenesses of manner which good society
-demands. Daniel was one of these diamonds of the first water, but was
-still in the rough, and needed some cutting and polishing to fit him to
-shine in the great world in which he was to figure so conspicuously.
-
-“None saw this more clearly than the sensible old Squire. The boy had
-one habit at table of which the Squire saw it would be a kindness to
-cure him. When not using his knife and fork he was accustomed to hold
-them upright in his fists, on either side of his plate. Daniel was a
-bashful boy of very delicate feelings, and the Squire feared to wound
-him by speaking to him directly on the subject. So he called aside one
-of the other students with whom he had been longer acquainted, and told
-him his dilemma. ‘Now,’ said he, ‘I want you this noon at the table to
-hold up your knife and fork as Daniel does. I will speak to you about
-it, and we will see if the boy does not take a hint for himself.’
-
-“The young man consented to be the scapegoat for his fellow-student,
-and several times during the meal planted his fists on the table, with
-his knife and fork as straight as if he had received orders to present
-arms. The Squire drew his attention to his position, courteously begged
-his pardon for speaking of the matter, and added a few kind words
-on the importance of young men correcting such little habits before
-going out into the world. The student thanked him for his interest and
-advice, and promised reform, and Daniel’s knife and fork were never
-from that day seen elevated at table.”
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER VI.
-
-PREPARING FOR COLLEGE.
-
-
-After nine months spent at Exeter Daniel was withdrawn by his father,
-not from any dissatisfaction with the school or with the pupil’s
-progress, but probably for economical reasons. Judge Webster was a poor
-man, and though the charges at Exeter at that time were very moderate
-they were a heavy draft upon the good father’s purse. But Dan was not
-taken back to farm-work. He was allowed to continue his classical
-studies, but under different auspices.
-
-In the town of Boscawan, only six miles off, the minister, Rev. Samuel
-Wood, was noted for his success in preparing boys for college. His
-charges, too, were wonderfully low. For board and instruction he only
-charged one dollar per week, which leads us to infer either that
-provisions were very cheap, or that boys had less appetite than is the
-case now. At any rate, the low price was a great inducement to Dan’s
-father.
-
-“Dan,” he said, soon after the boy came, “do you wish to continue your
-studies?”
-
-“Yes, father, if you are willing.”
-
-“I am not only willing but desirous that you should do so. I intend to
-place you with Rev. Mr. Wood, of Boscawen.”
-
-Daniel knew of Mr. Wood’s reputation as a teacher, and the prospect did
-not displease him.
-
-Still his father had not announced the plan he had in view for him.
-
-One cold winter day, when the snow lay deep on the ground, Judge
-Webster and Dan started for the house of his future teacher. As they
-were ascending a hill slowly through deep snows the Judge, who had for
-some time been silent, said, “Dan, I may as well tell you what plan I
-have in view for you. I shall ask Mr. Wood to prepare you for college,
-and I will let you enter at Dartmouth as soon as you are ready.”
-
-Daniel could not speak for emotion. He knew what a sacrifice it would
-involve for his father with his straitened means to carry through such
-a plan as that, and his heart was full. As he himself says, “A warm
-glow ran all over me, and I laid my head on my father’s shoulder and
-wept.”
-
-I am afraid that some boys—possibly some of my young readers—have
-received a similar announcement from their fathers with quite different
-feelings.
-
-We are to imagine Dan, then, an inmate of the minister’s family,
-pursuing his studies with success, but with less of formal restraint
-than when he was a pupil at Exeter. Indeed I shall not attempt
-to conceal the fact that occasionally Dan’s love of sport, and
-particularly of fishing, drew him away from his studies, and led him to
-incur the good doctor’s remonstrances.
-
-One day after a reprimand, which was tempered, however, by a compliment
-to his natural abilities, Daniel determined to surprise his teacher.
-
-The task assigned him to prepare was one hundred lines of Virgil, a
-long lesson, as many boys would think. Daniel did not go to bed, but
-spent all night in poring over his book.
-
-The next day, when the hour for recitation came, Dan recited his lesson
-with fluency and correctness.
-
-“Very well,” said Dr. Wood, preparing to close the book.
-
-“But, doctor, I have a few more lines that I can recite.”
-
-“Very well,” said Mr. Wood, supposing that Dan might have read
-twenty-five or thirty lines more. But the boy kept on till he had
-completed a second hundred.
-
-“Really, Dan, I compliment you on your industry,” said his teacher,
-again about to close the book.
-
-“But,” said Dan, “I have studied further.” “Very remarkable,” said the
-minister in surprise; “well, let us have them.”
-
-Dan rolled off another hundred lines, which he appeared to know quite
-as well as the previous two hundred.
-
-“You are a smart boy!” said the doctor approvingly, and not without a
-feeling of relief, for it is rather tedious to listen critically to the
-translation of three hundred lines.
-
-“But,” said Dan, “I am not through yet.”
-
-“Pray how much have you read?” asked Dr. Wood in amazement.
-
-“I can recite five hundred more if you like,” said Dan, his eyes
-twinkling with enjoyment at the doctor’s surprise.
-
-“I think that will do for to-day,” said Dr. Wood. “I don’t think I
-shall have time to hear them now. You may have the rest of the day for
-pigeon shooting.”
-
-Indeed Dan was always fond of sport, and not particularly fond of
-farm-work. My boy reader may like to read an anecdote of this time,
-which I will give in the very words in which Daniel told it to some
-friends at a later day.
-
-While at Dr. Wood’s, “my father sent for me in haying time to help
-him, and put me into a field to turn hay, and left me. It was pretty
-lonely there, and, after working some time, I found it very dull; and,
-as I knew my father was gone away, I walked home, and asked my sister
-Sally if she did not want to go and pick some whortleberries. She said
-yes. So I went and got some horses, and put a side-saddle on one, and
-we set off. We did not get home till it was pretty late, and I soon
-went to bed. When my father came home he asked my mother where I was,
-and what I had been about. She told him. The next morning when I awoke
-I saw all the clothes I had brought from Dr. Wood’s tied up in a small
-bundle again. When I saw my father he asked me how I liked haying. I
-told him I found it ‘pretty dull and lonesome yesterday.’ ’Well,’ said
-he, ‘I believe you may as well go back to Dr. Wood’s.’ So I took my
-bundle under my arm, and on my way I met Thomas W. Thompson, a lawyer
-in Salisbury; he laughed very heartily when he saw me. ‘So,’ said he,
-’your farming is over, is it?’”
-
-It will occur to my readers that, as Judge Webster was struggling so
-earnestly to give Dan an education, it would have been more considerate
-for the boy to have remained at his task, and so saved his father
-the trouble of finishing it. However, it is not my intention to
-present the boy as in all respects a model, though it is certain
-that he appreciated and was thoroughly grateful for his father’s
-self-sacrificing devotion.
-
-On one occasion Dan was set to mowing. He did not succeed very well.
-
-“What is the matter, Dan?” asked his father.
-
-“My scythe does not _hang_ well,” answered Dan, an answer which will be
-understood by country boys.
-
-His father took the scythe and tried to remedy the difficulty, but when
-it was handed back to Dan, it worked no better.
-
-“I think you had better hang it to suit yourself, Dan,” said his father.
-
-With a laughing face Dan hung it on the branch of a tree, and turning
-to his father said, “There, that is just right.”
-
-On another occasion Judge Webster, on returning home, questioned the
-boys as to what they had been doing in his absence.
-
-“What have you been doing, Ezekiel?” asked his father.
-
-“Nothing, sir,” was the frank reply.
-
-“And you, Daniel, what have you been doing?”
-
-“_Helping Zeke, sir._”
-
-There is no doubt that Judge Webster was more indulgent than was usual
-in that day to his children, and more particularly to Daniel, of whose
-talents he was proud, and of whose future distinction he may have had
-in his mind some faint foreshadowing. This indulgence was increased
-by Dan’s early delicacy of constitution. At any rate, Daniel had in
-his father his best friend, not only kind but judicious, and perhaps
-the eminence he afterwards attained was due in part to the judicious
-management of the father, who earnestly sought to give him a good start
-in life.
-
-While at Boscawan Dan found another circulating library, and was able
-to enlarge his reading and culture. Among the books which it contained
-was an English translation of Don Quixote, and this seems to have had a
-powerful fascination for the boy. “I began to read it,” he says in his
-autobiography, “and it is literally true that I never closed my eyes
-until I had finished it, nor did I lay it down, so great was the power
-of this extraordinary book on my imagination.”
-
-Meanwhile Daniel was making rapid progress in his classical studies.
-He studied fitfully perhaps, but nevertheless rapidly. In the summer
-of 1797, at the age of fifteen, he was pronounced ready to enter
-college. His acquisitions were by no means extensive, for in those
-days colleges were content with a scantier supply of preparatory
-knowledge than now. In the ancient languages he had read the first six
-books of Virgil’s Æneid, Cicero’s four Orations against Catiline, a
-little Greek grammar, and the four Evangelists of the Greek Testament.
-In mathematics he had some knowledge of arithmetic, but knew nothing
-of algebra or geometry. He had read a considerable number of books,
-however, enough to give him a literary taste, but he was by no means
-a prodigy of learning. Yet, slender as were his acquirements, his
-school life was at an end, and the doors of Dartmouth College opened to
-receive its most distinguished son.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER VII.
-
-DANIEL’S COLLEGE LIFE.
-
-
-It is all important point in a boy’s life when he enters college. He
-leaves home, in most cases, and, to a greater extent than ever before,
-he is trusted to order his own life and rely upon his own judgment.
-It is a trying ordeal, and many fail to pass through it creditably. A
-student who has plenty of money is in greater danger of wasting his
-time from the enlarged opportunities of enjoyment which money can buy.
-From this danger, at least, Daniel was free. His father found it hard
-enough to pay his ordinary expenses, and it is hardly likely that the
-boy ever had much spare money to spend on pleasure.
-
-Besides, though only fifteen, Daniel already possessed a gravity and
-earnestness not often to be found in much older students. These,
-however, were blended with a humor and love of fun which contributed to
-make him an agreeable companion for his fellow-students.
-
-Daniel’s development was not rapid. The oak tree grows steadily, but in
-rapidity of growth it is eclipsed by many trees of less importance.
-The great powers which our hero exhibited in after life did not at once
-make themselves manifest. He did not at once take his place proudly at
-the head of his class. This is shown by the fact that at the Sophomore
-exhibition neither of the two principal appointments was assigned to
-him. Notwithstanding this, it may safely be asserted that his time
-was well spent. In this connection I am sure my young readers will be
-interested in reading the testimony of Professor Shortliff.
-
-“Mr. Webster, while in college,” writes the professor, “was remarkable
-for his steady habits, his intense application to study, and his
-punctual attendance upon all the prescribed exercises. I know not that
-he was absent from a recitation, or from morning and evening prayers
-in the chapel, or from public worship on the Sabbath; and I doubt if
-ever a smile was seen upon his face during any religious exercise. He
-was always in his place, and with a decorum suited to it. He had no
-collision with any one, nor appeared to enter into the concerns of
-others, but emphatically minded his own business. But, as steady as the
-sun, he pursued with intense application the great object for which he
-came to college.”
-
-This is certainly high praise, and I am afraid such words could hardly
-be said with truth of the majority of the college students of to-day.
-Conscientious devotion to duty is often set down by college students
-as indicating a lack of proper spirit, and the punctilious scholar is
-often stigmatized as a toady, who is trying to curry favor with the
-Faculty. Daniel, however, understood very well how important to his
-future success was his improvement of the advantages which his father’s
-self-sacrifice had purchased for him. Judge Webster was obliged to
-mortgage his house and farm to meet the expenses incurred by Daniel’s
-education, and he would indeed have been most reprehensible if he had
-not constantly borne this in mind.
-
-To go into details, Daniel’s favorite studies were the Latin and Greek
-classics. He was but slenderly versed in these languages when he
-entered college, and the college course was not as advanced as it is at
-Dartmouth to-day. The first year, and part of the second, was devoted
-to authors and studies which now receive attention before entrance.
-For instance, the Freshman class went on with the Seventh Book of the
-Æneid and with the remainder of the Greek Testament, arithmetic was
-continued, and algebra was begun. While he was not below the average
-in mathematics, Daniel certainly did not excel in that department.
-It is related of Charles Sumner that he made strenuous efforts to
-become a good mathematical scholar in spite of, perhaps because of,
-his conscious distaste for that important branch, but without marked
-success. General reading and composition always attracted him, and he
-was probably one of the best read students at the time in college. He
-devoted his leisure hours to extensive readings in poetry, history and
-criticism. His powerful and retentive memory made this voluntary course
-of especial value, and years later there were times when he was able to
-make happy and striking quotations from authors he had not read since
-his college life.
-
-It is quite certain that Daniel at this time had no path marked out for
-his future life, yet he probably could not have made a more profitable
-preparation for that which actually lay before him than that which he
-was unconsciously making. The history of England and of his own country
-especially interested him, not alone the history of outward events, but
-the constitutional history. From the age of eight he had been familiar
-with the Constitution of the United States, read for the first time as
-printed on the cheap cotton handkerchief, of which mention has already
-been made. He never ceased to study it, and he well deserved the title
-sometimes given him of Expounder and Defender of the Constitution.
-
-At that time, as at present, it was the custom for the students to
-form societies, in which debates and other literary exercises were
-the principal features of the periodical meetings. Towards the middle
-of his college course Daniel joined “The United Fraternity,” then the
-leading society in college. He had long since overcome the diffidence
-which at Exeter prevented him from participating in the exercise of
-declamation. In the society he became distinguished both as a writer
-and debater, and ere long ranked in the general estimation as the best
-writer and speaker in college. So far as he exhibited precocity in
-anything he showed it in these two branches. His method of preparation,
-for he always prepared himself when he proposed to speak, is described
-by a classmate as follows: “He was accustomed to arrange his thoughts
-in his mind in his room or his private walks, and to put them upon
-paper just before the exercise would be called for. When he was
-required to speak at two o’clock, he would frequently begin to write
-after dinner, and when the bell rang he would fold his paper, put it in
-his pocket and go in, and speak with great ease. In his movements he
-was rather slow and deliberate, except when his feelings were aroused;
-then his whole soul would kindle into a flame.”
-
-As this was the formative period when young Webster’s intellectual
-character was taking shape; as, moreover, he was still a boy in years,
-no older than many who will read this book, I add another tribute to
-his industry in college and the ability which he displayed. It is from
-a letter written by Hon. Henry Hubbard to Prof. Sanborn.
-
-“I entered the Freshman class in 1799,” writes Mr. Hubbard, “at the
-early age of fourteen. I was two years in college with Mr. Webster.
-When I first went to Hanover I found his reputation already established
-as the most remarkable young man in the college. He was, I believe, so
-decidedly beyond any one else that no other student of his class was
-ever spoken of as _second_ to him. I was led, very soon, to appreciate
-most highly his scholarship and attainments. As a student his
-acquisitions seemed to me to be very extensive. Every subject appeared
-to contribute something to his intellectual stores. He acquired
-knowledge with remarkable facility. He seemed to grasp the meaning
-and substance of a book almost by intuition. Others toiled long and
-patiently for that which he acquired at a glance.
-
-“As a scholar, I should say that he was then distinguished for
-the uncommon extent of his knowledge, and for the ease with which
-he acquired it. But I should say that I was more impressed by his
-eloquence and power as a speaker, before the society of which we were
-both members, than by his other qualifications, however superior to
-others. There was a completeness and fullness in his views, and a
-force and expressiveness in his manner of presenting them, which no
-other student possessed. We used to listen to him with the deepest
-interest and respect, and no one thought of equaling the vigor and
-glow of his eloquence. The oration which he delivered before the
-United Fraternity on the day of his graduation is, I think, now among
-the records of that society. Whoever will read it at this late day,
-and bring to mind the appearance of the author, his manner and power,
-during its delivery, cannot fail to admit that I have said no more
-of his eloquence than I was warranted in saying. The students, and
-those who knew him best and judged him most impartially, felt that no
-one connected with the college deserved to be compared with him at
-the time he received his first degree. His habits and moral character
-were entirely unimpeachable. I never heard them questioned during our
-college acquaintance.”
-
-After this testimony I am certainly justified in holding up Daniel
-Webster, during his college life, as a fit model for all young men who
-at this day are placed in similar circumstances and pursuing a similar
-course.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER VIII.
-
-DANIEL RECEIVES SOME VALUABLE ADVICE
-
-
-Peter Harvey, in his interesting volume of “Reminiscences of Daniel
-Webster,” relates many incidents for which he was indebted to the free
-and friendly communications of Mr. Webster himself. One of these I will
-transfer to my pages, as it will be likely to amuse my young readers.
-I can do no better than quote it without alteration from Mr. Harvey’s
-book.
-
-“Mr. Webster was once telling me about a plain-spoken neighbor of
-his father, whose sons were schoolmates of his own. The neighbor had
-moved into the neighborhood of Hanover, where he had opened a little
-clearing, and had settled upon a piece of comparatively barren land.
-After Daniel had been in college several months his father said to him,
-
-“‘John Hanson is away up there somewhere. I should like to know how he
-is getting along. I think you had better find him out, and go and see
-him.’
-
-“So Daniel inquired about, and soon found out pretty nearly where
-Hanson lived.
-
-“‘One Saturday afternoon,’ related Mr. Webster, ’I thought I would
-trudge up there through the woods, and spend Sunday with my old
-friends. After a long, tedious walk I began to think I should never
-find the place; but I finally did, and when I got there I was pretty
-well tired out with climbing, jumping over logs, and so on. The family
-were not less delighted than surprised to see me, but they were as poor
-as Job’s cat. They were reduced to the last extreme of poverty, and
-their house contained but one apartment, with a rude partition to make
-two rooms.
-
-“’I saw how matters were; but it was too late to go back, and they
-seemed really glad to see me. They confessed to me that they had
-not even a cow, or any potatoes. The only thing they had to eat was
-a bundle of green grass and a little hog’s lard, and they actually
-subsisted on this grass fried in the hog’s fat. But it was not so bad
-after all. They fried up a great platter of it, and I made my supper
-and breakfast off it. About a year and a half afterwards, just before
-graduating, I thought that, before leaving Hanover, I would go and pay
-another visit to the Hansons. I found that they had improved somewhat,
-for they now had a cow and plenty of plain, homely fare. I spent the
-night there, and was about to leave the next morning, when Hanson said
-to me,
-
-“’“Well, Daniel, you are about to graduate. You’ve got through college,
-and have got college larnin’, and now, what are you going to do with
-it?”
-
-“’I told him I had not decided on a profession.
-
-“’“Well,” said he, “you are a good boy; your father was a kind man
-to me, and was always kind to the poor. I should like to do a kind
-turn to him and his. You’ve got through college, and people that go
-through college either become ministers, or doctors, or lawyers. As
-for bein’ a minister I would never think of doin’ that; they never get
-paid anything. Doctorin’ is a miserable profession; they live upon
-other people’s ailin’s, are up nights, and have no peace. And as for
-bein’ a lawyer, I would never propose that to anybody. Now,” said he,
-“Daniel, I’ll tell you what! You are a boy of parts; you understand
-this book-larnin’, and you are bright. I knew a man who had college
-larnin’ down in Rye, where I lived when I was a boy. That man was a
-conjurer; he could tell by consultin’ his books and study if a man had
-lost his cow where she was. That was a great thing, and if people lost
-anything, they would think nothin’ of payin’ three or four dollars to
-a man like that, so as to find their property. There is not a conjurer
-within a hundred miles of this place; and you are a bright boy, and
-have got this college larnin’. The best thing you can do, Daniel, is to
-study that, and _be a conjurer_!”’”
-
-We can imagine the serious, earnest tone in which this advice was
-given, and we may easily suppose that Daniel found it hard not to
-laugh when the climax was reached. We can hardly imagine the advice to
-have been taken. If, in place of Daniel Webster, the great lawyer, and
-the defender of the Constitution, we had Daniel Webster, the famous
-conjurer, it would be a ludicrous transformation. There are few persons
-who do not consider themselves qualified to give advice, but when my
-young readers are advised about the serious business of life, let them
-consider whether the advice comes from one who is qualified by wisdom
-and good judgment to give it.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER IX.
-
-BROTHERLY LOVE.
-
-
-Daniel’s path seemed to lie plain before him. He was a college student,
-receiving and using such advantages as Dartmouth could give him. At
-nineteen he would be a graduate, and well qualified to commence a
-professional course. So far as he was concerned Daniel felt that he had
-reason to congratulate himself. But there was another for whom he began
-to feel solicitude.
-
-Ezekiel Webster was nearly two years older than Daniel, and like him
-possessed uncommon natural gifts. A strong affection had united the two
-brothers from their earliest years. There was no reason, apart from
-Judge Webster’s poverty, why Ezekiel, as well as his younger brother,
-should not be allowed a college education. But the father hesitated
-long before he ventured to offer Daniel the education which he longed
-to give him, and to raise the necessary money was obliged to mortgage
-his humble house. His plan for Ezekiel was that he should remain at
-home and carry on the farm. As he grew older, and hard work had made
-him in his own words “old before his time,” he felt that it would
-be a relief to have a son like Ezekiel to take the burden from his
-shoulders, and keep up the farm. But Ezekiel scarcely more than Daniel
-had a vocation for farming. He too had a thirst for learning, and felt
-that a farmer’s life would be uncongenial. It is natural that he should
-have felt dissatisfied with his prospects, and that the claims of Duty
-which he recognized should nevertheless have seemed to him difficult to
-obey.
-
-Such was the state of feeling when Daniel came home on a vacation. To
-him Ezekiel revealed his thoughts and inward struggles.
-
-“I ought to stay, Daniel,” he said; “now that you are away father
-needs me more than ever, but I can’t bear the idea of growing up in
-ignorance, with no work more elevating than working on the farm.”
-
-Daniel was touched. He could see how unequal their lots were likely
-to be. While he might be a successful lawyer, his favorite brother,
-whose talents he considered to equal his own, would have to toil on the
-barren acres of their paternal farm.
-
-“I can’t bear the idea, either, Zeke,” he answered. “You are
-sacrificing yourself to me. Father has mortgaged the farm to pay my
-expenses, and you are working to pay it.”
-
-“If but one of us can have an education, Dan, I am glad that you are
-that one.”
-
-“But, Zeke, you are as smart as I, nay, smarter, and ought to have the
-same advantages.”
-
-“It cannot be, Daniel. I know that well enough. If I could be spared to
-leave home I should like to go out West. In a new part of the country I
-should have a better chance of getting on than here. Here on our barren
-little farm there is no chance to do better than get a bare living.”
-
-“I wish you could go to college too. Isn’t there some way of managing
-it?”
-
-“I have thought of it many times, but I see no way,” answered Ezekiel
-despondently.
-
-“May I mention the subject to father, Zeke?”
-
-“It would only trouble him, and after all it would do no good.”
-
-All night long the two brothers talked the matter over, and finally
-Zeke gave his consent to Dan’s broaching the subject to their father.
-The result I will give in Daniel’s words.
-
-“I ventured on the negotiation, and it was carried, as other things
-often are, by the earnest and sanguine manner of youth. I told him
-[Judge Webster] that I was unhappy at my brother’s prospects. For
-myself I saw my way to knowledge, respectability and self-protection;
-but as to him, all looked the other way; that I would keep school,
-and get along as well as I could, be more than four years in getting
-through college, if necessary, provided he also could be sent to study.
-He said at once he lived but for his children; that he had but little,
-and on that little he put no value, except so far as it might be useful
-to them; that to carry us both through college would take all he was
-worth; that, for himself, he was willing to run the risk, but that this
-was a serious matter to our mother and two unmarried sisters; that we
-must settle the matter with them, and if their consent was obtained, he
-would trust to Providence, and get along as well as he could.”
-
-So the matter was referred to Mrs. Webster, and she showed a devotion
-equal to that exhibited by her husband. Though she knew that the
-education of both of her boys would take the balance of their little
-property, she never hesitated. “I will trust the boys,” she answered
-promptly.
-
-Her confidence was not misplaced. She lived long enough to rejoice in
-the success of both sons, and to find a happy and comfortable home
-with Ezekiel. Nothing in the life of Daniel Webster is more beautiful
-than the devotion of the parents to their children, and the mutual
-affection which existed between them.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER X.
-
-THE TWO BROTHERS.
-
-
-Ezekiel was worthy of the sacrifices his parents made for him. If he
-was not the equal of Daniel in ability, he was still remarkable, and
-in time reached high rank as a lawyer in his native State. He was a
-man grown, and nearly a man in years, when his new plan of life was
-formed. He was close upon twenty years of age, a young man of striking
-appearance, “an improved edition of his father in form and features,”
-but thus far he had had only such educational advantages as were
-afforded by the common schools of his native town. But a small academy
-had been established in Salisbury, and of this he enrolled himself as a
-pupil. He remained here for two years, beginning the Latin grammar, for
-it was necessary, notwithstanding his age, to begin at the lowest round
-of the ladder.
-
-From the academy he went to reside with Dr. Wood, and under him
-completed his preparatory studies. The good minister was justly proud
-of having trained two such pupils as Daniel and Ezekiel Webster.
-
-Between the two brothers the natural relations of older and younger
-seemed to be reversed. Ezekiel looked up to Daniel, though the latter
-was two years his junior, and asked his advice, but Daniel never
-assumed the superiority which his elder brother was so ready to
-concede. Here is an extract from one of his letters: “You tell me that
-you have difficulties to encounter which I know nothing of. What do
-you mean, Ezekiel? Do you mean to flatter? That don’t become you; or,
-do you think you are inferior to me in natural advantages? If so, be
-assured you greatly mistake. Therefore, for the future say in your
-letters to me, ‘I am superior to you in natural endowments; I will know
-more in one year than you do now, and more in six than you ever will.’
-I should not resent this language. I should be very well pleased in
-hearing it; but be assured, as mighty as you are your great puissance
-shall never insure you a victory without a contest.”
-
-It will be seen how warm and free from jealousy were the relations
-between these two brothers. The spectacle is particularly pleasing
-because in so many families we find the case so different. Alienation,
-jealousy and strife are too often found. When brothers band together,
-cherishing a community of plans and interests, as in the case of the
-well-known publishers, the Harper brothers, their chance of a large
-and enduring success is much greater than it would be if all pulled in
-different directions.
-
-Ezekiel entered college just as Daniel, his younger brother, was
-leaving it. As he was destined to be associated with Daniel afterwards,
-my young readers may like to know how he succeeded in college. I quote,
-from the private correspondence of Daniel Webster, a letter written by
-Rev. George T. Chapman touching this point:
-
-“All my recollections of Ezekiel Webster are of a gratifying character.
-In the Senior year we occupied rooms opposite to each other, in a
-building directly north of the college. I am therefore able to state,
-from intimate personal acquaintance, that he was altogether exemplary
-in his habits and faithful in his studies. He had no enemies, and all
-were happy to be numbered in the list of his friends.
-
-“Owing to his absence in teaching school, no part was assigned him at
-Commencement. But I have no doubt he stood high in the estimation of
-the college Faculty; and although I should hesitate to pronounce him
-the first scholar in his class, it would be doing injustice to his
-memory to say that he was excelled by either of those who received
-the highest college honors on the day of our graduation. It has
-been recently stated that he was particularly distinguished for his
-knowledge of Greek; but I cannot now recall the circumstance to mind,
-nor, in fact, make any discrimination as to relative proficiency in
-the several branches of study. He was deficient in none. He was good
-in all. Such at least is my recollection of the reputation he enjoyed.
-After leaving college, from all that I have heard, he obtained a
-greater degree of eminence in the eye of the public than any of his
-classmates; and when I revert to college days, after the lapse of
-almost half a century, all my recollections of what he then was cause
-me to feel no surprise at the subsequent elevation which he attained.”
-
-I think I am justified in saying that Ezekiel was worthy of his
-relationship to Daniel, though he was overshadowed by the more
-brilliant talents and success of his younger brother. It is to be
-considered, however, that he was cut off in the midst of his career,
-before he had attained the age of fifty, and we cannot tell what might
-have been had he lived twenty years longer.
-
-But we must not forget that it is the life and the gradual development
-of Daniel’s powers that we are studying. My young readers will
-probably be surprised to learn that in college he was known as a poet,
-and appears to have written verse on many occasions with considerable
-facility. That he would ever have achieved eminence in this class of
-composition no one will claim, but as the productions of such a youth
-his verses merit notice. That my readers may judge for themselves, I
-will quote entire a letter in rhyme written by Daniel a little before
-he attained the age of seventeen. It was addressed to his friend,
-George Herbert:
-
- “DARTMOUTH COLLEGE, Dec. 20, 1798.
-
- “Dear George, I go. I leave the friend I love.
- Long since ’twas written in the books above.
- But what, good God! I leave thee, do I say?
- The thought distracts my soul, and fills me with dismay.
- But Heaven decreed it, let me not repine;
- I go; but, George, my heart is knit with thine.
- In vain old Time shall all his forces prove
- To tear my heart from the dear friend I love;
- Should you be distant far as Afric’s sand,
- By Fancy pictured, you’d be near at hand.
- This shall console my thoughts till time shall end:
- Though George be absent, George is still my friend.
- But other friends I leave; it wounds my heart
- To leave a Gilman, Conkey and a Clark;
- But hope through the sad thought my soul shall bear:
- Bereft of hope I’d sink in dark despair.
- When Phœbus a few courses shall have run,
- And e’er old Aries shall receive the sun,
- I shall return, nor more shall fear the day
- That from my friends shall take poor me away.
- Oh then roll on, ye lagging wheels of time,
- Roll on the hours; till then, dear George, I’m thine.
-
- “D. W.”
-
-Verse-writing was but an episode, an occasional diversion, with Daniel,
-and when he entered upon his professional life he found little time
-to devote to it. I will therefore cite but one other specimen of his
-college productions in this line. It was written shortly after his
-eighteenth birthday, and was appended to a letter written to his
-intimate friend, Mr. Bingham.
-
-It runs thus:
-
- “SYLVARUMQUE POTENS DIANA. A FABLE.
-
- “Bright Phœbus long all rival suns outshone,
- And rode triumphant on his splendid throne.
- When first he waked the blushes of the dawn,
- And spread his beauties o’er the flowery lawn,
- The yielding stars quick hastened from the sky,
- Nor moon dare longer with his glories vie;
- He reigned supreme, and decked in roseate light
- Beamed his full splendors on the astonished sight.
- At length on earth behold a damsel rise,
- Whose growing beauties charmed the wondering skies!
- As forth she walked to breathe the balmy air,
- And view the beauties of the gay parterre,
- Her radiant glories drowned the blaze of day,
- And through all nature shot a brighter ray.
- Old Phœbus saw—and blushed—now forced to own
- That with superior worth the damsel shone.
- Graced with his name he bade her ever shine,
- And in his rival owned a form divine!”
-
-One trait of the young college student I must refer to, because young
-men at that stage in their mental training are too apt to be marked by
-a self-sufficient and not altogether agreeable opinion of their own
-powers. Notwithstanding his great abilities Daniel was always modest,
-and disposed to under rather than overestimate himself. Shortly after
-his graduation he took occasion to express himself thus, in speaking to
-some friends:
-
-“The opinion of my scholarship was a mistaken one. It was
-overestimated. I will explain what I mean. Many other students read
-more than I did, and knew more than I did. But so much as I read I made
-my own. When a half hour, or an hour at most, had elapsed, I closed my
-book and thought over what I had read. If there was anything peculiarly
-interesting or striking in the passage I endeavored to recall it and
-lay it up in my memory, and commonly could effect my object. Then if,
-in debate or conversation afterwards, any subject came up on which I
-had read something, I could talk very easily so far as I had read, and
-then I was very careful to stop. Thus greater credit was given me for
-extensive and accurate knowledge than I really possessed.”
-
-It may be remarked generally that men of great abilities are more
-likely to be modest than third-rate men, who are very much afraid
-that they will not be rated as high as they should be. There are
-indeed exceptions, and those of a conspicuous character. The poet
-Wordsworth had a comfortable consciousness of his superiority to his
-contemporaries, and on one occasion, when he was asked if he had read
-the poems of such a one (a prominent poet), he answered, “I never read
-any poetry except my own.”
-
-It is a safe rule to let the world pronounce you great before you call
-attention to your own greatness.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XI.
-
-DANIEL AS AN ORATOR.
-
-
-The four years spent in college generally bear an important relation to
-the future success or non-success of the student. It is the formative
-period with most young men, that is, it is the time when the habits are
-formed which are to continue through life. Let us inquire, then, what
-did Daniel Webster’s college course do for him?
-
-We cannot claim that his attainments at graduation were equal to those
-of the most proficient graduates of our colleges to-day. The curriculum
-at Dartmouth, and indeed at all colleges, was more limited and
-elementary than at present. Daniel was a good Greek and Latin scholar
-for his advantages, but those were not great. He did, however, pay
-special attention to philosophical studies, and to the law of nations.
-He took an interest in current politics, as may be gathered from
-letters written in his college days, and was unconsciously preparing
-himself for the office of a statesman.
-
-He paid special attention also to oratory. No longer shrinking from
-speaking before his classmates, he voluntarily composed the pieces he
-declaimed, and took an active part besides in the debating society.
-I am sure my young reader will like to know how Daniel wrote at this
-time, and will like to compare the oratory of the college student with
-that of the future statesman. I shall, therefore, quote from a Fourth
-of July oration, which he delivered by invitation to the citizens
-and students at the age of eighteen. As in a boy’s features we trace
-a general likeness to his mature manhood, so I think we may trace a
-likeness in passages of this early effort to the speeches he made in
-the fullness of his fame.
-
-This is the opening of the address:
-
-“_Countrymen, Brethren and Fathers_: We are now assembled to celebrate
-an anniversary, ever to be held in dear remembrance by the sons of
-freedom. Nothing less than the birth of a nation, nothing less than the
-emancipation of three millions of people from the degrading chains of
-foreign bondage is the event we commemorate.
-
-“Twenty-four years have this day elapsed since these United States
-first raised the standard of liberty, and echoed the shouts of
-independence. Those of you who were then reaping the iron harvest of
-the martial field, whose bosoms then palpitated for the honor of
-America, will at this time experience a renewal of all that fervent
-patriotism, of all those indescribable emotions which then agitated
-your breasts. As for us, who were either then unborn, or not far enough
-advanced beyond the threshold of existence to engage in the grand
-conflict for liberty, we now most cordially unite with you to greet the
-return of this joyous anniversary, to welcome the return of the day
-that gave us freedom, and to hail the rising glories of our country.”
-
-Further on he paints the hardships and distresses through which the
-colonists had passed:
-
-“We behold a feeble band of colonists engaged in the arduous
-undertaking of a new settlement in the wilds of North America. Their
-civil liberty being mutilated, and the enjoyment of their religious
-sentiments denied them in the land that gave them birth, they braved
-the dangers of the then almost unnavigated ocean, and sought on the
-other side of the globe an asylum from the iron grasp of tyranny and
-the more intolerable scourge of ecclesiastical persecution.
-
-“But gloomy indeed was the prospect when arrived on this side of the
-Atlantic.
-
-“Scattered in detachments along a coast immensely extensive, at a
-distance of more than three thousand miles from their friends on
-the eastern continent, they were exposed to all those evils, and
-encountered or experienced all those difficulties, to which human
-nature seemed liable. Destitute of convenient habitations, the
-inclemencies of the seasons harassed them, the midnight beasts of prey
-howled terribly around them, and the more portentous yell of savage
-fury incessantly assailed them. But the same undiminished confidence
-in Almighty God, which prompted the first settlers of the country
-to forsake the unfriendly climes of Europe, still supported them
-under all their calamities, and inspired them with fortitude almost
-divine. Having a glorious issue to their labors now in prospect, they
-cheerfully endured the rigors of the climate, pursued the savage beast
-to his remotest haunt, and stood undismayed in the dismal hour of
-Indian battle.”
-
-Passing on to the Revolutionary struggle the young orator refers to
-“our brethren attacked and slaughtered at Lexington, our property
-plundered and destroyed at Concord,” to “the spiral flames of burning
-Charlestown,” and proceeds as follows:
-
-“Indelibly impressed on our memories still lives the dismal scene of
-Bunker’s awful mount, the grand theater of New England bravery, where
-slaughter stalked grimly triumphant, where relentless Britain saw her
-soldiers, the unhappy instruments of despotism, fallen in heaps beneath
-the nervous arm of injured freemen!
-
-“There the great Warren fought, and there, alas! he fell. Valuing his
-life only as it enabled him to serve his country, he freely resigned
-himself a willing martyr in the cause of liberty, and now lies
-encircled in the arms of glory.
-
- “’Peace to the patriot’s shade—let no rude blast
- Disturb the willow that nods o’er his tomb;
- Let orphan tears bedew his sacred urn,
- And fame’s proud trump proclaim the hero’s name
- Far as the circuit of the spheres extends!’
-
-“But, haughty Albion, thy reign shall soon be over. Thou shalt triumph
-no longer; thy empire already reels and totters; thy laurel even now
-begins to wither and thy fame to decay. Thou hast at length aroused the
-indignation of an insulted people; thy oppressions they deem no longer
-tolerable.
-
-“The Fourth Day of July, 1776, has now arrived, and America, manfully
-springing from the torturing fangs of the British lion, now rises
-majestic in the pride of her sovereignty, and bids her eagle elevate
-his wings! The solemn Declaration of Independence is now pronounced,
-amidst crowds of admiring citizens, by the supreme council of the
-nation, and received with the unbounded plaudits of a grateful people!
-That was the hour when heroism was proved—when the souls of men were
-tried!
-
-“It was then, ye venerable patriots,” there were some Revolutionary
-soldiers present—“it was then you lifted the indignant arm, and
-unitedly swore to be free! Despising such toys as subjugated empires,
-you then knew no middle fortune between liberty and death. Firmly
-relying on the protection of Heaven, unwarped in the resolution you had
-taken, you then undaunted met, engaged, defeated the gigantic power of
-Britain, and rode triumphant over the aggressions of your enemies!
-
-“Trenton, Princeton, Bennington and Saratoga were the successive
-theaters of your victories, and the utmost bounds of creation are the
-limits of your fame! The sacred fire of freedom, then enkindled in your
-breasts, shall be perpetuated through the long descent of future ages,
-and burn with undiminished fervor in the bosoms of millions yet unborn!”
-
-Further on we find the following passage:
-
-“The great drama is now completed; our independence is now
-acknowledged, and the hopes of our enemies are blasted forever.
-Columbia is now sealed in the forum of nations, and the empires of the
-world are amazed at the effulgence of her glory.
-
-“Thus, friends and citizens, did the kind hand of an overruling
-Providence conduct us, through toils, fatigues and dangers, to
-independence and peace. If piety be the rational exercise of the human
-soul, if religion be not a chimera, and if the vestiges of heavenly
-assistance are clearly traced in those events which mark the annals of
-our nation, it becomes us on this day, in consideration of the great
-things which have been done for us, to render the tribute of unfeigned
-thanks to that God who superintends the universe, and holds aloft the
-scale that weighs the destinies of nations.”
-
-The oration was a long one, and touched a variety of topics, but the
-extracts already given will convey a good idea of its excellencies and
-defects. My college readers will understand me when I say that the
-style is sophomoric and ambitious, but these faults may be pardoned in
-a youth of eighteen. The tone is elevated, it is marked by gravity and
-earnestness, the sentiments are just, there is evidence of thought,
-and, on the whole, we may regard the oration as a hopeful promise
-of the future. The magniloquence gave place in time to a weighty
-simplicity, in which every word told, and not one could be spared. It
-was rather remarkable that so young a man should have been selected to
-deliver such an address in Hanover, and indicates that Daniel had by
-this time acquired reputation as a public speaker.
-
-This was not the only occasion on which he was selected to speak in
-public. When a classmate, a general favorite, died, young Webster was
-unanimously selected to deliver an address of commemoration. He is said
-to have spoken with a fervor and eloquence which deeply stirred the
-hearts of the large audience that had assembled to hear him. “During
-the delivery the fall of a pin could have been heard at any moment; a
-dense audience were carried entirely away, and kept spellbound by the
-magic of his voice and manner; and when he sat down, he left a thousand
-people weeping real tears over a heartfelt sorrow. It is reported that
-there was not a dry eye in all the vast congregation which the event
-and the fame of the orator had brought together.”
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XII.
-
-STUDYING LAW.
-
-
-Daniel had now successfully accomplished the first object of his
-ambition. He was a college graduate. Though not the first scholar in
-his class he was very near the head, and probably in general culture
-stood first. There was a little misunderstanding which led to his
-declining to appear at Commencement. His friends desired him to deliver
-the valedictory, but the Faculty selected another, and Daniel remained
-silent. There is a report that he tore up his diploma in anger and
-disgust in presence of his classmates, saying, “My industry may make me
-a great man, but this miserable parchment cannot.” Had this story been
-true it would have done Daniel little credit. George Ticknor Curtis,
-who has written the most elaborate and trustworthy memoir of Webster
-states emphatically that there is no foundation for this story. Even if
-not entirely satisfied with the treatment he received at that time,
-Daniel’s loyalty to his Alma Mater was never doubted.
-
-And now the world was before the young graduate. What was he to do?
-
-His thoughts had long been fixed upon the legal profession. This was
-no proof of a special fitness for it, for at least half of the young
-men who graduate from our colleges make the same choice. But with
-Daniel the choice was a more serious one, for he very well knew that
-he could not afford to make a mistake here. Poverty was still his hard
-taskmaster, and he leaned beneath its dark shadow.
-
-My young reader will remember that at the age of fourteen Daniel
-officiated as office-boy for a young lawyer in his native town—Thomas
-W. Thompson. Now a college graduate of nineteen, he re-entered the same
-office as a law student. Mr. Thompson was a man of ability. He was a
-graduate of Harvard, where also he had filled the position of tutor.
-While the boy was obtaining an education at Dartmouth, Thompson was
-establishing a lucrative law practice. He became in time prominent
-in State politics, and finally went to Congress. It will be seen,
-therefore, that Daniel made a good choice, and that Mr. Thompson was
-something more than an obscure country lawyer.
-
-It is a little significant that the first law books which the young
-student read related to the law of nations. He read also standard
-literary works, and gave his leisure hours to hunting and fishing, the
-last of which was always a favorite sport with him. He gained some
-insight into the practical business of a law office. The reader will
-be amused at a humorous account of the manner in which he was employed
-during a temporary absence of his legal preceptor and a fellow-student.
-
-“I have made some few writs,” he says, “and am now about to bring an
-action of trespass for breaking a violin. The owner of the violin was
-at a husking, where
-
- ‘His jarring concord, and his discord dulcet,’
-
-made the girls skip over the husks as nimbly as Virgil’s Camilla over
-the tops of the corn, till an old surly creature caught his fiddle and
-broke it against the wall. For the sake of having plump witnesses the
-plaintiff will summons all the girls to attend the trial at Concord.”
-
-Here is another extract from a letter to the same friend which will
-amuse: “I thank you for your receipt for greasing boots. Have this
-afternoon to ride to the South Road, and in truth my boots admit not
-only water, but peas and gravel-stones. I wish I had better ones. As
-for ‘my new friend, tobacco,’ he is like most of that name has made me
-twice sick, and is now dismissed.
-
-“Heighho! a man wants a remedy against his neighbor, whose lips were
-found damage-feasant on his—the plaintiffs—wife’s cheek! What is to be
-done? But you have not read the law against kissing. I will write for
-advice and direction to Barrister Fuller.”
-
-So the young man appeared to be enjoying himself while pursuing
-his studies, and would probably have wished nothing better than to
-have gone on till he was prepared for admission to the bar on his
-own account. But there was a serious obstacle. His good father had
-well nigh exhausted his means in carrying Daniel through college,
-and Ezekiel through his preparatory studies, and was now very much
-straitened for money. It was felt to be time for Daniel to help him.
-He, therefore, “thought it his duty to suffer some delay in his
-profession for the sake of serving his elder brother,” by seeking
-employment outside.
-
-As a general thing when a college graduate is pressed by hard
-necessity, he turns his attention to the task of teaching, and such
-was the case with Daniel. Fortunately he soon found employment. From
-Fryeburg, Maine, there came to him an invitation to take charge of the
-academy there, and the young man accepted it. He was to be paid the
-munificent salary of three hundred and fifty dollars per year, and he
-felt that the offer was too dazzling to be rejected.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XIII.
-
-HOW DANIEL WENT TO FRYEBURG.
-
-
-When a young college graduate of to-day sets out for the scene of
-his dignified labors, he packs his trunk and buying a ticket for the
-station nearest the favored spot where he is to impart knowledge,
-takes his seat in a comfortable car, and is whirled rapidly to his
-destination.
-
-Not thus did Daniel go. Railroads had not been heard of, and no stages
-made the trip. He therefore purchased a horse for twenty-four dollars,
-deposited his limited wardrobe and a few books in his saddle-bags, and
-like a scholastic Don Quixote set out by the shortest path across the
-country for Fryeburg. In due time he arrived, and the trustees of the
-academy congratulated themselves on having secured Daniel Webster,
-A.B., as their preceptor. How much more would they have congratulated
-themselves could they have foreseen the future of the young teacher.
-
-Let me pause here to describe the appearance of the young man, as his
-friends of that time depict him. He was tall and thin (he weighed but
-one hundred and twenty pounds, which was certainly light weight for
-a man not far from six feet in height), with a thin face, high cheek
-bones, but bright, dark, penetrating eyes, which alone were sufficient
-to make him remarkable. He had not wholly overcome the early delicacy
-which had led his friends to select him as the scholar of the family,
-because he was not strong enough to labor on the farm. His habitual
-expression was grave and earnest, though, as we have seen, he had
-inherited, and always retained, a genial humor from his father.
-
-Three hundred and fifty dollars seems a small salary, but Daniel
-probably didn’t regard it with disdain. Expenses were small, as we are
-told that the current rate of board was but two dollars per week, less
-than a third of his income. Then his earnings were increased by a lucky
-circumstance.
-
-Young Webster found a home in the family of James Osgood, Esq.,
-registrar of deeds for the county of Oxford. Mr. Osgood did not propose
-to do the work himself, but was authorized to get it done.
-
-One evening soon after the advent of his new boarder, the registrar
-said, “Mr. Webster, have you a mind to increase your income?”
-
-“I should be exceedingly glad to do so, sir,” answered the young man,
-his face brightening with hopeful expectation.
-
-“You are aware that I hold the position of registrar of deeds for the
-county. It is my duty to see that all deeds are properly recorded?”
-
-“Yes, sir.”
-
-“This work I do not care to do myself, having sufficient other work to
-occupy my time. How would you like to undertake it in the evening? It
-would not interfere with your school duties.”
-
-“I am not a very good penman,” said the young man doubtfully.
-
-“Handsome penmanship is not required. It is sufficient if the deeds are
-copied in a plain, legible hand, and this may be attained by effort.”
-
-“How much compensation would be allowed?”
-
-“I receive two shillings and threepence for each deed recorded. I will
-allow you one shilling and sixpence, and you can average two deeds in
-an evening. What do you say?”
-
-One shilling and sixpence was twenty-five cents. Two deeds therefore
-would bring the young teacher fifty cents, and four evenings’ work,
-therefore, would pay his board, and leave him his salary clear. This
-was a tempting inducement, though it would involve dry and tedious
-labor.
-
-“I will accept,” said Daniel promptly.
-
-“Then you can begin at once,” said Mr. Osgood, well satisfied.
-
-It was a hard way of earning money, but money was very much needed. So,
-after the fatigues of the day, when supper was over, Daniel sat down
-to record dry deeds. The curious visitor to Fryeburg can still see two
-volumes of deeds, a large part of them in Daniel Webster’s handwriting.
-Though not a good writer, he forced himself to write well, and in his
-autobiography he says, “The ache is not yet out of my fingers, for
-nothing has ever been so laborious to me as writing, when under the
-necessity of writing a good hand.”
-
-I may be permitted to call the attention of my young readers to this
-point—that what he had undertaken to do he did well, although it was a
-task far from congenial. A young man or boy who observes this rule is
-likely to succeed in the end: Whatever you have to do do as well as you
-can.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XIV.
-
-THE PRECEPTOR OF FRYEBURG ACADEMY.
-
-
-It may be supposed that between his school in the daytime and his
-duties as copyist in the evening, Daniel found his time pretty well
-occupied. As we know, he was not drawn to the teacher’s office by any
-special love of that honorable vocation, but simply by the pecuniary
-emolument. But, though this was the case, he discharged his duties with
-conscientious fidelity, and made himself a favorite both among his
-pupils and in the village, where the new preceptor was, as is usual, a
-person of importance.
-
-He was accustomed to open and close the school with extemporaneous
-prayer, and those who remember the deep solemnity of manner which he
-could command at will will readily believe that this exercise was made
-impressive by the young teacher.
-
-No stories have been handed down of insubordination among his pupils.
-If there had been any, it would speedily have been quelled by the
-preceptor, whose demeanor was naturally dignified.
-
-It is remarkable how many of our great men have spent a portion
-of their early lives at the teacher’s desk. Gen. Garfield had an
-unusually extensive and varied experience as teacher, and would have
-passed through life very happily if he had never withdrawn from the
-school-room. Daniel Webster had not his special aptitude for it, but
-was nevertheless very fairly successful. One qualification, as we
-learn from the testimony of a pupil, was his “remarkable equanimity
-of temper.” The vexations of the school-room are neither few nor far
-between, but none of them were able to bring a frown to young Webster’s
-brow. Calmly he met and conquered all difficulties that came in his
-way, and secured the confidence and respect of his scholars.
-
-The young man also impressed his pupils and friends as a man of
-competent scholarship. Hon. Samuel Fessenden, of Portland, writes:
-“The first I ever knew of Daniel Webster was immediately after he left
-college, and was employed by my father, the secretary of the Trustees
-of Fryeburg Academy, to become the principal instructor in that
-institution. He was not, when he commenced, twenty years old. I heard
-no one complain that his scholarship was not adequate to the duty he
-had assumed. On the contrary, I heard the Rev. Dr. Nathaniel Porter, of
-Conway, and my father, the Rev. William Fessenden, of Fryeburg, both of
-whom were good scholars, and the former, Rev. Dr. Porter, a very great
-man, say that Daniel Webster was a very good scholar for his years.
-He did, while at Fryeburg, exhibit traits of talent and genius which
-drew from these two divines, and from other professional gentlemen,
-unqualified praise of his powers of mind. I remember very distinctly
-hearing my father remark that if Mr. Webster should live, and have
-health, and pursue a straightforward course of industry and virtue, he
-would become one of the greatest men this country had produced.”
-
-When it is remembered that the young man of whom this prediction
-was made was at the time an obscure teacher, in an obscure town, in
-what was then a frontier settlement, we must infer that he exhibited
-remarkable ability, and gave hints of a reserved power not yet called
-into action.
-
-In spite of his engrossing employments, the young man found time to
-enlarge his general culture by various reading. Nor did he neglect
-his professional studies, but continued the reading of Blackstone’s
-Commentaries. It is remarkable that with all this hard work he found
-time for society. Dr. Osgood, the registrar’s son, says: “He was
-usually serious, but often facetious and pleasant. He was an agreeable
-companion, and eminently social with all who shared his friendship.
-He was greatly beloved by all who knew him. His habits were strictly
-abstemious, and he neither took wine nor strong drink. He was punctual
-in his attendance upon public worship, and ever opened his school with
-prayer. I never heard him use a profane word, and never saw him lose
-his temper.”
-
-From all that has been said my young readers will see that Daniel was
-beginning life in the right way. It seems to me that at this period he
-was a model who may be safely copied in all respects. The reverence
-which he so plainly evinced as a young man for religion he never lost,
-but to the latest day of his life he yielded to none in his regard for
-the spirit of Christianity.
-
-Under date of May 18, 1802, Daniel writes to his favorite friend Harvey
-Bingham, giving some account of matters at Fryeburg. He had just
-returned from spending a short vacation with his brother at Hanover.
-
-“I arrived here last night,” he says; “but must fill this page by
-relating a little anecdote that happened yesterday. I accidentally
-fell in with one of my scholars on his return to the academy. He
-was mounted on the ugliest horse I ever saw or heard of except
-Sancho Panzas’s pacer. As I had two horses with me, I proposed to
-him to ride one of them, and tie his bay fast to his Bucephalus; he
-did accordingly, and turned her forward, where her odd appearance,
-indescribable gait, and frequent stumblings afforded us constant
-amusement. At length we approached Saco River, a very wide, deep and
-rapid stream, when this satire on the animal creation, as if to revenge
-herself on us for our sarcasms, plunged into the river, then very high
-by the freshet, and was wafted down the current like a bag of oats. I
-could scarcely sit on my horse for laughter. I am apt to laugh at the
-vexations of my friends. The fellow, who was of my own age, and my
-roommate half checked the current by oaths as big as lobsters, and the
-old Rosinante, who was all the while much at her ease, floated up among
-the willows far below on the opposite shore.”
-
-While Daniel was laboring as teacher and copyist at Fryeburg, his
-older brother, Ezekiel, was pursuing his studies at Dartmouth College,
-sustained there mainly by the remittances which Daniel was able to send
-him. The chief pleasure which the younger brother derived from his
-experience as teacher was, that it gave him the means of securing for
-his favorite brother the same advantages which he had himself enjoyed.
-He cheerfully postponed his plan of professional study in order to
-discharge this pious duty. Certainly the affection which united these
-two brothers was very beautiful, and creditable to both. Too often
-brothers are estranged without good reason, and follow selfishly
-their own plans, without the desire to help each other. To the end
-of Ezekiel’s life this mutual affection continued, and when he was
-suddenly removed by death Daniel was deeply affected, and staggered
-under the blow.
-
-How long was this occupation to continue? How long was the future
-statesman to devote himself to the comparatively humble duty of
-inducting country boys into the paths of knowledge?
-
-He had only engaged for two terms, but such was his success that the
-trustees were not willing to have him go. As an inducement to him to
-remain they offered to increase his small salary of three hundred and
-fifty dollars to five or six hundred, with a house to live in, a piece
-of land to cultivate, and possibly a clerkship of the Common Pleas.
-
-All this may sound very small to us, but to a youth who had been
-reared in such straitened circumstances as Daniel it seemed like a
-liberal competence. It required some decision and boldness to reject
-this certainly for the uncertain prospects of a young lawyer, before
-whom lay at the first a period of poverty and struggle. Then it must
-be added that Daniel was modest, and was far from believing that he
-was endowed with extraordinary talent. It is very probable that more
-than half the young men who graduate from our law schools to-day have
-a higher opinion of their abilities than Daniel Webster at the age of
-twenty. To illustrate his struggles I quote from a letter written at
-this time.
-
-“What shall I do? Shall I say, ‘Yes, gentlemen,’ and sit down here to
-spend my days in a kind of comfortable privacy, or shall I relinquish
-these prospects, and enter into a profession where my feelings will
-be constantly harrowed by objects either of dishonesty or misfortune;
-where my living must be squeezed from penury (for rich folks seldom
-go to law), and my moral principle be continually at hazard? I agree
-with you that the law is well calculated to draw forth the powers of
-the mind, but what are its effects on the heart? are they equally
-propitious? Does it inspire benevolence and awake tenderness; or does
-it, by a frequent repetition of wretched objects, blunt sensibility and
-stifle the still, small voice of mercy?
-
-“The talent with which Heaven has intrusted me is small, very small;
-yet I feel responsible for the use of it, and am not willing to pervert
-it to purposes reproachful or unjust, or to hide it, like the slothful
-servant, in a napkin.
-
-“On the whole, I imagine I shall make one more trial (of the law)
-in the ensuing autumn. If I prosecute the profession, I pray God to
-fortify me against its temptations. To the winds I dismiss those
-light hopes of eminence which ambition inspired and vanity fostered.
-To be ‘honest, to be capable, to be faithful’ to my client and my
-conscience. I believe you, my worthy boy, when you tell me what are
-your intentions. I have long known and long loved the honesty of your
-heart. But let us not rely too much on ourselves; let us look to some
-less fallible guide to direct us among the temptations that surround
-us.”
-
-In a letter written June 4, 1802, Mr. Webster refers to his indecision
-as to a career.
-
- “Now Hope leans forward on Life’s slender line,
- Shows me a lawyer, doctor or divine;
- Ardent springs forward to the distant goal,
- But indecision clogs the eager soul.
- Heaven bless my friend, and when he marks his way,
- And takes his bearings o’er life’s troubled sea,
- In that important moment may he find
- Choice and his friends and duty all combined.”
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XV.
-
-THE NEXT TWO YEARS.
-
-
-The die was cast! Daniel decided to forego the small but comfortable
-income insured to him as a teacher, and in accordance with his father’s
-wishes, as well as his own inclination, returned to the study of the
-law. He resumed his place (September, 1802) in the office of Mr.
-Thompson, at Salisbury, and there he remained till February or March,
-1804. Before leaving Fryeburg, at the request of the citizens he
-delivered a Fourth of July oration (his second), for which he received
-from the trustees of the academy a gratuity of five dollars! It was not
-many years before five hundred dollars would not have been considered
-too much for such a service from the then obscure teacher.
-
-My young readers would not feel particularly interested in the
-details of Daniel’s professional studies during the eighteen months
-he spent in the office of Mr. Thompson. From the larger biographies
-such information may be obtained by law students and those who take
-an interest therein. I shall content myself by extracting from Mr.
-Webster’s autobiography some account of the manner in which he employed
-his time.
-
-“I do not know whether I read much during this year and a half besides
-law books, with two exceptions. I read Hume through, not for the first
-time; but my principal occupation with books, when not law books,
-was with the Latin classics. I brought from college a very scanty
-inheritance of Latin. I now tried to add to it. I made myself familiar
-with most of Tully’s Orations, committed to memory large passages of
-some of them, read Sallust and Cæsar and Horace. Some of Horace’s odes
-I translated into poor English rhymes; they were printed. I have never
-seen them since. My brother was a far better English scholar than
-myself, and, in one of his vacations, we read Juvenal together. But I
-never mastered his style, so as to read him with ease and pleasure.
-At this period of my life I passed a great deal of time alone. My
-amusements were fishing and shooting and riding, and all these were
-without a companion. I loved this occasional solitude then, and have
-loved it ever since, and love it still. I like to contemplate nature,
-and to hold communion, unbroken by the presence of human beings, with
-‘this universal frame—thus wondrous fair.’ I like solitude also, as
-favorable to thoughts less lofty. I like to let the thoughts go free
-and indulge excursions. And when _thinking_ is to be done, one must,
-of course, be alone. No man knows himself who does not thus sometimes
-keep his own company. At a subsequent period of life I have found that
-my lonely journeys, when following the court on its circuits, have
-afforded many an edifying day.”
-
-It will be seen that young Webster aimed to be something more than a
-lawyer. Instead of throwing aside his law books when his daily reading
-was over with a sigh of relief that he could now devote his time to
-mere enjoyment, he closed them only to open the English and Latin
-classics, with a view to broaden his culture and qualify himself for
-something better than a routine lawyer, to whom his profession presents
-itself only as a means of livelihood. Pressed as he had been, and still
-was, by the burden of poverty, he never appears to have set before
-himself as a principal object the emoluments to be gained by legal
-practice. During his busy years his receipts were indeed very large,
-but they came to him as a consequence of his large and varied ability,
-and not because he had specially labored to that end.
-
-I have already mentioned the young man’s modesty. He did not
-apparently suspect the extent of his own powers, and did not look
-forward to fill any conspicuous place in his profession. He hoped
-indeed for “the acquirement of a decent, competent estate, enabling
-us to treat our friends as they deserve, and to live free from
-embarrassment.” This was the measure of his expectation.
-
-Yet it did occur to him at times that an office in a small country town
-hardly afforded the facilities for acquiring professional knowledge
-which it would be desirable to enjoy. Sometimes he hoped that he might
-be able to finish his studies in Boston, where he would meet with men
-of large ability, and where the practice of law took a larger range.
-But if he found it hard work to maintain himself in Salisbury, how
-could he hope to pay his way in Boston?
-
-But a way was unexpectedly opened to him. Before Ezekiel had completed
-his college course it was necessary for him to teach in order to fill
-his exhausted coffers, and by a lucky chance he obtained the charge
-of a small private school in what is now Kingston Street, Boston. He
-had eight scholars in Latin and Greek, but found himself unable to do
-justice to them on account of the long list of branches which he had
-to teach. He wrote to Daniel, offering him a sum sufficient to pay
-his board, if he would assume the charge of these pupils. This would
-require but an hour and a half daily, and would leave the law student
-ample time to prosecute his studies.
-
-It may readily be supposed that Daniel did not decline this offer. It
-was an experiment, perhaps, but it was worth trying. So he packed up
-his clothes and repaired to Boston, where he joined his brother, whom
-he arranged to assist in his duties. Now the relations of the brothers
-were again reversed, and it was the elder who took his turn in helping
-along the younger. The most eminent of the pupils thus coming under the
-instruction of Daniel Webster was Edward Everett, worthy as an orator
-to be named with his master. Webster, Everett, Choate! Nine out of ten,
-if called upon to name the three most renowned orators of New England,
-would single out these names, and it will indeed be a fortunate age
-that can boast three who can equal them. Among the pupils of Ezekiel
-Webster was George Ticknor, another eminent man who will need no
-introduction to my readers.
-
-Daniel had entered a new and auspicious period of study and
-opportunity. He had gained a foothold in Boston. How was he best to
-improve his residence? What great lawyer would open his office to the
-young New Hampshire student?
-
-Among the most eminent citizens and lawyers of Boston at that time was
-Christopher Gore. He had served the American Government at home and
-abroad, as district attorney for Massachusetts, and as a commissioner
-to England under Jay’s Treaty, for the settlement of claims brought
-by citizens of the United States for spoliation by British cruisers
-during the war of the French Revolution. A higher honor was in store
-for him, since in 1809 he was elected Governor of Massachusetts by the
-Federal party. In 1804, when young Webster arrived in Boston, he was in
-practice as a lawyer, his specialty being commercial law.
-
-Daniel learned that Mr. Gore had no clerk, and ambition led him to
-apply for the situation. He did not know any near friend of the
-distinguished lawyer, but a young man, whose acquaintance with him was
-nearly as slight as his, undertook to introduce him.
-
-When the two young men entered the office, Daniel, according to his
-own account, was shockingly embarrassed. But Mr. Gore, with his
-old-fashioned courtesy, speedily put at him at ease. The rest of the
-interview we will let Mr. Webster tell for himself.
-
-“I had the grace to begin with an unaffected apology; told him my
-position was very awkward, my appearance there very like an intrusion,
-and that, if I expected anything but a civil dismission, it was only
-founded in his known kindness and generosity of character. I was
-from the country, I said; had studied law for two years; had come to
-Boston to study a year more; had some respectable acquaintances in
-New Hampshire, not unknown to him, but had no introduction; that I
-had heard he had no clerk; thought it possible he would receive one;
-that I came to Boston to work, not to play; was most desirous, on all
-accounts, to be his pupil; and all I ventured to ask at present was,
-that he would keep a place for me in his office till I could write to
-New Hampshire for proper letters, showing me worthy of it.”
-
-This speech Daniel delivered fluently, having carefully considered what
-he intended to say.
-
-Mr. Gore heard him with encouraging good nature, and kindly invited the
-young visitor to sit down.
-
-“I do not mean to fill my office with clerks,” he said, “but am willing
-to receive one or two, and will consider what you have said.”
-
-He inquired what gentlemen of his acquaintance knew Daniel and his
-father, and in reply Daniel mentioned several, among others Mr.
-Peabody, who was Mr. Gore’s classmate.
-
-A pleasant conversation continued for a few minutes, and Daniel rose to
-go.
-
-“My young friend,” said Mr. Gore, “you look as if you might be trusted.
-You say you came to study and not to waste time. I will take you at
-your word. You may as well hang up your hat at once. Go into the other
-room, take your book and sit down to reading it, and write at your
-convenience to New Hampshire for your letters.”
-
-Daniel could hardly credit his good fortune in this prompt assent to
-his wishes. He felt that he had made an auspicious beginning in Boston,
-and made “a good stride onward” in securing admission to such an
-office.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XVI.
-
-A GREAT TEMPTATION.
-
-
-Our young student could not have been more favorably situated for
-study, and we may well believe that he made the best use of his
-advantages. I shall not describe his course at length, or in detail,
-but confine myself to such personal details as are likely to interest
-my reader.
-
-In November a rare pleasure awaited him. A gentleman of means, Mr.
-Taylor Baldwin, who had some occasion for his services, engaged him to
-accompany him on a leisurely journey in parts of New England and New
-York, not only defraying his expenses, but recompensing him liberally.
-I can do no better than quote the young man’s description of it in a
-letter to his friend Bingham, dated Jan. 2d, 1805:
-
-“Figure to yourself a large room in the third story of a brick
-building, in the center of Boston, a sea-coal fire, and a most enormous
-writing-table with half a cord of books on it. Then figure further to
-yourself your most obedient, with his back to the fire, and his face
-to the table, writing by candle-light, and you will precisely see a
-‘happy fellow.’ There now is a famous dash at description! Now let me
-try my talent at narration.
-
-“Well, then, on the fifth day of November, being election day, at just
-twenty-seven minutes and a half past twelve, I left Mrs. Whitwell’s,
-Court Street, Boston, and on the twenty-eighth day of the same month,
-at one o’clock P.M., arrived at time same Mrs. Whitwell’s, in the same
-Court Street. You can easily determine from the above account where I
-went!! If, however, you should be puzzled, I will tell you to Albany.
-Yes, James, I have even been to Albany. I cannot now tell you why,
-nor for what, but it was in a hackney coach, with a pair of nimble
-trotters, a smart coachman before, and a footman on horseback behind.
-There’s style for you! Moreover, I had my friend at my elbow.... My
-expenses were all amply paid, and on my return I put my hand in my
-pocket, and found one hundred and twenty dear delightfuls! Is not that
-good luck? And these dear delightfuls were, ’pon honor, all my own,
-yes, every dog of ’em. Now don’t you think I would jump to go to Albany
-again! But to be serious, I really went to Albany, in November, with
-a gentleman of this town, for which I received the above reward; and
-I’m so proud to have a dollar of my own I was determined to tell you
-of it. Of my journey and all that I saw and heard I cannot give you a
-particular account now.”
-
-The journey above mentioned was through Springfield to Albany, thence
-down to Hudson, returning by way of Hartford and Providence to Boston.
-Taken by rail it would not be much of a journey, but traveling by easy
-stages across the country, it must have been full of enjoyment to a
-young man wholly new to journeys of any kind.
-
-Daniel’s description of Albany in a letter to his brother is an amusing
-one.
-
-“Albany is no despicable place. To be sure it is irregular and without
-form. Its houses are generally old and poor-looking—its streets are
-rather dirty—but there are many exceptions. A part of the town is very
-high, overlooking the river in a very pleasant manner, and affording
-many fine seats. Some handsome buildings ornament the town. The Dutch
-Reformed Church and the new State Bank would not disgrace State Street
-(Boston). Here are all sorts of people, both Greek and Jew, Englishman
-and Dutchman, Negro and Indian. Almost everybody speaks English
-occasionally, though I have heard them speak among themselves in a
-_lingo_ which I never learned even at the Indian Charity School. The
-river here is half a mile wide, that is, I should think so; and, if I
-think wrong, you: must look at Dr. Morse and correct me.”
-
-The cosmopolitan character of Albany nearly eighty years since, when
-it probably contained not over five thousand inhabitants, is certainly
-rather amazing, and I can conceive the modern Albanian reading the
-description given above with considerable surprise. But Daniel was
-at an age and in a state of inexperience in which everything new
-is wonderful, and he certainly saw everything under very pleasant
-circumstances.
-
-From a letter written by his sister it appears that the young law
-student was paid seven dollars a day for his company by his rich and
-eccentric companion, who, if he lived to know of Webster’s eminence,
-probably concluded that the price was by no means exorbitant.
-
-In the letter of Sally Webster, already referred to, there is a passage
-which will amuse my young readers. “Before I have finished my nonsense
-I must tell you that our neighbors opposite the door fought a duel the
-other day, one with the gridiron, the other with the candlestick. The
-female, however, came off victorious, and he, with all speed, ran here
-with some lint and rum, to be applied immediately, for he was bleeding
-to death with a wound in his head caused by the gridiron.”
-
-It is evident that if the women of New Hampshire were not
-strong-minded, there were some who were strong-armed, and calculated to
-strike terror in an average husband.
-
-Meanwhile how were things going at the early home of the future
-statesman in New Hampshire? Judge Webster no doubt experienced
-satisfaction in knowing that the two sons for whom he had hoped so
-much, and sacrificed so much, were now possessors of a collegiate
-education, and in a fair way to make their own way in the world. But
-he was not without his anxieties. To obtain that education he had been
-obliged to mortgage his small estate for nearly all it was worth. He
-was sixty-five years of age, and a life of labor and exposure had made
-him old before his time. He could not look for many years more of life,
-and he might die before his two boys were able to support themselves
-by their professional labors, without speaking of taking his place at
-home. But he had been sustained by one hope, which finally seemed in a
-way of being realized. The clerk of the Court of Common Pleas, of which
-he was an associate judge, died. Chief Justice Farrar, knowing the
-family circumstances of his associate, immediately placed the office at
-his disposal for his son Daniel.
-
-For that day it was a lucrative office, paying much more than a
-judgeship. The emoluments were fifteen hundred dollars a year, and that
-would be a competence to a young man brought up like Daniel. It would
-make life easy to him, and enable him to smooth the pathway of his
-father, and release the homestead from mortgage.
-
-With glad heart Judge Webster wrote to Daniel of his good fortune,
-and Daniel on his side was elated. He felt that it would make him
-independent, that he would pay off the family debt, and assist his
-brother Ezekiel.
-
-So, full of the good news, he went over to the office in the morning,
-and with a beaming face acquainted Mr. Gore with the offer he had
-received, and then waited to receive his congratulations.
-
-“Well, my young friend,” said he, “the gentlemen have been very kind
-to you; I am glad of it. You must thank them for it. Certainly they
-are very good; you must write them a civil letter. You will write
-immediately, of course.”
-
-[Illustration: “_Will you carry us across on your back?_”—Page 286.]
-
-“I feel their kindness and liberality very deeply,” answered Daniel. “I
-shall certainly thank them in the best manner I am able, but, as I
-shall go to Salisbury so soon, I hardly think it is necessary to write.”
-
-“Why,” said Mr. Gore, seeming greatly surprised, “you surely don’t mean
-to accept it?”
-
-Daniel was astounded. Not to accept such a magnificent proposal! As
-soon as he could speak he said that he had no thought of anything else
-but acceptance.
-
-“Well,” said Mr. Gore, “you must decide for yourself; but come, sit
-down, and let us talk it over. The office is worth fifteen hundred a
-year, you say; well, it never will be worth any more. Ten to one if
-they find out it is so much the fees will be reduced. You are appointed
-now by friends; others may fill their places who are of different
-opinions, and who have friends of their own to provide for. You will
-lose your place; or, supposing you to retain it, what are you but a
-clerk for life? And your prospects as a lawyer are good enough to
-encourage you to go on. Go on, and finish your studies; you are poor
-enough, but there are greater evils than poverty; live on no man’s
-favor; what bread you do eat let it be the bread of independence;
-pursue your profession, make yourself useful to your friends, and a
-little formidable to your enemies, and you have nothing to fear.”
-
-Daniel hardly knew what to think or to say. It was presenting the
-subject from a very different point of view. He had looked forward to
-this office as a thing greatly to be desired. It had been the height
-of his ambition, and now his legal instructor, a man whose opinion he
-greatly valued, told him he must give it up. He was indeed flattered
-and encouraged by the eminent lawyer’s estimate of his talents and
-prospects, an estimate far beyond any he had formed for himself, for
-Daniel, as I have already had occasion to say, was modest, and wholly
-ignorant of the extent of his powers.
-
-It was not that he expected to enjoy a clerkship. He knew he should
-not, but he had been struggling so long with poverty that the prospect
-of a competency was most alluring. Besides he was a good son and a good
-brother. He knew how much his father’s mind would be relieved, how he
-could help his favorite brother, and it seemed very hard to resign such
-a piece of fortune.
-
-“Go home and think it over,” said Mr. Gore, “and come back in the
-morning, and we will have another talk.”
-
-Daniel followed his advice, but passed a sleepless night.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XVII.
-
-DANIEL REFUSES A CLERKSHIP.
-
-
-Those of my readers who have read “The Canal Boy” will remember that
-before Gen. Garfield graduated from college he too was met by a similar
-temptation, in the shape of an offer which, if accepted, would have
-materially changed his course of life, and given him a comfortable
-obscurity in place of national renown. He was offered a school in Troy,
-N. Y., with a salary of one hundred and twenty-five dollars per month,
-while up to that time he had never earned but eighteen dollars per
-month and board. He declined after a hard struggle, for he too had been
-reared in poverty and still suffered from it.
-
-And now a similar temptation had come to Daniel Webster.
-
-He went home and thought the matter over. He felt that Mr. Gore’s
-advice was good, but how could he accept it? His father was old and in
-poor health. He had set his heart on Daniel’s accepting this place.
-A contrary decision would strike him like a thunderbolt. Moreover it
-would bring him home, and give his father the comfort of his society,
-as well as pecuniary prosperity.
-
-It seemed a selfish thing to refuse, to show a lack of consideration
-for his father, and Daniel was a good son. I mention all these things
-to show that in this turning-point of his career Daniel had a hard
-decision to make. There was another circumstance to consider—his father
-was in present need of money.
-
-Finally Daniel made up his mind. If he could borrow a sum of money
-sufficient to help his father, he would venture to refuse the clerkship.
-
-He went to Mr. Joseph Taylor, a Boston acquaintance, and said to him
-abruptly, “Mr. Taylor, I want to borrow some money. I will pay you some
-time or other, but I can’t tell exactly when.”
-
-“You can have as much as you want,” answered Mr. Taylor kindly.
-
-“But,” said Daniel, “I want a good deal of money.”
-
-“How much?” asked his friend, not seeming alarmed at his rash promise.
-
-“Three or four hundred dollars,” was the reply, and this in the eyes of
-the young law student was a very large sum, though his ideas changed
-when money came in by thousands from wealthy clients, not many years
-afterwards.
-
-“You shall have it,” said Mr. Taylor, and he counted out the money into
-the young man’s hands.
-
-Daniel was elated with his success. He would not go home empty-handed,
-and this sum would soften the blow which his determination would bring
-to his father.
-
-Now to get home and have it over as soon as possible! He hired a seat
-in a country sleigh which had come down to market, and was on the point
-of returning, for there was neither railroad nor stage to convey him
-to his home. It was a crisp winter day, and they glided over the snowy
-roads for many hours till they were beyond the New Hampshire line.
-Still mile after mile was traversed till the old home was reached.
-
-Just at sunset Daniel reached his home. Through the window, even
-before he entered, he saw his father in his little room sitting in his
-arm-chair. The old man, worn out by a long life of hard labor, seemed
-very old and thin, but his eyes were as black and bright as ever.
-Daniel’s heart was touched, and he felt that the trial had come. It was
-no light thing to disappoint such a father.
-
-As he entered the presence of his father Judge Webster looked up with a
-smile of gladness.
-
-“Well, Daniel, we have got that office for you,” he said.
-
-“Yes, father,” said Daniel a little nervously. “The gentlemen were very
-kind. I must go and thank them.”
-
-“They gave it to you without my saying a word about it,” said Judge
-Webster complacently.
-
-“I must go and see Judge Farrar, and tell him I am much obliged to him,
-father.”
-
-Still the father suspected nothing of Daniel’s intention, though his
-son treated it more carelessly than he had anticipated. He had thought
-so much about it and come to look upon it as so desirable that it did
-not seem to him possible that his son could regard it in any other way,
-as indeed he would not but for Mr. Gore’s advice.
-
-But at last the true meaning of Daniel’s indifference flashed upon him,
-and he looked at him earnestly.
-
-He straightened himself up in his chair, and he regarded him intently.
-
-“Daniel, Daniel,” he said, “don’t you mean to take that office?”
-
-“No, indeed, father,” answered Daniel lightly, though his lightness
-was assumed, and covered a feeling of anxiety; “I hope I can do much
-better than that. I mean to use my tongue in the courts, not my pen; to
-be an actor, not a register of other men’s acts. I hope yet, sir, to
-astonish your honor in your own court by my professional attainments.”
-
-Youth is hopeful and ready to take risks; age is conservative and takes
-little for granted. Judge Webster must have thought his son’s decision
-exceedingly rash. Let me tell the rest of the story in Daniel’s words,
-as indeed I have closely adhered to his version thus far.
-
-“For a moment I thought he was angry. He rocked his chair slightly; a
-flash went over an eye softened by age, but still as black as jet; but
-it was gone, and I thought I saw that parental partiality was, after
-all, a little gratified at this apparent devotion to an honorable
-profession, and this seeming confidence of success in it. He looked at
-me for as much as a minute, and then said slowly, ‘Well, my son, your
-mother has always said you would come to something or nothing, she was
-not sure which; I think you are now about settling that doubt for her.’
-This he said, and never a word spoke more to me on the subject.”
-
-Daniel explained to his father the reasons which had induced him to
-arrive at the decision he had just expressed, and as an earnest of
-the good fortune which he anticipated in the career he had chosen
-he produced the money he had borrowed, and placed it in his father’s
-hands. Probably this satisfied Judge Webster that there were others who
-had faith in his son’s promise, since he could offer no other security
-for borrowed money. At any rate it softened his disappointment, since
-it brought him help which he sorely needed.
-
-Daniel stayed at home a week, contributing as such a son might to the
-happiness of his parents, who, now in the sunset of life, had little to
-hope for themselves, but lived wholly for their children.
-
-Now he must go back to Boston, for the period of his preparatory
-studies was drawing to a close, and he was almost to seek immediately
-admission to the bar.
-
-In March, 1805, he was admitted to practice in the Court of Common
-Pleas in Boston, the usual motion being made by his friend and teacher,
-Mr. Gore. This eminent lawyer, according to the custom of that time,
-accompanied his motion by a brief speech, which was of so complimentary
-a character that it must have been exceedingly gratifying to the legal
-neophyte, who stood waiting for the doors to open through which he was
-to enter into the precincts of a dignified and honorable profession.
-“It is a well-known tradition,” says Mr. George Ticknor Curtis, “that
-on this occasion Mr. Gore predicted the future eminence of his young
-friend. What he said has not been preserved; but that he said what Mr.
-Webster never forgot, that it was distinctly a prediction, and that it
-excited in him a resolve that it should not go unfulfilled, we have
-upon his own authority, though he appears to have been unwilling to
-repeat the words of Mr. Gore’s address.”
-
-Young Webster, whose career we have thus far followed in detail through
-the successive stages of his struggle with penury, was now no longer a
-farmer’s boy, but a full-fledged lawyer, of whom eminent men expected
-much.
-
-Another important question was to be decided, Where should Daniel
-put up his shingle, and commence the practice of his profession? In
-Boston the field was larger, and the chances of attaining professional
-eminence were greater. Many of his friends counseled his remaining
-in the city. But up in New Hampshire was an old man whose life was
-nearly over, to whose last days his company would bring solace and
-comfort. What prospects, however brilliant, could overbalance this
-consideration? With filial devotion Daniel decided to settle in New
-Hampshire, in Boscawan, but a few miles from Salisbury, where he
-could see his father almost daily. Boston could wait, professional
-opportunities could wait. His father’s happiness must not be
-disregarded. So in the spring of 1805 he became a country lawyer in the
-same town where he had prepared for college.
-
-Thirteen months later, in April, 1807, his father died.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XVIII.
-
-D. WEBSTER, ATTORNEY.
-
-
-This was the sign that our young lawyer attached to his office, in
-the town of Boscawan. The office was humble enough. It was on the
-second floor of a store, painted red, and the staircase leading to it
-was on the outside. His office rent was fifteen dollars a year, which
-certainly could not have been considered an extravagant sum.
-
-Here it was that the future great lawyer commenced practice. Though his
-fees amounted to but six or seven hundred dollars a year, his practice
-extended over three counties, Hillsborough, Rockingham and Grafton. We
-infer from his meager income, though it was ample for his needs in a
-place where living was so inexpensive, that his clients had no occasion
-to complain of immoderate charges.
-
-Judge Webster had the satisfaction of hearing his son make one speech
-in court, but he was so near the end of his earthly pilgrimage that
-he never heard another, being for the last few months confined within
-doors. The father listened with satisfaction, and regarded his son’s
-effort as a very creditable one.
-
-Daniel’s sole object in establishing himself in an obscure country
-place was to be near his father, who he knew could not live many years.
-The end was nearer than he supposed, for he died little more than a
-year later. It may have been a sacrifice, but probably he lost nothing
-by it. The quiet seclusion gave him more time for study, and he was
-laying a broad groundwork for his future fame to rest upon.
-
-It was while he was at Boscawan that he first encountered Mr. Jeremiah
-Mason, the acknowledged head of the New Hampshire bar. From a foot-note
-in Curtis’s Life, I quote the circumstances as told by Mr. Mason
-himself.
-
-“I had heard,” said Mr. Mason,” that there was a young lawyer up there
-who was reputed to be a wonderfully able fellow, and was said by the
-country people to be as black as the ace of spades, but I had never
-seen him. When they told me that he had prepared evidence for this
-prosecution (it was a case of forgery, the defendant being a man of
-respectable position), I thought it well to be careful, especially as
-the trial was to be conducted by the attorney-general. But when the
-trial came on the attorney-general was ill, and the prosecutors asked
-that Webster should be allowed to conduct the case. I assented to this
-readily, thinking I ought to have an easy time of it, and we were
-introduced to each other.
-
-“We went at it, and I soon found that I had no light work on my hands.
-He examined his witnesses and shaped his case with so much skill that
-I had to exert every faculty I possessed. I got the man off, but it
-was as hard a day’s work as I ever did in my life. There were other
-transactions behind this one which looked quite as awkward. When the
-verdict was announced I went up to the dock and whispered to the
-prisoner, as the sheriff let him out, to be off for Canada, and never
-to put himself within the reach of that young Webster again. From that
-time forth I never lost sight of Mr. Webster, and never had but one
-opinion of his powers.”
-
-This is remarkable testimony from the head of the bar to a practitioner
-so young, who was a mere novice in the profession.
-
-After the death of his father Daniel was still compelled for a time to
-remain in his country office. His practice was now worth something, and
-he had it in view to surrender it to his brother Ezekiel, who was now
-studying law, but had not been admitted to the bar. His father had
-left some debts, which Daniel voluntarily assumed. In the autumn of
-1807 Ezekiel succeeded to the double office of managing the home farm,
-and carrying on the law business of his younger brother. Then Daniel,
-feeling that he might safely do so, took down his “shingle,” and
-removed to Portsmouth, where he found a larger field for the exercise
-of his abilities, where he could gain a higher and more conspicuous
-position.
-
-His appearance at this time has been thus described by a member of
-Rev. Dr. Buckminster’s family. “Slender, and apparently of delicate
-organization, his large eyes and narrow brow seemed very predominant
-above the other features, which were sharply cut, refined and delicate.
-The paleness of his complexion was heightened by hair as black as the
-raven’s wing.”
-
-Daniel soon became intimate with the family of Dr. Buckminster,
-and from members of this family we learn much that is interesting
-concerning him. He developed, according to Mr. Lee, a “genial and
-exceedingly rich humor,” which did more to make him popular in society
-than any of his other diversified gifts. “We young people saw him only
-rarely in friendly visits. I well remember one afternoon that he came
-in, when the elders of the family were absent. He sat down by the
-window, and as now and then an inhabitant of the small town passed
-through the street, his fancy was caught by their appearance and his
-imagination excited, and he improvised the most humorous imaginary
-histories about them, which would have furnished a rich treasure for
-Dickens, could he have been the delighted listener, instead of the
-young girl for whose amusement this wealth of invention was extended.”
-Mr. Mason, who appreciated the young man’s humor, as well as his
-professional ability, used to say that “there was never such an actor
-lost to the stage as he would have made had he chosen to turn his
-talents in that direction.”
-
-Daniel was still fragile, not having yet out-grown his early delicacy.
-Dr. Buckminster prescribed as a remedy half an hour’s wood-sawing
-before breakfast, with a long two-handed saw, one end of which he held
-himself. The young lawyer doubtless found this early exercise a good
-appetizer, qualifying him to do full justice to the breakfast that
-succeeded.
-
-Within a year of his removal to Portsmouth Mr. Webster took a step
-most important to his happiness. He was married to Grace Fletcher,
-daughter of Rev. Elijah Fletcher, of Hopkinton. There is no occasion
-in a brief biography like this to speak at length of Mrs. Webster.
-It is sufficient to say that she was qualified by her natural powers
-and acquired culture to be a sympathizing friend and companion to the
-husband whom she saw gradually expanding intellectually, and rising
-higher in reputation, in the twenty years that they lived together.
-
-I have said that Mr. Webster’s removal to Portsmouth brought him a
-wider and more lucrative practice. He still lived plainly, however.
-His office, though more pretentious than the one at Boscawan, which
-he hired for fifteen dollars a year, was, according to Mr. Ticknor,
-“a common, ordinary looking room, with less furniture and more books
-than common. He had a small inner room, opening from the larger, rather
-an unusual thing. He lived in a small, modest wooden house, which was
-burned in the great fire in 1813,” a fire by which he lost a valuable
-library.
-
-Daniel Webster lived in Portsmouth nine years lacking one month. He
-was in no hurry to remove to the still wider field that was waiting
-for him in Boston. He says somewhere that these were very happy years.
-His great powers were gradually expanding. He grew like an oak tree,
-slowly, but his growth was steady, and the result was massive and
-majestic. It was not long before he was regarded as one of the most
-prominent lawyers in his native State, and he was generally matched
-in important suits with Jeremiah Mason, already referred to as the
-undisputed head of the bar. Mr. Mason was a remarkable man, not only
-intellectually but physically. He was a very Titan, almost tall enough
-to have attracted the attention of Barnum had he lived at a later
-period. He was six feet seven inches in height, and naturally attracted
-attention wherever he went—an attention, by the way, which he did not
-court, and which was embarrassing to him. An amusing story is told of
-him which I have somewhere read, and will record from memory.
-
-In spite of his great height Mr. Mason did not sit high, having a
-short body and legs of immense length. One day he was driving in the
-neighborhood of Portsmouth, when in a narrow road he met a man driving
-a cart, a stalwart man, inclined to be a bully, who, confident in his
-strength, was disposed to take advantage of it.
-
-“Turn out!” he said roughly to Mr. Mason.
-
-“My friend,” said the lawyer, who was in a light buggy,” I have already
-given you half the road.”
-
-“No, you haven’t,” answered the other roughly. “At any rate, you must
-turn out more.”
-
-“But I see no justice in that,” said the great lawyer mildly.
-
-The mildness of his manner led the bully to think Mr. Mason was afraid
-of him; so, with an oath, he repeated his demand.
-
-Mr. Mason felt that the matter had gone far enough. He slowly rose in
-his seat; the countryman with astonishment saw what he had supposed to
-be a man of average height towering into gigantic proportions, and he
-became alarmed.
-
-“Hold on!” he shouted; “you needn’t unroll yourself any more. I’ll turn
-out myself.”
-
-This great lawyer, though so often opposed to Webster, was unvaryingly
-kind to him, and as Daniel himself testifies, was of infinite advantage
-to him, not only by his friendship, but by the many good lessons he
-taught him and the example he set him in the commencement of his career.
-
-The young man admired his elder professional brother, and says of him:
-“If there be in the country a stronger intellect, if there be a mind of
-more native resources, if there be a vision that sees quicker or sees
-deeper into whatever is intricate or whatsoever is profound, I must
-confess I have not known it.”
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XIX.
-
-DANIEL OVERCOMES A BRAMBLE.
-
-
-There is no doubt that Mr. Webster derived considerable advantage from
-his association with his elder professional brother. He had adopted a
-style very common with young men, abounding in large words, and made
-his sentences longer than were needful. He observed that Mr. Mason,
-on the other hand, talked to the jury in a plain, conversational way,
-and cultivated simplicity of diction. Yet he was noted for his success
-in winning cases. Daniel was sensible enough to correct his fault and
-prune his too luxuriant style, very much to its improvement.
-
-No admirer of Daniel Webster should fail to read the volume of
-“Reminiscences” by his lifelong friend, Peter Harvey. His confidential
-relations with his distinguished friend make what he records not only
-entertaining but trustworthy and valuable. I shall venture to transfer
-to my pages from Mr. Harvey’s volume an account of two cases in which
-Mr. Webster was engaged during his residence in Portsmouth, with the
-suggestion that the entire volume will amply repay perusal.
-
-“Among Mr. Webster’s reminiscences of his professional career at
-Portsmouth, and of Jeremiah Mason’s connection with it, was one
-relating to a case in which a man named Bramble was implicated. Matthew
-Bramble, it appears, was a wealthy resident of Portsmouth, and, as the
-sequel proved, an unscrupulous man. His social position was good, but
-a feeling of distrust towards him existed in the community. It seems
-that Bramble had given to a man named Brown an annuity bond, agreeing
-to pay him one hundred dollars a year as long as he lived. This was
-to keep dominant a title to some real estate. Bramble had more than
-once tried to persuade Brown to take a ‘lump’ sum of money and cancel
-the bonds, but this Brown persistently declined to do, and in this he
-was supported by the advice of his friends. After in vain offering
-one thousand dollars, Bramble resorted to the following method of
-getting rid of his obligation. He was accustomed, when he paid the
-hundred dollars, to indorse it on the bond. The next chance he got, he
-indorsed, not one hundred dollars, but one thousand dollars, adding ‘in
-full consideration of and canceling this bond.’ Brown, who could not
-read or write, unsuspectingly signed his mark to this indorsement.
-Bramble then coolly handed him back the bond, and of course said
-nothing of the matter.
-
-“When the year came round, an altercation took place between them.
-
-“Bramble said, ‘I owe you nothing; I paid you a thousand dollars, and
-it is certified on your bond.’
-
-“Brown was a poor shoemaker, simple-minded, truthful, weak, not capable
-of coping with this wily scamp. He was friendless, while Bramble was
-a rich man. Poor Brown did not know what to do. He had convinced his
-neighbors that he was right. He went to Jeremiah Mason, who told him
-he was Mr. Bramble’s lawyer. Mr. Mason had asked Bramble about the
-matter, and the latter had showed the bond, and Mr. Mason probably
-believed him. A friend then advised Brown to go to Mr. Webster; and
-after hearing his story, Mr. Webster was quite convinced of the truth
-of Brown’s statement. He had no confidence in Bramble. In relating the
-story, he said to me: ‘I knew nothing positively against Bramble, but
-something impressed me that he was not a man of honor. I was at once
-satisfied that he had committed this fraud upon Brown, and I told the
-latter that I would sue Bramble for the annuity. He said he had nothing
-to give me in payment. I said I wanted nothing. I sent Bramble a
-letter, and he made his appearance in my office.
-
-“’“I should like to know,” he said sharply, “if you are going to take
-up a case of that kind in Portsmouth? It seems to me you don’t know on
-which side your bread is buttered.”
-
-“’“This man has come to me,” I replied, “without friends, and has told
-me a plain, straightforward story, and it sounds as if it were true. It
-is not a made-up story. I shall pursue this thing, and sue you, unless
-you settle it.”’
-
-“Bramble went to Mr. Mason, who afterwards said to Mr. Webster: ‘I
-think you have made a mistake. Bramble is a man of influence. It can’t
-be that the fellow tells the truth. Bramble would not do such a thing
-as that.’
-
-“Mr. Webster replied, ‘He has done just such a thing as that, and I
-shall try the suit.’
-
-“So the preliminary steps were taken, and the suit was brought. The
-case came on at Exeter in the Supreme Court, Judge Smith on the bench.
-It created great excitement. Bramble’s friends were incensed at the
-charge of forgery, and Brown, too, in his humble way, had his friends.
-Mr. Webster said: ‘I never in my life was more badly prepared for a
-case. There was no evidence for Brown, and what to do I did not know.
-But I had begun the suit, and was going to run for luck, perfectly
-satisfied that I was right. There were Bramble and his friends, with
-Mason; and poor Brown had only his counsel. And Mason began to sneer a
-little, saying, “That is a foolish case.”
-
-“’Well, a person named Lovejoy was then living in Portsmouth; and
-when there is a great deal of litigation, as there was in Portsmouth,
-and many towns in New Hampshire, there will always be one person of a
-kind not easily described—a shrewd man who is mixed up in all sorts of
-affairs. Lovejoy was a man of this kind, and was a witness in nearly
-all the cases ever tried in that section. He was an imperturbable
-witness, and never could be shaken in his testimony. Call Lovejoy, and
-he would swear that he was present on such an occasion, and he seemed
-to live by giving evidence in this way. I was getting a little anxious
-about the case. I was going to attempt to prove that Brown had been
-appealed to by Bramble for years to give up his bond, and take a sum of
-money, and that he had always stoutly refused, that he had no uses for
-money, and had never been in the receipt of money, and that he could
-not write, and was easily imposed upon. But although I felt that I was
-right, I began to fear that I should lose the case.
-
-“’A Portsmouth man who believed in Brown’s story came to me just before
-the case was called, and whispered in my ear, “I saw Lovejoy talking
-with Bramble just now in the entry, and he took a paper from him.”
-
-“’I thanked the man, told him that was a pretty important thing to
-know, and asked him to say nothing about it.
-
-“’In the course of the trial Mr. Mason called Lovejoy, and he took
-the oath. He went upon the stand and testified that some eight or
-ten months before he was in Brown’s shop, and that Brown mended his
-shoes for him. As he was sitting in the shop, he naturally fell into
-conversation about the bond, and said to Brown, “Bramble wants to get
-back the bond. Why don’t you sell it to him?” “Oh,” said Brown, “I
-have. He wanted me to do it, and as life is uncertain, I thought I
-might as well take the thousand dollars.” He went on to testify that
-_the said Brown_ told him so and so, and when he expressed himself
-in that way I knew he was being prompted from a written paper.
-The expression was an unnatural one for a man to use in ordinary
-conversation. It occurred to me in an instant that Bramble had given
-Lovejoy a paper, on which was set down what he wanted him to testify.
-There sat Mason, full of assurance, and for a moment I hesitated. Now,
-I thought, I will “make a spoon or spoil a horn.”
-
-“’I took the pen from behind my ear, drew myself up, and marched
-outside the bar to the witness stand.” Sir!” I exclaimed to Lovejoy,
-“give me the paper from which you are testifying!”
-
-“’In an instant he pulled it out of his pocket, but before he had got
-it quite out he hesitated and attempted to put it back. I seized it in
-triumph. There was his testimony in Bramble’s handwriting! Mr. Mason
-got up and claimed the protection of the court. Judge Smith inquired
-the meaning of this proceeding.
-
-“’I said: “Providence protects the innocent when they are friendless. I
-think I could satisfy the court and my learned brother who, of course,
-was ignorant of this man’s conduct, that I hold in Mr. Bramble’s
-handwriting the testimony of the very respectable witness who is on the
-stand.”
-
-“’The court adjourned, and I had nothing further to do. Mason told his
-client that he had better settle the affair as quickly as possible.
-Bramble came to my office, and as he entered I said, “Don’t you come in
-here! I don’t want any thieves in my office.”
-
-“’“Do whatever you please with me, Mr. Webster,” he replied. “I will do
-whatever you say.”
-
-“’“I will do nothing without witnesses. We must arrange this matter.”
-
-“’I consulted Mr. Mason, and he said he did not care how I settled it.
-So I told Bramble that in the first place there must be a new life-bond
-for one hundred dollars a year, and ample security for its payment, and
-that he must also pay Brown five hundred dollars and my fees, which I
-should charge pretty roundly. To all this he assented and thus the case
-ended.’”
-
-Mr. Webster’s professional brothers were very much puzzled to account
-for his knowing that Lovejoy had the paper in his pocket, and it was
-not for a long time that he gratified their curiosity and revealed the
-secret.
-
-My young readers will agree with me that Bramble was a contemptible
-fellow, and that the young lawyer, in revealing and defeating his
-meanness, did an important service not only to his client but to the
-cause of justice, which is often defeated by the very means that
-should secure it. In many cases lawyers lend themselves to the service
-of clients whose iniquity they have good reason to suspect. There is
-no nobler profession than that of law when it is invoked to redress
-grievances and defeat the designs of the wicked; but, as Mr. Webster
-himself has said, “The evil is, that an accursed thirst for money
-violates everything. We cannot study, because we must pettifog. We
-learn the low recourses of attorneyism when we should, learn the
-conceptions, the reasonings and the opinions of Cicero and Murray.
-The love of fame is extinguished, every ardent wish for knowledge
-repressed, conscience put in jeopardy, and the best feelings of the
-heart indurated by the mean, money-catching, abominable practices which
-cover with disgrace a part of the modern practitioners of the law.”
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XX.
-
-“THE LITTLE BLACK STABLE-BOY.”
-
-
-I am tempted to detail another case in which the young lawyer was able
-to do an important service to an acquaintance who had known him in his
-boyhood.
-
-In Grafton County lived a teamster named John Greenough, who was in
-the habit of making periodical trips to and from Boston with a load of
-goods. One day, when a mile or two distant from the house of Daniel’s
-father, his wagon was mired, owing to the size of his load and the
-state of the roads. He found that he could not continue his journey
-without help, and sent to the house of Judge Webster to borrow a span
-of horses.
-
-“Dan,” said the Judge, “take the horses and help Mr. Greenough out of
-his trouble.”
-
-The boy was roughly dressed like an ordinary farm-boy of that time,
-his head being surmounted by a ragged straw hat. He at once obeyed
-his father and gave the teamster the assistance which he so urgently
-required.
-
-The teamster thanked him for his assistance and drove on, giving little
-thought to the boy, or dreaming that the time would come when Dan would
-help him out of a worse scrape.
-
-Years passed and the farm-boy became a lawyer, but Greenough had lost
-track of him, and supposed he was still at work on his father’s farm.
-
-He was a poor man, owning a farm and little else. But a question arose
-as to his title to the farm. Suit was brought against him, and his
-whole property was at stake. He secured legal assistance, his lawyer
-being Moses P. Payson, of Bath. Mr. Payson thought he ought to have
-help, as the case was an important one, and suggested it to his client.
-The latter agreed, and Mr. Payson made his selection.
-
-Soon after, in an interview with Mr. Payson, Greenough inquired, “What
-lawyer have you hired to help you?”
-
-“Mr. Webster,” was the reply.
-
-“Webster, Webster!” repeated Greenough; “I don’t know any lawyer of
-that name. Is he from Boston?”
-
-“Oh, no; he came from your neighborhood,” was the reply. “It is Daniel
-Webster, the son of old Ebenezer Webster, of Salisbury.”
-
-“What!” exclaimed the teamster in dismay; “that little black stable-boy
-that once brought me some horses! Then I think we might as well give
-up the case. Can’t you get somebody else?”
-
-“No; the trial cannot be postponed. We must take our chances and make
-the best of it.”
-
-The teamster went home greatly depressed. He remembered the rough
-looking farm-boy in his rustic garb and old straw hat, and it seemed
-ridiculous that a good lawyer could have been made out of such
-unpromising materials. He was not the first man who had been misled by
-appearances. He was yet to learn that a poor boy may become an able
-lawyer. Of course the case must go on, but he looked forward to the
-result with little hope. He would lose his little farm he felt sure,
-and in his declining years be cast adrift penniless and destitute.
-
-When the day of trial came the teamster was in attendance, but he
-looked sad and depressed. Mr. Payson made the opening speech, and the
-trial proceeded. Mr. Webster was to make the closing argument.
-
-When he rose to speak Greenough looked at him with some curiosity.
-Yes, it was black Dan, a young man now, but as swarthy, though better
-dressed than the boy who had brought him the span of horses to help his
-wagon out of the mire.
-
-“What can he do?” thought the teamster, not without contempt.
-
-Daniel began to speak, and soon warmed to his work. He seemed
-thoroughly master of the case, and as he proceeded the teamster was
-surprised, and finally absorbed in his words. He drew nearer and drank
-in every word that fell from the lips of the “little black stable-boy,”
-as he had recently termed him.
-
-The jury were no less interested, and when the plea closed it was clear
-how they would render their verdict.
-
-Mr. Payson approached his client, and said with a smile, “Well, Mr.
-Greenough, what do you think of him now?”
-
-“Think!” exclaimed the teamster. “Why, I think he is an angel sent from
-heaven to save me from ruin, and my wife and children from misery.”
-
-The case was won, and Greenough returned home happy that his little
-farm would not be taken from him.
-
-Many lawyers aspire to the judicial office as the crowning professional
-dignity which they may wear with pride. But some of the greatest
-lawyers are not fitted for that office. They are born advocates, and
-the more brilliant they are the less, perhaps, do they possess that
-fair and even judgment which is requisite in a judge. Daniel Webster
-understood that his talents were not of a judicial character. At a
-later day (in 1840) he wrote to a friend as follows: “For my own part,
-I never could be a judge. There never was a time when I would have
-taken the office of chief justice of the United States or any other
-judicial station. I believe the truth may be that I have mixed so much
-study of politics with my study of law that, though I have some respect
-for myself as an advocate, and some estimate of my knowledge of general
-principles, yet I am not confident of possessing all the accuracy and
-precision of knowledge which the bench requires.”
-
-For nearly nine years Daniel Webster practiced law in Portsmouth. He
-could not have selected a more prominent place in New Hampshire; but
-the time came when he felt that for many reasons he should seek a
-larger field. One reason, which deservedly carried weight, was, that
-in a small town his income must necessarily be small. During these
-years of busy activity he never received in fees more than two thousand
-dollars a year. Fees were small then compared with what they are now,
-when lawyers by no means distinguished often charge more for their
-services in a single case than young Webster’s entire yearly income at
-that time.
-
-When the time came for removal the young lawyer hesitated between
-Boston, Albany and New York, but finally decided in favor of the
-first place. Of his removal we shall have occasion to speak further
-presently. Before doing so it is well to say that these nine years,
-though they brought Mr. Webster but little money, did a great deal
-for him in other ways. He was not employed in any great cases, or
-any memorable trials, though he and Jeremiah Mason were employed
-in the most important cases which came before the New Hampshire
-courts. Generally they were opposed to each other, and in his older
-professional compeer Daniel found a foeman worthy of his steel. He
-always had to do his best when Mason was engaged on the other side.
-That he fully appreciated Mr. Mason’s ability is evident from his
-tribute to him paid in a conversation with another eminent rival, Rufus
-Choate.
-
-“I have known Jeremiah Mason,” he said, “longer than I have known
-any other eminent man. He was the first man of distinction in the
-law whom I knew, and when I first became acquainted with him he was
-in full practice. I knew that generation of lawyers as a younger man
-knows those who are his superiors in age—by tradition, reputation and
-hearsay, and by occasionally being present and hearing their efforts.
-In this way I knew Luther Martin, Edmund Randolph, Goodloe Hart, and
-all those great lights of the law; and by the way, I think, on the
-whole, that was an abler bar than the present one—of course with some
-brilliant exceptions. Of the present bar of the United States I think
-I am able to form a pretty fair opinion, having an intimate personal
-knowledge of them in the local and federal courts; and this I can say,
-that I regard Jeremiah Mason as eminently superior to any other lawyer
-whom I ever met. I should rather with my own experience (and I have
-had some pretty tough experience with him) meet them all combined in
-a case, than to meet him alone and single-handed. He was the keenest
-lawyer I ever met or read about. If a man had Jeremiah Mason and he
-did not get his case, no human ingenuity or learning could get it. He
-drew from a very deep fountain. Yes, I should think he did,” added Mr.
-Webster, smiling, “from his great height.”
-
-The young reader will remember that Mr. Mason was six feet seven inches
-in height.
-
-It is always of great service when a young man is compelled at all
-times to do his best. Daniel could not oppose such a lawyer as he
-describes Mr. Mason without calling forth all his resources. It
-happened, therefore, that the nine years he spent in Portsmouth were by
-no means wasted, but contributed to develop and enlarge his powers,
-and provide him with resources which were to be of service to him in
-the broader and more conspicuous field in which he was soon to exercise
-his powers.
-
-Furthermore, during these nine years he first entered the arena where
-he was to gather unfading laurels, and establish his reputation not
-only as a great lawyer, but one of the foremost statesmen of any age.
-
-I allude to his election to Congress, in which he took his seat for
-the first time on the 24th of May, 1813, as a Representative from New
-Hampshire.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XXI.
-
-WHY DANIEL WAS SENT TO CONGRESS.
-
-
-Even in his Sophomore year at college Daniel had taken a considerable
-interest in public affairs, as might readily be shown by extracts from
-his private correspondence. This interest continued after he entered
-upon the practice of the law, but up to the period of his election
-to Congress he had never filled a public office. It is generally the
-case with our public men that they serve one or more preliminary terms
-in one or both branches of the State Legislature, thus obtaining a
-practical knowledge of parliamentary proceedings. This was not the case
-with Mr. Webster. His public career would probably have been still
-further postponed but for the unfortunate state of our relations with
-England and France for some years preceding the war of 1812.
-
-I can only allude very briefly to the causes which had almost
-annihilated our commerce and paralyzed our prosperity. Both England
-and France had been guilty of aggressions upon our commercial rights,
-and the former government especially had excited indignation by its
-pretended right to search American vessels, for British seamen and
-deserters. This was intensified by the retaliatory order of Napoleon,
-issued Dec. 17, 1807, known as the Milan Décrets, in accordance with
-which every vessel, of whatever nationality, that submitted to be
-searched, forfeited its neutral character, and even neutral vessels
-sailing between British ports were declared lawful prizes. Thus America
-was between two fires, and there seemed to be small chance of escape
-for any. Moreover, Great Britain interdicted all trade by neutrals
-between ports not friendly to her, and the United States was one of the
-chief sufferers from the extraordinary assumptions of the two hostile
-powers.
-
-To save our vessels from depredation President Jefferson recommended
-what is known as the Embargo, which prevented the departure of our
-vessels from our own ports, and thus of course suspended our commercial
-relations with the rest of the world. The Embargo was never a popular
-measure, and its effects were felt to be widely injurious. I do not
-propose to discuss the question, but merely to state that in 1808 Mr.
-Webster published a pamphlet upon the Embargo, and, as his biographer
-claims, this must be regarded as his first appearance in a public
-character. I must refer such of my readers as desire more fully to
-understand the condition of public affairs and the part that the young
-lawyer took therein to the first volume of Mr. Curtis’s memoir.
-
-It may be stated here, however, to explain the special interest which
-he felt in the matter, that Portsmouth, as a seaport, was largely
-affected by the suspension of American commerce, and its citizens
-felt an interest easily explained in what was so disastrous to their
-business prosperity.
-
-On the Fourth of July, 1812, Mr. Webster delivered by invitation an
-oration before the “Washington Benevolent Society,” of Portsmouth, in
-which he discussed in a vigorous way the policy of the government,
-which he did not approve. Sixteen days before Congress had declared
-war against England. To this war Mr. Webster was opposed. Whatever
-grievances the government may have suffered from England, he contended
-that there was “still more abundant cause of war against France.”
-Moreover America was not prepared for war. The navy had been suffered
-to fall into neglect during Jefferson’s administration, until it was
-utterly insufficient for the defense of our coasts and harbors.
-
-On this point he says: “If the plan of Washington had been pursued,
-and our navy had been suffered to grow with the growth of our commerce
-and navigation, what a blow might at this moment be struck, and what
-protection yielded, surrounded, as our commerce now is, with all the
-dangers of sudden war! Even as it is, all our immediate hopes of glory
-or conquest, all expectation of events that shall gratify the pride
-or spirit of the nation, rest on the gallantry of that little remnant
-of a navy that has now gone forth, like lightning, at the beck of
-Government, to scour the seas.
-
-“It will not be a bright page in our history which relates the total
-abandonment of all provision for naval defense by the successors of
-Washington. Not to speak of policy and expediency, it will do no credit
-to the national faith, stipulated and plighted as it was to that object
-in every way that could make the engagement solemn and obligatory. So
-long as our commerce remains unprotected, and our coasts and harbors
-undefended by naval and maritime means, the essential objects of the
-Union remain unanswered, and the just expectation of those who assented
-to it, unanswered.
-
-“A part of our navy has been suffered to go to entire decay; another
-part has been passed, like an article of useless lumber, under the
-hammer of the auctioneer. As if the millennium had already commenced,
-our politicians have beaten their swords into plowshares. They have
-actually bargained away in the market essential means of national
-defense, and carried the product to the Treasury. Without loss by
-accident or by enemies the second commercial nation in the world is
-reduced to the limitation of being unable to assert the sovereignty of
-its own seas, or to protect its navigation in sight of its own shores.
-What war and the waves have sometimes done for others, we have done for
-ourselves. We have taken the destruction of our marine out of the power
-of fortune, and richly achieved it by our own counsels.”
-
-This address made a profound impression, voicing as it did the general
-public feeling in New Hampshire on the subjects of which it treated.
-It led to an assembly of the people of Rockingham County a few weeks
-later, called to prepare a memorial to the President protesting against
-the war. To this convention Mr. Webster was appointed a delegate, and
-it was he who was selected to draft what has been since known as the
-“Rockingham Memorial.”
-
-One of the most noteworthy passages in this memorial—noteworthy because
-it is an early expression of his devotion to the Union—I find quoted
-by Mr. Curtis, and I shall follow his lead in transferring it to my
-pages.
-
-“We are, sir, from principle and habit attached to the Union of these
-States. But our attachment is to the substance, and not to the form.
-It is to the good which this Union is capable of producing, and not to
-the evil which is suffered unnaturally to grow out of it. If the time
-should ever arrive when this Union shall be holden together by nothing
-but the authority of law; when its incorporating, vital principles
-shall become extinct; when its principal exercises shall consist in
-acts of power and authority, not of protection and beneficence; when
-it shall lose the strong bond which it hath hitherto had in the public
-affections; and when, consequently, we shall be one, not in interest
-and mutual regard, but in name and form only—we, sir, shall look on
-that hour as the closing scene of our country’s prosperity.
-
-“We shrink from the separation of the States as an event fraught with
-incalculable evils, and it is among our strongest objections to the
-present course of measures that they have, in our opinion, a very
-dangerous and alarming bearing on such an event. If a separation of
-the States ever should take place, it will be on some occasion when
-one portion of the country undertakes to control, to regulate and to
-sacrifice the interest of another; when a small and heated majority
-in the Government, taking counsel of their passions, and not of their
-reason, contemptuously disregarding the interests and perhaps stopping
-the mouths of a large and respectable minority, shall by hasty, rash
-and ruinious measures, threaten to destroy essential rights, and lay
-waste the most important interests.
-
-“It shall be our most fervent supplication to Heaven to avert both the
-event and the occasion; and the Government may be assured that the tie
-that binds us to the Union will never be broken by us.”
-
-Even my young readers will be struck by the judicial calmness, the
-utter absence of heated partisanship, which mark the extracts I
-have made, and they will recall the passage well known to every
-schoolboy—the grand closing passage of the reply to Hayne.
-
-As regards style it will be seen that, though yet a young man, Mr.
-Webster had made a very marked advance on the Fourth of July address
-which he delivered while yet a college-student. He was but thirty years
-old when the memorial was drafted, and in dignified simplicity and
-elevation of tone it was worthy of his later days. The young lawyer,
-whose time had hitherto been employed upon cases of trifling moment in
-a country town, had been ripening his powers, and expanding into the
-intellectual proportions of a statesman. It was evident at any rate
-that his neighbors thought so, for he was nominated as a Representative
-to the Thirteenth Congress, in due time elected, and, as has already
-been stated, he first took his seat at a special session called by the
-President on the 24th of May, 1813.
-
-It was in this Congress that Daniel Webster made the acquaintance
-of two eminent men, with whose names his own is now most frequently
-associated—Henry Clay, of Kentucky, and John C. Calhoun, of South
-Carolina.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XXII.
-
-MR. WEBSTER AS A MEMBER OF CONGRESS.
-
-
-Before I proceed to speak of Mr. Webster’s Congressional career, I
-will make room for a professional anecdote, which carries with it an
-excellent lesson for my young readers.
-
-I find it in Harvey’s “Reminiscences,” already alluded to.
-
-“In the first years of his professional life a blacksmith called on him
-for advice respecting the title to a small estate bequeathed to him
-by his father. The terms of the will were peculiar, and the kind of
-estate transmitted was doubtful. An attempt had been made to annull the
-will. Mr. Webster examined the case, but was unable to give a definite
-opinion upon the matter for want of authorities. He looked through the
-law libraries of Mr. Mason and other legal gentlemen for authorities,
-but in vain. He ascertained what works he needed for consultation, and
-ordered them from Boston at an expense of fifty dollars. He spent the
-leisure hours of some weeks in going through them. He successfully
-argued the case when it came on for trial, and it was decided in his
-favor.
-
-“The blacksmith was in ecstasies, for his little all had been at stake.
-He called for his attorney’s bill. Mr. Webster, knowing his poverty,
-charged him only fifteen dollars, intending to suffer the loss of
-money paid out, and to lose the time expended in securing a verdict.
-Years passed away, and the case was forgotten, but not the treasured
-knowledge by which it was won. On one of his journeys to Washington Mr.
-Webster spent a few days in New York City. While he was there Aaron
-Burr waited on him for advice in a very important case pending in the
-State court. He told him the facts on which it was founded. Mr. Webster
-saw in a moment that it was an exact counterpart to the blacksmith’s
-will case. On being asked if he could state the law applicable to it he
-at once replied that he could.
-
-“He proceeded to quote decisions bearing upon the case, going back to
-the time of Charles II. As he went on with his array of principles
-and authorities, all cited with the precision and order of a table of
-contents, Mr. Burr arose in astonishment and asked with some warmth,
-
-“‘Mr. Webster, have you been consulted before in this case?’
-
-“‘Most certainly not,’ he replied. ‘I never heard of your case till
-this evening.’
-
-“‘Very well,’ said Mr. Burr; ‘proceed.’
-
-“Mr. Webster concluded the rehearsal of his authorities, and received
-from Mr. Burr the warmest praise of his profound knowledge of the law,
-and a fee large enough to remunerate him for all the time and trouble
-spent on the blacksmith’s case.”
-
-I have recorded this anecdote, partly to show the tenacity of Mr.
-Webster’s memory, which, after a lapse of years, enabled him so exactly
-to repeat the authorities he had relied upon in an old case; partly,
-also, to show how thoroughly he was wont to prepare himself, even in
-cases where he could expect but a small fee. In this case, not only
-did he subsequently turn his knowledge to profitable account, but he
-lost nothing by the kindness of heart which prompted him to place his
-best powers at the service of an humble client. My young readers will
-find that knowledge never comes amiss, but, in the course of a long and
-sometimes of a short life, we are generally able to employ it for our
-advantage.
-
-I come back to Daniel Webster’s entrance upon Congressional duties.
-
-He had reached the age of thirty-one, while Henry Clay, who occupied
-the Speaker’s chair, was five years older. Mr. Clay came forward much
-earlier in public life than his great rival. Though but thirty-six, he
-had twice been a member of the United States Senate, being in each case
-elected to serve the balance of an unexpired term. He had been a member
-of the Legislature of Kentucky, and Speaker of that body, and now he
-was serving, not for the first time, as Speaker of the U. S. House of
-Representatives. John C. Calhoun was the leading member of the House,
-and he as well as Mr. Clay favored the policy of the administration,
-both being supporters of the war. Other distinguished members there
-were, among them John McLean, of Ohio; Charles J. Ingersoll, of
-Pennsylvania; William Gaston, of North Carolina, and Felix Grundy, of
-Tennessee.
-
-Though Mr. Webster was a new member he was placed upon the Committee on
-Foreign Relations, at that time of course the most important position
-which could have been assigned him. This may be inferred from the
-names of his fellow members. He found himself associated with Calhoun,
-Grundy, Jackson, Fish and Ingersoll. He was, as I have stated, not in
-favor of the war, but since it had been inaugurated he took the ground
-that it should be vigorously prosecuted. He did not long remain silent,
-but took his stand both in the committee and in the House as one who
-thought the war inexpedient.
-
-It does not fall within the scope of this volume to detail the steps
-which the young member took in order to impress his views upon his
-fellow members; but, as a specimen of his oratory at that time, and
-because it will explain them sufficiently, I quote from a speech made
-by him in the regular session during the year 1814:
-
-“The humble aid which it would be in my power to render to measures
-of Government shall be given cheerfully, if Government will pursue
-measures which I can conscientiously support. Badly as I think of the
-original grounds of the war, as well as of the manner in which it
-has hitherto been conducted, if even now, failing in an honest and
-sincere attempt to procure just and honorable peace, it will return
-to measures of defence and protection such as reason and common sense
-and the public opinion all call for, my vote shall not be withholden
-from the means. Give up your futile object of invasion. Extinguish the
-fires that blaze on your inland frontier. Establish perfect safety and
-defense there by adequate force. Let every man that sleeps on your soil
-sleep in security. Stop the blood that flows from the veins of unarmed
-yeomanry and women and children. Give to the living time to bury and
-lament their dead in the quietness of private sorrow.
-
-“Having performed this work of beneficence and mercy on your inland
-border, turn and look with the eye of justice and compassion on your
-vast population along the coast. Unclinch the iron grasp of your
-Embargo. Take measures for that end before another sun sets upon you.
-With all the war of the enemy on your commerce, if you would cease
-to war on it yourselves you would still have some commerce. Apply
-that revenue to the augmentation of your navy. That navy will in turn
-protect your commerce. Let it no longer be said that not one ship of
-force, built by your hands, yet floats upon the ocean.
-
-“Turn the current of your efforts into the channel which national
-sentiment has already worn broad and deep to receive it. A naval
-force, competent to defend your coast against considerable armaments,
-to convoy your trade, and perhaps raise the blockade of your rivers,
-is not a chimera. It may be realized. If, then, the war must be
-continued, go to the ocean. If you are seriously contending for
-maritime rights, go to the theater where alone those rights can be
-defended. Thither every indication of your fortune points you. There
-the united wishes and exertions of the nation will go with you. Even
-our party divisions, acrimonious as they are, cease at the water’s
-edge. They are lost in attachment to national character on the element
-where that character is made respectable. In protecting naval interests
-by naval means, you will arm yourselves with the whole power of
-national sentiment, and may command the whole abundance of the national
-resources. In time you may enable yourselves to redress injuries in the
-place where they may be offered, and, if need be, to accompany your own
-flag throughout the world with the protection of your own cannon.”
-
-My young reader, without knowing much about the matter at issue, will
-nevertheless be struck with the statesmanlike character of these
-utterances. It is not often that a new member of Congress is able to
-discuss public matters with such fullness of knowledge, and in a tone
-of such dignity and elevation of sentiment. His fellow legislators were
-not long in learning that the new member from New Hampshire was no raw
-novice, but a publicist of remarkable ability, knowledge, and a trained
-orator. In a discussion which sprang up between Mr. Webster and Mr.
-Calhoun, the conceded leader of the House, the honors were at least
-divided, if Mr. Webster did not win the larger portion.
-
-While the young man was thus coming into national prominence his
-residence in Washington helped him in a professional way. He began to
-practice in the Supreme Court of the United States, being employed in
-several prize cases. Judge Marshall was at that time chief justice, and
-of him the young lawyer formed an exalted opinion. “I have never seen a
-man,” he writes, “of whose intellect I had a higher opinion.”
-
-On the 18th of April, 1814, the session of Congress terminated, and
-Mr. Webster undertook the long and toilsome journey from Washington
-to his New Hampshire home. It was not the same home which he left
-when he was called a year earlier to attend the special session. His
-house and library were destroyed by fire, and though the loss was
-but six thousand dollars, it was a severe set-back to a lawyer whose
-professional income had never exceeded two thousand dollars. He bore
-the loss, however, with equanimity, since it involved only a loss of
-money. His talent and education remained, and these were to earn him
-hundreds of thousands of dollars in the years to come.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XXIII.
-
-JOHN RANDOLPH AND WILLIAM PINKNEY.
-
-
-Mr. Webster served four years in Congress as a Representative from his
-native State. He had reached the age of thirty-one when he entered
-the public service, and therefore, though not the youngest, was
-among the youngest members of that important body. As we have seen,
-though without previous legislative experience, he advanced at once
-to a leading place and took prominent part in all the discussions
-of important questions, his opinions always carrying weight. He was
-opposed to the administration and its war policy, but he opposed it in
-no factious spirit.
-
-He distinguished himself particularly by his speeches on finance.
-When a bill was proposed to establish a national bank, with a capital
-of fifty millions of dollars, of which only four millions was to be
-specie, and the balance to consist of Government stocks, then very much
-depreciated, Mr. Webster rode forty miles on horseback from Baltimore
-to Washington, in order to defeat what he regarded as a scheme to
-create an irredeemable paper currency, fraught with widespread mischief
-to the country. The vigorous speech which he made defeated the bill.
-It is interesting to record that Mr. Calhoun, when the vote was
-announced, walked across the floor of the House to where Mr. Webster
-stood, and holding out both hands to him, told him that he should rely
-upon his help to prepare a new bill of a proper character. When this
-assurance was given Mr. Calhoun’s feelings were so stirred that he
-burst into tears, so deeply did he feel the importance of some aid for
-the Government, which he felt with Mr. Webster’s co-operation might be
-secured.
-
-It may be stated here that these great men cherished for each other
-mutual respect and friendship, widely as they differed on some points.
-The Senator from South Carolina showed this in a notable manner when he
-arose from his deathbed (his death followed in a few days), and sat in
-his place to listen to his great friend’s seventh of March speech, in
-1850, looking a wan and spectral auditor from the next world.
-
-The battle for sound money which Mr. Webster fought then has been
-renewed in later years, as some of my young readers may be aware. In
-his speeches he showed a thorough mastery of the subject which he
-discussed. He showed the evils of a debased coin, a depreciated paper
-currency, and a depressed and falling public credit, and it is largely
-due to his efforts that the country emerged from its chaotic financial
-condition with as little injury as it did.
-
-I have spoken of Mr. Webster’s relations then and later to Mr. Calhoun.
-Among the members of the House representing Virginia was the famous
-John Randolph, of Roanoke, with whom it was difficult for any one
-to keep on good terms. He saw fit to take offense at something said
-by Mr. Webster, and sent him a challenge. Webster was never charged
-by any man with physical cowardice, but he thoroughly despised the
-practice of dueling. He was not to be coerced into fighting by any fear
-that cowardice would be imputed to him. This may seem to us a very
-trivial matter, but seventy years ago and even much later, it required
-considerable moral courage to refuse a challenge. I place on record, as
-likely to interest my readers, the letter in which Mr. Webster declined
-to give satisfaction in the manner demanded.
-
-“SIR: For having declined to comply with your demand yesterday in the
-House for an explanation of words of a general nature used in debate,
-you now ‘demand of me that satisfaction which your insulted feelings
-require,’ and refer me to your friend, Mr.——, I presume, as he is the
-bearer of your note, for such arrangements as are usual.
-
-“This demand for explanation you, in my judgment, as a matter of right
-were not entitled to make on me, nor were the temper and style of your
-own reply to my objection to the sugar tax of a character to induce me
-to accord it as a matter of courtesy.
-
-“Neither can I, under the circumstances of the case, recognize in you a
-right to call me to the field to answer what you may please to consider
-an insult to your feelings.
-
-“It is unnecessary for me to state other and obvious considerations
-growing out of this case. It is enough that I do not feel myself bound
-at all times and under any circumstances to accept from any man who
-shall choose to risk his own life an invitation of this sort, although
-I shall be always prepared to repel in a suitable manner the aggression
-of any man who may presume upon such a refusal.
-
- “Your obedient servant,
-
- “DANIEL WEBSTER.”
-
-Mr. Randolph did not press the matter nor did he presume upon the
-refusal, but the matter was adjusted amicably. Nearly forty years
-later a similar reply to a challenge was sent by a later Senator from
-Massachusetts, Henry Wilson, and in both cases the resolute character
-of the men was so well known that no one dared to taunt the writer with
-cowardice.
-
-While upon the subject of physical courage I am tempted to transcribe
-from Mr. Harvey’s interesting volume an anecdote in which the famous
-lawyer, William Pinkney, is prominently mentioned. In answer to the
-question whether he ever carried pistols, Mr. Webster answered:
-
-“No, I never did. I always trusted to my strong arm, and I do not
-believe in pistols. There were some Southern men whose blood was hot
-and who got very much excited in debate, and I used myself to get
-excited, but I never resorted to any such extremity as the use of
-pistols.
-
-“The nearest I ever came to a downright row was with Mr. William
-Pinkney. Mr. Pinkney was the acknowledged head and leader of the
-American bar. He was the great practitioner at Washington when I was
-admitted to practice in the courts there. I found Mr. Pinkney by
-universal concession the very head of the bar—a lawyer of extraordinary
-accomplishments and withal a very wonderful man. But with all that
-there was something about him that was very small. He did things that
-one would hardly think it possible that a gentleman of his breeding and
-culture and great weight as a lawyer could do.
-
-“He was a very vain man. One saw it in every motion he made. When he
-came into court he was dressed in the very extreme of fashion—almost
-like a dandy. He would wear into the court-room his white gloves that
-had been put on fresh that morning and that he never put on again.
-He usually rode from his house to the Capitol on horseback, and his
-overalls were taken off and given to his servant who attended him.
-Pinkney showed in his whole appearance that he considered himself the
-great man of that arena, and that he expected deference to be paid
-to him as the acknowledged leader of the bar. He had a great many
-satellites—men of course much less eminent than himself at the bar—who
-flattered him, and employed him to take their briefs and argue their
-cases, they doing the work and he receiving the greatest share of the
-pay. That was the position that Mr. Pinkney occupied when I entered the
-bar at Washington.
-
-“I was a lawyer who had my living to get, and I felt that although I
-should not argue my cases as well as he could, still, if my clients
-employed me they should have the best ability I had to give them, and
-I should do the work myself. I did not propose to practice law in the
-Supreme Court by proxy. I think that in some pretty important cases I
-had Mr. Pinkney rather expected that I should fall into the current of
-his admirers and share my fees with him. This I utterly refused to do.
-
-“In some important case (I have forgotten what the case was) Mr.
-Pinkney was employed to argue it against me. I was going to argue it
-for my client myself. I had felt that on several occasions his manner
-was, to say the least, very annoying and aggravating. My intercourse
-with him, so far as I had any, was always marked with great courtesy
-and deference. I regarded him as the leader of the American bar; he
-had that reputation and justly. He was a very great lawyer. On the
-occasion to which I refer, in some colloquial discussion upon various
-minor points of the case he treated me with contempt. He pooh-poohed,
-as much as to say it was not worth while to argue a point that I did
-not know anything about, that I was no lawyer. I think he spoke of
-‘the gentleman from New Hampshire.’ At any rate, it was a thing that
-everybody in the court-house, including the judges, could not fail to
-observe. Chief Justice Marshall himself was pained by it. It was very
-hard for me to restrain my temper and keep cool, but I did so, knowing
-in what presence I stood. I think he construed my apparent humility
-into a want of what he would call spirit in resisting, and as a sort of
-acquiescence in his rule.
-
-“However the incident passed, the case was not finished when the hour
-for adjournment came, and the court adjourned until the next morning.
-
-“Mr. Pinkney took his whip and gloves, threw his cloak over his arm,
-and began to saunter away.
-
-“I went up to him and said very calmly, ‘Can I see you alone in one of
-the lobbies?’
-
-“He replied, ‘Certainly.’ I suppose he thought I was going to beg his
-pardon and ask his assistance. We passed one of the anterooms of the
-Capitol. I looked into one of the grand jury rooms, rather remote from
-the main court-room. There was no one in it, and we entered. As we did
-so I looked at the door, and found that there was a key in the lock;
-and, unobserved by him, I turned the key and put it in my pocket. Mr.
-Pinkney seemed to be waiting in some astonishment.
-
-“I advanced towards him and said: ‘Mr. Pinkney, you grossly insulted
-me in the court-room, and not for the first time either. In deference
-to your position, and to the respect in which I hold the court, I did
-not answer you as I was tempted to do on the spot.’
-
-“He began to parley.
-
-“I continued. ‘You know you did; don’t add another sin to that; don’t
-deny it; you know you did it, and you know it was premeditated. It was
-deliberate; it was purposely done; and if you deny it, you state an
-untruth. Now,’ I went on, ‘I am here to say to you, once for all, that
-you must ask my pardon, and go into court to-morrow morning and repeat
-the apology, or else either you or I will go out of this room in a
-different condition from that in which we entered it.’
-
-“I was never more in earnest. He looked at me, and saw that my eyes
-were pretty dark and firm. He began to say something. I interrupted him.
-
-“‘No explanation,’ said I; ‘admit the fact, and take it back. I do not
-want another word from you except that. I will hear no explanation;
-nothing but that you admit it and recall it.’
-
-“He trembled like an aspen leaf. He again attempted to explain.
-
-“Said I, ‘There is no other course. I have the key in my pocket, and
-you must apologize, or take what I give you.’
-
-“At that he humbled down, and said to me: ‘You are right, I am sorry; I
-did intend to bluff you; I regret it, and ask your pardon.’
-
-“‘Enough,’ I promptly replied. ‘Now, one promise before I open the
-door; and that is, that you will to-morrow state to the court that you
-have said things which wounded my feelings, and that you regret it.’
-
-“Pinkney replied, ‘I will do so.’
-
-“Then I unlocked the door, and passed out.
-
-“The next morning, when the court met, Mr. Pinkney at once rose, and
-stated to the court that a very unpleasant affair had occurred the
-morning before, as might have been observed by their honors; that his
-friend, Mr. Webster, had felt grieved at some things which had dropped
-from his lips; that his zeal for his client might have led him to say
-some things which he should not have said, and that he was sorry for
-having thus spoken.’
-
-“From that day,” adds Mr. Webster, “there was no man who treated me
-with so much respect and deference as Mr. William Pinkney.”
-
-I have recorded this anecdote that my young readers may understand
-clearly that the young lawyer was manly and self-respecting, and
-declined the method of satisfaction then in vogue from high and
-honorable motives.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XXIV.
-
-MR. WEBSTER IN BOSTON.
-
-
-Before his second Congressional term had expired, Mr. Webster carried
-out a plan which was first suggested by the destruction of his house
-and library. His talents demanded a wider arena. Moreover, his growing
-family necessitated a style of living for which his professional income
-was insufficient. Happily as his life had flowed on in the chief town
-in his native State, he felt that he must seek a new residence. For a
-time he hesitated between Albany and Boston, but happily for the latter
-he decided in its favor, and in August, 1816, he removed thither with
-his family, fixing his home in a house on Mt. Vernon Street, but a few
-rods from the State House.
-
-It mattered not where Daniel Webster might choose to locate himself, he
-was sure to take at once a leading position both as a lawyer and a man.
-He was now thirty-four years old. He had outlived his early delicacy,
-and began to assume that dignity and majesty of mein which made him
-everywhere a marked man. Appearances are oftentimes deceptive, but in
-his case it was not so. That outward majesty which has been quaintly
-described in the statement that “when Daniel Webster walked the streets
-of Boston he made the buildings look small,” was but the sign and
-manifestation of a corresponding intellectual greatness. By his removal
-New Hampshire lost her greatest son, and Boston gained its foremost
-citizen.
-
-His expectations of a largely increased professional income were fully
-realized. In Portsmouth his fees had never exceeded two thousand
-dollars per year. The third year after his removal his fee-book foots
-up over fifteen thousand dollars as the receipts of a single year, and
-this record is probably incomplete. His biographer, Mr. Curtis, says:
-“I am satisfied that his income, from 1818 until he again entered
-Congress in 1823, could not have been on an average less than $20,000 a
-year, though the customary fees of such counsel at that time were about
-one half of what they are now.” Now, for the first time, he was able
-to pay in full his father’s debts, which he had voluntarily assumed,
-declining to have his small estate thrown into bankruptcy.
-
-I shall have occasion, hereafter, to point out with regret the fact
-that his expenses increased even more rapidly than his income, and
-that he voluntarily incurred debts and pecuniary obligations which all
-his life long harassed him, and held him in an entirely unnecessary
-thraldom. On the subject of national finance Mr. Webster, as we have
-seen, held the soundest views; but in the management of his own
-finances, for the larger portion of his active life he displayed an
-incapacity to control his expenditures and confine them within his
-income which caused his best friends to grieve. In this respect, at any
-rate, I cannot present the hero whom we so deservedly admire as a model.
-
-The large increase in Mr. Webster’s income is sufficient to prove
-that he was employed in the most important cases. But fifteen years
-had elapsed since, as a raw graduate of a country college, he humbly
-sought an opportunity to study in the office of a well-known Boston
-lawyer. Now he took his place at the bar, and rapidly gained a much
-higher position than the man who had kindly extended to him a welcome.
-It is to the credit of Mr. Gore’s ability to read character and
-judge of ability that he foresaw and predicted all this when through
-his influence his student was led to decline the clerkship of a New
-Hampshire court, which then would have filled the measure of his
-ambition.
-
-And how was all this gained? I can assure my young readers that no
-great lawyer, no great writer, no great member of any profession,
-lounges into greatness. Daniel Webster worked, and worked hard. He
-rose early, not only because it gave him an opportunity of doing
-considerable while he was fresh and elastic, but because he had a
-country boy’s love of nature. Whether in city or country, the early
-morning hours were dear to him. As Mr. Lee says, “He did a large amount
-of work before others were awake in the house, and in the evening he
-was ready for that sweet sleep which ‘God gives to his beloved.’”
-
-During the period which elapsed between his arrival in Boston and his
-return to Congress as a Representative of his adopted city his life was
-crowded, and he appeared in many notable cases. But there was one which
-merits special mention, because he was enabled to do a great service to
-the college where he had been educated, and prove himself in a signal
-manner a grateful and loyal son.
-
-Of the celebrated Dartmouth College case I do not consider it necessary
-for my present purpose to speak in detail. It is sufficient to say
-that it was menaced with a serious peril. The chartered rights of the
-college were threatened by legislative interference; nay, more, an
-act was passed, and pronounced valid by the courts of New Hampshire,
-which imperilled the usefulness and prosperity of the institution. The
-matter was carried before the Supreme Court of the United States, and
-Mr. Webster’s services were secured. The argument which he made on that
-occasion established his reputation as a great lawyer. The closing
-portion was listened to with absorbing interest. It was marked by deep
-feeling on the part of the speaker. It is as follows:
-
-“This, sir, is my case. It is the case not merely of that humble
-institution, it is the case of every college in our land; it is
-more, it is the case of every eleemosynary institution throughout
-our country—of all those great charities founded by the piety of our
-ancestors, to alleviate human misery, and scatter blessings along
-the pathway of life. It is more! It is, in some sense, the case of
-every man among us who has property of which he may stripped, for the
-question is simply this: ‘Shall our State Legislatures be allowed to
-take that which is not their own, to turn it from its original use, and
-apply it to such ends or purposes as they in their discretion shall see
-fit?’
-
-“Sir, you may destroy this little institution; it is weak; it is in
-your hands. I know it is one of the lesser lights in the literary
-horizon of our country. You may put it out. But if you do so, you must
-carry through your work! You must extinguish, one after another, all
-those greater lights of science which, for more than a century, have
-thrown their light over our land!
-
-“It is, sir, as I have said, a small college, and yet there are those
-who love it—”
-
-Here the orator was overcome by emotion. His lips quivered, and his
-eyes filled with tears. The effect was extraordinary. All who heard
-him, from Chief Justice Marshall to the humblest attendant, were borne
-away on the tide of emotion as he gave expression in a few broken words
-to the tenderness which he felt for his Alma Mater.
-
-When he recovered his composure, he continued in deep, thrilling tones,
-“Sir, I know not how others may feel, but for myself, when I see my
-Alma Mater surrounded, like Cæsar in the Senate-house, by those who are
-reiterating stab after stab, I would not, for this right hand, have her
-turn to me, and say, ’Et tu quoque mi fili! And thou too, my son!’”
-
-This speech, which was masterly in point of logic as well as a powerful
-appeal to the feelings, was successful, and the opponents of the
-college were disastrously defeated.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XXV.
-
-THE ORATION AT PLYMOUTH.
-
-
-The three-fold character in which Daniel Webster achieved greatness
-was as lawyer, orator and statesman. In this respect he must be placed
-at the head of the immortal three whose names are usually conjoined.
-Mr. Calhoun did not pretend to be a lawyer, and Mr. Clay, though he
-practiced law, possessed but a small share of legal erudition, and
-when he gained cases, was indebted to his eloquence rather than to his
-mastery of the legal points involved. Both, however, may claim to be
-orators and statesmen, but even in these respects it is probable that
-the highest place would be accorded to their great compeer.
-
-Up to the age of thirty-eight Mr. Webster had not vindicated his claim
-to the title of a great orator. In Congress and in his profession he
-had shown himself a powerful, eloquent and convincing speaker, but it
-was not until he delivered at Plymouth his celebrated discourse on the
-two hundredth anniversary of the settlement that he established his
-fame as a great anniversary orator.
-
-Probably no better selection of an orator could have been made. The
-circumstances of his own early career, born and brought up as he was on
-the sterile soil of one of the original States of New England, trained
-like the first settlers in the rugged school of poverty and simplicity,
-wresting a bare subsistence from unwilling nature, he could enter into
-the feelings of those hardy men who brought the seeds of civilization
-and civil liberty from the shores of the Old World to find a lodgment
-for them in the soil of the New. He could appreciate and admire the
-spirit which actuated them, and no one was more likely to set a proper
-value on the results they achieved.
-
-So, by a happy conjuncture, the orator fitted the occasion, and the
-occasion was of a character to draw forth the best powers of the
-orator. It gave him an opportunity to pay a fitting tribute to the
-virtues of the stern but conscientious and deeply religious men, who
-had their faults indeed, but who in spite of them will always receive
-not only from their descendants but from the world a high measure of
-respect. Of the oration, the manner in which it was delivered, and
-its effect upon his audience, we have this account by an eye and ear
-witness, Mr. Ticknor:
-
-“In the morning I went with Mr. Webster to the church where he was to
-deliver the oration. It was the old First Church—Dr. Kendall’s. He did
-not find the pulpit convenient for his purpose, and after making two
-or three experiments, determined to speak from the deacon’s seat under
-it. An extemporaneous table, covered with a green baize cloth, was
-arranged for the occasion, and when the procession entered the church
-everything looked very appropriate, though when the arrangement was
-first suggested it sounded rather odd.
-
-“The building was crowded; indeed, the streets had seemed so all the
-morning, for the weather was fine, and the whole population was astir
-as for a holiday. The oration was an hour and fifty minutes long, but
-the whole of what was printed a year afterwards (for a year before it
-made its appearance) was not delivered. His manner was very fine—quite
-various in the different parts. The passage about the slave trade was
-delivered with a power of indignation such as I never witnessed on
-any other occasion. That at the end when, spreading his arms as if to
-embrace them, he welcomed future generations to the great inheritance
-which we have enjoyed, was spoken with the most attractive sweetness,
-and that peculiar smile which in him was always so charming.
-
-“The effect of the whole was very great. As soon as he got home to
-our lodgings all the principal people then in Plymouth crowded about
-him. He was full of animation and radiant with happiness. But there
-was something about him very grand and imposing at the same time. In a
-letter which I wrote the same day I said that ‘he seemed as if he were
-like the mount that might not be touched, and that burned with fire.’
-I have the same recollection of him still. I never saw him at any time
-when he seemed to me to be more conscious of his own powers, or to have
-a more true and natural enjoyment from their possession.”
-
-The occasion will always be memorable, for on that day it was revealed
-to the world that America possessed an orator fit to be ranked with the
-greatest orators of ancient or modern times. A year afterwards John
-Adams, in a letter to Mr. Webster, said of it: “It is the effort of a
-great mind, richly stored with every species of information. If there
-be an American who can read it without tears I am not that American.
-It enters more perfectly into the genuine spirit of New England than
-any production I ever read. The observations on the Greeks and Romans;
-on colonization in general; on the West India Islands; on the past,
-present and future of America, and on the slave trade are sagacious,
-profound and affecting in a high degree. Mr. Burke is no longer
-entitled to the praise, the most consummate orator of modern times.
-This oration will be read five hundred years hence with as much rapture
-as it was heard. It ought to be read at the end of every century, and
-indeed at the end of every year, forever and ever.”
-
-This testimony is the more interesting because the writer less then
-five years later was himself, with his great contemporary, Mr.
-Jefferson, to be the subject of an address which will always be
-reckoned as one of Webster’s masterpieces.
-
-And now, since many of my young readers will never read the Plymouth
-oration, I surrender the rest of this chapter to two extracts which may
-give them an idea of its high merits.
-
-“There are enterprises, military as well as civil, which sometimes
-check the current of events, give a new turn to human affairs, and
-transmit their consequences through ages. We see their importance in
-their results, and call them great because great things follow. There
-have been battles which have fixed the fate of nations. These come
-down to us in history with a solid and permanent interest, not created
-by a display of glittering armor, the rush of adverse battalions,
-the sinking and rising of pennons, the flight, the pursuit and the
-victory; but by their effect in advancing or retarding human knowledge,
-in overthrowing or establishing despotism, in extending or destroying
-human happiness.
-
-“When the traveler pauses on the plain of Marathon, what are the
-emotions which most strongly agitate his breast? What is that glorious
-recollection which thrills through his frame and suffuses his eyes?
-Not, I imagine, that Grecian skill and Grecian valor were here most
-signally displayed, but that Greece herself was here displayed. It is
-because to this spot, and to the event which has rendered it immortal,
-he refers all the succeeding glories of the republic. It is because,
-if that day had gone otherwise, Greece had perished. It is because he
-perceives that her philosophers and orators, her poets and painters,
-her sculptors and architects, her government and free institutions,
-point backward to Marathon, and that their future existence seems to
-have been suspended on the contingency whether the Persian or the
-Grecian banner should wave victorious in the beams of that day’s
-setting sun. And, as his imagination kindles at the retrospect, he is
-transported back to the interesting moment, he counts the fearful odds
-of the contending hosts, his interest for the result overwhelms him,
-he trembles as if it were still uncertain, and grows to doubt whether
-he may consider Socrates and Plato, Demosthenes, Sophocles and Phidias,
-as secure yet to himself and the world.
-
-“‘If God prosper us,’ might have been the appropriate language of
-our fathers when they landed upon this Rock. If God prosper us, we
-shall begin a work which shall last for ages; we shall plant here a
-new society in the principles of the fullest liberty and the purest
-religion; we shall fill this region of the great continent, which
-stretches almost from pole to pole, with civilization and Christianity;
-the temples of the true God shall rise, where now ascends the smoke of
-idolatrous sacrifice; fields and gardens, the flowers of summer and the
-waving and golden harvest of autumn shall extend over a thousand hills
-and stretch along a thousand valleys never yet, since the creation,
-reclaimed to the use of civilized man.
-
-“We shall whiten this coast with the canvas of a prosperous commerce;
-we shall stud the long and winding shore with a hundred cities. That
-which we sow in weakness shall be raised in strength. From our sincere
-but houseless worship there shall spring splendid temples to record
-God’s goodness, and from the simplicity of our social unions there
-shall arise wise and politic constitutions of government, full of
-the liberty which we ourselves bring and breathe; from our zeal for
-learning institutions shall spring which shall scatter the light of
-knowledge throughout the land, and, in time, paying back where they
-have borrowed, shall contribute their part to the great aggregate of
-human knowledge; and our descendants through all generations shall
-look back to this spot, and to this hour, with unabated affection and
-regard.”
-
-I close with the solemn and impressive peroration in which the orator
-addresses those who are to come after him.
-
-“Advance then, ye future generations! We would hail you as you rise in
-your long succession to fill the places which we now fill, and to taste
-the blessings of existence where we are passing, and soon shall have
-passed, our own human duration. We bid you welcome to this pleasant
-land of the fathers. We bid you welcome to the healthful skies and the
-verdant fields of New England. We greet your accession to the great
-inheritance which we have enjoyed. We welcome you to the blessings of
-good government and religious liberty. We welcome you to the treasures
-of science and the delights of learning. We welcome you to the
-transcendent sweets of domestic life, to the happiness of kindred and
-parents and children. We welcome you to the immeasurable blessings of
-rational existence, the immortal hope of Christianity, and the light of
-everlasting truth!”
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XXVI.
-
-THE BUNKER HILL ORATION.
-
-
-The oration at Plymouth first revealed the power of Mr. Webster. There
-are some men who exhaust themselves in one speech, one poem, or one
-story, and never attain again the high level which they have once
-reached.
-
-It was not so with Daniel Webster. He had a fund of reserved power
-which great occasions never drew upon in vain. It might be that in an
-ordinary case in court, where his feelings were not aroused, and no
-fitting demand made upon his great abilities, he would disappoint the
-expectations of those who supposed that he must always be eloquent. I
-heard a gentleman say once, “Oh, I heard Mr. Webster speak once, and
-his speech was commonplace enough.”
-
-“On what occasion?”
-
-“In court.”
-
-“What was the case?”
-
-“Oh, I don’t remember—some mercantile case.”
-
-It would certainly be unreasonable to expect any man to invest dry
-commercial details with eloquence. Certainly a lawyer always ambitious
-in his rhetoric would hardly commend himself to a sound, sensible
-client.
-
-But Mr. Webster always rose to the level of a great occasion. His
-occasional speeches were always carefully prepared and finished, and
-there is not one of them but will live. I now have to call special
-attention to the address delivered at the laying of the corner-stone
-of Bunker Hill Monument, at Charlestown, June 17, 1825. It was an
-occasion from which he could not help drawing inspiration. His father,
-now dead, whom he had loved and revered as few sons love and revere
-their parents, had been a participant, not indeed in the battle which
-the granite shaft was to commemorate, but in the struggle which the
-colonists waged for liberty. It may well be imagined that Mr. Webster
-gazed with no common emotion at the veterans who were present to hear
-their patriotism celebrated. Though the passages addressed to them—in
-part at least—are familiar to many of my readers, I will nevertheless
-quote them here. Apart from their subject they will never be forgotten
-by Americans.
-
-“Venerable men! you have come down to us from a former generation.
-Heaven has bounteously lengthened out your lives that you might behold
-this joyous day. You are now where you stood fifty years ago, this very
-hour, with your brothers and your neighbors, shoulder to shoulder in
-the strife of your country. Behold how altered! The same heavens are
-indeed over your heads; the same ocean rolls at your feet; but all
-else how changed! You hear now no roar of hostile cannon, you see now
-no mixed volumes of smoke and flame rising from burning Charlestown.
-The ground strewed with the dead and the dying; the impetuous charge;
-the steady and successful repulse; the loud call to repeated assault;
-the summoning of all that is manly to repeated resistance; a thousand
-bosoms freely and fearlessly bared in an instant to whatever of terror
-there may be in war and death—all these you have witnessed, but you
-witness them no more.
-
-“All is peace. The heights of yonder metropolis, its towers and roofs,
-which you then saw filled with wives and children and countrymen in
-distress and terror, and looking with unutterable emotions for the
-issue of the combat, have presented you to-day with the sight of
-its whole happy population come out to welcome and greet you with
-an universal jubilee. Yonder proud ships, by a felicity of position
-appropriately lying at the foot of this mound, and seeming fondly to
-cling around it, are not means of annoyance to you, but your country’s
-own means of distinction and defense. All is peace, and God has granted
-you this sight of your country’s happiness ere you slumber forever in
-the grave; he has allowed you to behold and to partake the reward of
-your patriotic toils; and he has allowed us, your sons and countrymen,
-to meet you here, and in the name of the present generation, in the
-name of your country, in the name of liberty, to thank you!
-
-“But, alas! you are not all here! Time and the sword have thinned your
-ranks. Prescott, Putnam, Stark, Brooks, Read, Pomeroy, Bridge! our eyes
-seek for you in vain amid this broken band. You are gathered to your
-fathers, and live only to your country in her grateful remembrance and
-your own bright example. But let us not too much grieve that you have
-met the common fate of men. You lived at least long enough to know that
-your work had been nobly and successfully accomplished. You lived to
-see your country’s independence established, and to sheathe your swords
-from war. On the light of liberty you saw arise the light of peace, like
-
- ‘another morn,
- Risen on mid-noon;’
-
-and the sky on which you closed your eyes was cloudless.”
-
-After a tribute to General Warren ‘the first great martyr in this great
-cause,’ Mr. Webster proceeds:
-
-“Veterans, you are the remnants of many a well-fought field. You bring
-with you marks of honor from Trenton and Monmouth, from Yorktown,
-Camden,. Bennington and Saratoga. Veterans of half a century, when
-in your youthful days you put everything at hazard in your country’s
-cause, good as that cause was, and sanguine as youth is, still your
-fondest hopes did not stretch onward to an hour like this. At a period
-to which you could not reasonably have expected to arrive, at a moment
-of national prosperity such as you could never have foreseen, you are
-now met here to enjoy the fellowship of old soldiers, and to receive
-the overflowings of an universal gratitude.
-
-“But your agitated countenances and your heaving breasts inform me that
-even this is not an unmixed joy. I perceive that a tumult of contending
-feelings rushes upon you. The images of the dead, as well as the
-persons of the living, throng to your embraces. The scene overwhelms
-you, and I turn from it. May the Father of all mercies smile upon your
-declining years and bless them! And when you shall here have exchanged
-your embraces, when you shall once more have pressed the hands which
-have been so often extended to give succor in adversity, or grasped in
-the exultation of victory, then look abroad into this lovely land which
-your young valor defended, and mark the happiness with which it is
-filled; yea, look abroad into the whole earth, and see what a name you
-have contributed to give your country, and what a praise you have added
-to freedom, and then rejoice in the sympathy and gratitude which beam
-upon your last days from the improved condition of mankind!”
-
-Not only were there war-scarred veterans present to listen entranced to
-the glowing periods of the inspired orator, but there was an eminent
-friend of America, a son of France, General Lafayette, who sat in a
-conspicuous seat and attracted the notice of all. To him the orator
-addressed himself in a manner no less impressive.
-
-“Fortunate, fortunate man! with what measure of devotion will you not
-thank God for the circumstances of your extraordinary life! You are
-connected with both hemispheres, and with two generations. Heaven saw
-fit to ordain that the electric spark of liberty should be conducted,
-through you, from the New World to the Old; and we, who are now here to
-perform this duty of patriotism, have all of us long ago received it
-in charge from our fathers to cherish your name and your virtues. You
-will account it an instance of your good fortune, sir, that you crossed
-the seas to visit us at a time which enables you to be present at this
-solemnity. You now behold the field, the renown of which reached you in
-the heart of France, and caused a thrill in your ardent bosom; you see
-the lines of the little redoubt thrown up by the incredible diligence
-of Prescott, defended to the last extremity by his lion-hearted valor,
-and within which the corner-stone of our monument has now taken its
-position. You see where Warren fell, and where Parker, Gardner,
-McCleary, Moore and other early patriots fell with him. Those who
-survived that day, and whose lives have been prolonged to the present
-hour, are now around you. Some of them you have known in the trying
-scenes of the war. Behold! They now stretch forth their feeble arms to
-embrace you. Behold! They raise their trembling voices to invoke the
-blessing of God on you and yours forever.”
-
-I should like to increase my quotations, but space will not permit. I
-have quoted enough to give my young readers an idea of this masterly
-address. When next they visit the hill where the monument stands
-complete, let them try to picture to themselves how it looked on
-that occasion when, from the platform where he stood Mr. Webster,
-with his clarion voice, facing the thousands who were seated before
-him on the rising hillside, and the other thousands who stood at the
-summit, spoke these eloquent words. Let them imagine the veteran
-soldiers, and the white-haired and venerable Lafayette, and they can
-better understand the effect which this address made on the eager and
-entranced listeners. They will not wonder at the tears which gathered
-in the eyes of the old soldiers as they bowed their heads to conceal
-their emotions. Surely there was no other man in America who could so
-admirably have improved the occasion.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XXVII.
-
-ADAMS AND JEFFERSON.
-
-
-July 4, 1826, was a memorable day. It was the fiftieth anniversary
-of American Independence, and for that reason, if no other, it was
-likely to be a day of note. But, by a singular coincidence, two eminent
-Americans, fathers of the republic, both of whom had filled the
-Presidency, yielded up their lives.
-
-When John Adams was dying at Quincy, in Massachusetts, he spoke of his
-great countryman, Thomas Jefferson, who he naturally supposed was to
-survive him. But the same day, and that the natal day of the republic,
-brought the illustrious career of each to a close. Not untimely, for
-John Adams had passed the age of ninety, and Jefferson was but a few
-years younger.
-
-Those were not the days of telegraphs nor of railroads, and the
-news had to be conveyed by stage-coaches, so that it was perhaps
-a month before the country through its large extent knew of the
-double loss which it had sustained. It was certainly by a most
-remarkable coincidence that these two great leaders, representing the
-two political parties which divided the country, but one in their
-devotion to the common welfare, passed from earthly scenes on the same
-anniversary. It was no wonder that they were the subjects of public
-addresses and sermons throughout the United States.
-
-Of all those addresses but one is remembered to-day. It was the oration
-delivered by Daniel Webster on the 2d of August, 1826. This too was
-an anniversary, the anniversary of the day when the Declaration of
-Independence had been engrossed by the Revolutionary Congress.
-
-As the circumstances attending the delivery of this oration will be new
-to my young readers, I quote from Mr. Ticknor’s description, as I find
-it in Mr. Curtis’s Life of Mr. Webster. After detailing an interview,
-in which Mr. Webster read him in advance some portions of the oration,
-he proceeds:
-
-“The next day, the 2d of August, the weather was fine, and the
-concourse to hear him immense. It was the first time that Faneuil
-Hall had been draped in mourning. The scene was very solemn, though
-the light of day was not excluded. Settees had been placed over the
-whole area of the hall; the large platform was occupied by many of the
-most distinguished men in New England, and, as it was intended that
-everything should be conducted with as much quietness as possible,
-the doors were closed when the procession had entered, and every
-part of the hall and galleries was filled. This was a mistake in the
-arrangements; the crowd on the outside, thinking that some space
-must still be left within, became very uneasy, and finally grew so
-tumultuous and noisy that the solemnities were interrupted. The police
-in vain attempted to restore order. It seemed as if confusion would
-prevail. Mr. Webster perceived that there was but one thing to be done.
-He advanced to the front of the stage, and said in a voice easily heard
-above the noise of tumult without and of alarm within, ‘_Let those
-doors be opened_.’
-
-“The power and authority of his manner were irresistible; the doors
-were opened, though with difficulty, from the pressure of the crowd on
-the outside; but after the first rush everything was quiet, and the
-order during the rest of the performance was perfect.
-
-“Mr. Webster spoke in an orator’s gown and wore small-clothes. He was
-in the perfection of his manly beauty and strength, his form filled out
-to its finest proportions, and his bearing, as he stood before the
-vast multitude, that of absolute dignity and power. His manuscript lay
-on a small table near him, but I think he did not once refer to it. His
-manner of speaking was deliberate and commanding. When he came to the
-passage on eloquence, and to the words, ‘It is action, noble, sublime,
-godlike action,’ he stamped his foot repeatedly on the stage, his form
-seemed to dilate, and he stood, as that whole audience saw and felt,
-the personification of what he so perfectly described. I never saw him
-when his manner was so grand and appropriate.
-
-“The two speeches attributed to Mr. Adams and his opponent attracted
-great attention from the first. Soon they were put into school-books,
-as specimens of English, and of eloquence. In time men began to
-believe they were genuine speeches, made by genuine men who were in
-the Congress of ’76; and at last Mr. Webster received letters asking
-whether such was the fact or not. In January, 1846, he sent me from
-Washington a letter he had just received, dated at Auburn, begging him
-to solve the doubt. With it he sent me his answer, which is published
-in his works, saying: ‘The accompanying letter and copy of answer
-respect a question which has been often asked me. I place them in your
-hands, to serve if similar inquiries should be made of you.’ Two months
-after, in March of the same year, he sent me a letter from Bangor, in
-Maine, asking the same question, beginning the note which accompanied
-it with these words: ‘Here comes another; I cannot possibly answer
-all of them, one after another.’ Indeed he continued to receive such
-letters until the edition of his works was published in 1851, though
-the matter was repeatedly discussed and explained in the newspapers.
-The fact is, that the speech he wrote for John Adams has such an air
-of truth and reality about it, that only a genius like Mr. Webster,
-perfectly familiar with whatever relates to the Revolution, and indeed
-with its spirit, could have written it.”
-
-There is hardly a schoolboy who reads this book who has not declaimed
-his famous speech, beginning, ‘Sink or swim, live or die, survive
-or perish, I give my hand and my heart to this vote.’ It is hard to
-believe that this noble and impressive speech, so true to the sturdy
-character of Mr. Adams, and so appropriate to the occasion, was written
-by Mr. Webster one morning, before breakfast, in his library. It is
-also surprising that the orator was not certain whether it really had
-merit or not, and read it to Mr. Ticknor for his opinion.
-
-Though parts of this speech are familiar, I shall nevertheless conclude
-my chapter with the exordium, since it will be read with fresh interest
-in this connection.
-
-“This is an unaccustomed spectacle. For the first time, fellow
-citizens, badges of mourning shroud the columns and overhang the arches
-of this hall. These walls, which were consecrated so long ago to the
-cause of American liberty, which witnessed her infant struggles, and
-rang with the shouts of her earliest victories, proclaim now that
-distinguished friends and champions of that great cause have fallen. It
-is right that it should be thus. The tears which flow and the honors
-which are paid when the founders of the republic die give hope that the
-republic itself may be immortal. It is fit that by public assembly and
-solemn observance, by anthem and by eulogy, we commemorate the services
-of national benefactors, extol their virtues, and render thanks to God
-for eminent blessings, early given and long continued, to our favored
-country.
-
-“Adams and Jefferson are no more, and we are assembled, fellow
-citizens, the aged, the middle-aged, and the young, by the spontaneous
-impulse of all, under the authority of the municipal government,
-with the presence of the chief magistrate of the commonwealth and
-others, its official representatives, the university, and the learned
-societies, to bear our part in the manifestations of respect and
-gratitude which universally pervade the land. Adams and Jefferson
-are no more. On our fiftieth anniversary, the great day of national
-jubilee, in the very hour of public rejoicing, in the midst of echoing
-and re-echoing voices of thanksgiving, while their own names were on
-all tongues, they took their flight together to the world of spirits.
-
-“If it be true that no one can safely be pronounced happy while he
-lives, if that event which terminates life can alone crown its honor
-and its glory, what felicity is here! The great epic of their lives how
-happily concluded! Poetry itself has hardly closed illustrious lives
-and finished the career of earthly renown by such a consummation. If
-we had the power, we could not wish to reverse this dispensation of
-Divine Providence. The great objects of life were accomplished, the
-drama was ready to be closed. It has closed; our patriots have fallen;
-but so fallen, at such age, with such coincidence, on such a day, that
-we cannot rationally lament that that end has come, which we know could
-not long be deferred.
-
-“Neither of these great men, fellow citizens, could have died at any
-time without leaving an immense void in our American society. They have
-been so intimately, and for so long a time, blended with the history of
-the country, and especially so united in our thoughts and recollections
-with the events of the Revolution, that the death of either would have
-touched the strings of public sympathy. We should have felt that one
-great link connecting us with former times was broken; that we had
-lost something more, as it were, of the presence of the Revolution
-itself and of the Act of Independence, and were driven on by another
-great remove from the days of our country’s early distinction, to meet
-posterity and to mix with the future. Like the mariner, whom the ocean
-and the winds carry along, till he sees the stars which have directed
-his course and lighted his pathless way descend one by one beneath the
-rising horizon, we should have felt that the stream of time had borne
-us onward till another great luminary, whose light had cheered us and
-whose guidance we had followed, had sunk from our sight.
-
-“But the concurrence of their death on the anniversary of independence
-has naturally awakened stronger emotions. Both had been presidents,
-both were early patriots, and both were distinguished and ever honored
-by their immediate agency in the act of independence. It cannot but
-seem striking and extraordinary that these two should live to see the
-fiftieth year from the date of that act; that they should complete
-that year; and that then, on the day which had just linked forever
-their own fame with their country’s glory, the heavens should open to
-receive them both at once. As their lives themselves were the gifts of
-Providence, who is not willing to recognize in their happy termination,
-as well as in their long continuance, proofs that our country and its
-benefactors are objects of His care?”
-
-Towards the close of the oration we find a striking passage familiar to
-many, and justly admired, touching the duties which devolve upon the
-favored citizens of the United States.
-
-“This lovely land, this glorious liberty, these benign institutions,
-the dear purchase of our fathers, are ours; ours to enjoy, ours to
-preserve, ours to transmit. Generations past and generations to come
-hold us responsible for this sacred trust. Our fathers from behind
-admonish us with their anxious paternal voices; posterity calls out to
-us from the bosom of the future; the world turns hither its solicitous
-eyes; all, all conjure us to act wisely and faithfully in the relation
-which we sustain.
-
-“We can never, indeed, pay the debt which is upon us; but, by virtue,
-by morality, by religion, by the cultivation of every good principle
-and every good habit, we may hope to enjoy the blessing through our
-day, and to leave it unimpaired to our children. Let us feel deeply how
-much of what we are, and of what we possess, we owe to this liberty,
-and to these institutions of government. Nature has indeed given us a
-soil which yields bounteously to the hands of industry, the mighty and
-fruitful ocean is before us, and the skies over our heads shed health
-and vigor. But what are lands, and skies, and seas to civilized man,
-without society, without knowledge, without morals, without religious
-culture? and how can these be enjoyed, in all their extent and all
-their excellence, but under the protection of wise institutions and a
-free government? Fellow citizens, there is not one of us, there is not
-one of us here present, who does not at this moment, and every moment,
-experience in his own condition, and in the condition of those most
-near and dear to him, the influence and the benefits of this liberty
-and these institutions. Let us then acknowledge the blessing, let
-us feel it deeply and powerfully, let us cherish a strong affection
-for it, and resolve to maintain and perpetuate it. The blood of
-our fathers, let it not have been shed in vain; the great hope of
-posterity, let it not be blasted!”
-
-It has been said with truth that no funeral oration has ever been
-pronounced, in any age, and in any language, which exceeds this in
-eloquence and simple grandeur. Happy the country that possesses two
-citizens of whom such praises can be uttered, and happy the nation
-that can find an orator of such transcendent genius to pronounce their
-eulogies!
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XXVIII.
-
-HOME LIFE AND DOMESTIC SORROWS.
-
-
-In speaking of Mr. Webster as an orator I have for some time neglected
-to speak of him in his domestic relations. He was blessed with a happy
-home. The wife he had chosen was fitted by intellect and culture to
-sympathize with him in his important work. Moreover, she had those
-sweet domestic qualities which are required to make home happy.
-Children had been born to them, and these were an important factor in
-the happiness of Mr. Webster’s home. He had a warm love for children,
-and was always an affectionate and indulgent parent, seldom chiding,
-but rebuking in love when occasion required.
-
-In January, 1817, came the first bereavement. His daughter, Grace,
-always precocious and delicate, developed lung trouble and wasted
-away. She seems to have been a remarkably bright and attractive child.
-Her heart was easily touched by sorrow or destitution, and she would
-never consent that applicants for relief should be sent from the door
-unsatisfied. “She would bring them herself into the house, see that
-their wants were supplied, comfort them with the ministration of her
-own little hands and the tender compassion of her large eyes. If her
-mother ever refused, those eyes would fill with tears, and she would
-urge their requests so perseveringly that there was no resisting her.”
-
-The death of this sweet child touched Mr. Webster nearly, and it was
-with a saddened heart that he returned to Washington to devote himself
-to his duties in the Supreme Court.
-
-On the 18th of December, 1824, death once more appeared in the little
-household, this time removing the youngest boy, Charles, then nearing
-his second birthday. This child, young as he was, is said to have borne
-a closer resemblance to his father than any of his other children. Both
-parents were devoted to him. Mrs. Webster writes to her husband just
-after the little boy’s death: “It was an inexpressible consolation to
-me, when I contemplated him in his sickness, that he had not one regret
-for the past, nor one dread for the future; he was as patient as a lamb
-during all his sufferings, and they were at last so great I was happy
-when they were ended. I shall always reflect on his brief life with
-mournful pleasure, and, I hope, remember with gratitude all the joy
-he gave me, and it has been great. And, oh, how fondly did I flatter
-myself it would be lasting!
-
- “’It was but yesterday, my child, thy little heart beat high;
- And I had scorned the warning voice that told me thou must die.’”
-
-When Mr. Webster received the intelligence of his loss, he, for the
-first time in years, indulged in his early fondness for verse, and
-wrote a few stanzas which have been preserved, though they were
-intended to be seen only by those near and dear to him. The prevailing
-thought is a striking one. Here are the verses:
-
- “The staff on which my years should lean
- Is broken ere those years come’ o’er me;
- My funeral rites thou shouldst have seen,
- But thou art in the tomb before me.
-
- “Thou rear’st to me no filial stone,
- No parent’s grave with tears beholdest;
- Thou art my ancestor—my son!
- And stand’st in Heaven’s account the oldest.
-
- “On earth my lot was soonest cast,
- Thy generation after mine;
- Thou hast thy predecessor passed,
- Earlier eternity is thine.
-
- “I should have set before thine eyes
- The road to Heaven, and showed it clear;
- But thou, untaught, spring’st to the skies,
- And leav’st thy teacher lingering here.
-
- “Sweet seraph, I would learn of thee,
- And hasten to partake thy bliss!
- And, oh! to thy world welcome me,
- As first I welcomed thee to this.”
-
-But a still heavier bereavement was in store, though it was delayed
-for some years. In the summer of 1827 the health of Mrs. Webster began
-to fail, and from that time she steadily declined until on the 21st
-of January, in the following year she died. Of Mr. Webster’s bearing
-at the funeral, Mr. Ticknor writes: “Mr. Webster came to Mr. George
-Blake’s in Summer Street, where we saw him both before and after the
-funeral. He seemed completely broken-hearted. At the funeral, when,
-with Mr. Paige, I was making some arrangements for the ceremonies, we
-noticed that Mr. Webster was wearing shoes that were not fit for the
-wet walking of the day, and I went to him and asked him if he would not
-ride in one of the carriages. ‘No,’ he said, ‘my children and I must
-follow their mother to the grave on foot. I could swim to Charlestown.’
-A few minutes afterwards he took Nelson and Daniel in either hand, and
-walked close to the hearse through the streets to the church in whose
-crypt the interment took place. It was a touching and solemn sight. He
-was excessively pale.”
-
-It is a striking commentary upon the emptiness of human honors where
-the heart is concerned that this great affliction came very soon after
-Mr. Webster’s election to the United State Senate, where he achieved
-his highest fame and gathered his choicest laurels. We can well imagine
-that he carried a sad heart to the halls of legislation, and realized
-how poorly the world’s honors compensate the heart for the wounds of
-bereavement. But Daniel Webster was not a man to suffer sorrow to
-get the mastery of him. He labored the harder in the service of his
-country, and found in the discharge of duty his best consolation.
-If I had room I would like to quote the tribute of Judge Storey to
-the character of Mr. Webster. I confine myself to one sentence: “Few
-persons have been more deservedly or more universally beloved; few have
-possessed qualities more attractive, more valuable or more elevating.”
-
-A little over a year later there was a fresh sorrow. Ezekiel
-Webster, the older brother, between whom and Daniel such warm and
-affectionate relations had always existed, died suddenly under striking
-circumstances. He was addressing a jury in the court-house at Concord,
-N. H., speaking with full force, when, without a moment’s warning, “he
-fell backward, without bending a joint, and, so far as appeared, was
-dead before his head reached the floor.”
-
-He was a man of large ability, though necessarily overshadowed by
-the colossal genius of his younger brother. It would be too much to
-expect two Daniel Websters in one family. His death had a depressing
-effect upon Daniel, for the two had been one in sympathy, and each
-had rejoiced in the success of the other. Together they had struggled
-up from poverty, achieved an education and professional distinction,
-and though laboring in different spheres, for Ezekiel kept aloof from
-politics, they continued to exchange views upon all subjects that
-interested either. It is not surprising, in view of his desolate
-household, and the loss of his favorite brother, that Daniel should
-write: “I confess the world, at present, has an aspect for me anything
-but cheerful. With a multitude of acquaintances I have few friends; my
-nearest intimacies are broken, and a sad void is made in the objects
-of affection.” Yet he was constrained to acknowledge that his life,
-on the whole, had been “fortunate and happy beyond the common lot,
-and it would be now ungrateful, as well as unavailing, to repine at
-calamities, of which, as they are human, I must expect to partake.”
-
-I have taken pains to speak of Mr. Webster’s home affections, because
-many, but only those who did not know him, have looked upon him as
-coldly intellectual, with a grand genius, but deficient in human
-emotions, when, as a fact, his heart was unusually warm and overflowing
-with tender sympathy.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XXIX.
-
-CALLED TO THE SENATE.
-
-
-I have called this biography “From Farm-boy to Senator,” because it is
-as a senator that Daniel Webster especially distinguished himself. At
-different times he filled the position of Secretary of State, but it
-was in the Senate Chamber, where he was associated with other great
-leaders, in especial Clay, Calhoun and Hayne, that he became a great
-central object of attention and admiration.
-
-Mr. Webster was not elected to the Senate till he had reached the age
-of forty-five. For him it was a late preferment, and when it came he
-accepted it reluctantly. Mr. Clay was not yet thirty when he entered
-the Senate, and Mr. Calhoun was Vice-President before he attained the
-age of forty-five. But there was this advantage in Mr. Webster’s case,
-that when he joined the highest legislative body in the United States
-he joined it as a giant, fully armed and equipped not only by nature
-but by long experience in the lower House of Congress, where he was a
-leader.
-
-The preferment came to him unsought. Mr. Mills, one of the senators
-from Massachusetts, who had filled his position acceptably, was
-drawing near the close of his term, and his failing health rendered
-his re-election impolitic. Naturally Mr. Webster was thought of as his
-successor, but he felt that he could hardly be spared from the lower
-House, where he was the leading supporter of the administration of John
-Quincy Adams. Levi Lincoln was at that time Governor of Massachusetts,
-and he too had been urged to become a candidate. Mr. Webster wrote him
-an urgent letter, in the hope of persuading him to favor this step.
-From that letter I quote:
-
-“I take it for granted that Mr. E. H. Mills will be no longer a
-candidate. The question then will be, Who is to succeed him? I need not
-say to you that you yourself will doubtless be a prominent object of
-consideration in relation to the vacant place, and the purpose of this
-communication requires me also to acknowledge that I deem it possible
-that my name also should be mentioned, more or less generally, as one
-who may be thought of, among others, for the same situation.... There
-are many strong personal reasons, and, as friends think, and as I think
-too, some _public_ reasons why I should decline the offer of a seat in
-the Senate if it should be made to me. Without entering at present
-into a detail of those reasons, I will say that the latter class of
-them grow out of the public station which I at present fill, and out
-of the necessity of increasing rather than of diminishing, in both
-branches of the National Legislature, the strength that may be reckoned
-on as friendly to the present administration.... To come, therefore, to
-the main point, I beg to say that I see no way in which the public good
-can be so well promoted as by _your_ consenting to go into the Senate.
-
-“This is my own clear and decided opinion; it is the opinion, equally
-clear and decided, of intelligent and patriotic friends here, and I am
-able to add that it is also the decided opinion of all those friends
-elsewhere whose judgment in such matters we should naturally regard. I
-believe I may say, without violating confidence, that it is the wish,
-entertained with some earnestness, of our friends at Washington that
-you should consent to be Mr. Mills’s successor.”
-
-No one certainly can doubt the absolute sincerity of these utterances.
-It was, and is, unusual for a representative to resist so earnestly
-what is considered a high promotion. Mr. Webster was an ambitious man,
-but he thought that the interests of the country required him to stay
-where he was, and hence his urgency.
-
-But Gov. Lincoln was no less patriotic. In an elaborate reply to Mr.
-Webster’s letter, from which I have quoted above, he urges that “the
-deficiency of power in the Senate is the weak point in the citadel” of
-the administration party. “No individual should be placed there but
-who was _now_ in armor for the conflict, who understood the proper
-mode of resistance, who personally knew and had measured strength
-with the opposition, who was familiar with the political interests
-and foreign relations of the country, with the course of policy of
-the administration, and who would be prepared at once to meet and
-decide upon the charter of measures which should be proposed. This,
-I undertake to say, no _novice_ in the national council could do. At
-least I would not promise to attempt it. I feel deeply that I could
-not do it successfully. There is no affectation of humility in this,
-and under such impressions I cannot suffer myself to be thought of in
-a manner which may make me responsible for great mischief in defeating
-the chance of a better selection.”
-
-I am sure my young readers will agree that this correspondence was
-highly honorable to both these eminent gentlemen. It is refreshing
-to turn from the self-sufficient and self-seeking politicians of our
-own day, most of whom are ready to undertake any responsibilities
-however large, without a doubt of their own fitness, to the modesty
-and backwardness of these really great men of fifty years since. In
-the light of Mr. Webster’s great career we must decide that Gov.
-Lincoln was right in deciding that he should be the next senator from
-Massachusetts.
-
-At any rate such was the decision arrived at, and in June, 1827, Mr.
-Webster was elected senator for a period of six years. In due time
-he took his seat. He was no novice, but a man known throughout the
-country, and quite the equal in fame of any of his compeers. I suppose
-no new senator has ever taken his seat who was already a man of such
-wide fame and national importance as Daniel Webster in 1827. Had James
-A. Garfield, instead of assuming the Presidency, taken the seat in the
-Senate to which he had been elected on the fourth of March, 1881, his
-would have been a parallel case.
-
-Of course there was some curiosity as to the opening speech of the
-already eminent senator. He soon found a fitting theme. A bill was
-introduced for the relief of the surviving officers of the Revolution.
-Such a bill was sure to win the active support of the orator who had
-delivered the address at Bunker Hill.
-
-Alluding to some objections which had been made to the principle
-of pensioning them, Mr. Webster said: “There is, I know, something
-repulsive and opprobrious in the name of pension. But God forbid that
-I should taunt them with it. With grief, heartfelt grief, do I behold
-the necessity which leads these veterans to accept the bounty of their
-country in a manner not the most agreeable to their feelings. Worn out
-and decrepit, represented before us by those, their former brothers in
-arms, who totter along our lobbies or stand leaning on their crutches,
-I, for one, would most gladly support such a measure as should consult
-at once their services, their years, their necessities and the delicacy
-of their sentiments. I would gladly give with promptitude and grace,
-with gratitude and delicacy, that which merit has earned and necessity
-demands.
-
-“It is objected that the militia have claims upon us; that they
-fought at the side of the regular soldiers, and ought to share in the
-country’s remembrance. But it is known to be impossible to carry the
-measure to such an extent as to embrace the militia, and it is plain,
-too, that the cases are different. The bill, as I have already said,
-confines itself to those who served, not occasionally, not temporarily,
-but permanently; who allowed themselves to be counted on as men who
-were to see the contest through, last as long as it might; and who
-have made the phrase ‘‘listing for the war’ a proverbial expression,
-signifying unalterable devotion to our cause, through good fortune and
-ill fortune, till it reached its close.
-
-“This is a plain distinction; and although, perhaps, I might wish to do
-more, I see good ground to stop here for the present, if we must stop
-anywhere. The militia who fought at Concord, at Lexington and at Bunker
-Hill, have been alluded to in the course of this debate in terms of
-well-deserved praise. Be assured, sir, there could with difficulty be
-found a man, who drew his sword or carried his musket at Concord, at
-Lexington or at Bunker Hill, who would wish you to reject this bill.
-They might ask you to do more, but never to refrain from doing this.
-Would to God they were assembled here, and had the fate of this bill
-in their own hands! Would to God the question of its passage were to
-be put to them! They would affirm it with a unity of acclamation that
-would rend the roof of the Capitol!”
-
-This is so much in Mr. Webster’s style that, had I quoted it without
-stating that it was his, I think many of my young readers would have
-been able to guess the authorship.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XXX.
-
-THE BEGINNING OF A GREAT BATTLE.
-
-
-When Andrew Jackson became President Mr. Webster found himself an
-anti-administration leader. He was respected and feared, and a plan was
-formed to break him down and overwhelm him in debate. The champion who
-was supposed equal to this task was Col. Hayne, of South Carolina, a
-graceful and forcible speaker, backed by the party in power and by the
-silent influence of John C. Calhoun, who, as Vice-President, presided
-over the councils of the Senate.
-
-On the 29th day of December, 1829, an apparently innocent resolution
-was offered by Mr. Foote, of Connecticut, in the following terms:
-
-“_Resolved_, That the Committee on Public Lands be instructed to
-inquire into the expediency of limiting for a certain period the sales
-of the public lands to such lands only as have been heretofore offered
-for sale and are subject to entry at the minimum price; also, whether
-the office of Surveyor-General may not be abolished without detriment
-to the public interest.”
-
-This resolution called forth the celebrated debate in which Mr. Webster
-demolished the eloquent champion of the South in a speech which will
-live as long as American history.
-
-Mr. Benton, of Missouri, in an elaborate speech furnished the keynote
-of the campaign. On Monday, the 18th, he made a speech in which a
-violent attack was made upon New England, its institutions and its
-representatives. He was followed by Col. Hayne, who elaborated the
-comparison drawn between the so-called illiberal policy of New England
-and the generous policy of the South towards the growing West. He
-charged the East with a spirit of jealousy and an unwillingness that
-the West should be rapidly settled, taking the resolution of the
-senator of Connecticut as his text.
-
-This attack excited surprise, not only by its violence and injustice,
-but by its suddenness. Mr. Webster shared in the general surprise.
-It was not long before he was led to suspect that he was aimed at as
-a well-known defender of New England. At any rate, he rose to reply,
-but a motion for adjournment cut him off, and he was obliged to wait
-for the next day before he could have the opportunity. The speech he
-then made, though not his great speech, was able and deserves notice.
-He disproved in the clearest manner the charges which had been made
-against New England, and showed that her policy had been the direct
-reverse. He dwelt especially upon the part which the Eastern States
-had in settling the great State of Ohio, which even then contained a
-population of a million. Upon this point he spoke as follows:
-
-“And here, sir, at the epoch of 1794, let us pause and survey the
-scene. It is now thirty-five years since that scene actually existed.
-Let us, sir, look back and behold it. Over all that is now Ohio there
-then stretched one vast wilderness, unbroken, except by two small spots
-of civilized culture, the one at Marietta, the other at Cincinnati.
-At these little openings, hardly a pin’s point upon the map, the arm
-of the frontiersman had leveled the forest and let in the sun. These
-little patches of earth, themselves almost shadowed by the overhanging
-boughs of the wilderness, which had stood and perpetuated itself from
-century to century ever since the Creation, were all that had been
-rendered verdant by the hand of man. In an extent of hundreds and
-thousands of square miles no other surface of smiling green attested
-the presence of civilization. The hunter’s path crossed mighty rivers
-flowing in solitary grandeur, whose sources lay in remote and unknown
-regions of the wilderness. It struck, upon the north, on a vast inland
-sea, over which the wintry tempest raged as upon the ocean; all around
-was bare creation.
-
-“It was a fresh, untouched, unbounded, magnificent wilderness. And,
-sir, what is it now? Is it imagination only, or can it possibly be
-fact, that presents such a change as surprises and astonishes us when
-we turn our eyes to what Ohio now is? Is it reality or a dream that in
-so short a period as even thirty-five years there has sprung up on the
-same surface an independent State, with a million of people? A million
-of inhabitants! An amount of population greater than all the cantons of
-Switzerland; equal to one third of all the people of the United States
-when they undertook to accomplish their independence! If, sir, we may
-judge of measures by their results, what lessons do these facts read us
-on the policy of the government? What inferences do they not authorize
-upon the general question of kindness or unkindness? What convictions
-do they enforce as to the wisdom and ability, on the one hand, or
-the folly and incapacity on the other, of our general management of
-Western affairs? For my own part, while I am struck with wonder at the
-success, I also look with admiration at the wisdom and foresight which
-originally arranged and prescribed the system for the settlement of the
-public domain.”
-
-Mr. Webster said in conclusion: “The Senate will bear me witness that
-I am not accustomed to allude to local opinions, nor to compare, nor
-to contrast, different portions of the country. I have often suffered
-things to pass, which I might properly enough have considered as
-deserving a remark, without any observation. But I have felt it my duty
-on this occasion to vindicate the State which I represent from charges
-and imputations on her public character and conduct which I know to be
-undeserved and unfounded. If advanced elsewhere, they might be passed,
-perhaps, without notice. But whatever is said here is supposed to be
-entitled to public regard and to deserve public attention; it derives
-importance and dignity from the place where it is uttered. As a true
-representative of the State which has sent me here it is my duty, and a
-duty which I shall fulfill, to place her history and her conduct, her
-honor and her character, in their just and proper light.
-
-“While I stand here as representative of Massachusetts, I will be her
-true representative, and, by the blessing of God, I will vindicate her
-character, motives and history from every imputation coming from a
-respectable source.”
-
-This was the first reply of Webster to Hayne, and it was able and
-convincing. But Col. Hayne and his friends had no intention of
-leaving the matter there. The next day the consideration of the bill
-was renewed. Mr. Webster’s friends wished to have the discussion
-postponed as he had an important case pending in the Supreme Court.
-Mr. Hayne objected, saying in a theatrical tone, “that he saw the
-senator from Massachusetts in his seat, and presumed he could make an
-arrangement that would enable him to be present during the discussion.
-He was unwilling that the subject should be postponed until he had an
-opportunity of replying to some of the observations which had fallen
-from the gentleman yesterday. He would not deny that some things had
-fallen from the gentleman which rankled here [touching his breast],
-from which he would desire at once to relieve himself. The gentleman
-had discharged his fire in the face of the Senate. He hoped he would
-now afford him the opportunity of returning the shot.”
-
-“Then it was,” as a Southern member of Congress afterwards expressed
-it, “that Mr. Webster’s person seemed to become taller and larger.
-His chest expanded and his eyeballs dilated. Folding his arms in a
-composed, firm and most expressive manner, he exclaimed: ‘Let the
-discussion proceed. I am ready. I am ready _now_ to receive the
-gentleman’s fire.’”
-
-Col. Hayne’s speech was the great effort of his life. He was a ready,
-accomplished and forcible speaker, and he vainly thought himself a
-match for the great senator from Massachusetts whose power he was yet
-to understand. He spoke as one who was confident of victory, with a
-self-confidence, a swagger, a violence of invective, which increased as
-he went on. He was encouraged by the evident delight of his friends,
-including the Vice-President. He did not finish his speech the first
-day, but closed with a hint of what he intended to do.
-
-“Sir,” he said, “the gentleman from Massachusetts has thought proper,
-for purposes best known to himself, to strike the South through me,
-the most unworthy of her servants. He has crossed the border, he has
-invaded the State of South Carolina, is making war upon her citizens,
-and endeavoring to overthrow her principles and institutions. Sir,
-when the gentleman provokes me to such a conflict, I meet him at the
-threshold, I will struggle while I have life for our altars and our
-firesides, and if God gives me strength I will drive back the invader
-discomfited. Nor shall I stop there. If the gentleman provokes war he
-shall have war. Sir, I will not stop at the border; I will carry the
-war into the enemy’s territory, and not consent to lay down my arms
-until I shall have obtained ‘indemnity for the past and security for
-the future.’ It is with unfeigned reluctance that I enter upon the
-performance of this part of my duty. I shrink, almost instinctively,
-from a course, however necessary, which may have a tendency to excite
-sectional feelings and sectional jealousies. But, sir, the task has
-been forced upon me, and I proceed right onward to the performance
-of my duty, be the consequences what they may; the responsibility is
-with those who have imposed upon me the necessity. The senator from
-Massachusetts has thought proper to cast the first stone, and, if he
-shall find, according to a homely adage, that ‘he lives in a glass
-house,’ on his head be the consequences.”
-
-Brave words these! But brave words do not necessarily win the victory,
-and Col. Hayne little knew what a foe he was challenging to combat.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XXXI.
-
-THE REPLY TO HAYNE.
-
-
-Before going farther I must speak of a pestilent doctrine then
-held in South Carolina, which underlay the whole controversy, and
-was the animating cause of the antagonism of the Southern leaders
-to the patriotic representatives of the North. This was known as
-nullification, and Mr. Calhoun was its sponsor. To explain: South
-Carolina claimed the right to overrule any law of the general
-government which did not please her, or which her courts might judge to
-be unconstitutional. If she did not see fit to pay customs, she claimed
-that the government could not coerce her. All power was reposed in her
-own executive, her own legislature, and her own judiciary, and the
-national power was subordinate to them.
-
-[Illustration: COL. ROBERT G. HAYNE.]
-
-It will be easily seen that this was a most dangerous doctrine to hold,
-one which if allowed would everywhere subject the national authority
-to contempt. The United States never had an external foe half so
-insidious or half so dangerous as this assumption which had grown up
-within its own borders.
-
-To return to the great debate. When Col. Hayne took his seat at the
-close of his second speech his friends gathered round him in warm
-congratulation. Mr. Webster’s friends were sober. Much as they admired
-him, they did not see how he was going to answer that speech. They knew
-that he would have little or no time for preparation, and it would not
-do for him to make an ordinary or commonplace reply to such a dashing
-harangue. So on the evening of Monday the friends of Mr. Webster
-walked about the streets gloomy and preoccupied. They feared for their
-champion.
-
-But how was it with him? During Col. Hayne’s speech he calmly took
-notes. Occasionally there was a flash from the depths of his dark eyes
-as a hint or a suggestion occurred to him, but he seemed otherwise
-indifferent and unmoved, He spent the evening as usual, and enjoyed a
-refreshing night’s sleep.
-
-In the morning of the eventful day three hours before the hour of
-meeting crowds set their faces towards the Capitol. At twelve o’clock
-the Senate Chamber—its galleries, floors and even lobbies—was filled to
-overflowing. The Speaker retained his place unwillingly in the House,
-but hardly enough members were present to transact business.
-
-When the fitting time came Mr. Webster rose. He was in the full vigor
-of a magnificent manhood, the embodiment of conscious strength. He
-gazed around him, never more self-possessed than at that moment. He saw
-his adversaries with their complacent faces already rejoicing in his
-anticipated discomfiture; he looked in the faces of his friends, and he
-noted their looks of anxious solicitude; but he had full confidence in
-his own strength, and his deep cavernous eyes glowed with “that stern
-joy which warriors feel in foemen worthy of their steel.”
-
-There was a hush of expectation and a breathless silence as those
-present waited for his first words.
-
-He began thus: “Mr. President, when the mariner has been tossed for
-many days, in thick weather, and on an unknown sea, he naturally avails
-himself of the first pause in the storm, the earliest glance of the
-sun, to take his latitude, and ascertain how far the elements have
-driven him from his true course. Let us imitate this prudence, and
-before we float further on the waves of this debate, refer to the point
-from which we departed, that we may at least be able to form some
-conjecture where we now are. I ask for the reading of the resolution.”
-
-This was felt to be a happy exordium, and was sufficient to rivet the
-attention of the vast audience.
-
-After the resolution was read Mr. Webster continued: “We have thus
-heard, sir, what the resolution is which is actually before us for
-consideration; and it will readily occur to every one that it is almost
-the only subject about which something has not been said in the speech,
-running through two days, by which the Senate has been now entertained
-by the gentleman from South Carolina. Every topic in the wide range of
-our public affairs, whether past or present, everything, general or
-local, whether belonging to national politics or party politics, seems
-to have attracted more or less of the honorable members attention, save
-only the resolution before the Senate. He has spoken of everything but
-the public lands; they have escaped his notice. To that subject in
-all his excursions he has not paid even the cold respect of a passing
-glance.
-
-“When this debate, sir, was to be resumed on Thursday morning, it so
-happened that it would have been convenient for me to be elsewhere. The
-honorable member, however, did not incline to put off the discussion
-to another day. He had a shot, he said, to return, and he wished to
-discharge it. That shot, which it was kind thus to inform us was
-coming, that we might stand out of the way, or prepare ourselves to
-fall before it and die with decency, has now been received. Under all
-advantages, and with expectation awakened by the tone which preceded
-it, it has been discharged and has spent its force. It may become me
-to say no more of its effect than that, if nobody is found, after all,
-either killed or wounded by it, it is not the first time in the history
-of human affairs that the vigor and success of the war have not quite
-come up to the lofty and sounding phrase of the manifesto.”
-
-Referring to Col. Hayne’s statement that there was something rankling
-here (indicating his heart) which he wished to relieve, Mr. Webster
-said: “In this respect, sir, I have a great advantage over the
-honorable gentleman. There is nothing _here_, sir, which gives me
-the slightest uneasiness; neither fear nor anger, nor that which is
-sometimes more troublesome than either, the consciousness of having
-been in the wrong.... I must repeat, also, that nothing has been
-received _here_ which _rankles_ or in any way gives me annoyance. I
-will not accuse the honorable gentleman of violating the rules of
-civilized war; I will not say he poisoned his arrows. But whether
-his shafts were, or were not, dipped in that which would have caused
-rankling if they had reached, there was not, as it happened, quite
-strength enough in the bow to bring them to their mark. If he wishes
-now to gather up these shafts he must look for them elsewhere; they
-will not be found fixed and quivering in the object at which they were
-aimed.”
-
-Col. Hayne and his friends, as they listened to these words, breathing
-a calm consciousness of power not unmixed with a grand disdain, must
-have realized that they had exulted too soon. Indeed Hayne’s friends
-had not all looked forward with confidence to his victory. Senator
-Iredell, of North Carolina, to a friend of Hayne’s who was praising his
-speech, had said the evening previous, “He has started the lion—but
-wait till we hear his roar, or feel his claws.”
-
-While I do not propose to give an abstract of this famous oration, I
-shall quote some of the most brilliant and effective passages, well
-known and familiar though they are, because they will be re-read with
-fresh and added interest in this connection. There was not a son of
-Massachusetts, nay, there was not a New Englander, whose heart was not
-thrilled by the splendid tribute to Massachusetts.
-
-“Mr. President, I shall enter upon no encomium on Massachusetts; she
-needs none. There she is. Behold her and judge for yourselves. There
-is her history; the world knows it by heart. The past, at least, is
-secure. There is Boston, and Concord, and Lexington, and Bunker Hill;
-and there they will remain forever. The bones of her sons, falling in
-the great struggle for independence, now lie mingled with the soil
-of every State from New England to Georgia, and there they will lie
-forever. And, sir, where American liberty raised its first voice, and
-where its youth was nurtured and sustained, there it still lives, in
-the strength of its manhood and full of its original spirit. If discord
-and disunion shall wound it, if party strife and blind ambition shall
-hawk at and tear it, if folly and madness, if uneasiness under salutary
-and necessary restraint, shall succeed in separating it from that union
-by which alone its existence is made sure, it will stand, in the end,
-by the side of that cradle in which its infancy was rocked; it will
-stretch forth its arm with whatever of vigor it may still retain over
-the friends who gather round it; and it will fall at last, if fall it
-must, amidst the proudest monuments of its own glory, and on the very
-spot of its origin.”
-
-Mr. Webster shows his magnanimity by pronouncing, in like manner, an
-eulogium upon his opponent’s native State, which is in bright contrast
-with the mean and unjust attacks of Col. Hayne upon Massachusetts. This
-is what he says:
-
-“Let me observe that the eulogium pronounced on the character of South
-Carolina by the honorable gentleman for her Revolutionary and other
-merits meets my hearty concurrence. I shall not acknowledge that the
-honorable member goes before me in regard for whatever of distinguished
-talent, of distinguished character, South Carolina has produced. I
-claim part of the honor. I partake in the pride of her great names. I
-claim them for countrymen, one and all, the Laurenses, the Rutledges,
-the Pinkneys, the Sumters, the Marions, Americans all, whose fame is no
-more to be hemmed in by State lines than their talents and patriotism
-were capable of being circumscribed within the same narrow limits. In
-their day and generation they served and honored the country, and the
-whole country; and their renown is one of the treasures of the whole
-country. Him whose honored name the gentleman himself bears—does he
-esteem me less capable of gratitude for his patriotism, or sympathy for
-his sufferings, than if his eyes had first opened upon the light of
-Massachusetts instead of South Carolina? Sir, does he suppose it in
-his power to exhibit a Carolina name so bright as to produce envy in my
-bosom? No, sir; increased gratification rather. I thank God that, if
-I am gifted with little of the spirit which is able to raise mortals
-to the skies, I have yet none, as I trust, of that other spirit which
-would drag angels down. When I shall be found, sir, in my place here in
-the Senate, or elsewhere, to sneer at public merit because it happens
-to spring up beyond the little limits of my own State or neighborhood;
-when I refuse, for any such cause, or for any cause, the homage due to
-American talent, to elevated patriotism, to sincere devotion to liberty
-and the country; or, if I see an uncommon endowment of Heaven, if I
-see extraordinary capacity and virtue in any son of the South, and if,
-moved by local prejudice or gangrened by State jealousy, I get up here
-to abate the tithe of a hair from his just character and just fame, may
-my tongue cleave to the roof of my mouth!”
-
-It must not be supposed that Mr. Webster’s speech was merely of a
-personal character. In a sound and logical manner he discussed the
-limits of constitutional authority, and combated the pernicious
-doctrine of State supremacy, which thirty years later was to kindle
-a civil war of vast proportions, the starting-point being South
-Carolina. At the risk of quoting paragraphs which my young readers may
-skip, I proceed to introduce an extract which may give an idea of this
-part of the oration.
-
-“We approach at length, sir, to a more important part of the honorable
-gentleman’s observations. Since it does not accord with my views
-of justice and policy to give away the public lands altogether, as
-mere matter of gratuity, I am asked by the honorable gentleman on
-what ground it is that I consent to vote them away in particular
-instances. How, he inquires, do I reconcile with these profound
-sentiments my support of measures appropriating portions of the land to
-particular roads, particular canals, particular rivers, and particular
-institutions of education in the West? This leads, sir, to the real and
-wide difference in political opinion between the honorable gentleman
-and myself. On my part, I look upon all these objects as connected with
-the common good, fairly embraced in its object and terms; he, on the
-contrary, deems them all, if good at all, only local good.
-
-“This is our difference.
-
-“The interrogatory which he proceeded to put at once explains this
-difference. ‘What interest,’ asks he, ‘has South Carolina in a canal
-in Ohio?’ Sir, this very question is full of significance. It develops
-the gentleman’s whole political system, and its answer expounds mine.
-Here we differ. I look upon a road over the Alleghanies, a canal
-round the Falls of the Ohio, or a canal or railway from the Atlantic
-to the Western waters, as being an object large and extensive enough
-to be fairly said to be for the common benefit. The gentleman thinks
-otherwise, and this is the key to his construction of the powers of
-the government. He may well ask what interest has South Carolina in a
-canal in Ohio. On his system, it is true, she has no interest. On that
-system, Ohio and South Carolina are different governments and different
-countries; connected here, it is true, by some slight and ill-defined
-bond of union, but in all main respects separate and diverse. On that
-system South Carolina has no more interest in a canal in Ohio than in
-Mexico. The gentleman, therefore, only follows out his own principles;
-he does no more than arrive at the natural conclusions of his own
-doctrines; he only announces the true results of that creed which he
-has adopted himself, and would persuade others to adopt, when he thus
-declares that South Carolina has no interest in a public work in Ohio.
-
-“Sir, we narrow-minded people of New England do not reason thus. Our
-notion of things is entirely different. We look upon the States not
-as separated but united. We love to dwell on that union, and on the
-mutual happiness which it has so much promoted, and the common renown
-which it has so greatly contributed to acquire. In our contemplation
-South Carolina and Ohio are parts of the same country, States
-united under the same general government, having interests common,
-associated, intermingled. In whatever is within the proper sphere of
-the constitutional power of this government we look upon the States as
-one. We do not impose geographical limits to our patriotic feelings or
-regard; we do not follow rivers and mountains and lines of latitude to
-find boundaries beyond which public improvements do not benefit us.
-
-“We who come here, as agents and representatives of these narrow-minded
-and selfish men of New England, consider ourselves as bound to regard
-with an equal eye the good of the whole in whatever is within our
-power of legislation. Sir, if a railroad or canal, beginning in South
-Carolina and ending in South Carolina, appeared to me to be of national
-importance and national magnitude, believing, as I do, that the power
-of government extends the encouragement of works of that description,
-if I were to stand up here and ask, What interest has Massachusetts
-in a railroad in South Carolina? I should not be willing to face my
-constituents. These same narrow-minded men would tell me that they had
-sent me to act for the whole country, and that one who possessed too
-little comprehension either of intellect or feeling, one who was not
-large enough both in mind and in heart to embrace the whole, was not
-fit to be intrusted with the interests of our part.”
-
-This will give an idea of the broad national sentiments entertained
-and expressed by the senator from Massachusetts. It is certainly in
-strong contrast to the narrow sectional views of Col. Hayne and John C.
-Calhoun.
-
-Towards the close of his speech Mr. Webster describes in an amusing way
-a supposed conflict in South Carolina between the customs officers of
-the government and a local force led by his opponent. It was playful,
-but Col. Hayne was moved by the ridicule with which it covered him more
-than by any of Mr. Webster’s arguments.
-
-It need hardly be said that the entire address was listened to with
-rapt attention. As it proceeded those friends of Mr. Webster who
-doubted his ability to cope with the Southern champion, and who had
-listened to his first words with feelings of anxious solicitude, became
-cheerful and even jubilant. In fact they changed aspects with Hayne’s
-friends who had awaited the opening of the speech with supercilious
-disdain. The calm power, the humorous contempt, with which Mr. Webster
-handled the doughty champion annoyed them not a little.
-
-I do not mean to underrate the ability or eloquence of Col. Hayne.
-Upon this point it is sufficient to quote the opinion of Mr. Everett,
-the tried and intimate friend of Daniel Webster, who says: “It is
-unnecessary to state, except to those who have come forward quite
-recently, that Col. Hayne was a gentleman of ability very far above
-the average, a highly accomplished debater, an experienced politician,
-a person possessing the full confidence of his friends, and entirely
-familiar with the argument on which the theory controverted in Mr.
-Webster’s speech rests.”
-
-Mr. March, in his “Reminiscences of Congress,” a book from which I have
-received valuable help in the composition of this chapter, describes
-Hayne’s oratory in these terms:
-
-“Hayne dashed into debate like the Mameluke cavalry upon a charge.
-There was a gallant air about him that could not but win admiration. He
-never provided for retreat; he never imagined it. He had an invincible
-confidence in himself, which arose partly from constitutional
-temperament, partly from previous success. His was the Napoleonic
-warfare: to strike at once for the capital of the enemy, heedless of
-danger or cost to his own forces. Not doubting to overcome all odds, he
-feared none, however seemingly superior. Of great fluency and no little
-force of expression, his speech never halted, and seldom fatigued.”
-
-Mr. Webster swept on to the close of his speech with power unabated.
-Some of his friends had feared he could not sustain his elevated
-flight, that he would mar the effect of his great passages by
-dropping to the commonplace. They had no need to fear. He thoroughly
-understood his own powers. At length he reached the peroration—that
-famous peroration, so well known, yet, in spite of its familiarity, so
-impossible to omit here.
-
-“When my eyes shall be turned to behold for the last time the sun
-in heaven, may I not see him shining on the broken and dishonored
-fragments of a once glorious Union; on States dissevered, discordant,
-belligerent; on a land rent with civil feuds, or drenched, it may
-be, in fraternal blood! Let their last feeble and lingering glance
-rather behold the gorgeous ensign of the republic, now known and
-honored throughout the earth, still full high advanced, its arms and
-trophies streaming in their original luster, not a stripe erased or
-polluted, not a single star obscured, bearing for its motto no such
-miserable interrogatory, ‘What is all this worth?’ nor those other
-words of delusion and folly, ‘Liberty first and Union afterwards:’ but
-everywhere, spread all over in characters of living light, blazing on
-all its ample folds, as they float over the seas and over the land,
-and in every wind under the whole heavens, that other sentiment, dear
-to every American heart—Liberty and Union, now and forever, one and
-inseparable!”
-
-Hayne attempted a reply to this speech, but it had little effect. It
-was followed by a telling _résumé_ of his positions by Mr. Webster, and
-so far as these two speakers were concerned the discussion closed.
-
-It is remarkable how little effort this famous oration cost it author.
-The constitutional argument, to be sure, was familiar to him, and
-he had but to state it, but for the great passages, including the
-exordium, the peroration, the encomium upon Massachusetts, the speaker
-was indebted to the inspiration of the moment; yet they are so compact,
-so fitly expressed, so elegantly worded, that he would be a bold man
-who should suggest even a verbal change.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XXXII.
-
-THE SECRET OF WEBSTER’S POWER.
-
-
-It is hardly necessary to say that when Mr. Webster’s speech in reply
-to Hayne was published and read by the country at large it made a
-profound impression. Doubtless it kindled afresh in many wavering
-hearts a love for that Union the claims of which upon the American
-citizen the orator so strongly urged. It is interesting to know that
-Hayne himself, while he essayed to answer it, appreciated its power.
-
-Mr. Harvey relates, upon Mr. Webster’s authority, that when he had
-finished his speech some Southern members approached him cordially and
-said, “Mr. Webster, I think you had better die now and rest your fame
-on that speech.”
-
-Mr. Hayne, who was standing near by, and heard the remark, said, “You
-ought not to die; a man who can make such speeches as that ought never
-to die.”
-
-It is related that Mr. Webster, meeting his opponent at the President’s
-reception the same evening, went up to him and remarked, pleasantly,
-
-“How are you to-night?”
-
-“None the better for you, sir,” answered Hayne, humorously.
-
-Henry Clay wrote later: “I congratulate you on the very great
-addition which you have made during the session to your previous high
-reputation. Your speeches, and particularly in reply to Mr. Hayne, are
-the theme of praise from every tongue, and I have shared in the delight
-which all have felt.”
-
-In its powerful defense of the Constitution Mr. Webster carried with
-him patriotic men all over the country. Hon. William Gaston, of North
-Carolina, wrote thus: “The ability with which the great argument
-is treated, the patriotic fervor with which the Union is asserted,
-give you claim to the gratitude of every one who loves his country
-and regards the Constitution as its best hope and surest stay. My
-engrossing occupations leave me little leisure for any correspondence
-except on business, but I have resolved to seize a moment to let you
-know that with us there is scarcely a division of opinion among the
-intelligent portion of the community. All of them whose understanding
-or whose conscience is not surrendered to the servitude of faction,
-greet your eloquent efforts with unmixed gratification.”
-
-It is an interesting question how far Mr. Webster prepared himself for
-this his greatest, or, at any rate, his most effective parliamentary
-speech.
-
-Upon this point let us read the statement of Mr. Webster himself, as
-given to his tried friend, Mr. Harvey.
-
-In reference to the remark that he had made no preparation for the
-Hayne speech, he said: “That was not quite so. If it was meant that
-I took notes and studied with a view to a reply, that was not true;
-but that I was thoroughly conversant with the subject of debate, from
-having made preparation for a totally different purpose than that
-speech, is true. The preparation for my reply to Hayne was made upon
-the occasion of Mr. Foote’s resolution to sell the public lands. Some
-years before that, Mr. McKinley, a senator from Alabama, introduced a
-resolution into the Senate, proposing to cede the public domains to
-the States in which they were situated. It struck me at that time as
-being so unfair and improper that I immediately prepared an argument
-to resist it. My argument embraced the whole history of the public
-lands, and the government’s action in regard to them. Then there was
-another question involved in the Hayne debate. It was as to the
-right and practice of petition. Mr. Calhoun had denied the right of
-petition on the subject of slavery. In other words, he claimed that,
-if the petition was for some subject which the Senate had no right
-to grant, then there was no right of petition. If the Senate had no
-such right, then the petitioners had no right to come there. Calhoun’s
-doctrine seemed to be accepted, and I made preparation to answer
-his proposition. It so happened that the debate did not take place,
-because the matter never was pressed. I had my notes tucked away in
-a pigeon-hole, and when Hayne made that attack upon me and upon New
-England I was already posted, and only had to take down my notes and
-refresh my memory. In other words, if he had tried to make a speech to
-fit my notes he could not have hit it better. No man is inspired with
-the occasion; I never was.”
-
-Mr. Webster was too great a man to wish for praise which he did not
-deserve. That is for men of inferior ability, who are glad to have it
-believed that their most elaborate utterances are “thrown off upon the
-spur of the moment.” Indeed he does not claim enough when he disclaims
-being inspired by the occasion. His encomium upon New England, his
-glowing peroration, were fused and put into enduring form under the
-pressure of strong emotion, which may well be termed inspiration. Yet
-it was always his habit to ascribe his great efforts to hard labor
-rather than to genius, and he remarked to a young clergyman on one
-occasion, who had questioned him in regard to some of his speeches,
-“Young man, there is no such thing as extemporaneous acquisition.”
-
-If a man like Daniel Webster felt constrained to say this, how much
-more ought labor to be held necessary by the ordinary mind. My young
-readers may be assured that diligent and uncomplaining toil are the
-secret springs in most cases of worldly success. So, if they chance
-to dash off a smooth essay in a mood of inspiration, they may have
-good cause to doubt whether it has any solid value. I recall a certain
-school where a prize was offered for an essay on a subject requiring a
-certain amount of thought and research. The leading contestants were
-two boys, one quick and brilliant, the other slow and plodding, but
-sound. Both were anxious to succeed. The second began in due time and
-worked steadily, not allowing himself to be unduly hurried. The first
-waited till within two days of the date at which the essays were to
-be submitted, and then dashed off an essay which was very creditable
-under the circumstances. But it did not win. It was slow and sure that
-won the prize, then, as in so many other cases. I am glad to have the
-potent example of Daniel Webster to help me in enforcing a lesson so
-valuable to youth.
-
-Yet Mr. Webster was always ready of speech. He could make a great
-speech upon any occasion, and upon any subject, however slight. An
-illustration of this is given by Hon. John Wentworth, of Illinois, in a
-letter from which I proceed to quote:
-
-“Mr. Webster won my lasting gratitude by his assistance in the passage
-of the River and Harbor bill, in 1846. The bill had passed the House
-and been referred to the Committee on Commerce, a majority of whom were
-of the ‘strict construction’ school, believing that Congress could
-improve a natural harbor, but could not make one. I went before the
-committee to defend the appropriation for a harbor at Little Fort, now
-called Waukegan. I found I had no friends there but Senator Reverdy
-Johnson, of Maryland. The committee recommended that the appropriation
-be struck out. Senator John A. Dix, of New York, led the opposition. He
-had been a graduate of West Point, was a good engineer, had brought the
-map of survey into the Senate, and was having great influence against
-it. I was seated in the lobby directly behind Col. Thomas H. Benton,
-and Webster was upon his usual walk. He gave me a nod of recognition
-and passed on. Gen. Dix kept up his fire and I felt it. Our senators,
-Sidney Breese and James Semple, were both from the southern part of our
-State, and had no personal knowledge of the merits of the case. The
-Indiana senators were similarly situated. Wisconsin had no senators.
-And the Michigan senators lived at Detroit, and they had only a general
-knowledge of Lake Michigan.
-
-“As Webster was traveling to and fro past me, the thought occurred to
-me that, as he was ‘a liberal constructionist,’ he was just the man
-to rectify all the damage that Gen. Dix was doing. But it was a small
-matter for so great a man. Besides, I knew that his colleague, Senator
-John Davis, was taking the side of Gen. Dix. As Webster would pass me
-I would resolve that the next time he would come I would speak to him.
-But my courage would forsake me when I reflected that he was a Whig and
-I was a Democrat. I wanted some excuse to speak to him. He had known
-my father. He was a son of New Hampshire, and a graduate of the same
-college with myself. But my heart failed me; and yet it was all the
-while sighing, ‘Webster, Webster, do but speak to me.’
-
-“At length came his voice, in deep, sepulchral tone, ‘Wentworth, what
-is Dix making all this ado about?’
-
-“Promptly the answer came: ‘Mr. Webster, since your trip around the
-lakes from Chicago, in 1837, we have had but few appropriations for old
-harbors and none for new ones. This place is half way between Chicago
-and Milwaukee, and we want a harbor of refuge there.’
-
-“‘I see the point, I see the point,’ says Webster, and at once went to
-his seat upon the Senate floor.
-
-“When Gen. Dix had concluded, Mr. Webster observed that he could
-add nothing to the conclusive argument of the senator from New York
-in favor of the appropriation. He thought he had satisfied all the
-senators that there was no harbor at the place, and so the House
-must have thought when it made the appropriation to construct one
-there. Upon what did the senator from New York found his doctrine
-that, when God created the world, or even Lake Michigan, He left
-nothing for man to do? The curse pronounced upon our first parents for
-their transgression was in entire conflict with any such doctrine.
-He did not believe that the Constitution of the United States was
-such a narrowly contracted instrument that it would not permit the
-construction of a harbor where the necessities of commerce required it.
-He then foreshadowed the growth of the West, its abundant products,
-its gigantic commerce, its numerous people. He started a steamer from
-Chicago laden to the guards with freight and passengers. He then
-described a storm in a manner that no man but Webster could describe.
-His flight of eloquence equaled his best at Bunker Hill or Plymouth
-Rock. You could hear the dashing waves, the whistling winds, the
-creaking timbers, and the shrieking passengers, and, as he sent the
-vessel to the bottom with all on board, he exclaimed: ‘What but a
-merciful Providence saved me from such a catastrophe when I passed over
-Lake Michigan in 1837?’ At such a dire disaster could the senator from
-New York derive any consolation from the reflection that his narrow
-interpretation of the Constitution had been maintained?
-
-“As Webster closed Col. Benton turned to me and said, ‘That is the
-greatest speech upon so small a matter that I ever heard.’ Reverdy
-Johnson came up and said, ‘Now, don’t you abuse the Whigs any more.’
-And Senator Breese said, ‘Now you can go back to the House. That speech
-saves us.’
-
-“The bill passed without amendment. But alas! President Polk vetoed
-it. And out of his veto grew that wonderful event in the history of
-Chicago, the river and harbor convention of 1847, a vast assemblage,
-composed of the most talented, enterprising, wealthy and influential
-men of all parts of the country. At the laying of the corner-stone of
-the Douglas Monument, Gen. Dix was here as the principal orator. While
-others were speaking I called his attention to our magnificent harbor
-works. After complimenting them highly he said, ‘They ought to protect
-you from any storm—even from such a one as Webster manufactured for you
-in the Senate in 1846.’”
-
-It must be remembered that this readiness of Mr. Webster arose not
-wholly from his great powers, but largely from the fact that all
-his life long he had been a diligent and faithful student. Hence it
-was that his mind was a vast reservoir of acquisition from which he
-could at will draw out what was most fitting upon any subject. So Sir
-Walter Scott, browsing in his boyhood among the treasures of legendary
-lore and feudal traditions, was unconsciously preparing himself for
-the novels and poetical romances with which many years afterwards he
-delighted the world, and made his native land famous.
-
-Recurring to the subject of nullification, at which Mr. Webster had
-aimed so powerful a blow, it may be said that it was scotched but not
-killed. Col. Hayne was overwhelmed, but he was not convinced. Neither
-was John C. Calhoun, the greater representative of the same State, who
-entirely accorded with Hayne in his extreme views of the rights and
-powers of the separate States. Not long afterwards Col. Hayne resigned
-his seat in the Senate, in order to be elected Governor of South
-Carolina, and lead at home the opponents of the government, while Mr.
-Calhoun, resigning his place as Vice-President, was elected senator in
-the place of Hayne, to lead the forces of nullification on the floor
-of the Senate. Through the firmness of President Jackson their schemes
-came to naught, but were revived, as we know, thirty years later by the
-citizens of the same State, and the Civil War was the result.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XXXIII.
-
-HONORS RECEIVED IN ENGLAND.
-
-
-It would require a volume far larger than the present to speak in
-detail of Mr. Webster’s public life, to point out his public services,
-to enumerate the occasions on which he took a distinguished part in
-debate. But this does not come within my plan. Fortunately there are
-other works in which such as desire it can gain all the information
-they desire upon these points. They will find how closely Mr. Webster
-was identified with the history of the nation, and what a powerful
-influence he exerted upon all public measures. And all the while he
-was making an equally brilliant reputation at the bar. He was employed
-in numerous “great cases,” and in none was he found unequal to his
-opportunity.
-
-The result of his multifarious and exhausting labors was a
-determination to make a tour of recreation, and not unnaturally
-he decided to visit England, a country which to every American of
-Anglo-Saxon race must possess a first attraction. His second wife, who
-died but a few weeks since, his daughter, and Mrs. Page, the wife of
-his brother-in-law, were of the party. His youngest son, Edward, then a
-Dartmouth student, joined them later.
-
-Mr. Webster’s fame had preceded him, and he received unusual honors.
-One paper in announcing his arrival said, “We cordially welcome to our
-shores this great and good man, and accept him as a fit representative
-of all the great and good qualities of our transatlantic brethren.”
-So great was the curiosity to see him that the press of carriages
-about the door of his hotel was almost unprecedented. He was invited
-everywhere, and was cordially received by the most prominent men. In
-fact, he was a “lion,” and that in a marked sense.
-
-Among others he met that eccentric and craggy genius, Thomas Carlyle,
-and I am sure my readers young and old will like to know what
-impression the great senator made upon the Scotch philosopher.
-
-This is what Carlyle writes:
-
-“American notabilities are daily becoming notable among us, the ties of
-the two parishes, mother and daughter, getting closer and closer knit.
-Indissoluble ties!
-
-“I reckon that this huge smoky wen may for some centuries yet be the
-best Mycale for our Saxon Panionium, a yearly meeting-place of ‘all
-the Saxons’ from beyond the Atlantic, from the antipodes, or wherever
-the restless wanderers dwell and toil. After centuries, if Boston, if
-New York, have become the most convenient ‘All-Saxondom,’ we will right
-cheerfully go thither to hold such festival and leave the wen.
-
-“Not many days ago I saw at breakfast the notablest of all your
-notabilities, Daniel Webster. He is a magnificent specimen. You might
-say to all the world, ‘This is our Yankee Englishman; such limbs we
-make in Yankee-land!’ As a logic-fencer, advocate or parliamentary
-Hercules, one would incline to back him at first sight against the
-extant world. The tanned complexion, that amorphous crag-like face, the
-dull black eyes under the precipice of brows [I am sure no one ever
-called Mr. Webster’s eyes dull before or since], like dull anthracite
-furnaces only waiting to be _blown_, the mastiff mouth accurately
-closed—I have not traced so much of _silent Berseker’s rage_ that I
-remember of in any other man. ‘I guess I should not like to be your
-nigger.’ Webster is not loquacious, but he is pertinent, conclusive, a
-dignified, perfectly-bred man, though not English in breeding, a man
-worthy of the best reception among us, and meeting such, I understand.”
-
-In a letter to Mr. Ticknor, John Kenyon indulges in some reminiscences
-of Mr. Webster, whom he met intimately, having traveled with him and
-his family party during four days.
-
-“Coleridge used to say that he had seldom known or heard of any great
-man who had not ‘much of the woman in him.’ Even so, that large
-intellect of Daniel Webster seemed to be coupled with all softer
-feelings, and his countenance and bearing at the very first impressed
-me with this.
-
-“All men, without having studied either science, are, we all know,
-more or less phrenologists and physiognomists. Right or wrong, I had
-found as I thought much sensibility in Webster’s countenance. A few
-weeks afterwards I had an opportunity of learning that it was not
-there _only_. We were in a hackney coach, driving along the New Road
-to Baring’s in the City. It was a longish drive, and we had time to
-get into a train of talk, also we were by that time what I may presume
-to call ‘intimate.’ I said, ‘Mr. Webster, you once, I believe, had
-a brother?’ ’Yes,’ he kindly said, ‘when I see you and your brother
-together I often think of him,’ and—I speak the fact as it was—I saw,
-after a little more talk on the subject of his brother, the tears begin
-to trickle down his cheek till he said to me, ‘I’ll give you an account
-of my early life,’ and he began with his father, and the farm in New
-Hampshire, and his own early education, and that of his brother, the
-details of his courtship and first marriage, and his no property at
-the time, but of his hopes in his profession and of his success, as he
-spoke showing much emotion. How could one help loving a man at once so
-powerful and so tender?”
-
-The opinions of those who are themselves eminent are of interest. Let
-us see, therefore, what Hallam, the historian, says of our subject.
-
-“I have had more than one opportunity,” he writes to Mr. Ticknor, “of
-hearing of you, especially from your very distinguished countryman,
-Mr. Webster, with whom I had the pleasure of becoming acquainted last
-summer. It is but an echo of the common voice here to say that I was
-extremely struck by his appearance, deportment and conversation. Mr.
-Webster approaches as nearly to the _beau ideal_ of a republican
-senator as any man that I have ever seen in the course of my life,
-worthy of Rome, or Venice, rather than of our noisy and wrangling
-generation. I wish that some of our public men here would take example
-from his grave and prudent manner of speaking on political subjects,
-which seemed to me neither too incautious nor too strikingly reserved.”
-
-It is seldom that a man’s personal appearance is so impressive as that
-of Daniel Webster, seldom that his greatness is so visibly stamped
-upon his face and figure. An admirer of Mr. Webster was once shocked
-by hearing him called “a hum-bug.” “What do you mean?” he demanded
-angrily. “I mean this,” was the reply, “that no man can possibly be as
-great as he looks.”
-
-I have said that Mr. Webster was the recipient of attentions from
-all classes, I may add, from the highest in the land. Mr. and Mrs.
-Webster dined privately with Queen Victoria by special invitation,
-and it is recorded that the young Queen, for she was then young,
-was much impressed by the majestic demeanor of the great American.
-Even the Eton boys, who are wont to chaff all visitors, forgot their
-propensity in the presence of Mr. Webster. As Mr. Kenyon, already
-quoted, writes: “Not one look of unseemly curiosity, much less of the
-quizzing which I had rather anticipated, had we to undergo. Webster was
-not merely gratified, he was visibly touched by the sight. You remember
-that Charles Lamb said at Eton—I do not pretend to quote his exact
-words—‘What a pity that these fine youths should grow up into paltry
-members of Parliament!’ For myself, when I saw them so cheerful and yet
-so civilized and well-conditioned, I remember thinking to myself at
-the moment, ’Well, if I had a boy I should send him to Eton.’”
-
-While at the Castle Inn, in Windsor, Mr. Webster wrote the following
-autograph, by request, for Mr. Kenyon:
-
- “When you and I are dead and gone
- This busy world will still jog on,
- And laugh and sing and be as hearty
- As if we still were of the party.”
-
-There is no doubt that Mr. Webster enjoyed heartily his well-earned
-recreation. He had good cause. Never certainly up to that time had an
-American been received in England with such distinguished honors. I
-will close by his own account of the way in which he was received.
-
-“I must say that the good people have treated me with great kindness.
-Their hospitality is unbounded, and I find nothing cold or stiff in
-their manners, at least not more than is observed among ourselves.
-There may be exceptions, but I think I may say this as a general truth.
-The thing in England most prejudiced against the United States is the
-press. Its ignorance of us is shocking, and it is increased by such
-absurdities as the travelers publish, to which stock of absurdities
-I am sorry to say Captain Marryatt is making an abundant addition.
-In general the Whigs know more and think better of America than the
-Tories. This is undeniable. Yet my intercourse I think is as much with
-the Conservatives as the Whigs. I have several invitations to pass
-time in the country after Parliament is prorogued. Two or three of
-them I have agreed to accept. Lord Lansdowne and the Earl of Radnor
-have invited us, who live in the south, the Duke of Rutland, Sir Henry
-Halford, Earl Fitzwilliam, Lord Lonsdale, etc., who live in the north.”
-
-Of one thing my young reader may be assured, that no attentions,
-however elevated the source, had any effect upon the simple dignity of
-a typical American citizen, or influenced him when a few years later,
-as Secretary of State, it became his duty to deal with our relations
-with England.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XXXIV.
-
-CALLED TO THE CABINET.
-
-
-In the Presidential campaign of 1840, General Harrison, the nominee of
-the Whig party, swept the country, and was elected amid demonstrations
-of popular enthusiasm till then unprecedented. As we look back upon
-this time, uninfluenced by passion, we can only wonder how a man so
-moderately fitted for the position should have aroused such a furor.
-That he should have been nominated, while such born leaders and
-accomplished statesmen as Mr. Webster were passed over, need excite no
-surprise. In an ideal republic the best man and the wisest statesman
-would be selected, but there are no ideal statesmen, and are not likely
-to be. General Harrison was available, and therefore was put forward as
-the standard-bearer.
-
-I do not mean to say that our nominees have always been mediocre men.
-James A. Garfield was a trained and experienced statesman, so was
-James Buchanan (his faults were of a different order), so were the
-early Presidents, and so have been occasional nominees of both great
-parties; but, as a rule, public men of the first rank have been passed
-by for candidates more available.
-
-General Harrison showed this evidence of fitness for his high station,
-that almost immediately after his election, he indicated a strong
-desire that Mr. Webster should enter his Cabinet. Modestly distrustful
-of his own abilities, he wished to strengthen his administration by
-calling to his councils Mr. Webster and Mr. Clay. He writes thus to Mr.
-Webster, Dec. 1, 1840:
-
-“Since I was first a candidate for the Presidency, I had determined,
-if successful, to solicit your able assistance in conducting the
-administration, and I now ask you to accept the State or Treasury
-Department. I have myself no preference of either for you, but it
-may perhaps be more difficult to fill the latter than the former,
-if you should decline it. It was the first designed for you, in the
-supposition that you had given more attention to the subject of
-the finances than Mr. Clay, to whom I intended to have offered the
-State Department. This, as well as any other post in the Cabinet, I
-understood, before my arrival here, from an intimate friend of that
-gentleman, he would decline. This he has since done personally to me.”
-
-Mr. Webster replied that “for the daily details of the Treasury,
-the matters of account, and the supervision of subordinate officers
-employed in the collection and disbursement of public moneys,” he did
-not think himself to be particularly well qualified. He indicated that
-he would accept the office of Secretary of State.
-
-Mr. Webster no doubt accurately gauged his own abilities. No one could
-be better fitted for the premiership and the conduct of our foreign
-relations, as the event proved. At this time especially a strong,
-judicious statesman of the first rank was required, for the relations
-between the United States and Great Britain were very delicate and even
-critical, and a rash hand might easily have plunged the two countries
-into war. One vexed question related to the boundary between this
-country and the provinces of Nova Scotia and Canada. This question was
-complicated by others of a still more irritating character, which space
-will not allow me to particularize. There was another question also,
-the long-standing claim of England to impress her own seamen, and to
-take them out of American vessels sailing on the high seas in time of
-war, rendering necessary the odious “right of search.”
-
-Mr. Webster was influenced to accept the post of Secretary of State,
-because he knew these questions ought to be settled, and he felt
-confident of his ability to settle them. With this view the people
-cordially agreed, and Gen. Harrison’s choice of the great statesman of
-New England to take charge of our foreign relations was a very popular
-one.
-
-Mr. Webster’s retirement from the Senate, and the necessary choice of
-a successor, gave occasion for a display of magnanimity. His relations
-with Ex-President John Quincy Adams were not friendly—he felt that
-he had been very badly treated by Mr. Adams on one occasion—but Mr.
-Adams, from his prominent position, was likely to be thought of as his
-successor in the Senate. Upon this subject Mr. Webster writes to a
-friend: “Some years ago, as you well know, an incident occurred which
-interrupted intercourse between Mr. Adams and myself for several years,
-and wounded the feelings of many of my friends as well as my own. With
-me that occurrence is overlooked and forgotten. I bury all remembrance
-of it under my regard for Mr. Adams’s talents, character, and public
-services.... Mr. Adams’s great knowledge and ability, his experience,
-and especially his thorough acquaintance with the foreign relations
-of the country, will undoubtedly make him prominent as a candidate;
-and I wish it to be understood that his election would be altogether
-agreeable to me.”
-
-Mr. Adams, however, remained in the House of Representatives, and Rufus
-Choate was selected to succeed Mr. Webster. Massachusetts was fortunate
-in having three citizens so eminently fitted to do her honor in the
-national councils.
-
-When the letter announcing Mr. Webster’s resignation of his seat was
-read in the Senate, Mr. Clay took occasion to pay a glowing tribute
-to his great eloquence and ability, referring to him as “one of the
-noblest specimens of American eloquence; one of the brightest ornaments
-of these halls, of this country, and of our common nature.”
-
-The lamented death of General Harrison, on the 5th of April, after but
-a single month in office, interrupted official business, and made Mr.
-Webster’s position still more difficult. John Tyler, Vice-President,
-succeeding, soon made himself obnoxious to the party that had elected
-him. All the members of the Cabinet, except Mr. Webster, resigned. Mr.
-Webster perceived that he could not do so without serious detriment to
-the national interests, and he remained steadfast, thereby incurring
-the censure of many, who did not appreciate the patriotism and
-self-sacrifice that actuated him. The Secretary of State was too astute
-a politician not to understand that he was periling his own political
-fortunes, that he was raising up for himself enemies in his own State,
-and that his adherence to the administration might cost him the
-promotion which he ardently desired, for he had already fixed his eyes
-upon the Presidency as an object to which he might legitimately aspire.
-Nevertheless he adhered and kept his post till his work was done, and
-he had accomplished for this country what no other hand could probably
-have done, the peaceful adjustment of her foreign differences.
-
-In the midst of the dissatisfaction a great meeting was held at Faneuil
-Hall, and Mr. Webster determined to go there and face the anger of
-his former friends. Whatever might have been the feelings of the
-packed audience when Mr. Webster rose before them in his magnificent
-manhood, and his deep, calm eyes fell upon the audience, every head was
-instantly uncovered in involuntary homage.
-
-In the course of his speech Mr. Webster said: “There are always
-delicacy and regret when one feels obliged to differ from his friends,
-but there is no embarrassment. There is no embarrassment, because, if I
-see the path of duty before me, I have that within me which will enable
-me to pursue it, and throw all embarrassment to the winds. A public man
-has no occasion to be embarrassed if he is honest. Himself and his
-feelings should be to him as nobody and as nothing; the interest of his
-country must be to him as everything; he must sink what is personal to
-himself, making exertions for his country, and it is his ability and
-readiness to do this which are to mark him as a great or as a little
-man in time to come.
-
-“There were many persons in September, 1841, who found great fault
-with my remaining in the President’s Cabinet. You know, gentlemen,
-that twenty years of honest and not altogether undistinguished service
-in the Whig cause did not save me from an outpouring of wrath which
-seldom proceeds from Whig pens and Whig tongues against anybody. I am,
-gentlemen, a little hard to coax, but as to being driven, this is out
-of the question. I chose to trust my own judgment; and thinking I was
-at a post where I was in the service of the country, and could do it
-good, I stayed there, and I leave it to you to-day to say, I leave it
-to my countrymen to say, whether the country would have been better
-off if I had left also. I have no attachment to office. I have tasted
-of its sweets, but I have tasted of its bitterness. I am content with
-what I have achieved; I am ready to rest satisfied with what is gained
-rather than to run the risk of doubtful efforts for new acquisitions.”
-
-This is the speech of a strong man—a man not to be turned by obloquy
-from any step which he has made up his mind to take. I think to-day few
-would question the good judgment which he displayed in retaining his
-seat in the Cabinet. He was enabled to negotiate a treaty with Great
-Britain—known as the Ashburton treaty—which, if not wholly satisfactory
-to the United States, at any rate harmonized differences to a large
-extent, and removed any immediate danger of hostilities.
-
-When Mr. Webster felt that his work was fully accomplished, on the 8th
-of May, 1843, he resigned the premiership, and hastened to his seaside
-home at Marshfield, there to enjoy the rest which he needed and craved.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XXXV.
-
-LIFE AT MARSHFIELD.
-
-
-The town of Marshfield is as intimately associated with the name of
-Daniel Webster as is Abbotsford with Sir Walter Scott. It is a sparsely
-settled town on the south-eastern shore of Massachusetts. Mr. Webster’s
-first acquaintance with it dates from 1824. Both Mr. and Mrs. Webster
-were charmed with the situation of the Thomas Farm, as it was then
-called, and the grand views which it afforded of the ocean. For several
-summers the Websters were boarders in the family of Captain Thomas, and
-finally, in 1831, he became the owner of the farm by purchase. Then
-he began to make improvements, and by the lavish expenditure of money
-converted it from a homely farm to a fitting residence for a famous
-lawyer.
-
-Henceforth this was the home to which the thoughts of the great
-statesman turned when, weary and exhausted with his labors in the
-courts, the Cabinet or the Senate, he felt the need of rest. He
-delighted to array himself in a farmer’s rough garb, to stride over
-his own fields, and look after his cattle. He had not forgotten his
-early tastes, and reveled in the free and unconventional life of this
-seaside farm. He drank in health from the invigorating sea breezes, and
-always bore more easily the burden of public cares after a few days at
-Marshfield.
-
-“I had rather be here than in the Senate,” he said on one occasion to
-his son, while amusing himself with feeding his cattle with ears of
-corn from an unhusked pile lying upon the barn floor.
-
-Mr. Webster was a keen disciple of Isaac Walton, and spent many an
-hour with rod and line, when perhaps his thoughts were busy with
-some intricate political problem, or his mind was occupied with the
-composition of some speech now famous.
-
-To Mr. Harvey’s “Reminiscences” I am indebted for the following
-anecdote of Mr. Webster, and indeed for most that I have said about his
-country life:
-
-“Soon after Mr. Webster went to Marshfield he was one day out on the
-marshes shooting birds. It was in the month of August, when the farmers
-were securing their salt hay. He came, in the course of his rambles, to
-the Green Harbor River, which he wished to cross. He beckoned to one of
-the men on the opposite bank to take him over in his boat, which lay
-moored in sight. The man at once left his work, came over and paddled
-Mr. Webster across the stream. He declined the payment offered him, but
-lingered a moment, with Yankee curiosity, to question the stranger. He
-surmised who Mr. Webster was, and with some hesitation remarked:
-
-“‘This is Daniel Webster, I believe?’
-
-“‘That is my name,’ replied the sportsman.
-
-“‘Well, now,’ said the farmer, ‘I am told that you can make from three
-to five dollars a day pleadin’ cases up in Boston.’
-
-“Mr. Webster replied that he was sometimes so fortunate as to receive
-that amount for his services.
-
-“‘Well, now,’ returned the rustic; ‘it seems to me, I declare, if I
-could get as much in the city pleadin’ law cases, I would not be a
-wadin’ over these marshes this hot weather shootin’ little birds.’”
-
-Had the simple countryman been told that his companion, who was dressed
-but little better than himself, was making from thirty to forty
-thousand dollars annually by these same “law cases,” we can hardly
-imagine the extent of his amazement, or perhaps incredulity.
-
-There is a tradition, and Mr. Webster has confirmed it, that he was one
-day out on the marsh when his attention was drawn to two young men,
-evidently from the city, who were standing on one side of a creek which
-it seemed necessary to cross. They were nicely dressed, and evidently
-dismayed by the apparent necessity of spoiling their fine clothes in
-the passage. Seeing a large rough-looking man, with his pants tucked in
-his boots, approaching them, their faces brightened as they saw a way
-out of their dilemma.
-
-“My good man,” said one, in an eager but patronizing way, “we are in
-trouble. Can you help us?”
-
-Mr. Webster looked at the young men and appreciated the situation.
-
-He answered gravely, “What is your difficulty?”
-
-“We want to get across this creek, but you see we might spoil our
-clothes if we undertook to wade.”
-
-Mr. Webster nodded.
-
-“You look like a good, strong fellow, and it won’t hurt your clothes.
-Will you carry us across on your back?”
-
-Mr. Webster’s eyes twinkled, but he did not suffer the young men to see
-it. They were lightly made, and no great burden to one of his herculean
-frame.
-
-“Yes,” he answered; “I will oblige you.”
-
-So he took the two over in turn, and deposited them, greatly to their
-satisfaction, safe and sound on the opposite shore.
-
-“I’m ever so much obliged,” said the first. “Here, my man, take this,”
-and he drew half a dollar from his pocket.
-
-The second made the same tender.
-
-“You are quite welcome, young gentlemen,” said Mr. Webster, “but I
-can’t think of accepting any recompense.”
-
-“Really, though, it’s worth it; isn’t it, Jones?” said the first young
-man, addressing his companion.
-
-“Of course it is. Better take the money, sir.”
-
-“I must decline,” said Mr. Webster, smiling.
-
-“Ever so much obliged. Really it’s very kind of you. By the way,
-doesn’t Daniel Webster live round here somewhere?”
-
-“Yes; you are on his land now,” said the rough-looking countryman.
-
-“You don’t say so. Is there any chance of seeing him, do you think?”
-
-“A very good chance. _You have only to take a good look at me._”
-
-“Are—you—Mr.—Webster?” faltered the young men simultaneously.
-
-“Men call me so,” answered the statesman, enjoying the confusion of the
-young men.
-
-They attempted to apologize for the liberty they had taken, and
-the great mistake they had made, but without much success, and
-notwithstanding the good-natured manner in which their excuses were
-received by Mr. Webster, were glad when they were out of his presence.
-
-I cannot resist the temptation to record another amusing incident in
-the summer life of Mr. Webster. One day he had gone to Chelsea Beach
-to shoot wild fowl. While lying among the tall grass he watched from
-his concealment the flocks of birds as they flew over the beach and
-adjacent waters. A flock appeared flying quite low, and he lowered
-the muzzle of his gun below the horizontal range to bring the birds
-before his eye. He fired, and instantly there was a loud cry proceeding
-from the beach below. In alarm Mr. Webster rushed down the bank,
-and descried a stranger rubbing his face and shoulder ruefully. The
-sportsman himself was not looking his best. His raiment was disordered
-and his face was begrimed with powder.
-
-“My dear sir,” he inquired anxiously, “did I hit you?”
-
-The man answered resentfully, “Yes, you did hit me; _and, from your
-looks, I should think that I am not the first man you have shot,
-either_.”
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XXXVI.
-
-THE SEVENTH OF MARCH SPEECH.
-
-
-Were I to undertake a complete account of Mr. Webster’s public acts
-during the last ten years of his life, I should require to write a
-volume upon this part of his life alone. This does not enter into my
-plan. I aim only to give my young readers a general idea of the public
-and private life of the great statesman, and must refer them for
-particulars to the valuable Life by George Ticknor Curtis, already more
-than once referred to.
-
-Mr. Webster was strongly opposed to the annexation of Texas, foreseeing
-that it would justly be resented by the people of the North as
-tending to increase “the obvious inequality which exists in the
-representation of the people in Congress by extending slavery and slave
-representation.”
-
-Slavery was the one great flaw in our otherwise glorious system of
-government. It was a standing reproach among the European nations that
-a government which claimed to be free held in forcible subjection
-three million slaves. It sowed dissension between the North and the
-South, and seemed to be the entering wedge destined ere long to split
-asunder the great republic. There were men on both sides of Mason and
-Dixon’s line who openly favored separation, but Mr. Webster was not
-one of these. His ardent devotion to the Union we have already seen
-in the glowing peroration to his memorable speech against Hayne. He
-watched with an anxiety which he did not attempt to conceal the growing
-exasperation of feeling between the two sections. Though he took the
-Northern view, he saw that there must be mutual concessions or the
-Union would be dissolved. He did not wish that event to come in his
-time, and it was in this frame of mind that he made his last great
-speech in the Senate—what is known as the seventh of March speech.
-
-It was a strong and temperate statement of the existing condition of
-affairs, and of the necessity of compromise. In making this speech Mr.
-Webster was fully aware that he was hazarding his popularity—nay, was
-sure to lose it—that he would grieve his best friends, and excite a
-storm of indignation at the North. He was not mistaken. The minds of
-men were in no mood for temperate counsels. They were in no mood to
-appreciate the patriotic motives which actuated the great statesman.
-He was charged with falling from honor and making undue concessions to
-slavery. Upon this last point I shall express no opinion. I only claim
-that Mr. Webster’s motives were pure, and that though he may have gone
-too far in his concessions, he was influenced thereto by the depth of
-his devotion to the Union. There were not wanting those who charged him
-with making in his speech a bid for the Presidency, forgetting that he
-could not have injured his chances more effectually than by stirring up
-against himself his warmest political friends.
-
-That Mr. Webster had an honorable ambition to serve his country in that
-great office—the greatest in its gift—no one will dispute. He knew his
-own fitness, and would have rejoiced to crown a life of high service
-with this elevated trust. But I have said elsewhere that it is only in
-an ideal republic that the greatest citizens reach the highest posts,
-and our republic is not an ideal one.
-
-In the light of our present experience we can see that Mr. Webster was
-wrong in supposing that the republic could go on indefinitely with
-slavery as its corner-stone. Any compromise could be only for a time.
-But he was an old man—sixty-eight years of age—grown cautious and
-conservative with advancing years, and he could not see through the
-clouds that gathered before him.
-
-With this brief vindication of his motives I proceed to give an extract
-from his last great speech:
-
-“Secession! Peaceable secession! Sir, your eyes and mine are never
-destined to see that miracle. The dismemberment of this vast country
-without convulsion! The breaking up of the fountains of the great deep
-without ruffling the surface! Who is so foolish—I beg everybody’s
-pardon—as to expect any such thing? Sir, he who sees these States now
-revolving in harmony around a common center, and expects to see them
-quit their places and fly off without convulsion, may look the next
-moment to see the heavenly bodies rush from their spheres and jostle
-against each other in the realms of space, without causing the wreck
-of the universe! There can be no such thing as a peaceable secession.
-Peaceable secession is an impossibility. Is the great Constitution
-under which we live, covering this whole country, is it to be thawed
-and melted away by secession, as the snows on the mountain melt under
-the influence of a vernal sun, disappear and run off? No, sir! No, sir!
-I will not state what might produce the disruption of the Union; but,
-sir, I see as plainly as I see the sun in heaven what that disruption
-must produce; I see that it must produce war, and such a war as I will
-not describe in its two-fold character.
-
-“Peaceable secession! Peaceable secession! The concurrent agreement
-of all the members of this great government to separate! A voluntary
-separation with alimony on one side, and on the other! Why, what
-would be the result? Where is the line to be drawn? What States are
-to secede? What is to remain America? What am I to be? An American no
-longer? Am I to become a sectional man, a local man, a separatist, with
-no country in common with the gentlemen who sit around me here, or who
-fill the other House of Congress? Heaven forbid! Where is the flag of
-the republic to remain? Where is the eagle still to tower? or is he to
-cower, and shrink, and fall to the ground? Why, sir, our ancestors,
-our fathers, and our grandfathers, those of them who are still living
-among us with prolonged lives, would rebuke and reproach us; and our
-children and our grandchildren would cry out shame upon us, if we of
-this generation should dishonor these ensigns of the power of the
-government and the harmony of the union which is every day felt among
-us with so much joy and gratitude. What is to become of the army? What
-is to become of the navy? What is to become of the public lands? How is
-each of the thirty States to defend itself?
-
-“I know, although the idea has not been stated distinctly, there is
-to be, or it is supposed possible that there will be, a Southern
-confederacy. I do not mean, when I allude to this statement, that any
-one seriously contemplates such a state of things. I do not mean to
-say that it is true, but I have heard it suggested elsewhere that the
-idea has been entertained that, after the dissolution of this Union
-a Southern Confederacy might be formed. I am sorry, sir, that it has
-ever been thought of, talked of or dreamed of, in the wildest flights
-of human imagination. But the idea, so far as it exists, must be of
-a separation, assigning the slave States to one side, and the free
-States to the other. Sir, I may express myself too strongly, perhaps,
-but there are impossibilities in the moral as well as in the physical
-world, and I hold the idea of a separation of these States, those
-that are free to form one government, and those that are slaveholding
-to form another, as such an impossibility. We could not separate the
-States by any such line if we were to draw it. We could not sit down
-here to-day and draw a line of separation that would satisfy any five
-men in the country. There are natural causes that would keep and tie us
-together, and there are social and domestic relations which we could
-not break if we would, and which we should not if we could.”
-
-In describing the consequences of secession it must be admitted
-that Mr. Webster spoke like a true prophet. All the evils that he
-predicted—the war such as the world had never seen—came to pass, but
-out of it the Union emerged stronger than ever, with its chief burden
-and reproach thrown overboard. Much as the war cost, we feel to-day
-that we are the better off that it was fought. Let us not blame Mr.
-Webster that he could not penetrate the future, and strove so hard to
-avert it. Probably his speech postponed it, but nothing could avert it.
-Can we doubt that if the great statesman were living to-day he would
-thank God that He had solved the great problem that had baffled the
-wisdom of the wisest, and brought substantial good from fratricidal
-strife?
-
-Among those who listened with rapt attention to Mr. Webster was John C.
-Calhoun, his great compeer, who had risen with difficulty from the bed
-where he lay fatally sick, to hear the senator from Massachusetts. “A
-tall, gaunt figure, wrapped in a long black cloak, with deep, cavernous
-black eyes, and a thick mass of snow-white hair brushed back from the
-large brow,” he seemed like a visitant from the next world. It was his
-last appearance in the Senate. Before March was over he had gone to his
-rest!
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XXXVII.
-
-CLOSING SCENES.
-
-
-Mr. Webster’s public life was drawing to a close. After the death of
-Gen. Taylor he accepted for a second time the post of Secretary of
-State, but there is nothing in his official work that calls for our
-special attention. Important questions came up and were satisfactorily
-disposed of. There was a strong hand at the helm.
-
-June, 1852, brought him a great disappointment. The Whig Convention
-assembled in Baltimore to nominate a candidate for the Presidency. Mr.
-Webster was by all means the leader of that party, and was one of the
-three candidates balloted for. But in the end the successful man was
-Gen. Winfield Scott. It was a nomination like that of Harrison and
-Taylor, dictated solely by what was thought to be availability. In this
-case a mistake was made. Gen. Scott was disastrously defeated by Gen.
-Franklin Pierce, the nominee of the Democracy.
-
-Gen. Pierce, though parted by politics, was a devoted friend of Mr.
-Webster, and the reader may be interested to know that on hearing of
-his nomination, he spoke thus: “Well, all I can say is, and I say it
-in sincerity, if the people of the United States were to repudiate
-caucuses, conventions, politicians and tricksters, and rise in the
-glory of their strength and might, without waiting for any convention
-to designate a candidate, but bent on placing in the Presidential
-chair the first citizen and statesman, the first patriot and man,
-Daniel Webster, it would do for republican government more than any
-event which has taken place in the history of the world. These are my
-sentiments, democracy or no democracy.”
-
-This is certainly a remarkable tribute from the nominee of one party to
-an unsuccessful candidate of another, but Gen. Pierce had shown on many
-occasions his warm friendship and admiration for Mr. Webster.
-
-At Mr. Webster’s age it was not likely that he would ever again be a
-candidate for the Presidency. His last chance had slipped away, and the
-disappointment was keen. He was already in declining health, induced
-partly by a severe accident which befell him in May, 1852, when he
-was thrown headlong to the earth while riding behind a span of horses
-to Plymouth. Probably the injury was greater than appeared. Towards
-the end of September, while at Marshfield, alarming symptoms were
-developed, and his grand physical system was evidently giving way. That
-month was to be his last. His earthly work was done, and he was never
-again to resume his work at Washington. The closing scenes are thus
-described by Mr. Curtis:
-
-“It was past midnight, when, awaking from one of the slumbers that he
-had at intervals, he seemed not to know whether he had not already
-passed from his earthly existence. He made a strong effort to ascertain
-what the consciousness that he could still perceive actually was,
-and then uttered those well-known words, ‘I still live!’ as if he
-had satisfied himself of the fact that he was striving to know. They
-were his last coherent utterance. A good deal later he said something
-in which the word ‘poetry’ was distinctly heard. His son immediately
-repeated to him one of the stanzas of Gray’s ‘Elegy.’ He heard it and
-smiled. After this respiration became more difficult, and at length
-it went on with perceptible intervals. All was now hushed within the
-chamber; and to us who stood waiting there were but three sounds in
-nature: the sighing of the autumn wind in the trees, the slow ticking
-of the clock in the hall below, and the deep breathing of our dying
-friend. Moments that seemed hours flowed on. Still the measured beat
-of time fell painfully distinct upon our ears; still the gentle moaning
-of the wind mingled with the only sound that arose within the room;
-for there were no sobs of women, no movements of men. So grand, and
-yet so calm and simple, had been his approach to the moment when he
-must know that he was with us no more, that he had lifted us into a
-composure which, but for his great example, we could not have felt. At
-twenty-three minutes before three o’clock his breathing ceased; the
-features settled into a superb repose; and Dr. Jeffries, who still held
-the pulse, after waiting a few seconds, gently laid down the arm, and
-amid a breathless silence, pronounced the single word, ‘Dead.’ The eyes
-were then closed, the remains were removed from the position in which
-death came, and all but those who had been appointed to wait and watch
-slowly and mournfully walked away.”
-
-Thus died a man whom all generations will agree in pronouncing great; a
-man not without faults, for he was human, but one to whom his country
-may point with pride as a sincere patriot, a devoted son, who, in
-eloquence at the bar and in the Senate, is worthy of a place beside
-the greatest orators of any nation, or any epoch. He has invested the
-name of an American citizen with added glory, for he was a typical
-American, the genuine product of our republican institutions. No poor
-boy who reads his life need despair of becoming eminent, for he can
-hardly have more obstacles to overcome than the farmers’ boy, who grew
-up on the sterile soil of New Hampshire, and fought his way upward with
-unfailing courage and pluck. Not once in a century is such a man born
-into the world—a man so amply endowed by his Creator—but he did not
-rely upon his natural talents, but was a firm believer in hard work.
-With all his marvelous ability he would not otherwise have left behind
-him such a name and fame.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XXXVIII.
-
-CENTENNIAL TRIBUTES.
-
-
-On the 18th of January, 1882, the hundredth birthday of Daniel Webster,
-the Marshfield Club assembled at the Parker House, in Boston, to
-take suitable notice of the anniversary. Though thirty years had
-elapsed since his death there was one at least present, Hon. Robert
-C. Winthrop, who had been intimately associated with him in public
-life, having been his successor in the Senate, and a warm personal
-friend. Most notable among the addresses was that of Gov. Long, of
-Massachusetts, which I shall venture to insert here, as containing
-in brief compass a fitting estimate of the great statesman whom the
-company had assembled to honor.
-
-
-GOVERNOR LONG’S ADDRESS.
-
-“It is but a poor tribute that even the most eloquent voice, least
-of all mine, can pay for Massachusetts to the memory of her greatest
-statesman, her mightiest intellect and her most powerful orator. Among
-her sons he towers like the lonely and massive shaft on Bunker Hill,
-upon the base and the crest of which his name is emblazoned clearer
-than if chiseled deep in its granite cubes. For years he was her
-synonym. Among the States he sustained her at that proud height which
-Winthrop and Sam Adams gave her in the colonial and provincial days.
-With what matchless grandeur he defended her! With what overwhelming
-power he impressed her convictions upon the national life! God seems
-to appoint men to special work, and, that done, the very effort of
-its achievement exhausts them, and they rise not again to the summit
-of their meridian. So it was with Webster. He knows little even of
-written constitutions and frames of government who does not know
-that they exist almost less in the letter than in the interpretation
-and construction of the letter. In this light it is not too much to
-say that the Constitution of the United States, as it existed when
-it carried our country through the greatest peril that ever tested
-it, was the crystallization of the mind of Webster as well as of its
-original framers. It came from them and was only accepted by some of
-our own as a compact of States, sovereign in all but certain enumerated
-powers delegated to a central government. He made it the crucible of
-a welded Union—the charter of one great country, the United States
-of America. He made the States a nation and enfolded them in its
-single banner. It was the overwhelming logic of his discussion, the
-household familiarity of his simple but irresistible statement, that
-gave us munition to fight the war for the preservation of the Union and
-the abolition of slavery. It was his eloquence, clear as crystal and
-precipitating itself in the school-books and literature of a people,
-which had trained up the generation of twenty years ago to regard
-this nation as one, to love its flag with a patriotism that knew no
-faction or section, to be loyal to the whole country, and to find in
-its Constitution power to suppress any hand or combination raised
-against it. The great Rebellion of 1861 went down hardly more before
-the cannon of Grant and Farragut than the thunder of Webster’s reply
-to Hayne. He knew not the extent of his own achievement. His greatest
-failure was that he rose not to the height and actual stroke of his
-own resistless argument, and that he lacked the sublime inspiration,
-the disentanglement and the courage to let the giant he had created
-go upon his errand, first of force, and then, through that, of surer
-peace. He had put the work and genius of more than an ordinary lifetime
-of service into the arching and knitting of the Union, and this he
-could not bear to put to the final test; his great heart was sincere
-in the prayer that his eyes might not behold the earthquake that would
-shake it to those foundations which, though he knew it not, he had made
-so strong that a succeeding generation saw them stand the shock as
-the oak withstands the storm. Men are not gods, and it needed in him
-that he should rise to a moral sublimity and daring as lofty as the
-intellectual heights above which he soared with unequaled strength. So
-had he been godlike.
-
-“A great man touches the heart of the people as well as their
-intelligence. They not only admire, they also love him. It sometimes
-seems as if they sought in him some weakness of our common human
-nature, that they may chide him for it, forgive it, and so endear him
-to themselves the more. Massachusetts had her friction with the younger
-Adams, only to lay him away with profounder honor, and to remember him
-devotedly as the defender of the right of petition and ‘the old man
-eloquent.’ She forgave the overweening conceit of Sumner, she revoked
-her unjust censure of him, and now points her youth to him in his high
-niche as the unsullied patriot, without fear and without reproach, who
-stood and spoke for equal rights, and whose last great service was to
-demand and enforce his country’s just claims against the dishonorable
-trespass of the cruisers of that England he had so much admired.
-Massachusetts smote, too, and broke the heart of Webster, her idol, and
-then broke her own above his grave, and to-day writes his name highest
-upon her roll of statesmen. It seems disjointed to say that, with such
-might as his, the impression that comes from his face upon the wall,
-as from his silhouette upon the background of our history, is that of
-sadness—the sadness of the great deep eyes, the sadness of the lonely
-shore he loved, and by which he sleeps. The story of Webster from the
-beginning is the very pathos of romance. A minor chord runs through it
-like the tenderest note in a song. What eloquence of tears is in that
-narrative, which reveals in this giant of intellectual strength the
-heart, the single loving heart, of a child, and in which he describes
-the winter sleighride up the New Hampshire hills when his father told
-him that, at whatever cost, he should have a college education, and he,
-too full to speak, while a warm glow ran all over him, laid his head
-upon his father’s shoulder and wept!
-
-“The greatness of Webster and his title to enduring gratitude have
-two illustrations. He taught the people of the United States, in the
-simplicity of common understanding, the principles of the Constitution
-and government of the country, and he wrought for them, in a style of
-matchless strength and beauty, the literature of statesmanship. From
-his lips flowed the discussion of constitutional law, of economic
-philosophy, of finance, of international right, of national grandeur
-and of the whole range of high public themes, so clear and judicial
-that it was no longer discussion, but judgment. To-day—and so it will
-be while the republic endures—the student and the legislator turn
-to the full fountain of his statement for the enunciation of these
-principles. What other authority is quoted, or holds even the second
-or third place? Even his words have imbedded themselves in the common
-phraseology, and come to the tongue like passages from the Psalms or
-the poets. I do not know that a sentence or a word of Sumner’s repeats
-itself in our every-day parlance. The exquisite periods of Everett are
-recalled like the consummate work of some master of music, but no note
-or refrain sings itself over and over again to our ears. The brilliant
-eloquence of Choate is like the flash of a bursting rocket, lingering
-upon the retina indeed after it has faded from the wings of the night,
-but as elusive of our grasp as spray-drops that glisten in the sun. The
-fiery enthusiasm of Andrews did, indeed, burn some of his heart-beats
-forever into the sentiment of Massachusetts; but Webster made his
-language the very household words of a nation. They are the library
-of a people. They inspired and still inspire patriotism. They taught
-and still teach loyalty. They are the school-book of the citizen. They
-are the inwrought and accepted fiber of American politics. If the
-temple of our republic shall ever fall, they will ‘still live’ above
-the ground like those great foundation stones in ancient ruins, which
-remain in lonely grandeur, unburied in the dust that springs to turf
-over all else, and making men wonder from what rare quarry and by what
-mighty force they came. To Webster, as to few other men, is it due
-that to-day, wherever a son of the United States, at home or abroad,
-‘beholds the gorgeous ensign of the republic, now known and honored
-throughout the earth, still full high advanced, its arms and trophies
-streaming in their original luster, not a stripe erased or polluted,
-nor a single star obscured,’ he can utter a prouder boast than, _Civis
-Romanus sum_. For he can say, I am an American citizen.”
-
-As a fitting pendant to this eloquent tribute I quote a portion of the
-address of Mr. Winthrop, whose name, personally and by inheritance,
-makes him one of the most eminent sons of Massachusetts:
-
-“And, after all, Mr. President, what are all the fine things which
-have ever been said of him, or which ever can be said of him, to-night
-or a hundred years hence, compared with the splendid record which
-he has left of himself as an advocate in the courts, as a debater
-in the Senate, as an orator before the people? We do not search out
-for what was said about Pericles or Demosthenes or Cicero or Burke.
-It is enough for us to read their orations. There are those, indeed,
-who may justly desire to be measured by the momentary opinions which
-others have formed and expressed about them. There are not a few who
-may well be content to live on the applauses and praises which their
-efforts have called forth from immediate hearers and admirers. They
-will enjoy at least a reflected and traditional fame. But Webster will
-always stand safest and strongest on his own showing. His fame will
-be independent of praise or dispraise from other men’s lips. He can
-be measured to his full altitude, as a thinker, a writer, a speaker,
-only by the standard of his own immortal productions. That masterly
-style, that pure Saxon English, that clear and cogent statement, that
-close and clinching logic, that power of going down to the depths
-and up to the heights of any great argument, letting the immaterial
-or incidental look out for itself, those vivid descriptions, those
-magnificent metaphors, those thrilling appeals—not introduced as mere
-ornaments wrought out in advance, and stored up for an opportunity of
-display, but sparkling and blazing out in the very heat of an effort,
-like gems uncovering themselves in the working of a mine—these are some
-of the characteristics which will secure for Webster a fame altogether
-his own, and will make his works a model and a study, long after most
-of those who have praised him, or who have censured him, shall be
-forgotten.
-
-“What if those six noble volumes of his were obliterated from the
-roll of American literature and American eloquence! What if those
-great speeches, recently issued in a single compendious volume, had
-no existence! What if those consummate defenses of the Constitution
-and the Union had never been uttered, and their instruction and
-inspiration had been lost to us during the fearful ordeal to which
-that Constitution and that Union have since been subjected? Are we
-quite sure that we should have had that Constitution as it was, and the
-Union as it is, to be fought for, if the birth we are commemorating had
-never occurred—if that bright Northern Star had never gleamed above
-the hills of New Hampshire? Let it be, if you please, that its light
-was not always serene and steady. Let it be that mist and clouds
-sometimes gathered over its disk, and hid its guiding rays from many a
-wistful eye. Say even, if you will, that to some eyes it seemed once
-to be shooting madly from its sphere. Make every deduction which his
-bitterest enemies have ever made for any alleged deviation from the
-course which he had marked out for it by others, or which it seemed to
-have marked out for itself, in its path across the sky. Still, still
-there is radiance and glory enough left, as we contemplate its whole
-golden track, to make us feel and acknowledge that it had no fellow in
-our firmament.”
-
-
-THE END.
-
-
- * * * * *
-
-Transcriber's Notes
-
-Obvious typographical errors have been silently corrected. All other
-spelling and punctuation remains unchanged.
-
-Italics are represented thus _italic_.
-
-
-
-
-
-
-End of Project Gutenberg's From Farm Boy to Senator, by Horatio Alger Jr.
-
-*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK FROM FARM BOY TO SENATOR ***
-
-***** This file should be named 53382-0.txt or 53382-0.zip *****
-This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
- http://www.gutenberg.org/5/3/3/8/53382/
-
-Produced by David Edwards, Les Galloway and the Online
-Distributed Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net (This
-file was produced from images generously made available
-by The Internet Archive)
-
-
-Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions will
-be renamed.
-
-Creating the works from print editions not protected by U.S. copyright
-law means that no one owns a United States copyright in these works,
-so the Foundation (and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United
-States without permission and without paying copyright
-royalties. Special rules, set forth in the General Terms of Use part
-of this license, apply to copying and distributing Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works to protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm
-concept and trademark. Project Gutenberg is a registered trademark,
-and may not be used if you charge for the eBooks, unless you receive
-specific permission. If you do not charge anything for copies of this
-eBook, complying with the rules is very easy. You may use this eBook
-for nearly any purpose such as creation of derivative works, reports,
-performances and research. They may be modified and printed and given
-away--you may do practically ANYTHING in the United States with eBooks
-not protected by U.S. copyright law. Redistribution is subject to the
-trademark license, especially commercial redistribution.
-
-START: FULL LICENSE
-
-THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
-PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
-
-To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
-distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
-(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full
-Project Gutenberg-tm License available with this file or online at
-www.gutenberg.org/license.
-
-Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-
-1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
-and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
-(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
-the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or
-destroy all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your
-possession. If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a
-Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound
-by the terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the
-person or entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph
-1.E.8.
-
-1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
-used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
-agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
-things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
-paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this
-agreement and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works. See paragraph 1.E below.
-
-1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the
-Foundation" or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection
-of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual
-works in the collection are in the public domain in the United
-States. If an individual work is unprotected by copyright law in the
-United States and you are located in the United States, we do not
-claim a right to prevent you from copying, distributing, performing,
-displaying or creating derivative works based on the work as long as
-all references to Project Gutenberg are removed. Of course, we hope
-that you will support the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting
-free access to electronic works by freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm
-works in compliance with the terms of this agreement for keeping the
-Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with the work. You can easily
-comply with the terms of this agreement by keeping this work in the
-same format with its attached full Project Gutenberg-tm License when
-you share it without charge with others.
-
-1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
-what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are
-in a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States,
-check the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this
-agreement before downloading, copying, displaying, performing,
-distributing or creating derivative works based on this work or any
-other Project Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no
-representations concerning the copyright status of any work in any
-country outside the United States.
-
-1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
-
-1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other
-immediate access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear
-prominently whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work
-on which the phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the
-phrase "Project Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed,
-performed, viewed, copied or distributed:
-
- This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and
- most other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no
- restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it
- under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included with this
- eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org. If you are not located in the
- United States, you'll have to check the laws of the country where you
- are located before using this ebook.
-
-1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is
-derived from texts not protected by U.S. copyright law (does not
-contain a notice indicating that it is posted with permission of the
-copyright holder), the work can be copied and distributed to anyone in
-the United States without paying any fees or charges. If you are
-redistributing or providing access to a work with the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the work, you must comply
-either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 or
-obtain permission for the use of the work and the Project Gutenberg-tm
-trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
-
-1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
-with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
-must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any
-additional terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms
-will be linked to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works
-posted with the permission of the copyright holder found at the
-beginning of this work.
-
-1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
-License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
-work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
-
-1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
-electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
-prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
-active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm License.
-
-1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
-compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including
-any word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access
-to or distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format
-other than "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official
-version posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site
-(www.gutenberg.org), you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense
-to the user, provide a copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means
-of obtaining a copy upon request, of the work in its original "Plain
-Vanilla ASCII" or other form. Any alternate format must include the
-full Project Gutenberg-tm License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
-
-1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
-performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
-unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
-
-1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
-access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-provided that
-
-* You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
- the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
- you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is owed
- to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he has
- agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the Project
- Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments must be paid
- within 60 days following each date on which you prepare (or are
- legally required to prepare) your periodic tax returns. Royalty
- payments should be clearly marked as such and sent to the Project
- Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the address specified in
- Section 4, "Information about donations to the Project Gutenberg
- Literary Archive Foundation."
-
-* You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
- you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
- does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
- License. You must require such a user to return or destroy all
- copies of the works possessed in a physical medium and discontinue
- all use of and all access to other copies of Project Gutenberg-tm
- works.
-
-* You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of
- any money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
- electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days of
- receipt of the work.
-
-* You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
- distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
-
-1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work or group of works on different terms than
-are set forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing
-from both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and The
-Project Gutenberg Trademark LLC, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm
-trademark. Contact the Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
-
-1.F.
-
-1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
-effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
-works not protected by U.S. copyright law in creating the Project
-Gutenberg-tm collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may
-contain "Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate
-or corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other
-intellectual property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or
-other medium, a computer virus, or computer codes that damage or
-cannot be read by your equipment.
-
-1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
-of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
-liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
-fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
-LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
-PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
-TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
-LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
-INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
-DAMAGE.
-
-1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
-defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
-receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
-written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
-received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium
-with your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you
-with the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in
-lieu of a refund. If you received the work electronically, the person
-or entity providing it to you may choose to give you a second
-opportunity to receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If
-the second copy is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing
-without further opportunities to fix the problem.
-
-1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
-in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS', WITH NO
-OTHER WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT
-LIMITED TO WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
-
-1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
-warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of
-damages. If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement
-violates the law of the state applicable to this agreement, the
-agreement shall be interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or
-limitation permitted by the applicable state law. The invalidity or
-unenforceability of any provision of this agreement shall not void the
-remaining provisions.
-
-1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
-trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
-providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in
-accordance with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the
-production, promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works, harmless from all liability, costs and expenses,
-including legal fees, that arise directly or indirectly from any of
-the following which you do or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this
-or any Project Gutenberg-tm work, (b) alteration, modification, or
-additions or deletions to any Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any
-Defect you cause.
-
-Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
-electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of
-computers including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It
-exists because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations
-from people in all walks of life.
-
-Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
-assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
-goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
-remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
-and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future
-generations. To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation and how your efforts and donations can help, see
-Sections 3 and 4 and the Foundation information page at
-www.gutenberg.org Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg
-Literary Archive Foundation
-
-The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
-501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
-state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
-Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
-number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent permitted by
-U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
-
-The Foundation's principal office is in Fairbanks, Alaska, with the
-mailing address: PO Box 750175, Fairbanks, AK 99775, but its
-volunteers and employees are scattered throughout numerous
-locations. Its business office is located at 809 North 1500 West, Salt
-Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887. Email contact links and up to
-date contact information can be found at the Foundation's web site and
-official page at www.gutenberg.org/contact
-
-For additional contact information:
-
- Dr. Gregory B. Newby
- Chief Executive and Director
- gbnewby@pglaf.org
-
-Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
-Literary Archive Foundation
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
-spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
-increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
-freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
-array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
-($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
-status with the IRS.
-
-The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
-charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
-States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
-considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
-with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
-where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To SEND
-DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any particular
-state visit www.gutenberg.org/donate
-
-While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
-have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
-against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
-approach us with offers to donate.
-
-International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
-any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
-outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
-
-Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
-methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
-ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations. To
-donate, please visit: www.gutenberg.org/donate
-
-Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works.
-
-Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm concept of a library of electronic works that could be
-freely shared with anyone. For forty years, he produced and
-distributed Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of
-volunteer support.
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
-editions, all of which are confirmed as not protected by copyright in
-the U.S. unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not
-necessarily keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper
-edition.
-
-Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search
-facility: www.gutenberg.org
-
-This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
-including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
-subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
-
diff --git a/old/53382-0.zip b/old/53382-0.zip
deleted file mode 100644
index 9b3fc53..0000000
--- a/old/53382-0.zip
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/53382-h.zip b/old/53382-h.zip
deleted file mode 100644
index 7d01396..0000000
--- a/old/53382-h.zip
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/53382-h/53382-h.htm b/old/53382-h/53382-h.htm
deleted file mode 100644
index ab43699..0000000
--- a/old/53382-h/53382-h.htm
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,10100 +0,0 @@
-<!DOCTYPE html PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.0 Strict//EN"
- "http://www.w3.org/TR/xhtml1/DTD/xhtml1-strict.dtd">
-<html xmlns="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml" xml:lang="en" lang="en">
- <head>
- <meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html;charset=utf-8" />
- <meta http-equiv="Content-Style-Type" content="text/css" />
- <title>
- The Project Gutenberg eBook of From Farm Boy to Senator; Being the History
- of the Boyhood and Manhood of Daniel Webster, by Horatio Alger, Jr..
- </title>
- <link rel="coverpage" href="images/cover.jpg" />
- <style type="text/css">
-
-body {
- margin-left: 10%;
- margin-right: 10%;
-}
-
-h1
-{
- margin-top: 2em; margin-bottom: 2em;
- text-align: center;
- font-size: x-large;
- font-weight: normal;
- line-height: 1.6;
-}
-
- h2,h3{
- text-align: center;
- clear: both;
- }
-
-div.chapter {page-break-before: always;}
-
-p
-{
- margin-top: .75em;
- text-align: justify;
- margin-bottom: .75em;
-}
-
-.p10 {margin-left: 6em;}
-.p20 {margin-left: 14em;}
-
-.half-title {
- margin-top: 2em; margin-bottom: 2em;
- text-align: center;
- font-size: x-large;
- font-weight: normal;
- line-height: 1.6;
-}
-
-.spaced {margin-top: 6em; margin-bottom: 6em;}
-.space-above {margin-top: 3em;}
-
-hr {
- width: 33%;
- margin-top: 2em;
- margin-bottom: 2em;
- margin-left: 33.5%;
- margin-right: 33.5%;
- clear: both;
-}
-
-hr.chap {width: 65%; margin-left: 17.5%; margin-right: 17.5%;}
-
-
-table {
- margin-left: auto;
- margin-right: auto;
-}
-
- .tdl {text-align: left;}
- .tdr {text-align: right;}
-
-.pagenum { /* uncomment the next line for invisible page numbers */
- visibility: hidden;
- position: absolute;
- left: 92%;
- font-size: smaller;
- text-align: right;
-} /* page numbers */
-
-
-
-.center {text-align: center;}
-
-.smcap {font-variant: small-caps;}
-
-
-.xs {font-size: x-small;}
-.small {font-size: small;}
-
-.large {font-size: large;}
-.xl {font-size: x-large;}
-
-
-/* Images */
-.figcenter {margin: 1em auto; text-align: center;}
-.caption {font-size: smaller; font-weight: bold;}
-img {border: none; max-width: 100%}
-
-
-/* Poetry */
-.poetry-container
- {
- text-align: center;
- margin: -1em 0;
- }
-
-.poetry
- {
- display: inline-block;
- text-align: left;
- }
-
-.poetry .stanza {margin: 1em 0em 1em 0em;}
-
-.poetry .verse
- {
- text-indent: -3em;
- padding-left: 3em;
- }
-
-.poetry .indent2 {text-indent: -2em;}
-.poetry .indent6 {text-indent: 0em;}
-.poetry .indent30 {text-indent: 12em;}
-
-@media handheld
-{
- .poetry
- {
- display: block;
- margin-left: 1em;
- }
-}
-
-/* Transcriber's notes */
-.transnote {background-color: #E6E6FA;
- color: black;
- font-size:smaller;
- padding:0.5em;
- margin-bottom:5em;
- font-family:sans-serif, serif; }
- </style>
- </head>
-<body>
-
-
-<pre>
-
-The Project Gutenberg EBook of From Farm Boy to Senator, by Horatio Alger Jr.
-
-This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and most
-other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no restrictions
-whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it under the terms of
-the Project Gutenberg License included with this eBook or online at
-www.gutenberg.org. If you are not located in the United States, you'll have
-to check the laws of the country where you are located before using this ebook.
-
-
-
-Title: From Farm Boy to Senator
- Being the History of the Boyhood and Manhood of Daniel Webter
-
-Author: Horatio Alger Jr.
-
-Release Date: October 27, 2016 [EBook #53382]
-
-Language: English
-
-Character set encoding: UTF-8
-
-*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK FROM FARM BOY TO SENATOR ***
-
-
-
-
-Produced by David Edwards, Les Galloway and the Online
-Distributed Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net (This
-file was produced from images generously made available
-by The Internet Archive)
-
-
-
-
-
-
-</pre>
-
-
-<div class="figcenter">
-<img src="images/frontis.jpg" alt="Two boys in a general store" />
-</div>
-
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_1" id="Page_1">[Pg 1]</a></span></p>
-
-
-<h1>
-<small>FROM</small><br />
-
-FARM BOY TO SENATOR;</h1>
-
-
-<p class="center xs">BEING THE HISTORY OF THE</p>
-
-<p class="center large">BOYHOOD AND MANHOOD<br />
-
-<span class="xs">OF</span><br />
-
-<span class="xl">DANIEL WEBSTER.</span></p>
-
-
-<p class="center space-above"><span class="smcap">By HORATIO ALGER, Jr.</span>,</p>
-
-<p class="center xs"><i>Author of “From Canal Boy to President,” “Ragged Dick
-Series,” “Tattered Tom Series,” etc., etc.</i></p>
-
-
-
-<p class="center space-above"><small>NEW YORK:<br />
-J. S. OGILVIE &amp; COMPANY,<br />
-<span class="smcap">No. 31 Rose Street</span>.</small>
-</p>
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_2" id="Page_2">[Pg 2]</a></span></p>
-
-
-<p class="center spaced">
-<span class="smcap small">Copyright, 1882,<br />
-by STREET &amp; SMITH.</span><br />
-</p>
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_3" id="Page_3">[Pg 3]</a></span></p>
-
-
-<p class="center spaced">
-<small>TO<br />
-<br />
-MY FRIEND AND COLLEGE CLASSMATE,</small><br />
-<br />
-JUDGE ADDISON BROWN,<br />
-<br />
-<span class="xs">OF NEW YORK,</span><br />
-<br />
-<small>THIS VOLUME IS CORDIALLY INSCRIBED.</small><br />
-</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_4" id="Page_4">[Pg 4]</a><br /><a name="Page_5" id="Page_5">[Pg 5]</a></span></p>
-
-
-
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-<h2><a name="CONTENTS" id="CONTENTS">CONTENTS.</a></h2>
-
-
-
-<div class="center">
-<table border="0" cellpadding="4" cellspacing="0" summary="">
-<tr>
- <td class="tdl"><small>CHAPTER</small></td>
- <td class="tdr"><small>PAGE</small></td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
- <td class="tdl">I.</td>
- <td class="tdl">The Cotton Handkerchief</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_9">9</a></td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
- <td class="tdl">II.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Daniel and his Father</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_17">17</a></td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
- <td class="tdl">III.</td>
- <td class="tdl">A Memorable Battle</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_25">25</a></td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
- <td class="tdl">IV.</td>
- <td class="tdl">An Important Step</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_33">33</a></td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
- <td class="tdl">V.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Daniel at Exeter Academy</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_41">41</a></td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
- <td class="tdl">VI.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Preparing for College</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_49">49</a></td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
- <td class="tdl">VII.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Daniel’s College Life</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_59">59</a></td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
- <td class="tdl">VIII.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Daniel Receives some Valuable Advice</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_67">67</a></td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
- <td class="tdl">IX.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Brotherly Love</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_71">71</a></td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
- <td class="tdl">X.</td>
- <td class="tdl">The Two Brothers</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_76">76</a></td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
- <td class="tdl">XI.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Daniel as an Orator</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_84">84</a></td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
- <td class="tdl">XII.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Studying Law</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_92">92</a></td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
- <td class="tdl">XIII.</td>
- <td class="tdl">How Daniel went to Fryeburg</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_97">97</a></td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
- <td class="tdl">XIV.</td>
- <td class="tdl">The Preceptor of Fryeburg Academy</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_101">101</a></td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
- <td class="tdl">XV.</td>
- <td class="tdl">The Next Two Years</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_109">109</a></td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
- <td class="tdl">XVI.</td>
- <td class="tdl">A Great Temptation</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_117">117</a></td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
- <td class="tdl">XVII.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Daniel Refuses a Clerkship</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_125">125</a></td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
- <td class="tdl">XVIII.</td>
- <td class="tdl">D. Webster, Attorney</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_133">133</a></td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
- <td class="tdl">XIX.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Daniel Overcomes a Bramble</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_141">141</a></td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
- <td class="tdl">XX.</td>
- <td class="tdl">“The Little Black Stable-Boy.”</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_150">150</a></td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
- <td class="tdl">XXI.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Why Daniel was sent to Congress</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_158">158</a></td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
- <td class="tdl">XXII.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Mr. Webster as a Member of Congress</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_166">166</a></td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
- <td class="tdl">XXIII.</td>
- <td class="tdl">John Randolph and William Pinkney</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_174">174</a></td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
- <td class="tdl">XXIV.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Mr. Webster in Boston</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_184">184</a><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_6" id="Page_6">[Pg 6]</a></span></td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
- <td class="tdl">XXV.</td>
- <td class="tdl">The Oration at Plymouth</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_190">190</a></td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
- <td class="tdl">XXVI.</td>
- <td class="tdl">The Bunker Hill Oration</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_199">199</a></td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
- <td class="tdl">XXVII.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Adams and Jefferson</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_207">207</a></td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
- <td class="tdl">XXVIII.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Home Life and Domestic Sorrows</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_218">218</a></td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
- <td class="tdl">XXIX.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Called to the Senate</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_225">225</a></td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
- <td class="tdl">XXX.</td>
- <td class="tdl">The Beginning of a Great Battle</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_232">232</a></td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
- <td class="tdl">XXXI.</td>
- <td class="tdl">The Reply to Hayne</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_240">240</a></td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
- <td class="tdl">XXXII.</td>
- <td class="tdl">The Secret of Webster’s Power</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_256">256</a></td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
- <td class="tdl">XXXIII.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Honors Received in England</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_267">267</a></td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
- <td class="tdl">XXXIV.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Called to the Cabinet</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_275">275</a></td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
- <td class="tdl">XXXV.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Life at Marshfield</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_283">283</a></td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
- <td class="tdl">XXXVI.</td>
- <td class="tdl">The Seventh of March Speech</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_289">289</a></td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
- <td class="tdl">XXXVII.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Closing Scenes</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_296">296</a></td>
-</tr>
-<tr>
- <td class="tdl">XXXVIII.</td>
- <td class="tdl">Centennial Tributes</td>
- <td class="tdr"><a href="#Page_301">301</a></td>
-</tr>
-</table></div>
-
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_7" id="Page_7">[Pg 7]</a></span></p>
-
-
-
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-<h2><a name="PREFACE" id="PREFACE">PREFACE.</a></h2>
-
-
-<p>But thirty years have elapsed since the death
-of Daniel Webster, and there is already danger
-that, so far as young people are concerned, he will
-become an historic reminiscence. Schoolboys,
-who declaim the eloquent extracts from his
-speeches which are included in all the school
-speakers, are indeed able to form some idea of his
-great oratorical powers and the themes which called
-them forth; but I have found that young classical
-students, as a rule, know more of Cicero’s life
-than of his. It seems to me eminently fitting
-that the leading incidents in the life of our great
-countryman, his struggles for an education, the
-steps by which he rose to professional and political
-distinction, should be made familiar to American
-boys. I have therefore essayed a “story biography,”
-which I have tried to write in such a manner
-as to make it attractive to young people, who
-are apt to turn away from ordinary biographies,
-in the fear that they may prove dull.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_8" id="Page_8">[Pg 8]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>I have not found my task an easy one. Webster’s
-life is so crowded with great services and
-events, it is so interwoven with the history of the
-nation, that to give a fair idea of him in a volume
-of ordinary size is almost impossible. I have
-found it necessary to leave out some things, and
-to refer briefly to others, lest my book should expand
-to undue proportions. Let me acknowledge
-then, with the utmost frankness, that my work is
-incomplete, and necessarily so. This causes me
-less regret, because those whom I may be fortunate
-enough to interest in my subject will
-readily find all that they wish to know in the noble
-Life of Webster, by George Ticknor Curtis, the
-captivating Reminiscences, by Peter Harvey, the
-Private Correspondence, edited by Fletcher Webster,
-and the collection of Mr. Webster’s speeches,
-edited by Mr. Everett. They will also find interesting
-views of Mr. Webster’s senatorial career
-in the Reminiscences of Congress, by Charles W.
-March.</p>
-
-<p>If this unpretending volume shall contribute in
-any way to extend the study of Mr. Webster’s
-life and works, I shall feel that my labor has been
-well bestowed.</p>
-
-<p>
-<span class="smcap">Horatio Alger, Jr.</span><br />
-<br />
-March 28, 1882.<br />
-</p>
-
-<div class="figcenter" >
-<img src="images/p008.jpg" alt="" />
-<div class="caption"><span class="smcap">Daniel Webster at the Age of Sixteen.</span></div>
-</div>
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-
-
-
-<p class="half-title"><span class="smcap">From Farm Boy to Senator.</span></p>
-<hr />
-<p class="half-title"><small>A BOYS’ LIFE OF</small><br />
-
-DANIEL WEBSTER.</p>
-<hr />
-
-
-
-<h2><a name="CHAPTER_I" id="CHAPTER_I">CHAPTER I.</a><br />
-
-<small>THE COTTON HANDKERCHIEF.</small></h2>
-
-
-<p>“Where are you going, Daniel?”</p>
-
-<p>“To Mr. Hoyt’s store.”</p>
-
-<p>“I’ll go in with you. Where is ’Zekiel this
-morning?”</p>
-
-<p>“I left him at work on the farm.”</p>
-
-<p>“I suppose you will both be farmers when you
-grow up?”</p>
-
-<p>“I don’t know,” answered Daniel, thoughtfully.
-“I don’t think I shall like it, but there
-isn’t anything else to do in Salisbury.”</p>
-
-<p>“You might keep a store, and teach school like
-Master Hoyt.”</p>
-
-<p>“Perhaps so. I should like it better than
-farming.”</p>
-
-<p>Daniel was but eight years old, a boy of strik<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_9" id="Page_9">[Pg 9]</a><br /><a name="Page_10" id="Page_10">[Pg 10]</a></span>ing
-appearance, with black hair and eyes, and a
-swarthy complexion. He was of slender frame,
-and his large dark eyes, deep set beneath an overhanging
-brow, gave a singular appearance to the
-thin face of the delicate looking boy.</p>
-
-<p>He was a farmer’s son, and lived in a plain,
-old-fashioned house, shaded by fine elms, and
-separated from the broad, quiet street by a fence.
-It was situated in a valley, at the bend of the
-Merrimac, on both sides of which rose high hills,
-which the boy climbed many a time for the more
-extended view they commanded. From a high
-sheep-pasture on his father’s farm, through a
-wide opening in the hills, he could see on a clear
-day Brentney Mountain in Vermont, and in a
-different direction the snowy top of Mount Washington,
-far away to the northeast.</p>
-
-<p>He entered the humble store with his companion.</p>
-
-<p>Behind the counter stood Master Hoyt, a tall
-man, of stern aspect, which could strike terror
-into the hearts of delinquent scholars when in
-the winter they came to receive instruction from
-him.</p>
-
-<p>“Good morning, Daniel,” said Master Hoyt,
-who was waiting upon a customer.</p>
-
-<p>“Good morning, sir,” answered Daniel, respectfully.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_11" id="Page_11">[Pg 11]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>“I hope you won’t forget what you learned at
-school last winter.”</p>
-
-<p>“No, sir, I will try not to.”</p>
-
-<p>“You mustn’t forget your reading and writing.”</p>
-
-<p>“No, sir; I read whatever I can find, but I
-don’t like writing much.”</p>
-
-<p>“You’ll never make much of a hand at writing,
-Daniel. Ezekiel writes far better than you.
-But you won’t need writing much when you’re
-following the plough.”</p>
-
-<p>“I hope I shan’t have to do that, Master
-Hoyt.”</p>
-
-<p>“Ay, you’re hardly strong enough, you may
-find something else to do in time. You may
-keep school like me—who knows?—but you’ll
-have to get some one else to set the copies,” and
-Master Hoyt laughed, as if he thought it a good
-joke.</p>
-
-<p>Daniel listened gravely to the master’s prediction,
-but it seemed to him he should hardly care
-to be a teacher like Mr. Hoyt, for the latter,
-though he was a good reader, wrote an excellent
-hand, and had a slight knowledge of grammar,
-could carry his pupils no further. No pupil was
-likely to wonder that “one small head could carry
-all he knew.” Yet the boys respected him, and
-in his limited way he did them good.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_12" id="Page_12">[Pg 12]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>Master Hoyt had by this time finished waiting
-upon his customer, and was at leisure to pay attention
-to his two young callers. He regarded
-them rather as pupils than as customers, for it
-is quite the custom in sparsely settled neighborhoods
-to “drop in” at the store for a chat.</p>
-
-<p>Meanwhile Daniel’s roving eyes had been attracted
-by a cotton pocket-handkerchief, which
-appeared to have something printed upon it.</p>
-
-<p>Master Hoyt noticed the direction of the boy’s
-gaze.</p>
-
-<p>“I see you are looking at the handkerchief,”
-he said. “Would you like to see what is printed
-on it?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, sir.”</p>
-
-<p>The handkerchief was taken down and placed
-in the boy’s hands. It was quite customary in
-those days, when books and papers were comparatively
-rare and difficult to obtain, to combine
-literature with plain homely utility, by printing
-reading matter of some kind on cheap cotton
-handkerchiefs. Nowadays boys would probably
-object to such a custom, but the boy, Daniel
-who was fond of reading, was attracted.</p>
-
-<p>“Is it a story?” he asked.</p>
-
-<p>“No, Daniel; it is the Constitution of the
-United States—the government we live under.”</p>
-
-<p>Daniel’s interest was excited. Of the govern<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_13" id="Page_13">[Pg 13]</a></span>ment
-he knew something, but not much, and up
-to that moment he had not known that there was
-a constitution, and indeed he couldn’t tell what a
-constitution was, but he thought he would like to
-know.</p>
-
-<p>“What is the price?” he asked.</p>
-
-<p>“Twenty-five cents.”</p>
-
-<p>Daniel felt in his pocket, and drew out a quarter
-of a dollar. It represented all his worldly
-wealth. It had not come to him all at once, but
-was the accumulation of pennies saved. He may
-have had other plans for spending it, but now
-when there was a chance of securing something
-to read he could not resist the temptation, so he
-passed over his precious coin, and the handkerchief
-became his.</p>
-
-<p>“It’s a good purchase,” said Master Hoyt, approvingly.
-“Take it home, Daniel, and read it,
-and you’ll know something of the government
-we’re living under. I suppose you’ve heard your
-father talk of the days when he was a soldier,
-and fought against the British?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, sir.”</p>
-
-<p>“When soldiers were called for, Captain Webster
-was one of the first to answer the call. But
-of course you are too young to remember that
-time.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, sir; but I have heard father talk about it.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_14" id="Page_14">[Pg 14]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>“Ay, ay; your father was selected to stand
-guard before General Washington’s headquarters
-on the night after Arnold’s treason. The general
-knew he could depend upon him.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, sir; I am sure of that,” said the boy
-proudly, for he had a high reverence and respect
-for his soldier father, who on his side was devoted
-to the best interests of his sons, and was ready
-when the time came to make sacrifices for them
-such as would have made most fathers hesitate.</p>
-
-<p>“Ah, those were dark days, Daniel. You are
-lucky to live in peaceful times, under a free
-government, but you must never forget how your
-father and other brave men fought to secure the
-blessings we now enjoy. Now General Washington
-is President, and we are no longer a subject
-colony, but we have a free and independent government.”</p>
-
-<p>It is doubtful how far Daniel and his young
-companion understood the remarks of Master
-Hoyt, but doubtless a time came further on when
-the words recurred to him, and in the light of his
-father’s conversations, which from time to time
-he held with his neighbors, gave him a more adequate
-idea of the character of that government in
-which in after years he was to take so prominent
-a part.</p>
-
-<p>“Are you going, Daniel?” asked William<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_15" id="Page_15">[Pg 15]</a></span>
-Hoyt, as the boys turned to leave his humble
-store.</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, sir; father may want me at home.”</p>
-
-<p>“Don’t forget your learning, my lad. You
-must be ready to take up your studies next winter.
-Soon you will know as much as I do.”</p>
-
-<p>It was meant for an encouraging remark, but
-the prospect it held out was not one to dazzle the
-imagination even of a boy of eight, for as I have
-already said the good man’s acquirements were of
-the most limited character.</p>
-
-<p>Daniel went home with his precious handkerchief
-snugly stowed away in his pocket. He was
-saving it till evening when he promised himself
-the pleasure of reading it.</p>
-
-<p>After supper by the light of the open log fire
-he brought out his new possession.</p>
-
-<p>“What have you there, my son?” asked his
-father.</p>
-
-<p>“It is a handkerchief, father, with the Constitution
-of the United States printed on it.”</p>
-
-<p>“Where did you get it?”</p>
-
-<p>“At Master Hoyt’s store.”</p>
-
-<p>“Dan spent all his money for it,” said Ezekiel.</p>
-
-<p>“Well, well, he might have done worse. It
-will do him no harm to read the Constitution of
-his country,” said the father, gravely.</p>
-
-<p>Thus assured of his father’s approval, the boy<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_16" id="Page_16">[Pg 16]</a></span>
-devoted himself to the reading of that famous
-document, of which in after years he was to become
-the staunch supporter and defender. For
-this boy was in his manhood to rank among the
-great men of the earth, and to leave a name and
-a fame to which his countrymen for centuries to
-come will point with just and patriotic pride.</p>
-
-<p>This boy with slender form, swarthy face, and
-dark eyes, was Daniel Webster.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_17" id="Page_17">[Pg 17]</a></span></p>
-
-
-
-
-<h2><a name="CHAPTER_II" id="CHAPTER_II">CHAPTER II.</a><br />
-
-<small>DANIEL AND HIS FATHER.</small></h2>
-
-
-<p>Daniel’s family had not lived many years at
-Elms Farm. Captain Webster first occupied a
-log house which he had himself built, and in this
-humble dwelling Ezekiel and one of his sisters
-were born. He was poor in worldly goods, but
-rich in children, having had ten born to him, five
-by the second marriage. Daniel was the youngest
-but one, and Sarah the youngest of all.</p>
-
-<p>When the war of the American Revolution
-broke out Daniel’s father was one of the first to
-take up arms. He himself drew up, and induced
-eighty-four of his townsmen to sign, the following
-patriotic pledge:</p>
-
-<p>“We do solemnly engage and promise that we
-will, to the utmost of our power, at the risk of
-our lives and fortunes, with arms, oppose the
-hostile proceedings of the British fleets and armies
-against the United American Colonies.”</p>
-
-<p>Daniel was proud of his descent from such a
-man, and in the last year of his life declared that<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_18" id="Page_18">[Pg 18]</a></span>
-“this is sufficient emblazonry for my arms;
-enough of heraldry for me.”</p>
-
-<p>Ebenezer Webster, Daniel’s father, is described
-as “a man of great firmness, whose bearing and
-manner were decisive; tall and erect, with a full
-chest, black hair and eyes, and rather large and
-prominent features.” He had never attended
-school, but his natural powers, supplemented by
-his own persistent efforts for education, qualified
-him for a high and influential place in the community
-in which he lived. But in one thing he
-was lacking, the ability to make money, and
-was obliged to practise the utmost frugality in
-his household. Though he filled various important
-positions, his compensation was of the
-smallest. He charged the town for important
-services but three or four shillings a day—a sum
-which even the most modest of office-holders
-nowadays would regard as quite beneath their
-acceptance.</p>
-
-<p>How he succeeded in wresting a subsistence
-for his large family from his sterile acres must
-remain a mystery. He was willing to live poorly,
-but there was one subject which cost him anxious
-thought. How was he to provide his family,
-and especially the two youngest boys, with the
-educational advantages which had been denied to
-him? There were no good schools near home,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_19" id="Page_19">[Pg 19]</a></span>
-and without money he could not send his boys
-out of town to school.</p>
-
-<p>Help came in an unexpected way.</p>
-
-<p>One day the stalwart farmer entered his house
-with a look of satisfaction on his dark and rugged
-features.</p>
-
-<p>“Wife,” he said, “I have been appointed Judge
-of the Court of Common Pleas for the county.”</p>
-
-<p>“Indeed!” said his wife, naturally pleased at
-the honor which had been conferred upon her
-husband.</p>
-
-<p>“It will bring me three to four hundred dollars
-a year,” said Mr. Webster, “and now I can hope
-to educate my boys.”</p>
-
-<p>This was his first thought, and hers. It was
-not proposed to improve their style of living, to
-buy new furniture or new clothes, but to spend
-it in such a way as would best promote the interests
-of those whom God had committed to their
-keeping.</p>
-
-<p>Three or four hundred dollars! It was a very
-small sum, so most of my boy readers will think;
-and so it was, but in a farmer’s household on the
-bleak acres of New Hampshire it would go a
-considerable way. Every dollar in Ebenezer
-Webster’s hands brought its money’s worth, and
-as we shall see hereafter it brought rich interest
-to the investor.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_20" id="Page_20">[Pg 20]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>But Daniel was still too young for any immediate
-steps to be taken in the desired direction.
-He was sent to the small town schools, where he
-learned what the master was able to teach him.
-Sometimes he had two and a half and three miles
-to walk to school, but the farmer’s boy, though
-delicate, was not thought too delicate for such a
-walk. Indeed the boy’s delicacy was in his favor,
-for he was thought not robust enough to work
-on the farm steadily, and was sent to school, as
-an elder half-brother, Joseph, laughingly said,
-“to make him equal with the rest of the boys.”
-It was hard for those who saw him in later years,
-in his majestic proportions, to believe that he
-had been a delicate boy. The tender sapling had
-become a stately oak, with not a trace of feebleness
-or lack of strength.</p>
-
-<p>One day when Daniel was at work in the hayfield,
-about the middle of the forenoon, Judge
-Webster, for this was his designation now, saw a
-carriage approaching.</p>
-
-<p>“Some one to see you, father,” suggested
-Daniel.</p>
-
-<p>“Yes,” said his father, preparing to leave his
-work; “it is the Congressman from our district.”</p>
-
-<p>“What is his name?”</p>
-
-<p>“Hon. Abiel Foster, my son. He lives in
-Canterbury.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_21" id="Page_21">[Pg 21]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>But the Congressman descended from his carriage
-and entered the field where Daniel and his
-father were at work. “Don’t let me interrupt
-you, Judge Webster,” said the visitor. “I merely
-wished to exchange a few words on public
-affairs.”</p>
-
-<p>Daniel was old enough to have some notion of
-the office of a Congressman and his duties, and
-he regarded the honorable gentleman with attention,
-and perhaps with reverent respect, though
-he is said not to have been endowed with more
-than average ability, notwithstanding he had been
-educated at college, and had once been a minister.</p>
-
-<p>When the conversation was over the Congressman
-got into his carriage and rode away. Judge
-Webster looked thoughtfully after him.</p>
-
-<p>Then he said to Daniel, “My son, that is a
-worthy man; he is a Member of Congress; he
-goes to Philadelphia, and gets six dollars a day,
-while I toil here. It is because he had an education
-which I never had. If I had had his early
-education I should have been in Philadelphia in
-his place. I came near it as it was. But I
-missed it, and now I must work here.”</p>
-
-<p>“My dear father,” answered Daniel, not without
-emotion, “you shall not work. Brother and
-I will work for you, and will wear our hands out,
-and you shall rest.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_22" id="Page_22">[Pg 22]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>The boy was much moved, and his breast
-heaved, for he knew well how hard his father
-had toiled for him and for all the family.</p>
-
-<p>“My child,” said Judge Webster, “it is of no
-importance to me. I now live but for my children.
-I could not give your elder brothers the
-advantages of knowledge, but I can do something
-for you. Exert yourself, improve your opportunities,
-learn, learn, and when I am gone you
-will not need to go through the hardships which
-I have undergone, and which have made me an
-old man before my time.”</p>
-
-<p>These words made a profound impression upon
-the boy. A man’s character and life add weight
-to the words which he utters, and wise and judicious
-advice coming from a trifler or a shallow
-person falls often unheeded, and with reason.
-But Daniel knew how much his father had accomplished
-without education—he knew how
-high his rank was among his neighbors, and no
-man ever probably received from him a tithe of
-that reverence which he felt for his plain, unlettered
-parent.</p>
-
-<p>By this time he knew that his father had been
-largely instrumental in inducing New Hampshire
-to ratify that Constitution of which he obtained
-his first knowledge from the cheap cotton handkerchief
-which he had purchased at Master Hoyt’s<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_23" id="Page_23">[Pg 23]</a></span>
-store. The acceptance was by no means a foregone
-conclusion. Many of the delegates to the
-convention had been instructed to vote against
-acceptance, and among them Ebenezer Webster
-himself. But he obtained permission later to
-vote according to his own judgment, and the
-speech which he made in favor of this important
-action has been preserved. Just before the vote
-was taken, he rose and said:</p>
-
-<p>“Mr. President, I have listened to the arguments
-for and against the Constitution. I am
-convinced such a government as that Constitution
-will establish, if adopted—a government acting
-directly on the people of the States—is necessary
-for the common defence and the public welfare.
-It is the only government which will enable us
-to pay off the national debt—the debt which we
-owe for the Revolution, and which we are bound
-in honor fully and fairly to discharge. Besides,
-I have followed the lead of Washington through
-seven years of war, and I have never been misled.
-His name is subscribed to this Constitution.
-He will not mislead us now. I shall vote for its
-adoption.”</p>
-
-<p>No wonder that Daniel inherited from his
-father a reverent attachment for that Constitution
-which Judge Webster by word and deed
-had helped to secure and establish. His father<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_24" id="Page_24">[Pg 24]</a></span>
-was a grave and earnest man, but he was not
-stern nor ascetic. His strength was softened by
-good humor, and his massive features were often
-lighted up by a contagious laugh which endeared
-him to his family, who loved no less than they
-respected him.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_25" id="Page_25">[Pg 25]</a></span></p>
-
-
-
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-<h2><a name="CHAPTER_III" id="CHAPTER_III">CHAPTER III.</a><br />
-
-<small>A MEMORABLE BATTLE.</small></h2>
-
-
-<p>Daniel, as well as his father, had a love of
-fun, and a sportive humor, which he always preserved.
-It is said that “all work and no play
-makes Jack a dull boy.” It is certainly a mistake
-when a boy is shut out from the innocent
-sports which boys delight in. John Stuart Mill,
-who was set to learning while little more than an
-infant, and who actually began to study Greek at
-four years of age—lamented in after years that
-he had never known what boyhood was.</p>
-
-<p>It was not so with Daniel. Though his father’s
-poverty made it necessary for all to work,
-Daniel, partly because of his early delicacy, had
-plenty of time allowed him for amusement. The
-favorite companion of his leisure hours was not a
-boy, but a veteran soldier and near neighbor,
-named Robert Wise. He had built a little cottage
-in the corner of the Webster farm, and there
-with his wife he lived till extreme old age. He
-was born in Yorkshire, had fought on both sides
-in the Revolutionary struggle, had travelled in<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_26" id="Page_26">[Pg 26]</a></span>
-various parts of Europe, and had a thousand stories
-to tell, to all of which the boy listened with
-avidity. Though he had twice deserted from the
-English king, his heart still thrilled with pride
-when Daniel read to him from the newspaper
-accounts of battles in which the English arms
-were victorious. He had never learned to read,
-and Daniel became his favorite because he was
-always ready to read to him as they sat together
-at nightfall at the cottage door.</p>
-
-<p>“Why don’t you learn to read yourself, Robert?”
-asked Daniel one day.</p>
-
-<p>“It’s too late, Dan. I’m gettin’ an old man
-now, and I couldn’t do it.”</p>
-
-<p>“What will you do when I am grown up, and
-gone away?”</p>
-
-<p>“I don’t know, Dan. It will be dull times for
-me.”</p>
-
-<p>When that time came the old man picked up
-a fatherless boy, and gave him a home and a
-chance to secure an education, in order that he
-might have some one to read the newspaper to
-him.</p>
-
-<p>Whenever Daniel had a day or a few hours to
-himself he ran across the fields to his humble
-neighbor’s house.</p>
-
-<p>“Come, Robert,” he would say, “I’ve got
-nothing to do. Let us go fishing.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_27" id="Page_27">[Pg 27]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>So the two would go down to the banks of the
-Merrimac, and embark in a boat which belonged
-to the old man, and paddle up and down the
-river, sometimes for an entire day. Daniel never
-lost his love of fishing, but in after years, when
-the cares of statesmanship were upon him, dressed
-in suitable style he would take his fishing pole and
-lie in wait for his finny victims, while perhaps he
-was mentally composing some one of his famous
-speeches, destined to thrill the hearts of thousands,
-or direct the policy of the government.
-These happy days spent in the open air corrected
-his native delicacy, and gradually imparted physical
-strength and vigor, and in time knit the vigorous
-frame which seemed a fitting temple for his
-massive intellect.</p>
-
-<p>Even the most trivial circumstances in the boyhood
-of such a man as Daniel Webster are noteworthy,
-and I am sure my boy-readers will read
-with interest and sympathy the account of a signal
-victory which the boy gained, though it was
-only over a feathered bully.</p>
-
-<p>Belonging to a neighbor was a cock of redoubtable
-prowess, a champion whose fame was in all
-the farmyards for miles around. One day Daniel,
-coming home from school, beheld with mortification
-the finish of a contest in which a favorite
-fowl of his own came off decidedly second best.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_28" id="Page_28">[Pg 28]</a></span>
-The victorious rooster strutted about in conscious
-and complacent triumph.</p>
-
-<p>“It’s too bad, Zeke!” said Daniel in genuine
-vexation, as he saw the crestfallen look of his own
-vanquished fowl. “I should like to see that impudent
-bully get well whipped.”</p>
-
-<p>“There isn’t a rooster about here that can whip
-him, Dan.”</p>
-
-<p>“I know that, but he will meet his match some
-time.”</p>
-
-<p>“At any rate I’ll drive him away. He’ll have
-to run from me.”</p>
-
-<p>Dan picked up a stone, and pelted the victor
-out of the yard, but the feathered bully, even in
-his flight, raised a crow of victory which vexed
-the boy.</p>
-
-<p>“I’d give all the money I’ve got, Zeke, for a
-rooster that would whip him,” said Dan.</p>
-
-<p>There came a time when Daniel had his wish.</p>
-
-<p>He was visiting a relation at some distance
-when mention was made casually of a famous
-fighting cock who had never been beaten.</p>
-
-<p>“Where is he to be found?” asked the boy
-eagerly.</p>
-
-<p>“Why do you ask?”</p>
-
-<p>“I would like to see him,” said Dan.</p>
-
-<p>“Oh, well, he belongs to Mr.——.”</p>
-
-<p>“Where does he live?”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_29" id="Page_29">[Pg 29]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>The desired information was given.</p>
-
-<p>Shortly after Daniel was missed. He found
-his way to the farm where the pugnacious fowl
-resided. In the yard he saw the owner, a
-farmer.</p>
-
-<p>“Good morning, sir,” said Dan.</p>
-
-<p>“Good morning, boy. What can I do for
-you?” was the reply.</p>
-
-<p>“I hear you have a cock who is a famous
-fighter.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, he’s never been beaten yet!” said the
-farmer complacently.</p>
-
-<p>“Can I see him?”</p>
-
-<p>“There he is,” said the owner, pointing out the
-feathered champion.</p>
-
-<p>Daniel surveyed the rooster with great interest.</p>
-
-<p>“Will you sell him?” he asked.</p>
-
-<p>“I don’t know. Why do you want to buy
-him?”</p>
-
-<p>Daniel explained his object frankly.</p>
-
-<p>“How much are you willing to give?” asked
-the farmer, for he was a Yankee, and ready for
-a trade.</p>
-
-<p>Daniel drew from his pocket half a dollar. It
-represented his entire cash capital.</p>
-
-<p>“Here is half a dollar,” he said. “I’ll give
-you that.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_30" id="Page_30">[Pg 30]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>“Haven’t you got anymore money?” asked
-the farmer, who had a keen scent for a bargain.</p>
-
-<p>“No, sir; it is all I have. I’d give you more
-if I had it.”</p>
-
-<p>Half a dollar in those days was a considerable
-sum of money, particularly in the eyes of a farmer,
-who handled very little money, his income
-being for the most part in the shape of corn, hay
-and vegetables. Having satisfied himself that it
-was all he could get, he gave a favorable answer
-to the boy’s application.</p>
-
-<p>Daniel’s eyes sparkled with delight, and he
-promptly handed over his fifty cent piece.</p>
-
-<p>“When do you want to take it?” asked the
-farmer.</p>
-
-<p>“Now,” answered Dan.</p>
-
-<p>“Very well.”</p>
-
-<p>The fowl was caught, and Daniel carried it
-back to the house of his relative in triumph.</p>
-
-<p>“I’m going home,” he said abruptly.</p>
-
-<p>“Going home? Why, you have only just
-come.”</p>
-
-<p>“I’ll come again soon, but I want to take this
-cock home, and see if he can’t whip Mr. ——-’s.
-I want to teach the little bully a lesson.”</p>
-
-<p>So in spite of all that could be said Daniel
-started on his way home.</p>
-
-<p>When he had gone a short distance he passed<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_31" id="Page_31">[Pg 31]</a></span>
-a yard stocked with poultry, where a large cock
-was strutting about defiantly, as if throwing down
-the gage of battle to any new comers.</p>
-
-<p>A boy was standing near the fence.</p>
-
-<p>“Will your cock fight?” asked Dan.</p>
-
-<p>“He can whip yours,” was the reply.</p>
-
-<p>“Are you willing to try it?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, come along.”</p>
-
-<p>The trial was made, and Dan’s new purchase
-maintained his reputation, by giving a sound
-drubbing to his feathered rival.</p>
-
-<p>Dan surveyed the result with satisfaction.</p>
-
-<p>“I guess he’ll do,” he said to himself.</p>
-
-<p>He kept on his way till he got within sight of
-home.</p>
-
-<p>“What brings you home so soon, Dan?” asked
-Zeke.</p>
-
-<p>“See here, Zeke!” said Dan eagerly.” Here
-is a cock that will whip Mr. ——’s all to pieces.”</p>
-
-<p>“Don’t be too sure of it!”</p>
-
-<p>“I’ve tried him once, and he’s game.”</p>
-
-<p>The boys did not have long to wait for the
-trial.</p>
-
-<p>Over came the haughty intruder, strutting
-about with his usual boastful air.</p>
-
-<p>Dan let loose his new fowl, and a battle
-royal commenced. Soon the tyrant of the barnyard
-found that he had met a foe worthy of his<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_32" id="Page_32">[Pg 32]</a></span>
-spur. For a time the contest was an open one,
-but in ten minutes the feathered bully was ignominiously
-defeated, and led about by the comb in
-a manner as humiliating as had ever happened
-when he was himself the victor.</p>
-
-<p>Daniel witnessed the defeat of the whilom tyrant
-with unbounded delight, and felt abundantly
-repaid for his investment of all his spare cash, as
-well as the cutting short of his visit. Probably
-in the famous passage at arms which he had many
-years after with Mr. Hayne, of South Carolina,
-his victory afforded him less satisfaction than this
-boyish triumph.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_33" id="Page_33">[Pg 33]</a></span></p>
-
-
-
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-<h2><a name="CHAPTER_IV" id="CHAPTER_IV">CHAPTER IV.</a><br />
-
-<small>AN IMPORTANT STEP.</small></h2>
-
-
-<p>“What are you thinking about, Dan?” asked
-his mother one evening as the boy sat thoughtfully
-gazing at the logs blazing in the fireplace.</p>
-
-<p>“I was wishing for something to read,” answered
-the boy.</p>
-
-<p>Indeed that was his chief trouble in those early
-days. Libraries were scarce, and private collections
-equally scarce, especially in small country
-places. So the boy’s appetite for books was not
-likely to be satisfied.</p>
-
-<p>Daniel’s words attracted the attention of his
-father.</p>
-
-<p>“I have been speaking to some of our neighbors
-to-day,” he said, “about establishing a small
-circulating library which we could all use. I
-think we shall do something about it soon.”</p>
-
-<p>“I hope you will, father,” said Dan eagerly.</p>
-
-<p>“If we all contribute a little, we can make a
-beginning. Besides we can put in some books we
-have already.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_34" id="Page_34">[Pg 34]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>A week or two later Judge Webster announced
-that the library had been established, and it may
-be easily supposed that Daniel was one of the
-first to patronize it. It was a small and, many of
-my boy friends would think, an unattractive
-collection. But in the collection was the “Spectator,”
-in reading which Daniel unconsciously did
-something towards forming a desirable style of
-his own. He was fond of poetry, and at an early
-age could repeat many of the psalms and hymns
-of Dr. Watts.</p>
-
-<p>There was another poem which so impressed
-him that he learned to repeat the whole of it.
-This was Pope’s “Essay on Man,” a poem which
-I fear is going out of fashion, which is certainly
-a pity, for apart from its literary merits it contains
-a great deal of sensible advice as to the conduct
-of life. As it is not of so much importance
-how much we read as how thoroughly, and how
-much we remember, there is reason to think that
-Daniel got more benefit from his four books than
-most of the boys of to-day from their multitude
-of books.</p>
-
-<p>Once, however, Daniel’s literary enthusiasm
-came near having serious consequences. A new
-almanac had been received, and as usual each
-of the months was provided with a couplet of
-poetry. After going to bed Daniel and Ezekiel<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_35" id="Page_35">[Pg 35]</a></span>
-got into a dispute about the couplet at the head
-of the April page, and in order to ascertain which
-was correct Dan got out of bed, went down stairs,
-and groped his way to the kitchen, where he
-lighted a candle and went in search of the almanac.
-He found it, and on referring to it ascertained
-that Ezekiel was right. His eagerness
-made him careless, and an unlucky spark from
-the candle set some cotton clothes on fire. The
-house would have been consumed but for the
-exertions and presence of mind of his father. It
-may be a comfort to some of my careless young
-readers to learn that so great a man as Daniel
-Webster occasionally got into mischief when he
-was a boy.</p>
-
-<p>Somewhere about this time a young lawyer, Mr.
-Thomas W. Thompson, came to Daniel’s native
-town and set up an office.</p>
-
-<p>As he was obliged to be absent at times, and
-yet did not wish to close his office, he proposed
-to Daniel to sit in his office and receive callers in
-his absence. Though boys do not generally take
-kindly to confinement, the office contained one attraction
-for the boy in a collection of books, probably
-of a miscellaneous character such as a young
-man is likely to pick up.</p>
-
-<p>Daniel’s time was not otherwise occupied, for
-he had no service to render, except to stay in the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_36" id="Page_36">[Pg 36]</a></span>
-office and inform callers when Mr. Thompson
-would be back, and he was therefore at liberty to
-make use of the books. He made a selection unusual
-for a boy. There was an old Latin grammar,
-which the young lawyer had probably used
-himself in his preparatory course. This book
-Daniel selected, and began to study by himself.
-His employer offered to hear him recite in it,
-and soon had occasion to be surprised at the
-strong and retentive memory of his office boy.
-Probably none of the law books attracted the
-future lawyer. It would have been surprising if
-they had.</p>
-
-<p>“Judge Webster,” said Thompson, on meeting
-the father of his young employee, “Dan will make
-a fine scholar if he has the chance.”</p>
-
-<p>“I think the boy has ability.”</p>
-
-<p>“He certainly has. He ought to go to college.”</p>
-
-<p>Judge Webster shook his head.</p>
-
-<p>“I should like it above all things,” he said,
-“but I can’t see my way clear. I am a poor man,
-as you know, and it would cost a great deal of
-money to carry Dan through college even after
-he were prepared.”</p>
-
-<p>This was true, and the young lawyer was unprepared
-with any suggestion as to how the difficult
-matter was to be arranged. But Judge Webster<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_37" id="Page_37">[Pg 37]</a></span>
-did not forget the conversation. He was considering
-what could be done towards giving his
-promising son an education. He was willing to
-sacrifice his comfort, even, if thereby he could
-give him a good start in life.</p>
-
-<p>Finally he made up his mind to start him on
-the way, even if he were obliged to stop short
-before reaching the desired goal.</p>
-
-<p>Not far away was an institution which has since
-become famous, Exeter Academy, which has now
-for a century been doing an important work in
-preparing boys for our best colleges, and has always
-maintained a high standard of scholarship.
-Thither Judge Webster determined to take
-Daniel, and provide for his expenses by domestic
-self-denial. It was not till he had fully made up
-his mind that he announced his determination to
-the boy.</p>
-
-<p>“Dan,” he said one evening, “you must be up
-early to-morrow.”</p>
-
-<p>“Why, father?”</p>
-
-<p>Daniel supposed he was to be set at some farm
-work.</p>
-
-<p>“We are going to make a journey,” answered
-Judge Webster.</p>
-
-<p>“A journey!” repeated the boy in surprise.
-“Where are we going?”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_38" id="Page_38">[Pg 38]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>“I am going to take you to Exeter, to put you
-at school there.”</p>
-
-<p>The boy listened with breathless interest and
-delight, mingled perhaps with a little apprehension,
-for he did not know he would succeed in
-the untried scenes which awaited him.</p>
-
-<p>“Won’t it be expensive, father?” he asked
-after a pause, for he knew well his father’s circumstances,
-and was unusually considerate for a
-boy.</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, my son, but I look to you to improve
-your time, so that I may find my investment a
-wise one.”</p>
-
-<p>“How are we to go, father?”</p>
-
-<p>“On horseback.”</p>
-
-<p>Dan was a little puzzled, not knowing whether
-he and his father were to ride on one horse or
-not, as was a frequent custom at that time. It
-would have been hard upon any horse, for the
-judge was a man of weight, and the boy though
-light would have considerably increased the burden.</p>
-
-<p>The next morning Daniel’s curiosity was gratified.
-In front of the farmhouse stood two
-horses, one belonging to his father, the other
-filled out with a side-saddle.</p>
-
-<p>“Is that horse for me?” asked Daniel in surprise.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_39" id="Page_39">[Pg 39]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>“Yes, my son.”</p>
-
-<p>“What do I want of a side-saddle? I am not
-a lady.”</p>
-
-<p>“Neighbor —— is sending the horse to Exeter
-for the use of a lady who is to return here. I
-agreed to take charge of it, and it happens just
-right, as you can use it.”</p>
-
-<p>“I don’t know how I can get along with it. It
-will look strange for me to be riding on a lady’s
-saddle.”</p>
-
-<p>“If a lady can ride on it probably you can.”</p>
-
-<p>So Dan and his father set out on their journey
-from the quiet country town to Exeter, the boy
-mounted on a lady’s horse. When in his later life
-he had occasion to refer to this journey, Mr.
-Webster recalled with great merriment the figure
-he must have cut as he rode meekly behind his
-father.</p>
-
-<p>No doubt as they rode along father and son conversed
-together about the important step which had
-been taken. Judge Webster already had formed
-the plan of sending Daniel to college, after he
-should have completed a course of preparation
-at Exeter, but upon this part of his plan he did
-not think it best yet to speak to his son, very
-probably because he had not yet made up his
-mind as to whether his circumstances would allow
-him to incur so heavy an expense.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_40" id="Page_40">[Pg 40]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>“My son,” said the father gravely, “I hope
-you will improve to the utmost the advantages I
-am securing for you. You must remember how
-much depends upon yourself. A boy’s future is
-largely in his own hands.”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, father, I will do the best I can.”</p>
-
-<p>“Mr. Thompson thinks you can make a good
-scholar.”</p>
-
-<p>“I will try, father.”</p>
-
-<p>“I shall have no money to leave you, Daniel,
-but I hope to give you an education, which is
-better than a fortune.”</p>
-
-<p>How would the father have been gratified if
-he could have foreseen the brilliant future in store
-for the boy of fourteen who was about to take
-his first important step in life.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_41" id="Page_41">[Pg 41]</a></span></p>
-
-
-
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-<h2><a name="CHAPTER_V" id="CHAPTER_V">CHAPTER V.</a><br />
-
-<small>DANIEL AT EXETER ACADEMY.</small></h2>
-
-
-<p>The principal of Exeter Academy at that time
-was Benjamin Abbot, LL.D., a man of high
-repute in letters as well as in the educational
-field. He was a man of dignified presence, who
-exacted and received deference not only from his
-pupils but from all with whom he came in
-contact.</p>
-
-<p>“Dr. Abbot,” said Judge Webster, when the
-two were admitted to his presence, “I have
-brought my son Daniel to study in your institution,
-if you find him qualified.”</p>
-
-<p>The dignified principal turned towards the
-bashful boy, and said, “What is your age, sir?”</p>
-
-<p>“Fourteen,” answered Daniel.</p>
-
-<p>“I will examine you first in reading. Take
-this Bible, my lad, and read that chapter.”</p>
-
-<p>It was the twenty-second chapter of St. Luke’s
-Gospel, and was very well adapted as a test of
-the boy’s ability in reading.</p>
-
-<p>Now if there was anything Dan could do well<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_42" id="Page_42">[Pg 42]</a></span>
-it was this. He never could remember the time
-when he could not read. Probably he had
-learned from his mother, and his first text-book
-was the Bible. He was endowed with reverence,
-and his grave, sonorous voice was especially well
-fitted for sacred reading.</p>
-
-<p>The boy took the book and commenced the
-task prescribed. Usually a few verses are considered
-sufficient, but in this case the dignified
-listener became absorbed in the boy’s reading,
-and he listened, half forgetful of the object he
-had in view. It is a good deal to say that he
-actually enjoyed it. He had seldom listened to
-a voice at once so rich, deep and sonorous as belonged
-to this young boy of fourteen. Daniel,
-too, forgot that he was on trial, and read with his
-whole soul intent upon the words before him.</p>
-
-<p>When he had completed the chapter Dr. Abbot
-said, abruptly, “You are qualified to enter this
-institution.”</p>
-
-<p>This was all the examination which in his case
-was required.</p>
-
-<p>It was no common school that Daniel had
-entered, as is shown by the list of eminent men
-who have gone forth from it. George Bancroft,
-Edward Everett, Alexander H. Everett, Lewis
-Cass, Levi Woodbury, John E. Palfrey and
-others received here the first rudiments of their<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_43" id="Page_43">[Pg 43]</a></span>
-classical education, and all of them looked back
-with affection to their Alma Mater. But without
-derogating from the fame of any of these eminent
-men, it may surely be said that in Daniel Webster
-not only Exeter but Dartmouth College
-boasts its greatest alumnus.</p>
-
-<p>Daniel soon vindicated the good judgment of
-Dr. Abbot in admitting him as a pupil. As to
-the manner in which he improved the advantages
-which his father’s self-denial had secured to him,
-I quote the testimony of Dr. Tefft in his interesting
-life of Webster:</p>
-
-<p>“During the nine months of his stay at Exeter
-he accomplished as much for himself, according
-to every account, as most young gentlemen could
-have accomplished in two years. When he left
-he had as thoroughly mastered grammar, arithmetic,
-geography and rhetoric, as the majority
-of college graduates usually have done after a
-full collegiate course. He had also made rapid
-progress in the study of the Latin language.
-Dr. Abbot, fully appreciating the capacity of his
-most remarkable pupil, did not tie him down to
-the ordinary routine of study, nor compel him to
-lag behind with the other pupils, but gave him
-free scope and a loose rein, that he might do his
-utmost; and the venerable preceptor, after the
-lapse of more than half a century, during all<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_44" id="Page_44">[Pg 44]</a></span>
-which time he continued to be a teacher, declared
-on a public occasion that Daniel Webster’s equal
-in the power of amassing knowledge he had
-never seen, and never expected to see again.</p>
-
-<p>“It is not enough to say of him, according to
-Dr. Abbot’s description of him at this time, that
-he had a quick perception and a memory of great
-tenacity and strength. He did not seem barely
-to read and remember, as other people do. He
-appeared, rather, to grasp the thoughts and facts
-given by his author with a peculiar force, to incorporate
-them into his mental being, and thus
-make them a part of himself. It is said of Sir
-Isaac Newton, after reading for the first time
-the geometry of Euclid, and on being asked
-what he thought of it, that he knew it all before.
-He understood geometry, it seems, by intuition,
-or by a perception so rapid that it seems like intuition;
-but it was also true of the great astronomer
-that he had great difficulty in remembering
-even his own calculations after he had gone
-through with them. Daniel Webster, on the
-other hand, though endowed with a very extraordinary
-quickness of insight, worked harder for
-his knowledge than did Newton; but when once
-he had gained a point, or learned a fact, it remained
-with him, a part of his own essence, forever
-afterwards. His mind was also wonderfully<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_45" id="Page_45">[Pg 45]</a></span>
-fertile. A single truth, which, with most boys
-of his age, would have remained a single truth,
-in him became at once a starting-point for a remarkable
-series of ideas, original and striking,
-growing up out of the seed sown by that mighty
-power of reflection, in which no youth of his
-years, probably, was ever his superior.”</p>
-
-<p>At that time an assistant in the school was
-Joseph S. Buckminster, who later became an
-eminent preacher in Boston, and died while yet
-a young man. He was very young at the time,
-a mere boy, yet such were his attainments, and
-such was the confidence reposed in him by his
-old teachers, that he was selected to fill the position
-of tutor. He it was who first directed the
-studies of the new scholar, and encouraged the
-bashful boy to do his best. In after life Webster
-never displayed timidity or awkwardness;
-but, fresh from the farm, thrown among a hundred
-boys, most of whom were better dressed
-and more used to society than he, he felt at times
-awkward and distrustful. One thing he found
-it hard to do was to declaim. This is certainly
-singular, considering how he excelled in reading,
-and considering moreover what an orator he
-afterwards became.</p>
-
-<p>It was not because he did not try. He committed
-more than one piece to memory, and<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_46" id="Page_46">[Pg 46]</a></span>
-recited it to himself out loud in the solitude of his
-own room, but when the time came to get up
-and declaim it before the teacher and his schoolmates
-he was obliged to give it up. Here is his
-own account of it:</p>
-
-<p>“Many a piece did I commit to memory, and
-rehearse in my own room over and over again;
-but when the day came, when the school collected,
-when my name was called, and I saw all
-eyes turned upon my seat, I could not raise myself
-from it. Sometimes the masters frowned,
-sometimes they smiled. Mr. Buckminster always
-pressed and entreated with the most winning
-kindness that I would venture only <em>once</em>; but
-I could not command sufficient resolution, and
-when the occasion was over I went home and
-wept tears of bitter mortification.”</p>
-
-<p>This is certainly encouraging for bashful boys.
-Here was a man who became one of the greatest
-orators—perhaps <em>the</em> greatest—and yet as a boy
-he made an ignominious failure in the very department
-in which he afterwards excelled. It is
-a lesson for parents also. Don’t too hastily
-conclude that your boys are dunces, and destined
-to failure, because they develop late, or are
-hindered from making a creditable figure by
-timidity or nervous self-consciousness.</p>
-
-<p>In this connection I am tempted to repeat an<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_47" id="Page_47">[Pg 47]</a></span>
-anecdote of Sir Walter Scott. It was not till
-comparatively late that he discovered his poetical
-ability. It is related of him that when already
-a young man he was rowing with a friend on a
-Scotch lake, when they mutually challenged each
-other to produce a few lines of poetry. Both
-made the trial, and both failed. Thereupon
-Scott said good-humoredly to his companion,
-“It’s clear neither of us was cut out for a poet.”
-Yet within ten years appeared the first of those
-Border poems which thrilled the hearts of his
-countrymen, and have lent a charm to the hills
-and lakes of Scotland which they will never
-lose.</p>
-
-<p>Daniel remained nine months at Exeter.
-Though he did not win reputation as a declaimer,
-he made his mark as a scholar. When he was
-approaching the end of his first term the usher
-said one day, “Webster, you may stop a few
-minutes after school; I wish to speak to you.”</p>
-
-<p>Daniel stopped, wondering whether in any way
-he had incurred censure.</p>
-
-<p>When they were alone the usher said, “The
-term is nearly over. Are you coming back next
-term?”</p>
-
-<p>Daniel hesitated. He enjoyed the advantages
-which the school afforded, but his feelings had
-been hurt at times by the looks of amusement<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_48" id="Page_48">[Pg 48]</a></span>
-directed at his rustic manners and ill-fitting
-garments.</p>
-
-<p>The usher noticed his hesitation, and said,
-“You are doing yourself great credit. You are
-a better scholar than any in your class. If you
-come back next term I shall put you into a
-higher class.”</p>
-
-<p>These encouraging words made the boy resolve
-to return, and regardless of ridicule pursue with
-diligence the path which had been marked out
-for him.</p>
-
-<p>It would be rather interesting to read the
-thoughts of Daniel’s schoolmates when years
-afterwards they saw the boy whom they had
-ridiculed moving forward with rapid strides to
-the foremost place in the councils of state, as
-well as in the legal profession.</p>
-
-<p>I am tempted to insert here, on the authority of
-an Exeter correspondent of the Chicago <cite>Advance</cite>,
-an anecdote of Daniel at this period which will
-interest my young readers:</p>
-
-<p>“When Daniel Webster’s father found that
-his son was not robust enough to make a successful
-farmer, he sent him to Exeter to prepare for
-college, and found a home for him among a number
-of other students in the family of ‘old
-Squire Clifford,’ as we of a younger generation
-had always heard him called. Daniel had up<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_49" id="Page_49">[Pg 49]</a></span>
-to this time led only the secular life of a country
-farmer’s boy, and, though the New Hampshire
-farmers have sent out many heroes as firm and
-true as the granite rocks in the pasture, there
-cannot be among the hard and homely work
-which such a life implies the little finenesses of
-manner which good society demands. Daniel
-was one of these diamonds of the first water, but
-was still in the rough, and needed some cutting
-and polishing to fit him to shine in the great
-world in which he was to figure so conspicuously.</p>
-
-<p>“None saw this more clearly than the sensible
-old Squire. The boy had one habit at table of
-which the Squire saw it would be a kindness to
-cure him. When not using his knife and fork
-he was accustomed to hold them upright in his
-fists, on either side of his plate. Daniel was a
-bashful boy of very delicate feelings, and the
-Squire feared to wound him by speaking to him
-directly on the subject. So he called aside one
-of the other students with whom he had been
-longer acquainted, and told him his dilemma.
-‘Now,’ said he, ‘I want you this noon at the
-table to hold up your knife and fork as Daniel
-does. I will speak to you about it, and we will
-see if the boy does not take a hint for himself.’</p>
-
-<p>“The young man consented to be the scapegoat
-for his fellow-student, and several times<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_50" id="Page_50">[Pg 50]</a></span>
-during the meal planted his fists on the table,
-with his knife and fork as straight as if he had
-received orders to present arms. The Squire
-drew his attention to his position, courteously
-begged his pardon for speaking of the matter,
-and added a few kind words on the importance
-of young men correcting such little habits before
-going out into the world. The student thanked
-him for his interest and advice, and promised
-reform, and Daniel’s knife and fork were never
-from that day seen elevated at table.”</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_51" id="Page_51">[Pg 51]</a></span></p>
-
-
-
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-<h2><a name="CHAPTER_VI" id="CHAPTER_VI">CHAPTER VI.</a><br />
-
-<small>PREPARING FOR COLLEGE.</small></h2>
-
-
-<p>After nine months spent at Exeter Daniel
-was withdrawn by his father, not from any dissatisfaction
-with the school or with the pupil’s
-progress, but probably for economical reasons.
-Judge Webster was a poor man, and though the
-charges at Exeter at that time were very moderate
-they were a heavy draft upon the good
-father’s purse. But Dan was not taken back to
-farm-work. He was allowed to continue his
-classical studies, but under different auspices.</p>
-
-<p>In the town of Boscawan, only six miles off,
-the minister, Rev. Samuel Wood, was noted for
-his success in preparing boys for college. His
-charges, too, were wonderfully low. For board
-and instruction he only charged one dollar per
-week, which leads us to infer either that provisions
-were very cheap, or that boys had less appetite
-than is the case now. At any rate, the low
-price was a great inducement to Dan’s father.</p>
-
-<p>“Dan,” he said, soon after the boy came, “do
-you wish to continue your studies?”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_52" id="Page_52">[Pg 52]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>“Yes, father, if you are willing.”</p>
-
-<p>“I am not only willing but desirous that you
-should do so. I intend to place you with Rev.
-Mr. Wood, of Boscawen.”</p>
-
-<p>Daniel knew of Mr. Wood’s reputation as a
-teacher, and the prospect did not displease him.</p>
-
-<p>Still his father had not announced the plan he
-had in view for him.</p>
-
-<p>One cold winter day, when the snow lay deep
-on the ground, Judge Webster and Dan started
-for the house of his future teacher. As they
-were ascending a hill slowly through deep snows
-the Judge, who had for some time been silent,
-said, “Dan, I may as well tell you what plan I
-have in view for you. I shall ask Mr. Wood to
-prepare you for college, and I will let you enter
-at Dartmouth as soon as you are ready.”</p>
-
-<p>Daniel could not speak for emotion. He knew
-what a sacrifice it would involve for his father
-with his straitened means to carry through such
-a plan as that, and his heart was full. As he
-himself says, “A warm glow ran all over me,
-and I laid my head on my father’s shoulder and
-wept.”</p>
-
-<p>I am afraid that some boys—possibly some of
-my young readers—have received a similar announcement
-from their fathers with quite different
-feelings.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_53" id="Page_53">[Pg 53]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>We are to imagine Dan, then, an inmate of the
-minister’s family, pursuing his studies with success,
-but with less of formal restraint than when
-he was a pupil at Exeter. Indeed I shall not attempt
-to conceal the fact that occasionally Dan’s
-love of sport, and particularly of fishing, drew
-him away from his studies, and led him to incur
-the good doctor’s remonstrances.</p>
-
-<p>One day after a reprimand, which was tempered,
-however, by a compliment to his natural
-abilities, Daniel determined to surprise his
-teacher.</p>
-
-<p>The task assigned him to prepare was one hundred
-lines of Virgil, a long lesson, as many boys
-would think. Daniel did not go to bed, but
-spent all night in poring over his book.</p>
-
-<p>The next day, when the hour for recitation
-came, Dan recited his lesson with fluency and
-correctness.</p>
-
-<p>“Very well,” said Dr. Wood, preparing to
-close the book.</p>
-
-<p>“But, doctor, I have a few more lines that I
-can recite.”</p>
-
-<p>“Very well,” said Mr. Wood, supposing that
-Dan might have read twenty-five or thirty lines
-more. But the boy kept on till he had completed
-a second hundred.</p>
-
-<p>“Really, Dan, I compliment you on your in<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_54" id="Page_54">[Pg 54]</a></span>dustry,”
-said his teacher, again about to close the
-book.</p>
-
-<p>“But,” said Dan, “I have studied further.”
-“Very remarkable,” said the minister in surprise;
-“well, let us have them.”</p>
-
-<p>Dan rolled off another hundred lines, which he
-appeared to know quite as well as the previous
-two hundred.</p>
-
-<p>“You are a smart boy!” said the doctor approvingly,
-and not without a feeling of relief, for
-it is rather tedious to listen critically to the translation
-of three hundred lines.</p>
-
-<p>“But,” said Dan, “I am not through yet.”</p>
-
-<p>“Pray how much have you read?” asked Dr.
-Wood in amazement.</p>
-
-<p>“I can recite five hundred more if you like,”
-said Dan, his eyes twinkling with enjoyment at
-the doctor’s surprise.</p>
-
-<p>“I think that will do for to-day,” said Dr.
-Wood. “I don’t think I shall have time to hear
-them now. You may have the rest of the day
-for pigeon shooting.”</p>
-
-<p>Indeed Dan was always fond of sport, and not
-particularly fond of farm-work. My boy reader
-may like to read an anecdote of this time, which
-I will give in the very words in which Daniel
-told it to some friends at a later day.</p>
-
-<p>While at Dr. Wood’s, “my father sent for me<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_55" id="Page_55">[Pg 55]</a></span>
-in haying time to help him, and put me into a
-field to turn hay, and left me. It was pretty
-lonely there, and, after working some time, I
-found it very dull; and, as I knew my father was
-gone away, I walked home, and asked my sister
-Sally if she did not want to go and pick some
-whortleberries. She said yes. So I went and
-got some horses, and put a side-saddle on one, and
-we set off. We did not get home till it was
-pretty late, and I soon went to bed. When my
-father came home he asked my mother where I
-was, and what I had been about. She told him.
-The next morning when I awoke I saw all the
-clothes I had brought from Dr. Wood’s tied up
-in a small bundle again. When I saw my father
-he asked me how I liked haying. I told him I
-found it ‘pretty dull and lonesome yesterday.’
-’Well,’ said he, ‘I believe you may as well go
-back to Dr. Wood’s.’ So I took my bundle under
-my arm, and on my way I met Thomas W.
-Thompson, a lawyer in Salisbury; he laughed
-very heartily when he saw me. ‘So,’ said he,
-’your farming is over, is it?’”</p>
-
-<p>It will occur to my readers that, as Judge
-Webster was struggling so earnestly to give Dan
-an education, it would have been more considerate
-for the boy to have remained at his task, and so
-saved his father the trouble of finishing it. How<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_56" id="Page_56">[Pg 56]</a></span>ever,
-it is not my intention to present the boy as
-in all respects a model, though it is certain that
-he appreciated and was thoroughly grateful for
-his father’s self-sacrificing devotion.</p>
-
-<p>On one occasion Dan was set to mowing. He
-did not succeed very well.</p>
-
-<p>“What is the matter, Dan?” asked his father.</p>
-
-<p>“My scythe does not <em>hang</em> well,” answered
-Dan, an answer which will be understood by
-country boys.</p>
-
-<p>His father took the scythe and tried to remedy
-the difficulty, but when it was handed back to
-Dan, it worked no better.</p>
-
-<p>“I think you had better hang it to suit yourself,
-Dan,” said his father.</p>
-
-<p>With a laughing face Dan hung it on the
-branch of a tree, and turning to his father said,
-“There, that is just right.”</p>
-
-<p>On another occasion Judge Webster, on returning
-home, questioned the boys as to what
-they had been doing in his absence.</p>
-
-<p>“What have you been doing, Ezekiel?” asked
-his father.</p>
-
-<p>“Nothing, sir,” was the frank reply.</p>
-
-<p>“And you, Daniel, what have you been doing?”</p>
-
-<p>“<em>Helping Zeke, sir.</em>”</p>
-
-<p>There is no doubt that Judge Webster was<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_57" id="Page_57">[Pg 57]</a></span>
-more indulgent than was usual in that day to
-his children, and more particularly to Daniel, of
-whose talents he was proud, and of whose future
-distinction he may have had in his mind some
-faint foreshadowing. This indulgence was increased
-by Dan’s early delicacy of constitution.
-At any rate, Daniel had in his father his best
-friend, not only kind but judicious, and perhaps
-the eminence he afterwards attained was due in
-part to the judicious management of the father,
-who earnestly sought to give him a good start in
-life.</p>
-
-<p>While at Boscawan Dan found another circulating
-library, and was able to enlarge his reading
-and culture. Among the books which it contained
-was an English translation of Don Quixote,
-and this seems to have had a powerful
-fascination for the boy. “I began to read it,” he
-says in his autobiography, “and it is literally true
-that I never closed my eyes until I had finished
-it, nor did I lay it down, so great was the power
-of this extraordinary book on my imagination.”</p>
-
-<p>Meanwhile Daniel was making rapid progress
-in his classical studies. He studied fitfully perhaps,
-but nevertheless rapidly. In the summer
-of 1797, at the age of fifteen, he was pronounced
-ready to enter college. His acquisitions were by
-no means extensive, for in those days colleges<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_58" id="Page_58">[Pg 58]</a></span>
-were content with a scantier supply of preparatory
-knowledge than now. In the ancient languages
-he had read the first six books of Virgil’s
-Æneid, Cicero’s four Orations against Catiline, a
-little Greek grammar, and the four Evangelists
-of the Greek Testament. In mathematics he had
-some knowledge of arithmetic, but knew nothing
-of algebra or geometry. He had read a considerable
-number of books, however, enough to give
-him a literary taste, but he was by no means a
-prodigy of learning. Yet, slender as were his
-acquirements, his school life was at an end, and
-the doors of Dartmouth College opened to receive
-its most distinguished son.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_59" id="Page_59">[Pg 59]</a></span></p>
-
-
-
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-<h2><a name="CHAPTER_VII" id="CHAPTER_VII">CHAPTER VII.</a><br />
-
-<small>DANIEL’S COLLEGE LIFE.</small></h2>
-
-
-<p>It is all important point in a boy’s life when
-he enters college. He leaves home, in most cases,
-and, to a greater extent than ever before, he is
-trusted to order his own life and rely upon
-his own judgment. It is a trying ordeal, and
-many fail to pass through it creditably. A student
-who has plenty of money is in greater danger
-of wasting his time from the enlarged opportunities
-of enjoyment which money can buy.
-From this danger, at least, Daniel was free. His
-father found it hard enough to pay his ordinary
-expenses, and it is hardly likely that the boy
-ever had much spare money to spend on pleasure.</p>
-
-<p>Besides, though only fifteen, Daniel already
-possessed a gravity and earnestness not often to
-be found in much older students. These, however,
-were blended with a humor and love of
-fun which contributed to make him an agreeable
-companion for his fellow-students.</p>
-
-<p>Daniel’s development was not rapid. The oak
-tree grows steadily, but in rapidity of growth it<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_60" id="Page_60">[Pg 60]</a></span>
-is eclipsed by many trees of less importance.
-The great powers which our hero exhibited in
-after life did not at once make themselves manifest.
-He did not at once take his place proudly
-at the head of his class. This is shown by the
-fact that at the Sophomore exhibition neither of
-the two principal appointments was assigned to
-him. Notwithstanding this, it may safely be asserted
-that his time was well spent. In this connection
-I am sure my young readers will be interested
-in reading the testimony of Professor
-Shortliff.</p>
-
-<p>“Mr. Webster, while in college,” writes the
-professor, “was remarkable for his steady habits,
-his intense application to study, and his punctual
-attendance upon all the prescribed exercises. I
-know not that he was absent from a recitation,
-or from morning and evening prayers in the
-chapel, or from public worship on the Sabbath;
-and I doubt if ever a smile was seen upon his
-face during any religious exercise. He was always
-in his place, and with a decorum suited to
-it. He had no collision with any one, nor appeared
-to enter into the concerns of others, but
-emphatically minded his own business. But, as
-steady as the sun, he pursued with intense application
-the great object for which he came to
-college.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_61" id="Page_61">[Pg 61]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>This is certainly high praise, and I am afraid
-such words could hardly be said with truth of the
-majority of the college students of to-day. Conscientious
-devotion to duty is often set down by
-college students as indicating a lack of proper
-spirit, and the punctilious scholar is often stigmatized
-as a toady, who is trying to curry favor
-with the Faculty. Daniel, however, understood
-very well how important to his future success
-was his improvement of the advantages which
-his father’s self-sacrifice had purchased for him.
-Judge Webster was obliged to mortgage his
-house and farm to meet the expenses incurred
-by Daniel’s education, and he would indeed have
-been most reprehensible if he had not constantly
-borne this in mind.</p>
-
-<p>To go into details, Daniel’s favorite studies
-were the Latin and Greek classics. He was but
-slenderly versed in these languages when he entered
-college, and the college course was not as advanced
-as it is at Dartmouth to-day. The first
-year, and part of the second, was devoted to
-authors and studies which now receive attention
-before entrance. For instance, the Freshman
-class went on with the Seventh Book of the Æneid
-and with the remainder of the Greek Testament,
-arithmetic was continued, and algebra was begun.
-While he was not below the average in mathe<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_62" id="Page_62">[Pg 62]</a></span>matics,
-Daniel certainly did not excel in that
-department. It is related of Charles Sumner that
-he made strenuous efforts to become a good mathematical
-scholar in spite of, perhaps because of,
-his conscious distaste for that important branch,
-but without marked success. General reading
-and composition always attracted him, and he
-was probably one of the best read students at the
-time in college. He devoted his leisure hours to
-extensive readings in poetry, history and criticism.
-His powerful and retentive memory made
-this voluntary course of especial value, and years
-later there were times when he was able to make
-happy and striking quotations from authors he
-had not read since his college life.</p>
-
-<p>It is quite certain that Daniel at this time had
-no path marked out for his future life, yet he
-probably could not have made a more profitable
-preparation for that which actually lay before
-him than that which he was unconsciously making.
-The history of England and of his own country
-especially interested him, not alone the history
-of outward events, but the constitutional history.
-From the age of eight he had been familiar with
-the Constitution of the United States, read for
-the first time as printed on the cheap cotton
-handkerchief, of which mention has already been
-made. He never ceased to study it, and he well<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_63" id="Page_63">[Pg 63]</a></span>
-deserved the title sometimes given him of Expounder
-and Defender of the Constitution.</p>
-
-<p>At that time, as at present, it was the custom
-for the students to form societies, in which debates
-and other literary exercises were the principal
-features of the periodical meetings. Towards
-the middle of his college course Daniel
-joined “The United Fraternity,” then the leading
-society in college. He had long since overcome
-the diffidence which at Exeter prevented him
-from participating in the exercise of declamation.
-In the society he became distinguished both as a
-writer and debater, and ere long ranked in the
-general estimation as the best writer and speaker
-in college. So far as he exhibited precocity in
-anything he showed it in these two branches.
-His method of preparation, for he always prepared
-himself when he proposed to speak, is described
-by a classmate as follows: “He was
-accustomed to arrange his thoughts in his mind
-in his room or his private walks, and to put them
-upon paper just before the exercise would be
-called for. When he was required to speak at
-two o’clock, he would frequently begin to write
-after dinner, and when the bell rang he would
-fold his paper, put it in his pocket and go in,
-and speak with great ease. In his movements
-he was rather slow and deliberate, except when<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_64" id="Page_64">[Pg 64]</a></span>
-his feelings were aroused; then his whole soul
-would kindle into a flame.”</p>
-
-<p>As this was the formative period when young
-Webster’s intellectual character was taking shape;
-as, moreover, he was still a boy in years, no older
-than many who will read this book, I add another
-tribute to his industry in college and the ability
-which he displayed. It is from a letter written
-by Hon. Henry Hubbard to Prof. Sanborn.</p>
-
-<p>“I entered the Freshman class in 1799,” writes
-Mr. Hubbard, “at the early age of fourteen. I
-was two years in college with Mr. Webster.
-When I first went to Hanover I found his reputation
-already established as the most remarkable
-young man in the college. He was, I believe, so
-decidedly beyond any one else that no other student
-of his class was ever spoken of as <em>second</em> to
-him. I was led, very soon, to appreciate most
-highly his scholarship and attainments. As a
-student his acquisitions seemed to me to be very
-extensive. Every subject appeared to contribute
-something to his intellectual stores. He acquired
-knowledge with remarkable facility. He
-seemed to grasp the meaning and substance of
-a book almost by intuition. Others toiled long
-and patiently for that which he acquired at a
-glance.</p>
-
-<p>“As a scholar, I should say that he was then<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_65" id="Page_65">[Pg 65]</a></span>
-distinguished for the uncommon extent of his
-knowledge, and for the ease with which he acquired
-it. But I should say that I was more impressed
-by his eloquence and power as a speaker,
-before the society of which we were both members,
-than by his other qualifications, however
-superior to others. There was a completeness
-and fullness in his views, and a force and expressiveness
-in his manner of presenting them, which
-no other student possessed. We used to listen
-to him with the deepest interest and respect, and
-no one thought of equaling the vigor and glow
-of his eloquence. The oration which he delivered
-before the United Fraternity on the day of
-his graduation is, I think, now among the records
-of that society. Whoever will read it at this
-late day, and bring to mind the appearance of the
-author, his manner and power, during its delivery,
-cannot fail to admit that I have said no more
-of his eloquence than I was warranted in saying.
-The students, and those who knew him best and
-judged him most impartially, felt that no one
-connected with the college deserved to be compared
-with him at the time he received his first
-degree. His habits and moral character were
-entirely unimpeachable. I never heard them
-questioned during our college acquaintance.”</p>
-
-<p>After this testimony I am certainly justified in<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_66" id="Page_66">[Pg 66]</a></span>
-holding up Daniel Webster, during his college
-life, as a fit model for all young men who at this
-day are placed in similar circumstances and pursuing
-a similar course.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_67" id="Page_67">[Pg 67]</a></span></p>
-
-
-
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-<h2><a name="CHAPTER_VIII" id="CHAPTER_VIII">CHAPTER VIII.</a><br />
-
-<small>DANIEL RECEIVES SOME VALUABLE ADVICE</small></h2>
-
-
-<p>Peter Harvey, in his interesting volume of
-“Reminiscences of Daniel Webster,” relates
-many incidents for which he was indebted to the
-free and friendly communications of Mr. Webster
-himself. One of these I will transfer to my
-pages, as it will be likely to amuse my young
-readers. I can do no better than quote it without
-alteration from Mr. Harvey’s book.</p>
-
-<p>“Mr. Webster was once telling me about a
-plain-spoken neighbor of his father, whose sons
-were schoolmates of his own. The neighbor had
-moved into the neighborhood of Hanover, where
-he had opened a little clearing, and had settled
-upon a piece of comparatively barren land. After
-Daniel had been in college several months his
-father said to him,</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_68" id="Page_68">[Pg 68]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>“‘John Hanson is away up there somewhere.
-I should like to know how he is getting along. I
-think you had better find him out, and go and
-see him.’</p>
-
-<p>“So Daniel inquired about, and soon found
-out pretty nearly where Hanson lived.</p>
-
-<p>“‘One Saturday afternoon,’ related Mr. Webster,
-’I thought I would trudge up there through
-the woods, and spend Sunday with my old friends.
-After a long, tedious walk I began to think I
-should never find the place; but I finally did,
-and when I got there I was pretty well tired out
-with climbing, jumping over logs, and so on.
-The family were not less delighted than surprised
-to see me, but they were as poor as Job’s cat.
-They were reduced to the last extreme of
-poverty, and their house contained but one apartment,
-with a rude partition to make two rooms.</p>
-
-<p>“’I saw how matters were; but it was too late
-to go back, and they seemed really glad to see
-me. They confessed to me that they had not
-even a cow, or any potatoes. The only thing
-they had to eat was a bundle of green grass and
-a little hog’s lard, and they actually subsisted on
-this grass fried in the hog’s fat. But it was not
-so bad after all. They fried up a great platter of
-it, and I made my supper and breakfast off it.
-About a year and a half afterwards, just before
-graduating, I thought that, before leaving Hanover,
-I would go and pay another visit to the
-Hansons. I found that they had improved somewhat,
-for they now had a cow and plenty of plain,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_69" id="Page_69">[Pg 69]</a></span>
-homely fare. I spent the night there, and was
-about to leave the next morning, when Hanson
-said to me,</p>
-
-<p>“’“Well, Daniel, you are about to graduate.
-You’ve got through college, and have got college
-larnin’, and now, what are you going to do with
-it?”</p>
-
-<p>“’I told him I had not decided on a profession.</p>
-
-<p>“’“Well,” said he, “you are a good boy; your
-father was a kind man to me, and was always
-kind to the poor. I should like to do a kind turn
-to him and his. You’ve got through college,
-and people that go through college either become
-ministers, or doctors, or lawyers. As for bein’ a
-minister I would never think of doin’ that; they
-never get paid anything. Doctorin’ is a miserable
-profession; they live upon other people’s
-ailin’s, are up nights, and have no peace. And
-as for bein’ a lawyer, I would never propose that
-to anybody. Now,” said he, “Daniel, I’ll tell you
-what! You are a boy of parts; you understand
-this book-larnin’, and you are bright. I knew a
-man who had college larnin’ down in Rye, where
-I lived when I was a boy. That man was a conjurer;
-he could tell by consultin’ his books and
-study if a man had lost his cow where she was.
-That was a great thing, and if people lost any<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_70" id="Page_70">[Pg 70]</a></span>thing,
-they would think nothin’ of payin’ three
-or four dollars to a man like that, so as to find
-their property. There is not a conjurer within a
-hundred miles of this place; and you are a
-bright boy, and have got this college larnin’. The
-best thing you can do, Daniel, is to study that,
-and <em>be a conjurer</em>!”’”</p>
-
-<p>We can imagine the serious, earnest tone in
-which this advice was given, and we may easily
-suppose that Daniel found it hard not to laugh
-when the climax was reached. We can hardly
-imagine the advice to have been taken. If, in
-place of Daniel Webster, the great lawyer, and
-the defender of the Constitution, we had Daniel
-Webster, the famous conjurer, it would be a
-ludicrous transformation. There are few persons
-who do not consider themselves qualified to give
-advice, but when my young readers are advised
-about the serious business of life, let them consider
-whether the advice comes from one who is
-qualified by wisdom and good judgment to give
-it.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_71" id="Page_71">[Pg 71]</a></span></p>
-
-
-
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-<h2><a name="CHAPTER_IX" id="CHAPTER_IX">CHAPTER IX.</a><br />
-
-<small>BROTHERLY LOVE.</small></h2>
-
-
-<p>Daniel’s path seemed to lie plain before him.
-He was a college student, receiving and using
-such advantages as Dartmouth could give him.
-At nineteen he would be a graduate, and well
-qualified to commence a professional course. So
-far as he was concerned Daniel felt that he had
-reason to congratulate himself. But there was
-another for whom he began to feel solicitude.</p>
-
-<p>Ezekiel Webster was nearly two years older
-than Daniel, and like him possessed uncommon
-natural gifts. A strong affection had united the
-two brothers from their earliest years. There
-was no reason, apart from Judge Webster’s
-poverty, why Ezekiel, as well as his younger
-brother, should not be allowed a college education.
-But the father hesitated long before he
-ventured to offer Daniel the education which he
-longed to give him, and to raise the necessary
-money was obliged to mortgage his humble<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_72" id="Page_72">[Pg 72]</a></span>
-house. His plan for Ezekiel was that he should
-remain at home and carry on the farm. As he
-grew older, and hard work had made him in his
-own words “old before his time,” he felt that it
-would be a relief to have a son like Ezekiel to
-take the burden from his shoulders, and keep up
-the farm. But Ezekiel scarcely more than Daniel
-had a vocation for farming. He too had a thirst
-for learning, and felt that a farmer’s life would
-be uncongenial. It is natural that he should
-have felt dissatisfied with his prospects, and that
-the claims of Duty which he recognized should
-nevertheless have seemed to him difficult to
-obey.</p>
-
-<p>Such was the state of feeling when Daniel
-came home on a vacation. To him Ezekiel revealed
-his thoughts and inward struggles.</p>
-
-<p>“I ought to stay, Daniel,” he said; “now that
-you are away father needs me more than ever,
-but I can’t bear the idea of growing up in ignorance,
-with no work more elevating than working
-on the farm.”</p>
-
-<p>Daniel was touched. He could see how unequal
-their lots were likely to be. While he
-might be a successful lawyer, his favorite brother,
-whose talents he considered to equal his own,
-would have to toil on the barren acres of their
-paternal farm.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_73" id="Page_73">[Pg 73]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>“I can’t bear the idea, either, Zeke,” he answered.
-“You are sacrificing yourself to me.
-Father has mortgaged the farm to pay my expenses,
-and you are working to pay it.”</p>
-
-<p>“If but one of us can have an education, Dan,
-I am glad that you are that one.”</p>
-
-<p>“But, Zeke, you are as smart as I, nay, smarter,
-and ought to have the same advantages.”</p>
-
-<p>“It cannot be, Daniel. I know that well
-enough. If I could be spared to leave home I
-should like to go out West. In a new part of
-the country I should have a better chance of
-getting on than here. Here on our barren little
-farm there is no chance to do better than get a
-bare living.”</p>
-
-<p>“I wish you could go to college too. Isn’t
-there some way of managing it?”</p>
-
-<p>“I have thought of it many times, but I see
-no way,” answered Ezekiel despondently.</p>
-
-<p>“May I mention the subject to father, Zeke?”</p>
-
-<p>“It would only trouble him, and after all it
-would do no good.”</p>
-
-<p>All night long the two brothers talked the
-matter over, and finally Zeke gave his consent to
-Dan’s broaching the subject to their father. The
-result I will give in Daniel’s words.</p>
-
-<p>“I ventured on the negotiation, and it was carried,
-as other things often are, by the earnest and<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_74" id="Page_74">[Pg 74]</a></span>
-sanguine manner of youth. I told him [Judge
-Webster] that I was unhappy at my brother’s
-prospects. For myself I saw my way to knowledge,
-respectability and self-protection; but as
-to him, all looked the other way; that I would
-keep school, and get along as well as I could, be
-more than four years in getting through college,
-if necessary, provided he also could be sent to
-study. He said at once he lived but for his children;
-that he had but little, and on that little he
-put no value, except so far as it might be useful
-to them; that to carry us both through college
-would take all he was worth; that, for himself,
-he was willing to run the risk, but that this was
-a serious matter to our mother and two unmarried
-sisters; that we must settle the matter with them,
-and if their consent was obtained, he would trust
-to Providence, and get along as well as he
-could.”</p>
-
-<p>So the matter was referred to Mrs. Webster,
-and she showed a devotion equal to that exhibited
-by her husband. Though she knew that the education
-of both of her boys would take the balance
-of their little property, she never hesitated. “I
-will trust the boys,” she answered promptly.</p>
-
-<p>Her confidence was not misplaced. She lived
-long enough to rejoice in the success of both sons,
-and to find a happy and comfortable home with<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_75" id="Page_75">[Pg 75]</a></span>
-Ezekiel. Nothing in the life of Daniel Webster
-is more beautiful than the devotion of the parents
-to their children, and the mutual affection which
-existed between them.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_76" id="Page_76">[Pg 76]</a></span></p>
-
-
-
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-<h2><a name="CHAPTER_X" id="CHAPTER_X">CHAPTER X.</a><br />
-
-<small>THE TWO BROTHERS.</small></h2>
-
-
-<p>Ezekiel was worthy of the sacrifices his parents
-made for him. If he was not the equal of
-Daniel in ability, he was still remarkable, and in
-time reached high rank as a lawyer in his native
-State. He was a man grown, and nearly a man
-in years, when his new plan of life was formed.
-He was close upon twenty years of age, a young
-man of striking appearance, “an improved edition
-of his father in form and features,” but thus far
-he had had only such educational advantages as
-were afforded by the common schools of his native
-town. But a small academy had been established
-in Salisbury, and of this he enrolled himself
-as a pupil. He remained here for two years,
-beginning the Latin grammar, for it was necessary,
-notwithstanding his age, to begin at the
-lowest round of the ladder.</p>
-
-<p>From the academy he went to reside with Dr.
-Wood, and under him completed his preparatory
-studies. The good minister was justly proud of<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_77" id="Page_77">[Pg 77]</a></span>
-having trained two such pupils as Daniel and
-Ezekiel Webster.</p>
-
-<p>Between the two brothers the natural relations
-of older and younger seemed to be reversed.
-Ezekiel looked up to Daniel, though the latter
-was two years his junior, and asked his advice,
-but Daniel never assumed the superiority which
-his elder brother was so ready to concede. Here
-is an extract from one of his letters: “You tell
-me that you have difficulties to encounter which
-I know nothing of. What do you mean, Ezekiel?
-Do you mean to flatter? That don’t become
-you; or, do you think you are inferior to me in
-natural advantages? If so, be assured you greatly
-mistake. Therefore, for the future say in your
-letters to me, ‘I am superior to you in natural
-endowments; I will know more in one year than
-you do now, and more in six than you ever will.’
-I should not resent this language. I should be
-very well pleased in hearing it; but be assured,
-as mighty as you are your great puissance shall
-never insure you a victory without a contest.”</p>
-
-<p>It will be seen how warm and free from jealousy
-were the relations between these two brothers.
-The spectacle is particularly pleasing because
-in so many families we find the case so
-different. Alienation, jealousy and strife are
-too often found. When brothers band together,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_78" id="Page_78">[Pg 78]</a></span>
-cherishing a community of plans and interests, as
-in the case of the well-known publishers, the
-Harper brothers, their chance of a large and enduring
-success is much greater than it would be
-if all pulled in different directions.</p>
-
-<p>Ezekiel entered college just as Daniel, his
-younger brother, was leaving it. As he was destined
-to be associated with Daniel afterwards,
-my young readers may like to know how he succeeded
-in college. I quote, from the private correspondence
-of Daniel Webster, a letter written
-by Rev. George T. Chapman touching this
-point:</p>
-
-<p>“All my recollections of Ezekiel Webster are
-of a gratifying character. In the Senior year we
-occupied rooms opposite to each other, in a building
-directly north of the college. I am therefore
-able to state, from intimate personal acquaintance,
-that he was altogether exemplary in his habits
-and faithful in his studies. He had no enemies,
-and all were happy to be numbered in the list of
-his friends.</p>
-
-<p>“Owing to his absence in teaching school, no
-part was assigned him at Commencement. But
-I have no doubt he stood high in the estimation
-of the college Faculty; and although I should
-hesitate to pronounce him the first scholar in his
-class, it would be doing injustice to his memory<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_79" id="Page_79">[Pg 79]</a></span>
-to say that he was excelled by either of those
-who received the highest college honors on the
-day of our graduation. It has been recently
-stated that he was particularly distinguished for
-his knowledge of Greek; but I cannot now recall
-the circumstance to mind, nor, in fact, make any
-discrimination as to relative proficiency in the several
-branches of study. He was deficient in none.
-He was good in all. Such at least is my recollection
-of the reputation he enjoyed. After leaving
-college, from all that I have heard, he obtained a
-greater degree of eminence in the eye of the public
-than any of his classmates; and when I revert
-to college days, after the lapse of almost half a
-century, all my recollections of what he then was
-cause me to feel no surprise at the subsequent
-elevation which he attained.”</p>
-
-<p>I think I am justified in saying that Ezekiel
-was worthy of his relationship to Daniel, though
-he was overshadowed by the more brilliant talents
-and success of his younger brother. It is to be
-considered, however, that he was cut off in the
-midst of his career, before he had attained the
-age of fifty, and we cannot tell what might have
-been had he lived twenty years longer.</p>
-
-<p>But we must not forget that it is the life and
-the gradual development of Daniel’s powers that
-we are studying. My young readers will proba<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_80" id="Page_80">[Pg 80]</a></span>bly
-be surprised to learn that in college he was
-known as a poet, and appears to have written
-verse on many occasions with considerable facility.
-That he would ever have achieved eminence
-in this class of composition no one will claim, but
-as the productions of such a youth his verses
-merit notice. That my readers may judge for
-themselves, I will quote entire a letter in rhyme
-written by Daniel a little before he attained the
-age of seventeen. It was addressed to his friend,
-George Herbert:</p>
-
-<div class="poetry-container"><div class="poetry"><div class="stanza">
-<div class="verse">“<span class="smcap">Dartmouth College</span>, Dec. 20, 1798.</div>
-</div><div class="stanza">
-<div class="verse">“Dear George, I go. I leave the friend I love.</div>
-<div class="verse">Long since ’twas written in the books above.</div>
-<div class="verse">But what, good God! I leave thee, do I say?</div>
-<div class="verse">The thought distracts my soul, and fills me with dismay.</div>
-<div class="verse">But Heaven decreed it, let me not repine;</div>
-<div class="verse">I go; but, George, my heart is knit with thine.</div>
-<div class="verse">In vain old Time shall all his forces prove</div>
-<div class="verse">To tear my heart from the dear friend I love;</div>
-<div class="verse">Should you be distant far as Afric’s sand,</div>
-<div class="verse">By Fancy pictured, you’d be near at hand.</div>
-<div class="verse">This shall console my thoughts till time shall end:</div>
-<div class="verse">Though George be absent, George is still my friend.</div>
-<div class="verse">But other friends I leave; it wounds my heart</div>
-<div class="verse">To leave a Gilman, Conkey and a Clark;</div>
-<div class="verse">But hope through the sad thought my soul shall bear:</div>
-<div class="verse">Bereft of hope I’d sink in dark despair.</div>
-<div class="verse">When Phœbus a few courses shall have run,</div>
-<div class="verse">And e’er old Aries shall receive the sun,</div><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_81" id="Page_81">[Pg 81]</a></span>
-<div class="verse">I shall return, nor more shall fear the day</div>
-<div class="verse">That from my friends shall take poor me away.</div>
-<div class="verse">Oh then roll on, ye lagging wheels of time,</div>
-<div class="verse">Roll on the hours; till then, dear George, I’m thine.</div>
-</div><div class="stanza">
-<div class="verse indent30">“D. W.”</div>
-</div></div></div>
-
-<p>Verse-writing was but an episode, an occasional
-diversion, with Daniel, and when he entered
-upon his professional life he found little
-time to devote to it. I will therefore cite but
-one other specimen of his college productions in
-this line. It was written shortly after his eighteenth
-birthday, and was appended to a letter
-written to his intimate friend, Mr. Bingham.</p>
-
-<p>It runs thus:</p>
-
-<div class="poetry-container"><div class="poetry"><div class="stanza">
-<div class="verse">“SYLVARUMQUE POTENS DIANA. A FABLE.</div>
-</div><div class="stanza">
-<div class="verse">“Bright Phœbus long all rival suns outshone,</div>
-<div class="verse">And rode triumphant on his splendid throne.</div>
-<div class="verse">When first he waked the blushes of the dawn,</div>
-<div class="verse">And spread his beauties o’er the flowery lawn,</div>
-<div class="verse">The yielding stars quick hastened from the sky,</div>
-<div class="verse">Nor moon dare longer with his glories vie;</div>
-<div class="verse">He reigned supreme, and decked in roseate light</div>
-<div class="verse">Beamed his full splendors on the astonished sight.</div>
-<div class="verse">At length on earth behold a damsel rise,</div>
-<div class="verse">Whose growing beauties charmed the wondering skies!</div>
-<div class="verse">As forth she walked to breathe the balmy air,</div>
-<div class="verse">And view the beauties of the gay parterre,</div>
-<div class="verse">Her radiant glories drowned the blaze of day,</div>
-<div class="verse">And through all nature shot a brighter ray.</div><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_82" id="Page_82">[Pg 82]</a></span>
-<div class="verse">Old Phœbus saw—and blushed—now forced to own</div>
-<div class="verse">That with superior worth the damsel shone.</div>
-<div class="verse">Graced with his name he bade her ever shine,</div>
-<div class="verse">And in his rival owned a form divine!”</div>
-</div></div></div>
-
-<p>One trait of the young college student I must
-refer to, because young men at that stage in their
-mental training are too apt to be marked by a
-self-sufficient and not altogether agreeable opinion
-of their own powers. Notwithstanding his
-great abilities Daniel was always modest, and
-disposed to under rather than overestimate himself.
-Shortly after his graduation he took occasion
-to express himself thus, in speaking to some
-friends:</p>
-
-<p>“The opinion of my scholarship was a mistaken
-one. It was overestimated. I will explain what
-I mean. Many other students read more than I
-did, and knew more than I did. But so much as
-I read I made my own. When a half hour, or
-an hour at most, had elapsed, I closed my book
-and thought over what I had read. If there was
-anything peculiarly interesting or striking in the
-passage I endeavored to recall it and lay it up in
-my memory, and commonly could effect my object.
-Then if, in debate or conversation afterwards,
-any subject came up on which I had read
-something, I could talk very easily so far as I
-had read, and then I was very careful to stop.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_83" id="Page_83">[Pg 83]</a></span>
-Thus greater credit was given me for extensive
-and accurate knowledge than I really possessed.”</p>
-
-<p>It may be remarked generally that men of
-great abilities are more likely to be modest than
-third-rate men, who are very much afraid that
-they will not be rated as high as they should be.
-There are indeed exceptions, and those of a conspicuous
-character. The poet Wordsworth had
-a comfortable consciousness of his superiority to
-his contemporaries, and on one occasion, when he
-was asked if he had read the poems of such a
-one (a prominent poet), he answered, “I never
-read any poetry except my own.”</p>
-
-<p>It is a safe rule to let the world pronounce
-you great before you call attention to your own
-greatness.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_84" id="Page_84">[Pg 84]</a></span></p>
-
-
-
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-<h2><a name="CHAPTER_XI" id="CHAPTER_XI">CHAPTER XI.</a><br />
-
-<small>DANIEL AS AN ORATOR.</small></h2>
-
-
-<p>The four years spent in college generally bear
-an important relation to the future success or
-non-success of the student. It is the formative
-period with most young men, that is, it is the
-time when the habits are formed which are to
-continue through life. Let us inquire, then,
-what did Daniel Webster’s college course do for
-him?</p>
-
-<p>We cannot claim that his attainments at graduation
-were equal to those of the most proficient
-graduates of our colleges to-day. The curriculum
-at Dartmouth, and indeed at all colleges, was
-more limited and elementary than at present.
-Daniel was a good Greek and Latin scholar
-for his advantages, but those were not great.
-He did, however, pay special attention to philosophical
-studies, and to the law of nations. He
-took an interest in current politics, as may be
-gathered from letters written in his college days,
-and was unconsciously preparing himself for the
-office of a statesman.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_85" id="Page_85">[Pg 85]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>He paid special attention also to oratory. No
-longer shrinking from speaking before his classmates,
-he voluntarily composed the pieces he declaimed,
-and took an active part besides in the
-debating society. I am sure my young reader
-will like to know how Daniel wrote at this time,
-and will like to compare the oratory of the college
-student with that of the future statesman. I
-shall, therefore, quote from a Fourth of July
-oration, which he delivered by invitation to the
-citizens and students at the age of eighteen. As
-in a boy’s features we trace a general likeness to
-his mature manhood, so I think we may trace a
-likeness in passages of this early effort to the
-speeches he made in the fullness of his fame.</p>
-
-<p>This is the opening of the address:</p>
-
-<p>“<em>Countrymen, Brethren and Fathers</em>: We are
-now assembled to celebrate an anniversary, ever
-to be held in dear remembrance by the sons of
-freedom. Nothing less than the birth of a nation,
-nothing less than the emancipation of three
-millions of people from the degrading chains of
-foreign bondage is the event we commemorate.</p>
-
-<p>“Twenty-four years have this day elapsed since
-these United States first raised the standard of
-liberty, and echoed the shouts of independence.
-Those of you who were then reaping the iron
-harvest of the martial field, whose bosoms then<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_86" id="Page_86">[Pg 86]</a></span>
-palpitated for the honor of America, will at this
-time experience a renewal of all that fervent
-patriotism, of all those indescribable emotions
-which then agitated your breasts. As for us,
-who were either then unborn, or not far enough
-advanced beyond the threshold of existence to
-engage in the grand conflict for liberty, we now
-most cordially unite with you to greet the return
-of this joyous anniversary, to welcome the return
-of the day that gave us freedom, and to hail the
-rising glories of our country.”</p>
-
-<p>Further on he paints the hardships and distresses
-through which the colonists had passed:</p>
-
-<p>“We behold a feeble band of colonists engaged
-in the arduous undertaking of a new settlement
-in the wilds of North America. Their civil
-liberty being mutilated, and the enjoyment of
-their religious sentiments denied them in the
-land that gave them birth, they braved the
-dangers of the then almost unnavigated ocean,
-and sought on the other side of the globe an
-asylum from the iron grasp of tyranny and the
-more intolerable scourge of ecclesiastical persecution.</p>
-
-<p>“But gloomy indeed was the prospect when
-arrived on this side of the Atlantic.</p>
-
-<p>“Scattered in detachments along a coast immensely
-extensive, at a distance of more than<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_87" id="Page_87">[Pg 87]</a></span>
-three thousand miles from their friends on the
-eastern continent, they were exposed to all those
-evils, and encountered or experienced all those
-difficulties, to which human nature seemed liable.
-Destitute of convenient habitations, the inclemencies
-of the seasons harassed them, the midnight
-beasts of prey howled terribly around
-them, and the more portentous yell of savage
-fury incessantly assailed them. But the same
-undiminished confidence in Almighty God, which
-prompted the first settlers of the country to forsake
-the unfriendly climes of Europe, still supported
-them under all their calamities, and inspired
-them with fortitude almost divine. Having
-a glorious issue to their labors now in prospect,
-they cheerfully endured the rigors of the
-climate, pursued the savage beast to his remotest
-haunt, and stood undismayed in the dismal hour
-of Indian battle.”</p>
-
-<p>Passing on to the Revolutionary struggle the
-young orator refers to “our brethren attacked
-and slaughtered at Lexington, our property
-plundered and destroyed at Concord,” to “the
-spiral flames of burning Charlestown,” and proceeds
-as follows:</p>
-
-<p>“Indelibly impressed on our memories still
-lives the dismal scene of Bunker’s awful mount,
-the grand theater of New England bravery,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_88" id="Page_88">[Pg 88]</a></span>
-where slaughter stalked grimly triumphant,
-where relentless Britain saw her soldiers, the unhappy
-instruments of despotism, fallen in heaps
-beneath the nervous arm of injured freemen!</p>
-
-<p>“There the great Warren fought, and there,
-alas! he fell. Valuing his life only as it enabled
-him to serve his country, he freely resigned himself
-a willing martyr in the cause of liberty,
-and now lies encircled in the arms of glory.</p>
-
-<div class="poetry-container"><div class="poetry"><div class="stanza">
-<div class="verse">“’Peace to the patriot’s shade—let no rude blast</div>
-<div class="verse">Disturb the willow that nods o’er his tomb;</div>
-<div class="verse">Let orphan tears bedew his sacred urn,</div>
-<div class="verse">And fame’s proud trump proclaim the hero’s name</div>
-<div class="verse">Far as the circuit of the spheres extends!’</div>
-</div></div></div>
-
-<p>“But, haughty Albion, thy reign shall soon be
-over. Thou shalt triumph no longer; thy empire
-already reels and totters; thy laurel even
-now begins to wither and thy fame to decay.
-Thou hast at length aroused the indignation of
-an insulted people; thy oppressions they deem
-no longer tolerable.</p>
-
-<p>“The Fourth Day of July, 1776, has now arrived,
-and America, manfully springing from the
-torturing fangs of the British lion, now rises majestic
-in the pride of her sovereignty, and bids
-her eagle elevate his wings! The solemn Declaration
-of Independence is now pronounced,
-amidst crowds of admiring citizens, by the su<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_89" id="Page_89">[Pg 89]</a></span>preme
-council of the nation, and received with
-the unbounded plaudits of a grateful people!
-That was the hour when heroism was proved—when
-the souls of men were tried!</p>
-
-<p>“It was then, ye venerable patriots,” there
-were some Revolutionary soldiers present—“it
-was then you lifted the indignant arm, and
-unitedly swore to be free! Despising such toys
-as subjugated empires, you then knew no middle
-fortune between liberty and death. Firmly relying
-on the protection of Heaven, unwarped in
-the resolution you had taken, you then undaunted
-met, engaged, defeated the gigantic power of
-Britain, and rode triumphant over the aggressions
-of your enemies!</p>
-
-<p>“Trenton, Princeton, Bennington and Saratoga
-were the successive theaters of your victories,
-and the utmost bounds of creation are the limits
-of your fame! The sacred fire of freedom, then
-enkindled in your breasts, shall be perpetuated
-through the long descent of future ages, and
-burn with undiminished fervor in the bosoms of
-millions yet unborn!”</p>
-
-<p>Further on we find the following passage:</p>
-
-<p>“The great drama is now completed; our independence
-is now acknowledged, and the hopes
-of our enemies are blasted forever. Columbia is
-now sealed in the forum of nations, and the em<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_90" id="Page_90">[Pg 90]</a></span>pires
-of the world are amazed at the effulgence
-of her glory.</p>
-
-<p>“Thus, friends and citizens, did the kind hand
-of an overruling Providence conduct us, through
-toils, fatigues and dangers, to independence and
-peace. If piety be the rational exercise of the
-human soul, if religion be not a chimera, and if
-the vestiges of heavenly assistance are clearly
-traced in those events which mark the annals of
-our nation, it becomes us on this day, in consideration
-of the great things which have been
-done for us, to render the tribute of unfeigned
-thanks to that God who superintends the universe,
-and holds aloft the scale that weighs the
-destinies of nations.”</p>
-
-<p>The oration was a long one, and touched a
-variety of topics, but the extracts already given
-will convey a good idea of its excellencies and
-defects. My college readers will understand me
-when I say that the style is sophomoric and
-ambitious, but these faults may be pardoned in a
-youth of eighteen. The tone is elevated, it is
-marked by gravity and earnestness, the sentiments
-are just, there is evidence of thought, and,
-on the whole, we may regard the oration as a
-hopeful promise of the future. The magniloquence
-gave place in time to a weighty simplicity,
-in which every word told, and not one could be<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_91" id="Page_91">[Pg 91]</a></span>
-spared. It was rather remarkable that so young
-a man should have been selected to deliver such
-an address in Hanover, and indicates that Daniel
-had by this time acquired reputation as a public
-speaker.</p>
-
-<p>This was not the only occasion on which he
-was selected to speak in public. When a classmate,
-a general favorite, died, young Webster
-was unanimously selected to deliver an address
-of commemoration. He is said to have spoken
-with a fervor and eloquence which deeply stirred
-the hearts of the large audience that had assembled
-to hear him. “During the delivery the
-fall of a pin could have been heard at any moment;
-a dense audience were carried entirely
-away, and kept spellbound by the magic of his
-voice and manner; and when he sat down, he
-left a thousand people weeping real tears over a
-heartfelt sorrow. It is reported that there was
-not a dry eye in all the vast congregation which
-the event and the fame of the orator had brought
-together.”</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_92" id="Page_92">[Pg 92]</a></span></p>
-
-
-
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-<h2><a name="CHAPTER_XII" id="CHAPTER_XII">CHAPTER XII.</a><br />
-
-<small>STUDYING LAW.</small></h2>
-
-
-<p>Daniel had now successfully accomplished the
-first object of his ambition. He was a college
-graduate. Though not the first scholar in his
-class he was very near the head, and probably in
-general culture stood first. There was a little
-misunderstanding which led to his declining to
-appear at Commencement. His friends desired
-him to deliver the valedictory, but the Faculty
-selected another, and Daniel remained silent.
-There is a report that he tore up his diploma in
-anger and disgust in presence of his classmates,
-saying, “My industry may make me a great man,
-but this miserable parchment cannot.” Had
-this story been true it would have done Daniel
-little credit. George Ticknor Curtis, who has
-written the most elaborate and trustworthy memoir
-of Webster states emphatically that there
-is no foundation for this story. Even if not entirely
-satisfied with the treatment he received at<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_93" id="Page_93">[Pg 93]</a></span>
-that time, Daniel’s loyalty to his Alma Mater was
-never doubted.</p>
-
-<p>And now the world was before the young
-graduate. What was he to do?</p>
-
-<p>His thoughts had long been fixed upon the
-legal profession. This was no proof of a special
-fitness for it, for at least half of the young men
-who graduate from our colleges make the same
-choice. But with Daniel the choice was a more
-serious one, for he very well knew that he could
-not afford to make a mistake here. Poverty was
-still his hard taskmaster, and he leaned beneath
-its dark shadow.</p>
-
-<p>My young reader will remember that at the
-age of fourteen Daniel officiated as office-boy for
-a young lawyer in his native town—Thomas W.
-Thompson. Now a college graduate of nineteen,
-he re-entered the same office as a law student.
-Mr. Thompson was a man of ability. He was a
-graduate of Harvard, where also he had filled the
-position of tutor. While the boy was obtaining
-an education at Dartmouth, Thompson was establishing
-a lucrative law practice. He became in
-time prominent in State politics, and finally went
-to Congress. It will be seen, therefore, that
-Daniel made a good choice, and that Mr. Thompson
-was something more than an obscure country
-lawyer.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_94" id="Page_94">[Pg 94]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>It is a little significant that the first law books
-which the young student read related to the law
-of nations. He read also standard literary works,
-and gave his leisure hours to hunting and fishing,
-the last of which was always a favorite sport with
-him. He gained some insight into the practical
-business of a law office. The reader will be
-amused at a humorous account of the manner in
-which he was employed during a temporary absence
-of his legal preceptor and a fellow-student.</p>
-
-<p>“I have made some few writs,” he says, “and
-am now about to bring an action of trespass for
-breaking a violin. The owner of the violin was
-at a husking, where</p>
-
-<p>
-‘His jarring concord, and his discord dulcet,’<br />
-</p>
-
-<p>made the girls skip over the husks as nimbly as
-Virgil’s Camilla over the tops of the corn, till an
-old surly creature caught his fiddle and broke it
-against the wall. For the sake of having plump
-witnesses the plaintiff will summons all the girls
-to attend the trial at Concord.”</p>
-
-<p>Here is another extract from a letter to the
-same friend which will amuse: “I thank you for
-your receipt for greasing boots. Have this afternoon
-to ride to the South Road, and in truth my
-boots admit not only water, but peas and gravel-stones.
-I wish I had better ones. As for<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_95" id="Page_95">[Pg 95]</a></span> ‘my
-new friend, tobacco,’ he is like most of that
-name has made me twice sick, and is now dismissed.</p>
-
-<p>“Heighho! a man wants a remedy against his
-neighbor, whose lips were found damage-feasant
-on his—the plaintiffs—wife’s cheek! What is to
-be done? But you have not read the law against
-kissing. I will write for advice and direction to
-Barrister Fuller.”</p>
-
-<p>So the young man appeared to be enjoying
-himself while pursuing his studies, and would
-probably have wished nothing better than to have
-gone on till he was prepared for admission to the
-bar on his own account. But there was a serious
-obstacle. His good father had well nigh exhausted
-his means in carrying Daniel through
-college, and Ezekiel through his preparatory
-studies, and was now very much straitened for
-money. It was felt to be time for Daniel to help
-him. He, therefore, “thought it his duty to
-suffer some delay in his profession for the sake of
-serving his elder brother,” by seeking employment
-outside.</p>
-
-<p>As a general thing when a college graduate is
-pressed by hard necessity, he turns his attention
-to the task of teaching, and such was the case
-with Daniel. Fortunately he soon found employment.
-From Fryeburg, Maine, there came to him<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_96" id="Page_96">[Pg 96]</a></span>
-an invitation to take charge of the academy there,
-and the young man accepted it. He was to be
-paid the munificent salary of three hundred and
-fifty dollars per year, and he felt that the offer
-was too dazzling to be rejected.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_97" id="Page_97">[Pg 97]</a></span></p>
-
-
-
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-<h2><a name="CHAPTER_XIII" id="CHAPTER_XIII">CHAPTER XIII.</a><br />
-
-<small>HOW DANIEL WENT TO FRYEBURG.</small></h2>
-
-
-<p>When a young college graduate of to-day sets
-out for the scene of his dignified labors, he packs
-his trunk and buying a ticket for the station
-nearest the favored spot where he is to impart
-knowledge, takes his seat in a comfortable car,
-and is whirled rapidly to his destination.</p>
-
-<p>Not thus did Daniel go. Railroads had not been
-heard of, and no stages made the trip. He therefore
-purchased a horse for twenty-four dollars,
-deposited his limited wardrobe and a few books
-in his saddle-bags, and like a scholastic Don
-Quixote set out by the shortest path across the
-country for Fryeburg. In due time he arrived,
-and the trustees of the academy congratulated
-themselves on having secured Daniel Webster,
-A.B., as their preceptor. How much more would
-they have congratulated themselves could they
-have foreseen the future of the young teacher.</p>
-
-<p>Let me pause here to describe the appearance<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_98" id="Page_98">[Pg 98]</a></span>
-of the young man, as his friends of that time
-depict him. He was tall and thin (he weighed
-but one hundred and twenty pounds, which was
-certainly light weight for a man not far from six
-feet in height), with a thin face, high cheek bones,
-but bright, dark, penetrating eyes, which alone
-were sufficient to make him remarkable. He had
-not wholly overcome the early delicacy which had
-led his friends to select him as the scholar of the
-family, because he was not strong enough to
-labor on the farm. His habitual expression was
-grave and earnest, though, as we have seen, he
-had inherited, and always retained, a genial
-humor from his father.</p>
-
-<p>Three hundred and fifty dollars seems a small
-salary, but Daniel probably didn’t regard it with
-disdain. Expenses were small, as we are told that
-the current rate of board was but two dollars per
-week, less than a third of his income. Then his
-earnings were increased by a lucky circumstance.</p>
-
-<p>Young Webster found a home in the family of
-James Osgood, Esq., registrar of deeds for the
-county of Oxford. Mr. Osgood did not propose
-to do the work himself, but was authorized to
-get it done.</p>
-
-<p>One evening soon after the advent of his new
-boarder, the registrar said, “Mr. Webster, have
-you a mind to increase your income?”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_99" id="Page_99">[Pg 99]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>“I should be exceedingly glad to do so, sir,”
-answered the young man, his face brightening
-with hopeful expectation.</p>
-
-<p>“You are aware that I hold the position of
-registrar of deeds for the county. It is my duty
-to see that all deeds are properly recorded?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, sir.”</p>
-
-<p>“This work I do not care to do myself, having
-sufficient other work to occupy my time. How
-would you like to undertake it in the evening?
-It would not interfere with your school duties.”</p>
-
-<p>“I am not a very good penman,” said the young
-man doubtfully.</p>
-
-<p>“Handsome penmanship is not required. It is
-sufficient if the deeds are copied in a plain, legible
-hand, and this may be attained by effort.”</p>
-
-<p>“How much compensation would be allowed?”</p>
-
-<p>“I receive two shillings and threepence for
-each deed recorded. I will allow you one shilling
-and sixpence, and you can average two deeds in
-an evening. What do you say?”</p>
-
-<p>One shilling and sixpence was twenty-five
-cents. Two deeds therefore would bring the
-young teacher fifty cents, and four evenings’ work,
-therefore, would pay his board, and leave him his
-salary clear. This was a tempting inducement,
-though it would involve dry and tedious labor.</p>
-
-<p>“I will accept,” said Daniel promptly.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_100" id="Page_100">[Pg 100]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>“Then you can begin at once,” said Mr. Osgood,
-well satisfied.</p>
-
-<p>It was a hard way of earning money, but money
-was very much needed. So, after the fatigues of
-the day, when supper was over, Daniel sat down
-to record dry deeds. The curious visitor to Fryeburg
-can still see two volumes of deeds, a large
-part of them in Daniel Webster’s handwriting.
-Though not a good writer, he forced himself to
-write well, and in his autobiography he says,
-“The ache is not yet out of my fingers, for nothing
-has ever been so laborious to me as writing,
-when under the necessity of writing a good hand.”</p>
-
-<p>I may be permitted to call the attention of my
-young readers to this point—that what he had undertaken
-to do he did well, although it was a task
-far from congenial. A young man or boy who
-observes this rule is likely to succeed in the end:
-Whatever you have to do do as well as you can.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_101" id="Page_101">[Pg 101]</a></span></p>
-
-
-
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-<h2><a name="CHAPTER_XIV" id="CHAPTER_XIV">CHAPTER XIV.</a><br />
-
-<small>THE PRECEPTOR OF FRYEBURG ACADEMY.</small></h2>
-
-
-<p>It may be supposed that between his school
-in the daytime and his duties as copyist in the
-evening, Daniel found his time pretty well occupied.
-As we know, he was not drawn to the
-teacher’s office by any special love of that honorable
-vocation, but simply by the pecuniary
-emolument. But, though this was the case, he
-discharged his duties with conscientious fidelity,
-and made himself a favorite both among his
-pupils and in the village, where the new preceptor
-was, as is usual, a person of importance.</p>
-
-<p>He was accustomed to open and close the
-school with extemporaneous prayer, and those
-who remember the deep solemnity of manner
-which he could command at will will readily believe
-that this exercise was made impressive by
-the young teacher.</p>
-
-<p>No stories have been handed down of insubordination
-among his pupils. If there had been
-any, it would speedily have been quelled by the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_102" id="Page_102">[Pg 102]</a></span>
-preceptor, whose demeanor was naturally dignified.</p>
-
-<p>It is remarkable how many of our great men
-have spent a portion of their early lives at the
-teacher’s desk. Gen. Garfield had an unusually
-extensive and varied experience as teacher, and
-would have passed through life very happily if
-he had never withdrawn from the school-room.
-Daniel Webster had not his special aptitude for
-it, but was nevertheless very fairly successful.
-One qualification, as we learn from the testimony
-of a pupil, was his “remarkable equanimity of
-temper.” The vexations of the school-room are
-neither few nor far between, but none of them
-were able to bring a frown to young Webster’s
-brow. Calmly he met and conquered all difficulties
-that came in his way, and secured the confidence
-and respect of his scholars.</p>
-
-<p>The young man also impressed his pupils and
-friends as a man of competent scholarship. Hon.
-Samuel Fessenden, of Portland, writes: “The
-first I ever knew of Daniel Webster was immediately
-after he left college, and was employed
-by my father, the secretary of the Trustees of
-Fryeburg Academy, to become the principal instructor
-in that institution. He was not, when he
-commenced, twenty years old. I heard no one
-complain that his scholarship was not adequate to<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_103" id="Page_103">[Pg 103]</a></span>
-the duty he had assumed. On the contrary, I
-heard the Rev. Dr. Nathaniel Porter, of Conway,
-and my father, the Rev. William Fessenden, of
-Fryeburg, both of whom were good scholars, and
-the former, Rev. Dr. Porter, a very great man,
-say that Daniel Webster was a very good scholar
-for his years. He did, while at Fryeburg, exhibit
-traits of talent and genius which drew from
-these two divines, and from other professional
-gentlemen, unqualified praise of his powers of
-mind. I remember very distinctly hearing my
-father remark that if Mr. Webster should live,
-and have health, and pursue a straightforward
-course of industry and virtue, he would become
-one of the greatest men this country had produced.”</p>
-
-<p>When it is remembered that the young man
-of whom this prediction was made was at the
-time an obscure teacher, in an obscure town, in
-what was then a frontier settlement, we must infer
-that he exhibited remarkable ability, and gave
-hints of a reserved power not yet called into action.</p>
-
-<p>In spite of his engrossing employments, the
-young man found time to enlarge his general
-culture by various reading. Nor did he neglect
-his professional studies, but continued the reading
-of Blackstone’s Commentaries. It is remarkable<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_104" id="Page_104">[Pg 104]</a></span>
-that with all this hard work he found time for
-society. Dr. Osgood, the registrar’s son, says:
-“He was usually serious, but often facetious and
-pleasant. He was an agreeable companion, and
-eminently social with all who shared his friendship.
-He was greatly beloved by all who knew
-him. His habits were strictly abstemious, and
-he neither took wine nor strong drink. He was
-punctual in his attendance upon public worship,
-and ever opened his school with prayer. I never
-heard him use a profane word, and never saw
-him lose his temper.”</p>
-
-<p>From all that has been said my young readers
-will see that Daniel was beginning life in the
-right way. It seems to me that at this period he
-was a model who may be safely copied in all
-respects. The reverence which he so plainly
-evinced as a young man for religion he never lost,
-but to the latest day of his life he yielded to none
-in his regard for the spirit of Christianity.</p>
-
-<p>Under date of May 18, 1802, Daniel writes to
-his favorite friend Harvey Bingham, giving some
-account of matters at Fryeburg. He had just returned
-from spending a short vacation with his
-brother at Hanover.</p>
-
-<p>“I arrived here last night,” he says; “but
-must fill this page by relating a little anecdote
-that happened yesterday. I accidentally fell in<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_105" id="Page_105">[Pg 105]</a></span>
-with one of my scholars on his return to the
-academy. He was mounted on the ugliest horse
-I ever saw or heard of except Sancho Panzas’s
-pacer. As I had two horses with me, I proposed
-to him to ride one of them, and tie his bay fast to
-his Bucephalus; he did accordingly, and turned
-her forward, where her odd appearance, indescribable
-gait, and frequent stumblings afforded
-us constant amusement. At length we approached
-Saco River, a very wide, deep and rapid
-stream, when this satire on the animal creation,
-as if to revenge herself on us for our sarcasms,
-plunged into the river, then very high by the
-freshet, and was wafted down the current like a
-bag of oats. I could scarcely sit on my horse for
-laughter. I am apt to laugh at the vexations of
-my friends. The fellow, who was of my own
-age, and my roommate half checked the current by
-oaths as big as lobsters, and the old Rosinante, who
-was all the while much at her ease, floated up among
-the willows far below on the opposite shore.”</p>
-
-<p>While Daniel was laboring as teacher and
-copyist at Fryeburg, his older brother, Ezekiel,
-was pursuing his studies at Dartmouth College,
-sustained there mainly by the remittances which
-Daniel was able to send him. The chief pleasure
-which the younger brother derived from his experience
-as teacher was, that it gave him the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_106" id="Page_106">[Pg 106]</a></span>
-means of securing for his favorite brother the
-same advantages which he had himself enjoyed.
-He cheerfully postponed his plan of professional
-study in order to discharge this pious duty. Certainly
-the affection which united these two
-brothers was very beautiful, and creditable to
-both. Too often brothers are estranged without
-good reason, and follow selfishly their own plans,
-without the desire to help each other. To the
-end of Ezekiel’s life this mutual affection continued,
-and when he was suddenly removed by
-death Daniel was deeply affected, and staggered
-under the blow.</p>
-
-<p>How long was this occupation to continue?
-How long was the future statesman to devote himself
-to the comparatively humble duty of inducting
-country boys into the paths of knowledge?</p>
-
-<p>He had only engaged for two terms, but such
-was his success that the trustees were not willing
-to have him go. As an inducement to him to
-remain they offered to increase his small salary
-of three hundred and fifty dollars to five or six
-hundred, with a house to live in, a piece of land
-to cultivate, and possibly a clerkship of the Common
-Pleas.</p>
-
-<p>All this may sound very small to us, but to a
-youth who had been reared in such straitened
-circumstances as Daniel it seemed like a liberal<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_107" id="Page_107">[Pg 107]</a></span>
-competence. It required some decision and boldness
-to reject this certainly for the uncertain
-prospects of a young lawyer, before whom lay at
-the first a period of poverty and struggle. Then
-it must be added that Daniel was modest, and
-was far from believing that he was endowed with
-extraordinary talent. It is very probable that
-more than half the young men who graduate from
-our law schools to-day have a higher opinion of
-their abilities than Daniel Webster at the age of
-twenty. To illustrate his struggles I quote from
-a letter written at this time.</p>
-
-<p>“What shall I do? Shall I say, ‘Yes, gentlemen,’
-and sit down here to spend my days in
-a kind of comfortable privacy, or shall I relinquish
-these prospects, and enter into a profession
-where my feelings will be constantly harrowed
-by objects either of dishonesty or misfortune;
-where my living must be squeezed from penury
-(for rich folks seldom go to law), and my moral
-principle be continually at hazard? I agree with
-you that the law is well calculated to draw forth
-the powers of the mind, but what are its effects
-on the heart? are they equally propitious? Does
-it inspire benevolence and awake tenderness; or
-does it, by a frequent repetition of wretched objects,
-blunt sensibility and stifle the still, small
-voice of mercy?</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_108" id="Page_108">[Pg 108]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>“The talent with which Heaven has intrusted
-me is small, very small; yet I feel responsible for
-the use of it, and am not willing to pervert it to
-purposes reproachful or unjust, or to hide it,
-like the slothful servant, in a napkin.</p>
-
-<p>“On the whole, I imagine I shall make one
-more trial (of the law) in the ensuing autumn.
-If I prosecute the profession, I pray God to
-fortify me against its temptations. To the winds
-I dismiss those light hopes of eminence which
-ambition inspired and vanity fostered. To be
-‘honest, to be capable, to be faithful’ to my client
-and my conscience. I believe you, my worthy
-boy, when you tell me what are your intentions.
-I have long known and long loved the honesty of
-your heart. But let us not rely too much on ourselves;
-let us look to some less fallible guide to
-direct us among the temptations that surround
-us.”</p>
-
-<p>In a letter written June 4, 1802, Mr. Webster
-refers to his indecision as to a career.</p>
-
-<div class="poetry-container"><div class="poetry"><div class="stanza">
-<div class="verse">“Now Hope leans forward on Life’s slender line,</div>
-<div class="verse">Shows me a lawyer, doctor or divine;</div>
-<div class="verse">Ardent springs forward to the distant goal,</div>
-<div class="verse">But indecision clogs the eager soul.</div>
-<div class="verse">Heaven bless my friend, and when he marks his way,</div>
-<div class="verse">And takes his bearings o’er life’s troubled sea,</div>
-<div class="verse">In that important moment may he find</div>
-<div class="verse">Choice and his friends and duty all combined.”</div>
-</div></div></div>
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_109" id="Page_109">[Pg 109]</a></span></p>
-
-
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-<h2><a name="CHAPTER_XV" id="CHAPTER_XV">CHAPTER XV.</a><br />
-
-<small>THE NEXT TWO YEARS.</small></h2>
-
-
-<p>The die was cast! Daniel decided to forego
-the small but comfortable income insured to him
-as a teacher, and in accordance with his father’s
-wishes, as well as his own inclination, returned
-to the study of the law. He resumed his place
-(September, 1802) in the office of Mr. Thompson,
-at Salisbury, and there he remained till February
-or March, 1804. Before leaving Fryeburg,
-at the request of the citizens he delivered a
-Fourth of July oration (his second), for which he
-received from the trustees of the academy a gratuity
-of five dollars! It was not many years before
-five hundred dollars would not have been
-considered too much for such a service from the
-then obscure teacher.</p>
-
-<p>My young readers would not feel particularly
-interested in the details of Daniel’s professional
-studies during the eighteen months he spent in
-the office of Mr. Thompson. From the larger
-biographies such information may be obtained by<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_110" id="Page_110">[Pg 110]</a></span>
-law students and those who take an interest
-therein. I shall content myself by extracting
-from Mr. Webster’s autobiography some account
-of the manner in which he employed his time.</p>
-
-<p>“I do not know whether I read much during
-this year and a half besides law books, with two
-exceptions. I read Hume through, not for the
-first time; but my principal occupation with
-books, when not law books, was with the Latin
-classics. I brought from college a very scanty
-inheritance of Latin. I now tried to add to it.
-I made myself familiar with most of Tully’s Orations,
-committed to memory large passages of
-some of them, read Sallust and Cæsar and Horace.
-Some of Horace’s odes I translated into
-poor English rhymes; they were printed. I have
-never seen them since. My brother was a far
-better English scholar than myself, and, in one
-of his vacations, we read Juvenal together. But
-I never mastered his style, so as to read him with
-ease and pleasure. At this period of my life I
-passed a great deal of time alone. My amusements
-were fishing and shooting and riding, and
-all these were without a companion. I loved this
-occasional solitude then, and have loved it ever
-since, and love it still. I like to contemplate nature,
-and to hold communion, unbroken by the
-presence of human beings, with<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_111" id="Page_111">[Pg 111]</a></span> ‘this universal
-frame—thus wondrous fair.’ I like solitude also,
-as favorable to thoughts less lofty. I like to let
-the thoughts go free and indulge excursions.
-And when <em>thinking</em> is to be done, one must, of
-course, be alone. No man knows himself who
-does not thus sometimes keep his own company.
-At a subsequent period of life I have found that
-my lonely journeys, when following the court on
-its circuits, have afforded many an edifying day.”</p>
-
-<p>It will be seen that young Webster aimed to
-be something more than a lawyer. Instead of
-throwing aside his law books when his daily reading
-was over with a sigh of relief that he could
-now devote his time to mere enjoyment, he closed
-them only to open the English and Latin classics,
-with a view to broaden his culture and qualify
-himself for something better than a routine lawyer,
-to whom his profession presents itself only
-as a means of livelihood. Pressed as he had
-been, and still was, by the burden of poverty, he
-never appears to have set before himself as a
-principal object the emoluments to be gained by
-legal practice. During his busy years his receipts
-were indeed very large, but they came to him as
-a consequence of his large and varied ability,
-and not because he had specially labored to that
-end.</p>
-
-<p>I have already mentioned the young man’s<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_112" id="Page_112">[Pg 112]</a></span>
-modesty. He did not apparently suspect the
-extent of his own powers, and did not look forward
-to fill any conspicuous place in his profession.
-He hoped indeed for “the acquirement of
-a decent, competent estate, enabling us to treat
-our friends as they deserve, and to live free from
-embarrassment.” This was the measure of his
-expectation.</p>
-
-<p>Yet it did occur to him at times that an office
-in a small country town hardly afforded the
-facilities for acquiring professional knowledge
-which it would be desirable to enjoy. Sometimes
-he hoped that he might be able to finish
-his studies in Boston, where he would meet with
-men of large ability, and where the practice of
-law took a larger range. But if he found it hard
-work to maintain himself in Salisbury, how could
-he hope to pay his way in Boston?</p>
-
-<p>But a way was unexpectedly opened to him.
-Before Ezekiel had completed his college course
-it was necessary for him to teach in order to fill
-his exhausted coffers, and by a lucky chance he
-obtained the charge of a small private school in
-what is now Kingston Street, Boston. He had
-eight scholars in Latin and Greek, but found
-himself unable to do justice to them on account
-of the long list of branches which he had to teach.
-He wrote to Daniel, offering him a sum suffi<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_113" id="Page_113">[Pg 113]</a></span>cient
-to pay his board, if he would assume the
-charge of these pupils. This would require but
-an hour and a half daily, and would leave the law
-student ample time to prosecute his studies.</p>
-
-<p>It may readily be supposed that Daniel did not
-decline this offer. It was an experiment, perhaps,
-but it was worth trying. So he packed up
-his clothes and repaired to Boston, where he
-joined his brother, whom he arranged to assist in
-his duties. Now the relations of the brothers
-were again reversed, and it was the elder who
-took his turn in helping along the younger. The
-most eminent of the pupils thus coming under
-the instruction of Daniel Webster was Edward
-Everett, worthy as an orator to be named with his
-master. Webster, Everett, Choate! Nine out
-of ten, if called upon to name the three most renowned
-orators of New England, would single
-out these names, and it will indeed be a fortunate
-age that can boast three who can equal them.
-Among the pupils of Ezekiel Webster was George
-Ticknor, another eminent man who will need no
-introduction to my readers.</p>
-
-<p>Daniel had entered a new and auspicious period
-of study and opportunity. He had gained a
-foothold in Boston. How was he best to improve
-his residence? What great lawyer would open
-his office to the young New Hampshire student?</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_114" id="Page_114">[Pg 114]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>Among the most eminent citizens and lawyers
-of Boston at that time was Christopher Gore.
-He had served the American Government at
-home and abroad, as district attorney for Massachusetts,
-and as a commissioner to England under
-Jay’s Treaty, for the settlement of claims brought
-by citizens of the United States for spoliation by
-British cruisers during the war of the French
-Revolution. A higher honor was in store for
-him, since in 1809 he was elected Governor of
-Massachusetts by the Federal party. In 1804,
-when young Webster arrived in Boston, he was
-in practice as a lawyer, his specialty being commercial
-law.</p>
-
-<p>Daniel learned that Mr. Gore had no clerk, and
-ambition led him to apply for the situation. He
-did not know any near friend of the distinguished
-lawyer, but a young man, whose acquaintance
-with him was nearly as slight as his, undertook to
-introduce him.</p>
-
-<p>When the two young men entered the office,
-Daniel, according to his own account, was shockingly
-embarrassed. But Mr. Gore, with his old-fashioned
-courtesy, speedily put at him at ease.
-The rest of the interview we will let Mr. Webster
-tell for himself.</p>
-
-<p>“I had the grace to begin with an unaffected
-apology; told him my position was very awk<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_115" id="Page_115">[Pg 115]</a></span>ward,
-my appearance there very like an intrusion,
-and that, if I expected anything but a civil dismission,
-it was only founded in his known kindness
-and generosity of character. I was from the
-country, I said; had studied law for two years;
-had come to Boston to study a year more; had
-some respectable acquaintances in New Hampshire,
-not unknown to him, but had no introduction;
-that I had heard he had no clerk; thought it
-possible he would receive one; that I came to
-Boston to work, not to play; was most desirous,
-on all accounts, to be his pupil; and all I ventured
-to ask at present was, that he would keep a
-place for me in his office till I could write to New
-Hampshire for proper letters, showing me worthy
-of it.”</p>
-
-<p>This speech Daniel delivered fluently, having
-carefully considered what he intended to say.</p>
-
-<p>Mr. Gore heard him with encouraging good
-nature, and kindly invited the young visitor to
-sit down.</p>
-
-<p>“I do not mean to fill my office with clerks,”
-he said, “but am willing to receive one or two,
-and will consider what you have said.”</p>
-
-<p>He inquired what gentlemen of his acquaintance
-knew Daniel and his father, and in reply
-Daniel mentioned several, among others Mr. Peabody,
-who was Mr. Gore’s classmate.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_116" id="Page_116">[Pg 116]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>A pleasant conversation continued for a few
-minutes, and Daniel rose to go.</p>
-
-<p>“My young friend,” said Mr. Gore, “you look
-as if you might be trusted. You say you came
-to study and not to waste time. I will take you
-at your word. You may as well hang up your
-hat at once. Go into the other room, take your
-book and sit down to reading it, and write at your
-convenience to New Hampshire for your letters.”</p>
-
-<p>Daniel could hardly credit his good fortune in
-this prompt assent to his wishes. He felt that
-he had made an auspicious beginning in Boston,
-and made “a good stride onward” in securing
-admission to such an office.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_117" id="Page_117">[Pg 117]</a></span></p>
-
-
-
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-<h2><a name="CHAPTER_XVI" id="CHAPTER_XVI">CHAPTER XVI.</a><br />
-
-<small>A GREAT TEMPTATION.</small></h2>
-
-
-<p>Our young student could not have been more
-favorably situated for study, and we may well
-believe that he made the best use of his advantages.
-I shall not describe his course at length,
-or in detail, but confine myself to such personal
-details as are likely to interest my reader.</p>
-
-<p>In November a rare pleasure awaited him.
-A gentleman of means, Mr. Taylor Baldwin, who
-had some occasion for his services, engaged him
-to accompany him on a leisurely journey in parts
-of New England and New York, not only defraying
-his expenses, but recompensing him
-liberally. I can do no better than quote the young
-man’s description of it in a letter to his friend
-Bingham, dated Jan. 2d, 1805:</p>
-
-<p>“Figure to yourself a large room in the third
-story of a brick building, in the center of Boston,
-a sea-coal fire, and a most enormous writing-table
-with half a cord of books on it. Then
-figure further to yourself your most obedient,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_118" id="Page_118">[Pg 118]</a></span>
-with his back to the fire, and his face to the
-table, writing by candle-light, and you will precisely
-see a ‘happy fellow.’ There now is a
-famous dash at description! Now let me try
-my talent at narration.</p>
-
-<p>“Well, then, on the fifth day of November,
-being election day, at just twenty-seven minutes
-and a half past twelve, I left Mrs. Whitwell’s,
-Court Street, Boston, and on the twenty-eighth
-day of the same month, at one o’clock
-<span class="smcap">P.M.</span>, arrived at time same Mrs. Whitwell’s, in the
-same Court Street. You can easily determine
-from the above account where I went!! If,
-however, you should be puzzled, I will tell you
-to Albany. Yes, James, I have even been to
-Albany. I cannot now tell you why, nor for
-what, but it was in a hackney coach, with a pair
-of nimble trotters, a smart coachman before, and
-a footman on horseback behind. There’s style for
-you! Moreover, I had my friend at my elbow....
-My expenses were all amply paid, and
-on my return I put my hand in my pocket, and
-found one hundred and twenty dear delightfuls!
-Is not that good luck? And these dear delightfuls
-were, ’pon honor, all my own, yes, every dog
-of ’em. Now don’t you think I would jump to
-go to Albany again! But to be serious, I really
-went to Albany, in November, with a gentle<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_119" id="Page_119">[Pg 119]</a></span>man
-of this town, for which I received the above
-reward; and I’m so proud to have a dollar of my
-own I was determined to tell you of it. Of my
-journey and all that I saw and heard I cannot
-give you a particular account now.”</p>
-
-<p>The journey above mentioned was through
-Springfield to Albany, thence down to Hudson,
-returning by way of Hartford and Providence to
-Boston. Taken by rail it would not be much of
-a journey, but traveling by easy stages across the
-country, it must have been full of enjoyment to a
-young man wholly new to journeys of any kind.</p>
-
-<p>Daniel’s description of Albany in a letter to
-his brother is an amusing one.</p>
-
-<p>“Albany is no despicable place. To be sure it
-is irregular and without form. Its houses are
-generally old and poor-looking—its streets are
-rather dirty—but there are many exceptions. A
-part of the town is very high, overlooking the
-river in a very pleasant manner, and affording
-many fine seats. Some handsome buildings ornament
-the town. The Dutch Reformed Church
-and the new State Bank would not disgrace
-State Street (Boston). Here are all sorts of
-people, both Greek and Jew, Englishman and
-Dutchman, Negro and Indian. Almost everybody
-speaks English occasionally, though I have
-heard them speak among themselves in a <em>lingo</em><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_120" id="Page_120">[Pg 120]</a></span>
-which I never learned even at the Indian Charity
-School. The river here is half a mile wide, that
-is, I should think so; and, if I think wrong, you:
-must look at Dr. Morse and correct me.”</p>
-
-<p>The cosmopolitan character of Albany nearly
-eighty years since, when it probably contained
-not over five thousand inhabitants, is certainly
-rather amazing, and I can conceive the modern
-Albanian reading the description given above
-with considerable surprise. But Daniel was at
-an age and in a state of inexperience in which
-everything new is wonderful, and he certainly
-saw everything under very pleasant circumstances.</p>
-
-<p>From a letter written by his sister it appears
-that the young law student was paid seven
-dollars a day for his company by his rich and
-eccentric companion, who, if he lived to know of
-Webster’s eminence, probably concluded that the
-price was by no means exorbitant.</p>
-
-<p>In the letter of Sally Webster, already referred
-to, there is a passage which will amuse my
-young readers. “Before I have finished my
-nonsense I must tell you that our neighbors opposite
-the door fought a duel the other day, one
-with the gridiron, the other with the candlestick.
-The female, however, came off victorious, and
-he, with all speed, ran here with some lint and<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_121" id="Page_121">[Pg 121]</a></span>
-rum, to be applied immediately, for he was bleeding
-to death with a wound in his head caused
-by the gridiron.”</p>
-
-<p>It is evident that if the women of New Hampshire
-were not strong-minded, there were some
-who were strong-armed, and calculated to strike
-terror in an average husband.</p>
-
-<p>Meanwhile how were things going at the early
-home of the future statesman in New Hampshire?
-Judge Webster no doubt experienced
-satisfaction in knowing that the two sons for
-whom he had hoped so much, and sacrificed so
-much, were now possessors of a collegiate education,
-and in a fair way to make their own way in
-the world. But he was not without his anxieties.
-To obtain that education he had been
-obliged to mortgage his small estate for nearly
-all it was worth. He was sixty-five years of age,
-and a life of labor and exposure had made him
-old before his time. He could not look for
-many years more of life, and he might die before
-his two boys were able to support themselves by
-their professional labors, without speaking of
-taking his place at home. But he had been sustained
-by one hope, which finally seemed in a
-way of being realized. The clerk of the Court
-of Common Pleas, of which he was an associate
-judge, died. Chief Justice Farrar, knowing the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_122" id="Page_122">[Pg 122]</a></span>
-family circumstances of his associate, immediately
-placed the office at his disposal for his son Daniel.</p>
-
-<p>For that day it was a lucrative office, paying
-much more than a judgeship. The emoluments
-were fifteen hundred dollars a year, and that
-would be a competence to a young man brought
-up like Daniel. It would make life easy to him,
-and enable him to smooth the pathway of his
-father, and release the homestead from mortgage.</p>
-
-<p>With glad heart Judge Webster wrote to
-Daniel of his good fortune, and Daniel on his
-side was elated. He felt that it would make him
-independent, that he would pay off the family
-debt, and assist his brother Ezekiel.</p>
-
-<p>So, full of the good news, he went over to the
-office in the morning, and with a beaming face
-acquainted Mr. Gore with the offer he had received,
-and then waited to receive his congratulations.</p>
-
-<p>“Well, my young friend,” said he, “the
-gentlemen have been very kind to you; I am
-glad of it. You must thank them for it. Certainly
-they are very good; you must write them
-a civil letter. You will write immediately, of
-course.”</p>
-
-<div class="figcenter">
-<img src="images/p122.jpg" alt="" />
-<div class="caption">“<em>Will you carry us across on your back?</em>”—<a href="#Page_286">Page 286</a>.</div>
-</div>
-
-<p>“I feel their kindness and liberality very
-deeply,” answered Daniel. “I shall certainly<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_123" id="Page_123">[Pg 123]</a></span>
-thank them in the best manner I am able, but, as
-I shall go to Salisbury so soon, I hardly think it
-is necessary to write.”</p>
-
-<p>“Why,” said Mr. Gore, seeming greatly surprised,
-“you surely don’t mean to accept it?”</p>
-
-<p>Daniel was astounded. Not to accept such a
-magnificent proposal! As soon as he could
-speak he said that he had no thought of anything
-else but acceptance.</p>
-
-<p>“Well,” said Mr. Gore, “you must decide for
-yourself; but come, sit down, and let us talk it
-over. The office is worth fifteen hundred a year,
-you say; well, it never will be worth any more.
-Ten to one if they find out it is so much the fees will
-be reduced. You are appointed now by friends;
-others may fill their places who are of different
-opinions, and who have friends of their own to
-provide for. You will lose your place; or, supposing
-you to retain it, what are you but a clerk
-for life? And your prospects as a lawyer are
-good enough to encourage you to go on. Go on,
-and finish your studies; you are poor enough,
-but there are greater evils than poverty; live on
-no man’s favor; what bread you do eat let it be
-the bread of independence; pursue your profession,
-make yourself useful to your friends, and
-a little formidable to your enemies, and you have
-nothing to fear.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_124" id="Page_124">[Pg 124]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>Daniel hardly knew what to think or to say.
-It was presenting the subject from a very different
-point of view. He had looked forward to
-this office as a thing greatly to be desired. It
-had been the height of his ambition, and now his
-legal instructor, a man whose opinion he greatly
-valued, told him he must give it up. He was
-indeed flattered and encouraged by the eminent
-lawyer’s estimate of his talents and prospects, an
-estimate far beyond any he had formed for himself,
-for Daniel, as I have already had occasion
-to say, was modest, and wholly ignorant of the
-extent of his powers.</p>
-
-<p>It was not that he expected to enjoy a clerkship.
-He knew he should not, but he had been
-struggling so long with poverty that the prospect
-of a competency was most alluring. Besides
-he was a good son and a good brother. He
-knew how much his father’s mind would be relieved,
-how he could help his favorite brother,
-and it seemed very hard to resign such a piece of
-fortune.</p>
-
-<p>“Go home and think it over,” said Mr. Gore,
-“and come back in the morning, and we will
-have another talk.”</p>
-
-<p>Daniel followed his advice, but passed a sleepless
-night.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_125" id="Page_125">[Pg 125]</a></span></p>
-
-
-
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-<h2><a name="CHAPTER_XVII" id="CHAPTER_XVII">CHAPTER XVII.</a><br />
-
-<small>DANIEL REFUSES A CLERKSHIP.</small></h2>
-
-
-<p>Those of my readers who have read “The
-Canal Boy” will remember that before Gen. Garfield
-graduated from college he too was met by
-a similar temptation, in the shape of an offer
-which, if accepted, would have materially changed
-his course of life, and given him a comfortable
-obscurity in place of national renown. He was
-offered a school in Troy, N. Y., with a salary of
-one hundred and twenty-five dollars per month,
-while up to that time he had never earned but
-eighteen dollars per month and board. He declined
-after a hard struggle, for he too had been
-reared in poverty and still suffered from it.</p>
-
-<p>And now a similar temptation had come to
-Daniel Webster.</p>
-
-<p>He went home and thought the matter over.
-He felt that Mr. Gore’s advice was good, but how
-could he accept it? His father was old and in
-poor health. He had set his heart on Daniel’s ac<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_126" id="Page_126">[Pg 126]</a></span>cepting
-this place. A contrary decision would
-strike him like a thunderbolt. Moreover it would
-bring him home, and give his father the comfort
-of his society, as well as pecuniary prosperity.</p>
-
-<p>It seemed a selfish thing to refuse, to show a
-lack of consideration for his father, and Daniel
-was a good son. I mention all these things to
-show that in this turning-point of his career
-Daniel had a hard decision to make. There was
-another circumstance to consider—his father was
-in present need of money.</p>
-
-<p>Finally Daniel made up his mind. If he could
-borrow a sum of money sufficient to help his
-father, he would venture to refuse the clerkship.</p>
-
-<p>He went to Mr. Joseph Taylor, a Boston acquaintance,
-and said to him abruptly, “Mr.
-Taylor, I want to borrow some money. I will
-pay you some time or other, but I can’t tell exactly
-when.”</p>
-
-<p>“You can have as much as you want,”
-answered Mr. Taylor kindly.</p>
-
-<p>“But,” said Daniel, “I want a good deal of
-money.”</p>
-
-<p>“How much?” asked his friend, not seeming
-alarmed at his rash promise.</p>
-
-<p>“Three or four hundred dollars,” was the
-reply, and this in the eyes of the young law<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_127" id="Page_127">[Pg 127]</a></span>
-student was a very large sum, though his ideas
-changed when money came in by thousands from
-wealthy clients, not many years afterwards.</p>
-
-<p>“You shall have it,” said Mr. Taylor, and he
-counted out the money into the young man’s
-hands.</p>
-
-<p>Daniel was elated with his success. He would
-not go home empty-handed, and this sum would
-soften the blow which his determination would
-bring to his father.</p>
-
-<p>Now to get home and have it over as soon as
-possible! He hired a seat in a country sleigh
-which had come down to market, and was on the
-point of returning, for there was neither railroad
-nor stage to convey him to his home. It was a
-crisp winter day, and they glided over the snowy
-roads for many hours till they were beyond the
-New Hampshire line. Still mile after mile was
-traversed till the old home was reached.</p>
-
-<p>Just at sunset Daniel reached his home.
-Through the window, even before he entered,
-he saw his father in his little room sitting in his
-arm-chair. The old man, worn out by a long
-life of hard labor, seemed very old and thin, but
-his eyes were as black and bright as ever. Daniel’s
-heart was touched, and he felt that the trial had
-come. It was no light thing to disappoint such a
-father.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_128" id="Page_128">[Pg 128]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>As he entered the presence of his father Judge
-Webster looked up with a smile of gladness.</p>
-
-<p>“Well, Daniel, we have got that office for you,”
-he said.</p>
-
-<p>“Yes, father,” said Daniel a little nervously.
-“The gentlemen were very kind. I must go and
-thank them.”</p>
-
-<p>“They gave it to you without my saying a
-word about it,” said Judge Webster complacently.</p>
-
-<p>“I must go and see Judge Farrar, and tell him
-I am much obliged to him, father.”</p>
-
-<p>Still the father suspected nothing of Daniel’s
-intention, though his son treated it more carelessly
-than he had anticipated. He had thought
-so much about it and come to look upon it as so
-desirable that it did not seem to him possible that
-his son could regard it in any other way, as indeed
-he would not but for Mr. Gore’s advice.</p>
-
-<p>But at last the true meaning of Daniel’s indifference
-flashed upon him, and he looked at him
-earnestly.</p>
-
-<p>He straightened himself up in his chair, and he
-regarded him intently.</p>
-
-<p>“Daniel, Daniel,” he said, “don’t you mean to
-take that office?”</p>
-
-<p>“No, indeed, father,” answered Daniel lightly,
-though his lightness was assumed, and covered
-a feeling of anxiety; “I hope I can do much<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_129" id="Page_129">[Pg 129]</a></span>
-better than that. I mean to use my tongue in
-the courts, not my pen; to be an actor, not a
-register of other men’s acts. I hope yet, sir, to
-astonish your honor in your own court by my
-professional attainments.”</p>
-
-<p>Youth is hopeful and ready to take risks; age
-is conservative and takes little for granted.
-Judge Webster must have thought his son’s decision
-exceedingly rash. Let me tell the rest of
-the story in Daniel’s words, as indeed I have
-closely adhered to his version thus far.</p>
-
-<p>“For a moment I thought he was angry. He
-rocked his chair slightly; a flash went over an
-eye softened by age, but still as black as jet;
-but it was gone, and I thought I saw that parental
-partiality was, after all, a little gratified at this
-apparent devotion to an honorable profession, and
-this seeming confidence of success in it. He
-looked at me for as much as a minute, and then
-said slowly, ‘Well, my son, your mother has always
-said you would come to something or nothing,
-she was not sure which; I think you are now
-about settling that doubt for her.’ This he said,
-and never a word spoke more to me on the subject.”</p>
-
-<p>Daniel explained to his father the reasons
-which had induced him to arrive at the decision
-he had just expressed, and as an earnest of the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_130" id="Page_130">[Pg 130]</a></span>
-good fortune which he anticipated in the career
-he had chosen he produced the money he had
-borrowed, and placed it in his father’s hands.
-Probably this satisfied Judge Webster that there
-were others who had faith in his son’s promise,
-since he could offer no other security for borrowed
-money. At any rate it softened his disappointment,
-since it brought him help which he sorely
-needed.</p>
-
-<p>Daniel stayed at home a week, contributing as
-such a son might to the happiness of his parents,
-who, now in the sunset of life, had little to hope
-for themselves, but lived wholly for their children.</p>
-
-<p>Now he must go back to Boston, for the period
-of his preparatory studies was drawing to a close,
-and he was almost to seek immediately admission
-to the bar.</p>
-
-<p>In March, 1805, he was admitted to practice in
-the Court of Common Pleas in Boston, the usual
-motion being made by his friend and teacher, Mr.
-Gore. This eminent lawyer, according to the
-custom of that time, accompanied his motion by
-a brief speech, which was of so complimentary a
-character that it must have been exceedingly
-gratifying to the legal neophyte, who stood waiting
-for the doors to open through which he was
-to enter into the precincts of a dignified and<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_131" id="Page_131">[Pg 131]</a></span>
-honorable profession. “It is a well-known tradition,”
-says Mr. George Ticknor Curtis, “that on
-this occasion Mr. Gore predicted the future eminence
-of his young friend. What he said has not
-been preserved; but that he said what Mr. Webster
-never forgot, that it was distinctly a prediction,
-and that it excited in him a resolve that it should
-not go unfulfilled, we have upon his own authority,
-though he appears to have been unwilling to repeat
-the words of Mr. Gore’s address.”</p>
-
-<p>Young Webster, whose career we have thus
-far followed in detail through the successive
-stages of his struggle with penury, was now no
-longer a farmer’s boy, but a full-fledged lawyer,
-of whom eminent men expected much.</p>
-
-<p>Another important question was to be decided,
-Where should Daniel put up his shingle, and commence
-the practice of his profession? In Boston
-the field was larger, and the chances of attaining
-professional eminence were greater. Many of his
-friends counseled his remaining in the city. But
-up in New Hampshire was an old man whose life
-was nearly over, to whose last days his company
-would bring solace and comfort. What prospects,
-however brilliant, could overbalance this consideration?
-With filial devotion Daniel decided
-to settle in New Hampshire, in Boscawan, but a
-few miles from Salisbury, where he could see<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_132" id="Page_132">[Pg 132]</a></span>
-his father almost daily. Boston could wait, professional
-opportunities could wait. His father’s
-happiness must not be disregarded. So in the
-spring of 1805 he became a country lawyer in the
-same town where he had prepared for college.</p>
-
-<p>Thirteen months later, in April, 1807, his
-father died.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_133" id="Page_133">[Pg 133]</a></span></p>
-
-
-
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-<h2><a name="CHAPTER_XVIII" id="CHAPTER_XVIII">CHAPTER XVIII.</a><br />
-
-<small>D. WEBSTER, ATTORNEY.</small></h2>
-
-
-<p>This was the sign that our young lawyer attached
-to his office, in the town of Boscawan.
-The office was humble enough. It was on the
-second floor of a store, painted red, and the staircase
-leading to it was on the outside. His office
-rent was fifteen dollars a year, which certainly
-could not have been considered an extravagant
-sum.</p>
-
-<p>Here it was that the future great lawyer commenced
-practice. Though his fees amounted to
-but six or seven hundred dollars a year, his practice
-extended over three counties, Hillsborough,
-Rockingham and Grafton. We infer from his
-meager income, though it was ample for his
-needs in a place where living was so inexpensive,
-that his clients had no occasion to complain of
-immoderate charges.</p>
-
-<p>Judge Webster had the satisfaction of hearing
-his son make one speech in court, but he was so
-near the end of his earthly pilgrimage that he<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_134" id="Page_134">[Pg 134]</a></span>
-never heard another, being for the last few
-months confined within doors. The father
-listened with satisfaction, and regarded his son’s
-effort as a very creditable one.</p>
-
-<p>Daniel’s sole object in establishing himself in
-an obscure country place was to be near his
-father, who he knew could not live many years.
-The end was nearer than he supposed, for he
-died little more than a year later. It may have
-been a sacrifice, but probably he lost nothing by
-it. The quiet seclusion gave him more time for
-study, and he was laying a broad groundwork
-for his future fame to rest upon.</p>
-
-<p>It was while he was at Boscawan that he first
-encountered Mr. Jeremiah Mason, the acknowledged
-head of the New Hampshire bar. From
-a foot-note in Curtis’s Life, I quote the circumstances
-as told by Mr. Mason himself.</p>
-
-<p>“I had heard,” said Mr. Mason,” that there
-was a young lawyer up there who was reputed to
-be a wonderfully able fellow, and was said by the
-country people to be as black as the ace of spades,
-but I had never seen him. When they told me
-that he had prepared evidence for this prosecution
-(it was a case of forgery, the defendant being
-a man of respectable position), I thought it well
-to be careful, especially as the trial was to be
-conducted by the attorney-general. But when<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_135" id="Page_135">[Pg 135]</a></span>
-the trial came on the attorney-general was ill,
-and the prosecutors asked that Webster should
-be allowed to conduct the case. I assented to this
-readily, thinking I ought to have an easy time of
-it, and we were introduced to each other.</p>
-
-<p>“We went at it, and I soon found that I had
-no light work on my hands. He examined his
-witnesses and shaped his case with so much skill
-that I had to exert every faculty I possessed. I
-got the man off, but it was as hard a day’s work
-as I ever did in my life. There were other transactions
-behind this one which looked quite as
-awkward. When the verdict was announced I
-went up to the dock and whispered to the prisoner,
-as the sheriff let him out, to be off for Canada,
-and never to put himself within the reach of that
-young Webster again. From that time forth I
-never lost sight of Mr. Webster, and never had
-but one opinion of his powers.”</p>
-
-<p>This is remarkable testimony from the head of
-the bar to a practitioner so young, who was a
-mere novice in the profession.</p>
-
-<p>After the death of his father Daniel was still
-compelled for a time to remain in his country
-office. His practice was now worth something,
-and he had it in view to surrender it to his
-brother Ezekiel, who was now studying law, but
-had not been admitted to the bar. His father<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_136" id="Page_136">[Pg 136]</a></span>
-had left some debts, which Daniel voluntarily
-assumed. In the autumn of 1807 Ezekiel succeeded
-to the double office of managing the
-home farm, and carrying on the law business of
-his younger brother. Then Daniel, feeling that
-he might safely do so, took down his “shingle,”
-and removed to Portsmouth, where he found
-a larger field for the exercise of his abilities,
-where he could gain a higher and more conspicuous
-position.</p>
-
-<p>His appearance at this time has been thus described
-by a member of Rev. Dr. Buckminster’s
-family. “Slender, and apparently of delicate
-organization, his large eyes and narrow brow
-seemed very predominant above the other features,
-which were sharply cut, refined and delicate.
-The paleness of his complexion was
-heightened by hair as black as the raven’s wing.”</p>
-
-<p>Daniel soon became intimate with the family
-of Dr. Buckminster, and from members of this
-family we learn much that is interesting concerning
-him. He developed, according to Mr.
-Lee, a “genial and exceedingly rich humor,”
-which did more to make him popular in society
-than any of his other diversified gifts. “We
-young people saw him only rarely in friendly
-visits. I well remember one afternoon that he
-came in, when the elders of the family were ab<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_137" id="Page_137">[Pg 137]</a></span>sent.
-He sat down by the window, and as now
-and then an inhabitant of the small town passed
-through the street, his fancy was caught by their
-appearance and his imagination excited, and he
-improvised the most humorous imaginary histories
-about them, which would have furnished
-a rich treasure for Dickens, could he have been
-the delighted listener, instead of the young girl
-for whose amusement this wealth of invention
-was extended.” Mr. Mason, who appreciated
-the young man’s humor, as well as his professional
-ability, used to say that “there was never
-such an actor lost to the stage as he would have
-made had he chosen to turn his talents in that
-direction.”</p>
-
-<p>Daniel was still fragile, not having yet out-grown
-his early delicacy. Dr. Buckminster prescribed
-as a remedy half an hour’s wood-sawing
-before breakfast, with a long two-handed saw,
-one end of which he held himself. The young
-lawyer doubtless found this early exercise a good
-appetizer, qualifying him to do full justice to the
-breakfast that succeeded.</p>
-
-<p>Within a year of his removal to Portsmouth
-Mr. Webster took a step most important to his
-happiness. He was married to Grace Fletcher,
-daughter of Rev. Elijah Fletcher, of Hopkinton.
-There is no occasion in a brief biography like this<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_138" id="Page_138">[Pg 138]</a></span>
-to speak at length of Mrs. Webster. It is sufficient
-to say that she was qualified by her natural
-powers and acquired culture to be a sympathizing
-friend and companion to the husband whom
-she saw gradually expanding intellectually, and
-rising higher in reputation, in the twenty years
-that they lived together.</p>
-
-<p>I have said that Mr. Webster’s removal to
-Portsmouth brought him a wider and more lucrative
-practice. He still lived plainly, however.
-His office, though more pretentious than the one
-at Boscawan, which he hired for fifteen dollars
-a year, was, according to Mr. Ticknor, “a common,
-ordinary looking room, with less furniture
-and more books than common. He had a small
-inner room, opening from the larger, rather an
-unusual thing. He lived in a small, modest
-wooden house, which was burned in the great
-fire in 1813,” a fire by which he lost a valuable
-library.</p>
-
-<p>Daniel Webster lived in Portsmouth nine years
-lacking one month. He was in no hurry to remove
-to the still wider field that was waiting for him
-in Boston. He says somewhere that these were
-very happy years. His great powers were gradually
-expanding. He grew like an oak tree,
-slowly, but his growth was steady, and the result
-was massive and majestic. It was not long be<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_139" id="Page_139">[Pg 139]</a></span>fore
-he was regarded as one of the most prominent
-lawyers in his native State, and he was
-generally matched in important suits with Jeremiah
-Mason, already referred to as the undisputed
-head of the bar. Mr. Mason was a remarkable
-man, not only intellectually but physically. He
-was a very Titan, almost tall enough to have attracted
-the attention of Barnum had he lived at
-a later period. He was six feet seven inches in
-height, and naturally attracted attention wherever
-he went—an attention, by the way, which he did
-not court, and which was embarrassing to him.
-An amusing story is told of him which I have
-somewhere read, and will record from memory.</p>
-
-<p>In spite of his great height Mr. Mason did not
-sit high, having a short body and legs of immense
-length. One day he was driving in the neighborhood
-of Portsmouth, when in a narrow road
-he met a man driving a cart, a stalwart man, inclined
-to be a bully, who, confident in his strength,
-was disposed to take advantage of it.</p>
-
-<p>“Turn out!” he said roughly to Mr. Mason.</p>
-
-<p>“My friend,” said the lawyer, who was in a
-light buggy,” I have already given you half the
-road.”</p>
-
-<p>“No, you haven’t,” answered the other roughly.
-“At any rate, you must turn out more.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_140" id="Page_140">[Pg 140]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>“But I see no justice in that,” said the great
-lawyer mildly.</p>
-
-<p>The mildness of his manner led the bully to
-think Mr. Mason was afraid of him; so, with an
-oath, he repeated his demand.</p>
-
-<p>Mr. Mason felt that the matter had gone far
-enough. He slowly rose in his seat; the countryman
-with astonishment saw what he had supposed
-to be a man of average height towering
-into gigantic proportions, and he became alarmed.</p>
-
-<p>“Hold on!” he shouted; “you needn’t unroll
-yourself any more. I’ll turn out myself.”</p>
-
-<p>This great lawyer, though so often opposed to
-Webster, was unvaryingly kind to him, and as
-Daniel himself testifies, was of infinite advantage
-to him, not only by his friendship, but by the
-many good lessons he taught him and the example
-he set him in the commencement of his career.</p>
-
-<p>The young man admired his elder professional
-brother, and says of him: “If there be in the
-country a stronger intellect, if there be a mind of
-more native resources, if there be a vision that
-sees quicker or sees deeper into whatever is intricate
-or whatsoever is profound, I must confess I
-have not known it.”</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_141" id="Page_141">[Pg 141]</a></span></p>
-
-
-
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-<h2><a name="CHAPTER_XIX" id="CHAPTER_XIX">CHAPTER XIX.</a><br />
-
-<small>DANIEL OVERCOMES A BRAMBLE.</small></h2>
-
-
-<p>There is no doubt that Mr. Webster derived
-considerable advantage from his association with
-his elder professional brother. He had adopted
-a style very common with young men, abounding
-in large words, and made his sentences longer
-than were needful. He observed that Mr. Mason,
-on the other hand, talked to the jury in a plain,
-conversational way, and cultivated simplicity of
-diction. Yet he was noted for his success in winning
-cases. Daniel was sensible enough to correct
-his fault and prune his too luxuriant style,
-very much to its improvement.</p>
-
-<p>No admirer of Daniel Webster should fail to
-read the volume of “Reminiscences” by his lifelong
-friend, Peter Harvey. His confidential relations
-with his distinguished friend make what he
-records not only entertaining but trustworthy and
-valuable. I shall venture to transfer to my pages
-from Mr. Harvey’s volume an account of two
-cases in which Mr. Webster was engaged during<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_142" id="Page_142">[Pg 142]</a></span>
-his residence in Portsmouth, with the suggestion
-that the entire volume will amply repay perusal.</p>
-
-<p>“Among Mr. Webster’s reminiscences of his
-professional career at Portsmouth, and of Jeremiah
-Mason’s connection with it, was one relating
-to a case in which a man named Bramble was implicated.
-Matthew Bramble, it appears, was a
-wealthy resident of Portsmouth, and, as the sequel
-proved, an unscrupulous man. His social position
-was good, but a feeling of distrust towards him
-existed in the community. It seems that Bramble
-had given to a man named Brown an annuity
-bond, agreeing to pay him one hundred dollars a
-year as long as he lived. This was to keep dominant
-a title to some real estate. Bramble had
-more than once tried to persuade Brown to take
-a ‘lump’ sum of money and cancel the bonds, but
-this Brown persistently declined to do, and in
-this he was supported by the advice of his friends.
-After in vain offering one thousand dollars, Bramble
-resorted to the following method of getting
-rid of his obligation. He was accustomed, when
-he paid the hundred dollars, to indorse it on the
-bond. The next chance he got, he indorsed, not
-one hundred dollars, but one thousand dollars,
-adding ‘in full consideration of and canceling
-this bond.’ Brown, who could not read or write,
-unsuspectingly signed his mark to this indorse<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_143" id="Page_143">[Pg 143]</a></span>ment.
-Bramble then coolly handed him back the
-bond, and of course said nothing of the matter.</p>
-
-<p>“When the year came round, an altercation
-took place between them.</p>
-
-<p>“Bramble said, ‘I owe you nothing; I paid
-you a thousand dollars, and it is certified on your
-bond.’</p>
-
-<p>“Brown was a poor shoemaker, simple-minded,
-truthful, weak, not capable of coping with this
-wily scamp. He was friendless, while Bramble
-was a rich man. Poor Brown did not know what
-to do. He had convinced his neighbors that he
-was right. He went to Jeremiah Mason, who
-told him he was Mr. Bramble’s lawyer. Mr.
-Mason had asked Bramble about the matter, and
-the latter had showed the bond, and Mr. Mason
-probably believed him. A friend then advised
-Brown to go to Mr. Webster; and after hearing
-his story, Mr. Webster was quite convinced of
-the truth of Brown’s statement. He had no confidence
-in Bramble. In relating the story, he
-said to me: ‘I knew nothing positively against
-Bramble, but something impressed me that he
-was not a man of honor. I was at once satisfied
-that he had committed this fraud upon Brown,
-and I told the latter that I would sue Bramble
-for the annuity. He said he had nothing to give
-me in payment. I said I wanted nothing. I<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_144" id="Page_144">[Pg 144]</a></span>
-sent Bramble a letter, and he made his appearance
-in my office.</p>
-
-<p>“’“I should like to know,” he said sharply, “if
-you are going to take up a case of that kind in
-Portsmouth? It seems to me you don’t know on
-which side your bread is buttered.”</p>
-
-<p>“’“This man has come to me,” I replied, “without
-friends, and has told me a plain, straightforward
-story, and it sounds as if it were true. It
-is not a made-up story. I shall pursue this thing,
-and sue you, unless you settle it.”’</p>
-
-<p>“Bramble went to Mr. Mason, who afterwards
-said to Mr. Webster: ‘I think you have made a
-mistake. Bramble is a man of influence. It
-can’t be that the fellow tells the truth. Bramble
-would not do such a thing as that.’</p>
-
-<p>“Mr. Webster replied, ‘He has done just such
-a thing as that, and I shall try the suit.’</p>
-
-<p>“So the preliminary steps were taken, and the
-suit was brought. The case came on at Exeter in
-the Supreme Court, Judge Smith on the bench.
-It created great excitement. Bramble’s friends
-were incensed at the charge of forgery, and
-Brown, too, in his humble way, had his friends.
-Mr. Webster said: ‘I never in my life was more
-badly prepared for a case. There was no evidence
-for Brown, and what to do I did not know. But
-I had begun the suit, and was going to run for<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_145" id="Page_145">[Pg 145]</a></span>
-luck, perfectly satisfied that I was right. There
-were Bramble and his friends, with Mason; and
-poor Brown had only his counsel. And Mason
-began to sneer a little, saying, “That is a foolish
-case.”</p>
-
-<p>“’Well, a person named Lovejoy was then living
-in Portsmouth; and when there is a great
-deal of litigation, as there was in Portsmouth,
-and many towns in New Hampshire, there will
-always be one person of a kind not easily described—a
-shrewd man who is mixed up in all
-sorts of affairs. Lovejoy was a man of this kind,
-and was a witness in nearly all the cases ever tried
-in that section. He was an imperturbable witness,
-and never could be shaken in his testimony.
-Call Lovejoy, and he would swear that he was
-present on such an occasion, and he seemed to
-live by giving evidence in this way. I was getting
-a little anxious about the case. I was going
-to attempt to prove that Brown had been appealed
-to by Bramble for years to give up his
-bond, and take a sum of money, and that he had
-always stoutly refused, that he had no uses for
-money, and had never been in the receipt of
-money, and that he could not write, and was
-easily imposed upon. But although I felt that I
-was right, I began to fear that I should lose the
-case.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_146" id="Page_146">[Pg 146]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>“’A Portsmouth man who believed in Brown’s
-story came to me just before the case was called,
-and whispered in my ear, “I saw Lovejoy talking
-with Bramble just now in the entry, and he took
-a paper from him.”</p>
-
-<p>“’I thanked the man, told him that was a
-pretty important thing to know, and asked him to
-say nothing about it.</p>
-
-<p>“’In the course of the trial Mr. Mason called
-Lovejoy, and he took the oath. He went upon
-the stand and testified that some eight or ten
-months before he was in Brown’s shop, and that
-Brown mended his shoes for him. As he was sitting
-in the shop, he naturally fell into conversation
-about the bond, and said to Brown, “Bramble
-wants to get back the bond. Why don’t you
-sell it to him?” “Oh,” said Brown, “I have. He
-wanted me to do it, and as life is uncertain, I
-thought I might as well take the thousand dollars.”
-He went on to testify that <em>the said Brown</em>
-told him so and so, and when he expressed himself
-in that way I knew he was being prompted
-from a written paper. The expression was an
-unnatural one for a man to use in ordinary conversation.
-It occurred to me in an instant that
-Bramble had given Lovejoy a paper, on which
-was set down what he wanted him to testify.
-There sat Mason, full of assurance, and for a<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_147" id="Page_147">[Pg 147]</a></span>
-moment I hesitated. Now, I thought, I will
-“make a spoon or spoil a horn.”</p>
-
-<p>“’I took the pen from behind my ear, drew
-myself up, and marched outside the bar to the witness
-stand.” Sir!” I exclaimed to Lovejoy, “give
-me the paper from which you are testifying!”</p>
-
-<p>“’In an instant he pulled it out of his pocket,
-but before he had got it quite out he hesitated
-and attempted to put it back. I seized it in
-triumph. There was his testimony in Bramble’s
-handwriting! Mr. Mason got up and claimed
-the protection of the court. Judge Smith inquired
-the meaning of this proceeding.</p>
-
-<p>“’I said: “Providence protects the innocent
-when they are friendless. I think I could satisfy
-the court and my learned brother who, of course,
-was ignorant of this man’s conduct, that I hold in
-Mr. Bramble’s handwriting the testimony of the
-very respectable witness who is on the stand.”</p>
-
-<p>“’The court adjourned, and I had nothing
-further to do. Mason told his client that he had
-better settle the affair as quickly as possible.
-Bramble came to my office, and as he entered I
-said, “Don’t you come in here! I don’t want
-any thieves in my office.”</p>
-
-<p>“’“Do whatever you please with me, Mr.
-Webster,” he replied. “I will do whatever you
-say.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_148" id="Page_148">[Pg 148]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>“’“I will do nothing without witnesses. We
-must arrange this matter.”</p>
-
-<p>“’I consulted Mr. Mason, and he said he did
-not care how I settled it. So I told Bramble
-that in the first place there must be a new life-bond
-for one hundred dollars a year, and ample
-security for its payment, and that he must also
-pay Brown five hundred dollars and my fees,
-which I should charge pretty roundly. To all
-this he assented and thus the case ended.’”</p>
-
-<p>Mr. Webster’s professional brothers were very
-much puzzled to account for his knowing that
-Lovejoy had the paper in his pocket, and it was
-not for a long time that he gratified their curiosity
-and revealed the secret.</p>
-
-<p>My young readers will agree with me that
-Bramble was a contemptible fellow, and that the
-young lawyer, in revealing and defeating his
-meanness, did an important service not only to
-his client but to the cause of justice, which is
-often defeated by the very means that should
-secure it. In many cases lawyers lend themselves
-to the service of clients whose iniquity they
-have good reason to suspect. There is no nobler
-profession than that of law when it is invoked to
-redress grievances and defeat the designs of the
-wicked; but, as Mr. Webster himself has said,
-“The evil is, that an accursed thirst for money<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_149" id="Page_149">[Pg 149]</a></span>
-violates everything. We cannot study, because
-we must pettifog. We learn the low recourses
-of attorneyism when we should, learn the conceptions,
-the reasonings and the opinions of Cicero
-and Murray. The love of fame is extinguished,
-every ardent wish for knowledge repressed, conscience
-put in jeopardy, and the best feelings of
-the heart indurated by the mean, money-catching,
-abominable practices which cover with disgrace
-a part of the modern practitioners of the law.”</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_150" id="Page_150">[Pg 150]</a></span></p>
-
-
-
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-<h2><a name="CHAPTER_XX" id="CHAPTER_XX">CHAPTER XX.</a><br />
-
-<small>“THE LITTLE BLACK STABLE-BOY.”</small></h2>
-
-
-<p>I am tempted to detail another case in which
-the young lawyer was able to do an important
-service to an acquaintance who had known him
-in his boyhood.</p>
-
-<p>In Grafton County lived a teamster named
-John Greenough, who was in the habit of making
-periodical trips to and from Boston with a load
-of goods. One day, when a mile or two distant
-from the house of Daniel’s father, his wagon was
-mired, owing to the size of his load and the state
-of the roads. He found that he could not continue
-his journey without help, and sent to the
-house of Judge Webster to borrow a span of
-horses.</p>
-
-<p>“Dan,” said the Judge, “take the horses and
-help Mr. Greenough out of his trouble.”</p>
-
-<p>The boy was roughly dressed like an ordinary
-farm-boy of that time, his head being surmounted
-by a ragged straw hat. He at once obeyed his
-father and gave the teamster the assistance which
-he so urgently required.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_151" id="Page_151">[Pg 151]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>The teamster thanked him for his assistance
-and drove on, giving little thought to the boy, or
-dreaming that the time would come when Dan
-would help him out of a worse scrape.</p>
-
-<p>Years passed and the farm-boy became a lawyer,
-but Greenough had lost track of him, and
-supposed he was still at work on his father’s farm.</p>
-
-<p>He was a poor man, owning a farm and little
-else. But a question arose as to his title to the
-farm. Suit was brought against him, and his
-whole property was at stake. He secured legal
-assistance, his lawyer being Moses P. Payson, of
-Bath. Mr. Payson thought he ought to have
-help, as the case was an important one, and suggested
-it to his client. The latter agreed, and
-Mr. Payson made his selection.</p>
-
-<p>Soon after, in an interview with Mr. Payson,
-Greenough inquired, “What lawyer have you
-hired to help you?”</p>
-
-<p>“Mr. Webster,” was the reply.</p>
-
-<p>“Webster, Webster!” repeated Greenough;
-“I don’t know any lawyer of that name. Is he
-from Boston?”</p>
-
-<p>“Oh, no; he came from your neighborhood,”
-was the reply. “It is Daniel Webster, the son
-of old Ebenezer Webster, of Salisbury.”</p>
-
-<p>“What!” exclaimed the teamster in dismay;
-“that little black stable-boy that once brought<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_152" id="Page_152">[Pg 152]</a></span>
-me some horses! Then I think we might as well
-give up the case. Can’t you get somebody else?”</p>
-
-<p>“No; the trial cannot be postponed. We must
-take our chances and make the best of it.”</p>
-
-<p>The teamster went home greatly depressed.
-He remembered the rough looking farm-boy in
-his rustic garb and old straw hat, and it seemed
-ridiculous that a good lawyer could have been
-made out of such unpromising materials. He was
-not the first man who had been misled by appearances.
-He was yet to learn that a poor boy may
-become an able lawyer. Of course the case must
-go on, but he looked forward to the result with
-little hope. He would lose his little farm he felt
-sure, and in his declining years be cast adrift
-penniless and destitute.</p>
-
-<p>When the day of trial came the teamster was
-in attendance, but he looked sad and depressed.
-Mr. Payson made the opening speech, and the
-trial proceeded. Mr. Webster was to make the
-closing argument.</p>
-
-<p>When he rose to speak Greenough looked at
-him with some curiosity. Yes, it was black Dan,
-a young man now, but as swarthy, though better
-dressed than the boy who had brought him the
-span of horses to help his wagon out of the mire.</p>
-
-<p>“What can he do?” thought the teamster, not
-without contempt.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_153" id="Page_153">[Pg 153]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>Daniel began to speak, and soon warmed to
-his work. He seemed thoroughly master of the
-case, and as he proceeded the teamster was surprised,
-and finally absorbed in his words. He
-drew nearer and drank in every word that fell
-from the lips of the “little black stable-boy,” as
-he had recently termed him.</p>
-
-<p>The jury were no less interested, and when the
-plea closed it was clear how they would render
-their verdict.</p>
-
-<p>Mr. Payson approached his client, and said
-with a smile, “Well, Mr. Greenough, what do
-you think of him now?”</p>
-
-<p>“Think!” exclaimed the teamster. “Why, I
-think he is an angel sent from heaven to save
-me from ruin, and my wife and children from
-misery.”</p>
-
-<p>The case was won, and Greenough returned
-home happy that his little farm would not be
-taken from him.</p>
-
-<p>Many lawyers aspire to the judicial office as the
-crowning professional dignity which they may
-wear with pride. But some of the greatest lawyers
-are not fitted for that office. They are born
-advocates, and the more brilliant they are the less,
-perhaps, do they possess that fair and even judgment
-which is requisite in a judge. Daniel Webster
-understood that his talents were not of a<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_154" id="Page_154">[Pg 154]</a></span>
-judicial character. At a later day (in 1840) he
-wrote to a friend as follows: “For my own
-part, I never could be a judge. There never was
-a time when I would have taken the office of chief
-justice of the United States or any other judicial
-station. I believe the truth may be that I
-have mixed so much study of politics with my
-study of law that, though I have some respect
-for myself as an advocate, and some estimate of
-my knowledge of general principles, yet I am not
-confident of possessing all the accuracy and precision
-of knowledge which the bench requires.”</p>
-
-<p>For nearly nine years Daniel Webster practiced
-law in Portsmouth. He could not have selected
-a more prominent place in New Hampshire; but
-the time came when he felt that for many reasons
-he should seek a larger field. One reason, which
-deservedly carried weight, was, that in a small
-town his income must necessarily be small. During
-these years of busy activity he never received
-in fees more than two thousand dollars a year.
-Fees were small then compared with what they
-are now, when lawyers by no means distinguished
-often charge more for their services in a
-single case than young Webster’s entire yearly
-income at that time.</p>
-
-<p>When the time came for removal the young
-lawyer hesitated between Boston, Albany and<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_155" id="Page_155">[Pg 155]</a></span>
-New York, but finally decided in favor of the
-first place. Of his removal we shall have occasion
-to speak further presently. Before doing so
-it is well to say that these nine years, though they
-brought Mr. Webster but little money, did a
-great deal for him in other ways. He was not
-employed in any great cases, or any memorable
-trials, though he and Jeremiah Mason were employed
-in the most important cases which came
-before the New Hampshire courts. Generally
-they were opposed to each other, and in his older
-professional compeer Daniel found a foeman
-worthy of his steel. He always had to do his
-best when Mason was engaged on the other side.
-That he fully appreciated Mr. Mason’s ability is
-evident from his tribute to him paid in a conversation
-with another eminent rival, Rufus
-Choate.</p>
-
-<p>“I have known Jeremiah Mason,” he said,
-“longer than I have known any other eminent
-man. He was the first man of distinction in
-the law whom I knew, and when I first became
-acquainted with him he was in full practice. I
-knew that generation of lawyers as a younger
-man knows those who are his superiors in age—by
-tradition, reputation and hearsay, and by
-occasionally being present and hearing their efforts.
-In this way I knew Luther Martin, Ed<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_156" id="Page_156">[Pg 156]</a></span>mund
-Randolph, Goodloe Hart, and all those
-great lights of the law; and by the way, I think,
-on the whole, that was an abler bar than the
-present one—of course with some brilliant exceptions.
-Of the present bar of the United
-States I think I am able to form a pretty fair
-opinion, having an intimate personal knowledge
-of them in the local and federal courts; and this
-I can say, that I regard Jeremiah Mason as eminently
-superior to any other lawyer whom I ever
-met. I should rather with my own experience
-(and I have had some pretty tough experience
-with him) meet them all combined in a case, than
-to meet him alone and single-handed. He was
-the keenest lawyer I ever met or read about. If
-a man had Jeremiah Mason and he did not get
-his case, no human ingenuity or learning could
-get it. He drew from a very deep fountain.
-Yes, I should think he did,” added Mr. Webster,
-smiling, “from his great height.”</p>
-
-<p>The young reader will remember that Mr.
-Mason was six feet seven inches in height.</p>
-
-<p>It is always of great service when a young man
-is compelled at all times to do his best. Daniel
-could not oppose such a lawyer as he describes
-Mr. Mason without calling forth all his resources.
-It happened, therefore, that the nine years he
-spent in Portsmouth were by no means wasted,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_157" id="Page_157">[Pg 157]</a></span>
-but contributed to develop and enlarge his powers,
-and provide him with resources which were
-to be of service to him in the broader and more
-conspicuous field in which he was soon to exercise
-his powers.</p>
-
-<p>Furthermore, during these nine years he first
-entered the arena where he was to gather unfading
-laurels, and establish his reputation not only as a
-great lawyer, but one of the foremost statesmen
-of any age.</p>
-
-<p>I allude to his election to Congress, in which
-he took his seat for the first time on the 24th of
-May, 1813, as a Representative from New Hampshire.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_158" id="Page_158">[Pg 158]</a></span></p>
-
-
-
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-<h2><a name="CHAPTER_XXI" id="CHAPTER_XXI">CHAPTER XXI.</a><br />
-
-<small>WHY DANIEL WAS SENT TO CONGRESS.</small></h2>
-
-
-<p>Even in his Sophomore year at college Daniel
-had taken a considerable interest in public affairs,
-as might readily be shown by extracts from his
-private correspondence. This interest continued
-after he entered upon the practice of the law, but
-up to the period of his election to Congress he
-had never filled a public office. It is generally
-the case with our public men that they serve one
-or more preliminary terms in one or both
-branches of the State Legislature, thus obtaining
-a practical knowledge of parliamentary proceedings.
-This was not the case with Mr. Webster.
-His public career would probably have been still
-further postponed but for the unfortunate state
-of our relations with England and France for
-some years preceding the war of 1812.</p>
-
-<p>I can only allude very briefly to the causes
-which had almost annihilated our commerce and
-paralyzed our prosperity. Both England and
-France had been guilty of aggressions upon our<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_159" id="Page_159">[Pg 159]</a></span>
-commercial rights, and the former government
-especially had excited indignation by its pretended
-right to search American vessels, for British
-seamen and deserters. This was intensified
-by the retaliatory order of Napoleon, issued Dec.
-17, 1807, known as the Milan Décrets, in accordance
-with which every vessel, of whatever
-nationality, that submitted to be searched, forfeited
-its neutral character, and even neutral vessels
-sailing between British ports were declared
-lawful prizes. Thus America was between two
-fires, and there seemed to be small chance of escape
-for any. Moreover, Great Britain interdicted
-all trade by neutrals between ports not
-friendly to her, and the United States was one of
-the chief sufferers from the extraordinary assumptions
-of the two hostile powers.</p>
-
-<p>To save our vessels from depredation President
-Jefferson recommended what is known as the
-Embargo, which prevented the departure of our
-vessels from our own ports, and thus of course
-suspended our commercial relations with the rest
-of the world. The Embargo was never a popular
-measure, and its effects were felt to be widely
-injurious. I do not propose to discuss the question,
-but merely to state that in 1808 Mr. Webster
-published a pamphlet upon the Embargo,
-and, as his biographer claims, this must be re<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_160" id="Page_160">[Pg 160]</a></span>garded
-as his first appearance in a public character.
-I must refer such of my readers as desire
-more fully to understand the condition of public
-affairs and the part that the young lawyer took
-therein to the first volume of Mr. Curtis’s memoir.</p>
-
-<p>It may be stated here, however, to explain the
-special interest which he felt in the matter, that
-Portsmouth, as a seaport, was largely affected
-by the suspension of American commerce, and
-its citizens felt an interest easily explained in
-what was so disastrous to their business prosperity.</p>
-
-<p>On the Fourth of July, 1812, Mr. Webster
-delivered by invitation an oration before the
-“Washington Benevolent Society,” of Portsmouth,
-in which he discussed in a vigorous way
-the policy of the government, which he did not
-approve. Sixteen days before Congress had declared
-war against England. To this war Mr.
-Webster was opposed. Whatever grievances the
-government may have suffered from England, he
-contended that there was “still more abundant
-cause of war against France.” Moreover America
-was not prepared for war. The navy had been
-suffered to fall into neglect during Jefferson’s
-administration, until it was utterly insufficient
-for the defense of our coasts and harbors.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_161" id="Page_161">[Pg 161]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>On this point he says: “If the plan of Washington
-had been pursued, and our navy had been
-suffered to grow with the growth of our commerce
-and navigation, what a blow might at
-this moment be struck, and what protection
-yielded, surrounded, as our commerce now is,
-with all the dangers of sudden war! Even as it
-is, all our immediate hopes of glory or conquest,
-all expectation of events that shall gratify the
-pride or spirit of the nation, rest on the gallantry
-of that little remnant of a navy that has now
-gone forth, like lightning, at the beck of Government,
-to scour the seas.</p>
-
-<p>“It will not be a bright page in our history
-which relates the total abandonment of all provision
-for naval defense by the successors of
-Washington. Not to speak of policy and expediency,
-it will do no credit to the national faith,
-stipulated and plighted as it was to that object
-in every way that could make the engagement
-solemn and obligatory. So long as our commerce
-remains unprotected, and our coasts and harbors
-undefended by naval and maritime means, the essential
-objects of the Union remain unanswered,
-and the just expectation of those who assented
-to it, unanswered.</p>
-
-<p>“A part of our navy has been suffered to go
-to entire decay; another part has been passed,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_162" id="Page_162">[Pg 162]</a></span>
-like an article of useless lumber, under the hammer
-of the auctioneer. As if the millennium
-had already commenced, our politicians have
-beaten their swords into plowshares. They have
-actually bargained away in the market essential
-means of national defense, and carried the product
-to the Treasury. Without loss by accident
-or by enemies the second commercial nation in
-the world is reduced to the limitation of being
-unable to assert the sovereignty of its own seas,
-or to protect its navigation in sight of its own
-shores. What war and the waves have sometimes
-done for others, we have done for ourselves. We
-have taken the destruction of our marine out of
-the power of fortune, and richly achieved it by
-our own counsels.”</p>
-
-<p>This address made a profound impression,
-voicing as it did the general public feeling in New
-Hampshire on the subjects of which it treated. It
-led to an assembly of the people of Rockingham
-County a few weeks later, called to prepare a
-memorial to the President protesting against the
-war. To this convention Mr. Webster was appointed
-a delegate, and it was he who was selected
-to draft what has been since known as the
-“Rockingham Memorial.”</p>
-
-<p>One of the most noteworthy passages in this
-memorial—noteworthy because it is an early<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_163" id="Page_163">[Pg 163]</a></span>
-expression of his devotion to the Union—I find
-quoted by Mr. Curtis, and I shall follow his lead
-in transferring it to my pages.</p>
-
-<p>“We are, sir, from principle and habit attached
-to the Union of these States. But our
-attachment is to the substance, and not to the
-form. It is to the good which this Union is capable
-of producing, and not to the evil which is
-suffered unnaturally to grow out of it. If the
-time should ever arrive when this Union shall be
-holden together by nothing but the authority of
-law; when its incorporating, vital principles shall
-become extinct; when its principal exercises shall
-consist in acts of power and authority, not of
-protection and beneficence; when it shall lose the
-strong bond which it hath hitherto had in the
-public affections; and when, consequently, we
-shall be one, not in interest and mutual regard,
-but in name and form only—we, sir, shall look on
-that hour as the closing scene of our country’s
-prosperity.</p>
-
-<p>“We shrink from the separation of the States
-as an event fraught with incalculable evils, and it
-is among our strongest objections to the present
-course of measures that they have, in our
-opinion, a very dangerous and alarming bearing
-on such an event. If a separation of the States
-ever should take place, it will be on some occa<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_164" id="Page_164">[Pg 164]</a></span>sion
-when one portion of the country undertakes
-to control, to regulate and to sacrifice the interest
-of another; when a small and heated majority
-in the Government, taking counsel of
-their passions, and not of their reason, contemptuously
-disregarding the interests and perhaps
-stopping the mouths of a large and respectable
-minority, shall by hasty, rash and ruinious measures,
-threaten to destroy essential rights, and lay
-waste the most important interests.</p>
-
-<p>“It shall be our most fervent supplication to
-Heaven to avert both the event and the occasion;
-and the Government may be assured that the tie
-that binds us to the Union will never be broken
-by us.”</p>
-
-<p>Even my young readers will be struck by the
-judicial calmness, the utter absence of heated
-partisanship, which mark the extracts I have
-made, and they will recall the passage well known
-to every schoolboy—the grand closing passage
-of the reply to Hayne.</p>
-
-<p>As regards style it will be seen that, though
-yet a young man, Mr. Webster had made a very
-marked advance on the Fourth of July address
-which he delivered while yet a college-student.
-He was but thirty years old when the memorial
-was drafted, and in dignified simplicity and elevation
-of tone it was worthy of his later days.<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_165" id="Page_165">[Pg 165]</a></span>
-The young lawyer, whose time had hitherto been
-employed upon cases of trifling moment in a
-country town, had been ripening his powers, and
-expanding into the intellectual proportions of a
-statesman. It was evident at any rate that his
-neighbors thought so, for he was nominated as a
-Representative to the Thirteenth Congress, in due
-time elected, and, as has already been stated, he
-first took his seat at a special session called by the
-President on the 24th of May, 1813.</p>
-
-<p>It was in this Congress that Daniel Webster
-made the acquaintance of two eminent men, with
-whose names his own is now most frequently associated—Henry
-Clay, of Kentucky, and John
-C. Calhoun, of South Carolina.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_166" id="Page_166">[Pg 166]</a></span></p>
-
-
-
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-<h2><a name="CHAPTER_XXII" id="CHAPTER_XXII">CHAPTER XXII.</a><br />
-
-<small>MR. WEBSTER AS A MEMBER OF CONGRESS.</small></h2>
-
-
-<p>Before I proceed to speak of Mr. Webster’s
-Congressional career, I will make room for a professional
-anecdote, which carries with it an excellent
-lesson for my young readers.</p>
-
-<p>I find it in Harvey’s “Reminiscences,” already
-alluded to.</p>
-
-<p>“In the first years of his professional life a
-blacksmith called on him for advice respecting
-the title to a small estate bequeathed to him by
-his father. The terms of the will were peculiar,
-and the kind of estate transmitted was doubtful.
-An attempt had been made to annull the will.
-Mr. Webster examined the case, but was unable
-to give a definite opinion upon the matter for
-want of authorities. He looked through the law
-libraries of Mr. Mason and other legal gentlemen
-for authorities, but in vain. He ascertained what
-works he needed for consultation, and ordered
-them from Boston at an expense of fifty dollars.
-He spent the leisure hours of some weeks in
-going through them. He successfully argued<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_167" id="Page_167">[Pg 167]</a></span>
-the case when it came on for trial, and it was
-decided in his favor.</p>
-
-<p>“The blacksmith was in ecstasies, for his little
-all had been at stake. He called for his attorney’s
-bill. Mr. Webster, knowing his poverty,
-charged him only fifteen dollars, intending to
-suffer the loss of money paid out, and to lose the
-time expended in securing a verdict. Years
-passed away, and the case was forgotten, but not
-the treasured knowledge by which it was won.
-On one of his journeys to Washington Mr. Webster
-spent a few days in New York City. While
-he was there Aaron Burr waited on him for advice
-in a very important case pending in the
-State court. He told him the facts on which it
-was founded. Mr. Webster saw in a moment
-that it was an exact counterpart to the blacksmith’s
-will case. On being asked if he could
-state the law applicable to it he at once replied
-that he could.</p>
-
-<p>“He proceeded to quote decisions bearing upon
-the case, going back to the time of Charles II.
-As he went on with his array of principles and
-authorities, all cited with the precision and order
-of a table of contents, Mr. Burr arose in astonishment
-and asked with some warmth,</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_168" id="Page_168">[Pg 168]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>“‘Mr. Webster, have you been consulted before
-in this case?’</p>
-
-<p>“‘Most certainly not,’ he replied. ‘I never
-heard of your case till this evening.’</p>
-
-<p>“‘Very well,’ said Mr. Burr; ‘proceed.’</p>
-
-<p>“Mr. Webster concluded the rehearsal of his
-authorities, and received from Mr. Burr the
-warmest praise of his profound knowledge of the
-law, and a fee large enough to remunerate him
-for all the time and trouble spent on the blacksmith’s
-case.”</p>
-
-<p>I have recorded this anecdote, partly to show
-the tenacity of Mr. Webster’s memory, which,
-after a lapse of years, enabled him so exactly to
-repeat the authorities he had relied upon in an
-old case; partly, also, to show how thoroughly he
-was wont to prepare himself, even in cases where
-he could expect but a small fee. In this case,
-not only did he subsequently turn his knowledge
-to profitable account, but he lost nothing by the
-kindness of heart which prompted him to place
-his best powers at the service of an humble client.
-My young readers will find that knowledge never
-comes amiss, but, in the course of a long and
-sometimes of a short life, we are generally able to
-employ it for our advantage.</p>
-
-<p>I come back to Daniel Webster’s entrance upon
-Congressional duties.</p>
-
-<p>He had reached the age of thirty-one, while
-Henry Clay, who occupied the Speaker’s chair,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_169" id="Page_169">[Pg 169]</a></span>
-was five years older. Mr. Clay came forward
-much earlier in public life than his great rival.
-Though but thirty-six, he had twice been a member
-of the United States Senate, being in each
-case elected to serve the balance of an unexpired
-term. He had been a member of the Legislature
-of Kentucky, and Speaker of that body, and now
-he was serving, not for the first time, as Speaker
-of the U. S. House of Representatives. John C.
-Calhoun was the leading member of the House,
-and he as well as Mr. Clay favored the policy of
-the administration, both being supporters of the
-war. Other distinguished members there were,
-among them John McLean, of Ohio; Charles J.
-Ingersoll, of Pennsylvania; William Gaston, of
-North Carolina, and Felix Grundy, of Tennessee.</p>
-
-<p>Though Mr. Webster was a new member he
-was placed upon the Committee on Foreign Relations,
-at that time of course the most important
-position which could have been assigned him.
-This may be inferred from the names of his fellow
-members. He found himself associated with
-Calhoun, Grundy, Jackson, Fish and Ingersoll.
-He was, as I have stated, not in favor of the war,
-but since it had been inaugurated he took the
-ground that it should be vigorously prosecuted.
-He did not long remain silent, but took his stand<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_170" id="Page_170">[Pg 170]</a></span>
-both in the committee and in the House as one
-who thought the war inexpedient.</p>
-
-<p>It does not fall within the scope of this volume
-to detail the steps which the young member took
-in order to impress his views upon his fellow
-members; but, as a specimen of his oratory at
-that time, and because it will explain them sufficiently,
-I quote from a speech made by him in
-the regular session during the year 1814:</p>
-
-<p>“The humble aid which it would be in my
-power to render to measures of Government shall
-be given cheerfully, if Government will pursue
-measures which I can conscientiously support.
-Badly as I think of the original grounds of the
-war, as well as of the manner in which it has
-hitherto been conducted, if even now, failing in
-an honest and sincere attempt to procure just
-and honorable peace, it will return to measures
-of defence and protection such as reason and
-common sense and the public opinion all call for,
-my vote shall not be withholden from the means.
-Give up your futile object of invasion. Extinguish
-the fires that blaze on your inland frontier.
-Establish perfect safety and defense there by
-adequate force. Let every man that sleeps on
-your soil sleep in security. Stop the blood that
-flows from the veins of unarmed yeomanry and
-women and children. Give to the living time to<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_171" id="Page_171">[Pg 171]</a></span>
-bury and lament their dead in the quietness of
-private sorrow.</p>
-
-<p>“Having performed this work of beneficence
-and mercy on your inland border, turn and look
-with the eye of justice and compassion on your
-vast population along the coast. Unclinch the
-iron grasp of your Embargo. Take measures for
-that end before another sun sets upon you. With
-all the war of the enemy on your commerce, if
-you would cease to war on it yourselves you
-would still have some commerce. Apply that
-revenue to the augmentation of your navy. That
-navy will in turn protect your commerce. Let
-it no longer be said that not one ship of force,
-built by your hands, yet floats upon the ocean.</p>
-
-<p>“Turn the current of your efforts into the
-channel which national sentiment has already
-worn broad and deep to receive it. A naval
-force, competent to defend your coast against
-considerable armaments, to convoy your trade,
-and perhaps raise the blockade of your rivers, is
-not a chimera. It may be realized. If, then,
-the war must be continued, go to the ocean. If
-you are seriously contending for maritime rights,
-go to the theater where alone those rights can be
-defended. Thither every indication of your fortune
-points you. There the united wishes and
-exertions of the nation will go with you. Even<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_172" id="Page_172">[Pg 172]</a></span>
-our party divisions, acrimonious as they are, cease
-at the water’s edge. They are lost in attachment
-to national character on the element where that
-character is made respectable. In protecting
-naval interests by naval means, you will arm
-yourselves with the whole power of national sentiment,
-and may command the whole abundance
-of the national resources. In time you may enable
-yourselves to redress injuries in the place
-where they may be offered, and, if need be, to
-accompany your own flag throughout the world
-with the protection of your own cannon.”</p>
-
-<p>My young reader, without knowing much about
-the matter at issue, will nevertheless be struck
-with the statesmanlike character of these utterances.
-It is not often that a new member of
-Congress is able to discuss public matters with
-such fullness of knowledge, and in a tone of such
-dignity and elevation of sentiment. His fellow
-legislators were not long in learning that the new
-member from New Hampshire was no raw novice,
-but a publicist of remarkable ability, knowledge,
-and a trained orator. In a discussion which
-sprang up between Mr. Webster and Mr. Calhoun,
-the conceded leader of the House, the
-honors were at least divided, if Mr. Webster did
-not win the larger portion.</p>
-
-<p>While the young man was thus coming into<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_173" id="Page_173">[Pg 173]</a></span>
-national prominence his residence in Washington
-helped him in a professional way. He began to
-practice in the Supreme Court of the United
-States, being employed in several prize cases.
-Judge Marshall was at that time chief justice,
-and of him the young lawyer formed an exalted
-opinion. “I have never seen a man,” he writes,
-“of whose intellect I had a higher opinion.”</p>
-
-<p>On the 18th of April, 1814, the session of Congress
-terminated, and Mr. Webster undertook the
-long and toilsome journey from Washington to
-his New Hampshire home. It was not the same
-home which he left when he was called a year
-earlier to attend the special session. His house
-and library were destroyed by fire, and though
-the loss was but six thousand dollars, it was a
-severe set-back to a lawyer whose professional income
-had never exceeded two thousand dollars.
-He bore the loss, however, with equanimity, since
-it involved only a loss of money. His talent and
-education remained, and these were to earn him
-hundreds of thousands of dollars in the years to
-come.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_174" id="Page_174">[Pg 174]</a></span></p>
-
-
-
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-<h2><a name="CHAPTER_XXIII" id="CHAPTER_XXIII">CHAPTER XXIII.</a><br />
-
-<small>JOHN RANDOLPH AND WILLIAM PINKNEY.</small></h2>
-
-
-<p>Mr. Webster served four years in Congress as
-a Representative from his native State. He had
-reached the age of thirty-one when he entered
-the public service, and therefore, though not the
-youngest, was among the youngest members of
-that important body. As we have seen, though
-without previous legislative experience, he advanced
-at once to a leading place and took prominent
-part in all the discussions of important
-questions, his opinions always carrying weight.
-He was opposed to the administration and its
-war policy, but he opposed it in no factious
-spirit.</p>
-
-<p>He distinguished himself particularly by his
-speeches on finance. When a bill was proposed
-to establish a national bank, with a capital of fifty
-millions of dollars, of which only four millions
-was to be specie, and the balance to consist of
-Government stocks, then very much depreciated,
-Mr. Webster rode forty miles on horseback from<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_175" id="Page_175">[Pg 175]</a></span>
-Baltimore to Washington, in order to defeat what
-he regarded as a scheme to create an irredeemable
-paper currency, fraught with widespread
-mischief to the country. The vigorous speech
-which he made defeated the bill. It is interesting
-to record that Mr. Calhoun, when the vote
-was announced, walked across the floor of the
-House to where Mr. Webster stood, and holding
-out both hands to him, told him that he should
-rely upon his help to prepare a new bill of
-a proper character. When this assurance was
-given Mr. Calhoun’s feelings were so stirred that
-he burst into tears, so deeply did he feel the importance
-of some aid for the Government, which
-he felt with Mr. Webster’s co-operation might be
-secured.</p>
-
-<p>It may be stated here that these great men cherished
-for each other mutual respect and friendship,
-widely as they differed on some points. The
-Senator from South Carolina showed this in a notable
-manner when he arose from his deathbed
-(his death followed in a few days), and sat in his
-place to listen to his great friend’s seventh of
-March speech, in 1850, looking a wan and spectral
-auditor from the next world.</p>
-
-<p>The battle for sound money which Mr. Webster
-fought then has been renewed in later years,
-as some of my young readers may be aware. In<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_176" id="Page_176">[Pg 176]</a></span>
-his speeches he showed a thorough mastery of the
-subject which he discussed. He showed the evils
-of a debased coin, a depreciated paper currency,
-and a depressed and falling public credit, and it
-is largely due to his efforts that the country
-emerged from its chaotic financial condition with
-as little injury as it did.</p>
-
-<p>I have spoken of Mr. Webster’s relations then
-and later to Mr. Calhoun. Among the members
-of the House representing Virginia was the
-famous John Randolph, of Roanoke, with whom
-it was difficult for any one to keep on good terms.
-He saw fit to take offense at something said by
-Mr. Webster, and sent him a challenge. Webster
-was never charged by any man with physical
-cowardice, but he thoroughly despised the practice
-of dueling. He was not to be coerced into
-fighting by any fear that cowardice would be imputed
-to him. This may seem to us a very trivial
-matter, but seventy years ago and even much
-later, it required considerable moral courage to
-refuse a challenge. I place on record, as likely
-to interest my readers, the letter in which Mr.
-Webster declined to give satisfaction in the manner
-demanded.</p>
-
-<p>“<span class="smcap">Sir</span>: For having declined to comply with
-your demand yesterday in the House for an explanation
-of words of a general nature used in<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_177" id="Page_177">[Pg 177]</a></span>
-debate, you now ‘demand of me that satisfaction
-which your insulted feelings require,’ and refer
-me to your friend, Mr.——, I presume, as he is
-the bearer of your note, for such arrangements as
-are usual.</p>
-
-<p>“This demand for explanation you, in my
-judgment, as a matter of right were not entitled
-to make on me, nor were the temper and style of
-your own reply to my objection to the sugar tax
-of a character to induce me to accord it as a matter
-of courtesy.</p>
-
-<p>“Neither can I, under the circumstances of the
-case, recognize in you a right to call me to the
-field to answer what you may please to consider
-an insult to your feelings.</p>
-
-<p>“It is unnecessary for me to state other and
-obvious considerations growing out of this case.
-It is enough that I do not feel myself bound at
-all times and under any circumstances to accept
-from any man who shall choose to risk his own
-life an invitation of this sort, although I shall be
-always prepared to repel in a suitable manner the
-aggression of any man who may presume upon
-such a refusal.</p>
-
-<p class="p10">
-“Your obedient servant,</p>
-<p class="p20">
-“<span class="smcap">Daniel Webster</span>.”
-</p>
-
-<p>Mr. Randolph did not press the matter nor did
-he presume upon the refusal, but the matter was<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_178" id="Page_178">[Pg 178]</a></span>
-adjusted amicably. Nearly forty years later a
-similar reply to a challenge was sent by a later
-Senator from Massachusetts, Henry Wilson, and
-in both cases the resolute character of the men
-was so well known that no one dared to taunt
-the writer with cowardice.</p>
-
-<p>While upon the subject of physical courage I
-am tempted to transcribe from Mr. Harvey’s
-interesting volume an anecdote in which the
-famous lawyer, William Pinkney, is prominently
-mentioned. In answer to the question whether
-he ever carried pistols, Mr. Webster answered:</p>
-
-<p>“No, I never did. I always trusted to my
-strong arm, and I do not believe in pistols.
-There were some Southern men whose blood was
-hot and who got very much excited in debate,
-and I used myself to get excited, but I never resorted
-to any such extremity as the use of pistols.</p>
-
-<p>“The nearest I ever came to a downright row
-was with Mr. William Pinkney. Mr. Pinkney
-was the acknowledged head and leader of the
-American bar. He was the great practitioner at
-Washington when I was admitted to practice in
-the courts there. I found Mr. Pinkney by universal
-concession the very head of the bar—a
-lawyer of extraordinary accomplishments and
-withal a very wonderful man. But with all that
-there was something about him that was very<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_179" id="Page_179">[Pg 179]</a></span>
-small. He did things that one would hardly
-think it possible that a gentleman of his breeding
-and culture and great weight as a lawyer could do.</p>
-
-<p>“He was a very vain man. One saw it in
-every motion he made. When he came into
-court he was dressed in the very extreme of
-fashion—almost like a dandy. He would wear
-into the court-room his white gloves that had
-been put on fresh that morning and that he
-never put on again. He usually rode from his
-house to the Capitol on horseback, and his overalls
-were taken off and given to his servant who
-attended him. Pinkney showed in his whole appearance
-that he considered himself the great
-man of that arena, and that he expected deference
-to be paid to him as the acknowledged leader of
-the bar. He had a great many satellites—men
-of course much less eminent than himself at the
-bar—who flattered him, and employed him to
-take their briefs and argue their cases, they doing
-the work and he receiving the greatest share of
-the pay. That was the position that Mr. Pinkney
-occupied when I entered the bar at Washington.</p>
-
-<p>“I was a lawyer who had my living to get, and
-I felt that although I should not argue my cases
-as well as he could, still, if my clients employed
-me they should have the best ability I had to<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_180" id="Page_180">[Pg 180]</a></span>
-give them, and I should do the work myself. I
-did not propose to practice law in the Supreme
-Court by proxy. I think that in some pretty
-important cases I had Mr. Pinkney rather expected
-that I should fall into the current of his
-admirers and share my fees with him. This I
-utterly refused to do.</p>
-
-<p>“In some important case (I have forgotten
-what the case was) Mr. Pinkney was employed
-to argue it against me. I was going to argue it
-for my client myself. I had felt that on several
-occasions his manner was, to say the least, very
-annoying and aggravating. My intercourse with
-him, so far as I had any, was always marked with
-great courtesy and deference. I regarded him as
-the leader of the American bar; he had that reputation
-and justly. He was a very great lawyer.
-On the occasion to which I refer, in some colloquial
-discussion upon various minor points of the
-case he treated me with contempt. He pooh-poohed,
-as much as to say it was not worth while
-to argue a point that I did not know anything
-about, that I was no lawyer. I think he spoke
-of ‘the gentleman from New Hampshire.’ At
-any rate, it was a thing that everybody in the
-court-house, including the judges, could not fail
-to observe. Chief Justice Marshall himself was
-pained by it. It was very hard for me to restrain<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_181" id="Page_181">[Pg 181]</a></span>
-my temper and keep cool, but I did so, knowing
-in what presence I stood. I think he construed
-my apparent humility into a want of what he
-would call spirit in resisting, and as a sort of acquiescence
-in his rule.</p>
-
-<p>“However the incident passed, the case was
-not finished when the hour for adjournment
-came, and the court adjourned until the next
-morning.</p>
-
-<p>“Mr. Pinkney took his whip and gloves, threw
-his cloak over his arm, and began to saunter
-away.</p>
-
-<p>“I went up to him and said very calmly, ‘Can
-I see you alone in one of the lobbies?’</p>
-
-<p>“He replied, ‘Certainly.’ I suppose he thought
-I was going to beg his pardon and ask his assistance.
-We passed one of the anterooms of the
-Capitol. I looked into one of the grand jury
-rooms, rather remote from the main court-room.
-There was no one in it, and we entered. As we
-did so I looked at the door, and found that there
-was a key in the lock; and, unobserved by him,
-I turned the key and put it in my pocket. Mr.
-Pinkney seemed to be waiting in some astonishment.</p>
-
-<p>“I advanced towards him and said:<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_182" id="Page_182">[Pg 182]</a></span> ‘Mr.
-Pinkney, you grossly insulted me in the court-room,
-and not for the first time either. In deference
-to your position, and to the respect in
-which I hold the court, I did not answer you as
-I was tempted to do on the spot.’</p>
-
-<p>“He began to parley.</p>
-
-<p>“I continued. ‘You know you did; don’t add
-another sin to that; don’t deny it; you know
-you did it, and you know it was premeditated.
-It was deliberate; it was purposely done; and if
-you deny it, you state an untruth. Now,’ I
-went on, ‘I am here to say to you, once for all,
-that you must ask my pardon, and go into court
-to-morrow morning and repeat the apology, or
-else either you or I will go out of this room in a
-different condition from that in which we entered
-it.’</p>
-
-<p>“I was never more in earnest. He looked at
-me, and saw that my eyes were pretty dark and
-firm. He began to say something. I interrupted
-him.</p>
-
-<p>“‘No explanation,’ said I; ‘admit the fact,
-and take it back. I do not want another word
-from you except that. I will hear no explanation;
-nothing but that you admit it and recall it.’</p>
-
-<p>“He trembled like an aspen leaf. He again
-attempted to explain.</p>
-
-<p>“Said I,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_183" id="Page_183">[Pg 183]</a></span> ‘There is no other course. I have
-the key in my pocket, and you must apologize,
-or take what I give you.’</p>
-
-<p>“At that he humbled down, and said to me:
-‘You are right, I am sorry; I did intend to bluff
-you; I regret it, and ask your pardon.’</p>
-
-<p>“‘Enough,’ I promptly replied. ‘Now, one
-promise before I open the door; and that is, that
-you will to-morrow state to the court that you
-have said things which wounded my feelings,
-and that you regret it.’</p>
-
-<p>“Pinkney replied, ‘I will do so.’</p>
-
-<p>“Then I unlocked the door, and passed out.</p>
-
-<p>“The next morning, when the court met, Mr.
-Pinkney at once rose, and stated to the court
-that a very unpleasant affair had occurred the
-morning before, as might have been observed by
-their honors; that his friend, Mr. Webster, had
-felt grieved at some things which had dropped
-from his lips; that his zeal for his client might
-have led him to say some things which he
-should not have said, and that he was sorry for
-having thus spoken.’</p>
-
-<p>“From that day,” adds Mr. Webster, “there
-was no man who treated me with so much respect
-and deference as Mr. William Pinkney.”</p>
-
-<p>I have recorded this anecdote that my young
-readers may understand clearly that the young
-lawyer was manly and self-respecting, and declined
-the method of satisfaction then in vogue
-from high and honorable motives.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_184" id="Page_184">[Pg 184]</a></span></p>
-
-
-
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-<h2><a name="CHAPTER_XXIV" id="CHAPTER_XXIV">CHAPTER XXIV.</a><br />
-
-<small>MR. WEBSTER IN BOSTON.</small></h2>
-
-
-<p>Before his second Congressional term had expired,
-Mr. Webster carried out a plan which was
-first suggested by the destruction of his house
-and library. His talents demanded a wider
-arena. Moreover, his growing family necessitated
-a style of living for which his professional
-income was insufficient. Happily as his life had
-flowed on in the chief town in his native State,
-he felt that he must seek a new residence. For
-a time he hesitated between Albany and Boston,
-but happily for the latter he decided in its favor,
-and in August, 1816, he removed thither with
-his family, fixing his home in a house on Mt.
-Vernon Street, but a few rods from the State
-House.</p>
-
-<p>It mattered not where Daniel Webster might
-choose to locate himself, he was sure to take at
-once a leading position both as a lawyer and a
-man. He was now thirty-four years old. He
-had outlived his early delicacy, and began to as<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_185" id="Page_185">[Pg 185]</a></span>sume
-that dignity and majesty of mein which
-made him everywhere a marked man. Appearances
-are oftentimes deceptive, but in his case it
-was not so. That outward majesty which has
-been quaintly described in the statement that
-“when Daniel Webster walked the streets of
-Boston he made the buildings look small,” was
-but the sign and manifestation of a corresponding
-intellectual greatness. By his removal New
-Hampshire lost her greatest son, and Boston
-gained its foremost citizen.</p>
-
-<p>His expectations of a largely increased professional
-income were fully realized. In Portsmouth
-his fees had never exceeded two thousand
-dollars per year. The third year after his removal
-his fee-book foots up over fifteen thousand
-dollars as the receipts of a single year, and
-this record is probably incomplete. His biographer,
-Mr. Curtis, says: “I am satisfied that
-his income, from 1818 until he again entered
-Congress in 1823, could not have been on an
-average less than $20,000 a year, though the
-customary fees of such counsel at that time were
-about one half of what they are now.” Now, for
-the first time, he was able to pay in full his
-father’s debts, which he had voluntarily assumed,
-declining to have his small estate thrown into
-bankruptcy.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_186" id="Page_186">[Pg 186]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>I shall have occasion, hereafter, to point out
-with regret the fact that his expenses increased
-even more rapidly than his income, and that
-he voluntarily incurred debts and pecuniary obligations
-which all his life long harassed him, and
-held him in an entirely unnecessary thraldom.
-On the subject of national finance Mr. Webster,
-as we have seen, held the soundest views; but in
-the management of his own finances, for the
-larger portion of his active life he displayed an
-incapacity to control his expenditures and confine
-them within his income which caused his
-best friends to grieve. In this respect, at any
-rate, I cannot present the hero whom we so
-deservedly admire as a model.</p>
-
-<p>The large increase in Mr. Webster’s income is
-sufficient to prove that he was employed in the
-most important cases. But fifteen years had
-elapsed since, as a raw graduate of a country
-college, he humbly sought an opportunity to
-study in the office of a well-known Boston lawyer.
-Now he took his place at the bar, and rapidly
-gained a much higher position than the man who
-had kindly extended to him a welcome. It is to
-the credit of Mr. Gore’s ability to read character
-and judge of ability that he foresaw and predicted
-all this when through his influence his student
-was led to decline the clerkship of a New Hamp<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_187" id="Page_187">[Pg 187]</a></span>shire
-court, which then would have filled the
-measure of his ambition.</p>
-
-<p>And how was all this gained? I can assure
-my young readers that no great lawyer, no great
-writer, no great member of any profession,
-lounges into greatness. Daniel Webster worked,
-and worked hard. He rose early, not only because
-it gave him an opportunity of doing considerable
-while he was fresh and elastic, but
-because he had a country boy’s love of nature.
-Whether in city or country, the early morning
-hours were dear to him. As Mr. Lee says,
-“He did a large amount of work before others
-were awake in the house, and in the evening he
-was ready for that sweet sleep which ‘God gives
-to his beloved.’”</p>
-
-<p>During the period which elapsed between his
-arrival in Boston and his return to Congress as
-a Representative of his adopted city his life was
-crowded, and he appeared in many notable cases.
-But there was one which merits special mention,
-because he was enabled to do a great service to
-the college where he had been educated, and
-prove himself in a signal manner a grateful and
-loyal son.</p>
-
-<p>Of the celebrated Dartmouth College case I
-do not consider it necessary for my present purpose
-to speak in detail. It is sufficient to say<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_188" id="Page_188">[Pg 188]</a></span>
-that it was menaced with a serious peril. The
-chartered rights of the college were threatened
-by legislative interference; nay, more, an act was
-passed, and pronounced valid by the courts of
-New Hampshire, which imperilled the usefulness
-and prosperity of the institution. The
-matter was carried before the Supreme Court of
-the United States, and Mr. Webster’s services
-were secured. The argument which he made on
-that occasion established his reputation as a great
-lawyer. The closing portion was listened to with
-absorbing interest. It was marked by deep feeling
-on the part of the speaker. It is as follows:</p>
-
-<p>“This, sir, is my case. It is the case not
-merely of that humble institution, it is the case
-of every college in our land; it is more, it is the
-case of every eleemosynary institution throughout
-our country—of all those great charities
-founded by the piety of our ancestors, to alleviate
-human misery, and scatter blessings along the
-pathway of life. It is more! It is, in some
-sense, the case of every man among us who has
-property of which he may stripped, for the question
-is simply this: ‘Shall our State Legislatures
-be allowed to take that which is not their own,
-to turn it from its original use, and apply it to
-such ends or purposes as they in their discretion
-shall see fit?’</p>
-
-<p>“Sir, you may destroy this little institution;<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_189" id="Page_189">[Pg 189]</a></span>
-it is weak; it is in your hands. I know it is one
-of the lesser lights in the literary horizon of our
-country. You may put it out. But if you do
-so, you must carry through your work! You
-must extinguish, one after another, all those
-greater lights of science which, for more than a
-century, have thrown their light over our land!</p>
-
-<p>“It is, sir, as I have said, a small college, and
-yet there are those who love it—”</p>
-
-<p>Here the orator was overcome by emotion.
-His lips quivered, and his eyes filled with tears.
-The effect was extraordinary. All who heard
-him, from Chief Justice Marshall to the humblest
-attendant, were borne away on the tide of
-emotion as he gave expression in a few broken
-words to the tenderness which he felt for his
-Alma Mater.</p>
-
-<p>When he recovered his composure, he continued
-in deep, thrilling tones, “Sir, I know not
-how others may feel, but for myself, when I see
-my Alma Mater surrounded, like Cæsar in the
-Senate-house, by those who are reiterating stab
-after stab, I would not, for this right hand, have
-her turn to me, and say, ’Et tu quoque mi fili!
-And thou too, my son!’”</p>
-
-<p>This speech, which was masterly in point of
-logic as well as a powerful appeal to the feelings,
-was successful, and the opponents of the college
-were disastrously defeated.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_190" id="Page_190">[Pg 190]</a></span></p>
-
-
-
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-<h2><a name="CHAPTER_XXV" id="CHAPTER_XXV">CHAPTER XXV.</a><br />
-
-<small>THE ORATION AT PLYMOUTH.</small></h2>
-
-
-<p>The three-fold character in which Daniel
-Webster achieved greatness was as lawyer, orator
-and statesman. In this respect he must be placed
-at the head of the immortal three whose names
-are usually conjoined. Mr. Calhoun did not pretend
-to be a lawyer, and Mr. Clay, though he
-practiced law, possessed but a small share of legal
-erudition, and when he gained cases, was indebted
-to his eloquence rather than to his mastery of the
-legal points involved. Both, however, may claim
-to be orators and statesmen, but even in these
-respects it is probable that the highest place
-would be accorded to their great compeer.</p>
-
-<p>Up to the age of thirty-eight Mr. Webster had
-not vindicated his claim to the title of a great
-orator. In Congress and in his profession he had
-shown himself a powerful, eloquent and convincing
-speaker, but it was not until he delivered at
-Plymouth his celebrated discourse on the two
-hundredth anniversary of the settlement that he<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_191" id="Page_191">[Pg 191]</a></span>
-established his fame as a great anniversary orator.</p>
-
-<p>Probably no better selection of an orator could
-have been made. The circumstances of his own
-early career, born and brought up as he was on
-the sterile soil of one of the original States of
-New England, trained like the first settlers in the
-rugged school of poverty and simplicity, wresting
-a bare subsistence from unwilling nature, he
-could enter into the feelings of those hardy men
-who brought the seeds of civilization and civil
-liberty from the shores of the Old World to find
-a lodgment for them in the soil of the New.
-He could appreciate and admire the spirit which
-actuated them, and no one was more likely to set
-a proper value on the results they achieved.</p>
-
-<p>So, by a happy conjuncture, the orator fitted
-the occasion, and the occasion was of a character
-to draw forth the best powers of the orator. It
-gave him an opportunity to pay a fitting tribute
-to the virtues of the stern but conscientious and
-deeply religious men, who had their faults indeed,
-but who in spite of them will always receive not
-only from their descendants but from the world
-a high measure of respect. Of the oration, the
-manner in which it was delivered, and its effect
-upon his audience, we have this account by an
-eye and ear witness, Mr. Ticknor:</p>
-
-<p>“In the morning I went with Mr. Webster to<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_192" id="Page_192">[Pg 192]</a></span>
-the church where he was to deliver the oration.
-It was the old First Church—Dr. Kendall’s.
-He did not find the pulpit convenient for his
-purpose, and after making two or three experiments,
-determined to speak from the deacon’s
-seat under it. An extemporaneous table, covered
-with a green baize cloth, was arranged for the
-occasion, and when the procession entered the
-church everything looked very appropriate,
-though when the arrangement was first suggested
-it sounded rather odd.</p>
-
-<p>“The building was crowded; indeed, the
-streets had seemed so all the morning, for the
-weather was fine, and the whole population was
-astir as for a holiday. The oration was an hour
-and fifty minutes long, but the whole of what
-was printed a year afterwards (for a year before
-it made its appearance) was not delivered. His
-manner was very fine—quite various in the different
-parts. The passage about the slave trade
-was delivered with a power of indignation such
-as I never witnessed on any other occasion.
-That at the end when, spreading his arms as if
-to embrace them, he welcomed future generations
-to the great inheritance which we have enjoyed,
-was spoken with the most attractive sweetness,
-and that peculiar smile which in him was always
-so charming.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_193" id="Page_193">[Pg 193]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>“The effect of the whole was very great. As
-soon as he got home to our lodgings all the
-principal people then in Plymouth crowded about
-him. He was full of animation and radiant with
-happiness. But there was something about him
-very grand and imposing at the same time. In
-a letter which I wrote the same day I said
-that ‘he seemed as if he were like the mount that
-might not be touched, and that burned with fire.’
-I have the same recollection of him still. I never
-saw him at any time when he seemed to me to
-be more conscious of his own powers, or to have
-a more true and natural enjoyment from their
-possession.”</p>
-
-<p>The occasion will always be memorable, for on
-that day it was revealed to the world that America
-possessed an orator fit to be ranked with the
-greatest orators of ancient or modern times. A
-year afterwards John Adams, in a letter to Mr.
-Webster, said of it: “It is the effort of a great
-mind, richly stored with every species of information.
-If there be an American who can read
-it without tears I am not that American. It enters
-more perfectly into the genuine spirit of
-New England than any production I ever read.
-The observations on the Greeks and Romans; on
-colonization in general; on the West India Islands;
-on the past, present and future of Amer<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_194" id="Page_194">[Pg 194]</a></span>ica,
-and on the slave trade are sagacious, profound
-and affecting in a high degree. Mr. Burke is
-no longer entitled to the praise, the most consummate
-orator of modern times. This oration
-will be read five hundred years hence with as
-much rapture as it was heard. It ought to be
-read at the end of every century, and indeed at
-the end of every year, forever and ever.”</p>
-
-<p>This testimony is the more interesting because
-the writer less then five years later was himself,
-with his great contemporary, Mr. Jefferson, to be
-the subject of an address which will always be
-reckoned as one of Webster’s masterpieces.</p>
-
-<p>And now, since many of my young readers
-will never read the Plymouth oration, I surrender
-the rest of this chapter to two extracts which may
-give them an idea of its high merits.</p>
-
-<p>“There are enterprises, military as well as
-civil, which sometimes check the current of
-events, give a new turn to human affairs, and
-transmit their consequences through ages. We
-see their importance in their results, and call
-them great because great things follow. There
-have been battles which have fixed the fate of
-nations. These come down to us in history with
-a solid and permanent interest, not created by a
-display of glittering armor, the rush of adverse
-battalions, the sinking and rising of pennons, the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_195" id="Page_195">[Pg 195]</a></span>
-flight, the pursuit and the victory; but by
-their effect in advancing or retarding human
-knowledge, in overthrowing or establishing despotism,
-in extending or destroying human happiness.</p>
-
-<p>“When the traveler pauses on the plain of
-Marathon, what are the emotions which most
-strongly agitate his breast? What is that glorious
-recollection which thrills through his frame and
-suffuses his eyes? Not, I imagine, that Grecian
-skill and Grecian valor were here most signally
-displayed, but that Greece herself was here displayed.
-It is because to this spot, and to the
-event which has rendered it immortal, he refers
-all the succeeding glories of the republic. It is
-because, if that day had gone otherwise, Greece
-had perished. It is because he perceives that her
-philosophers and orators, her poets and painters,
-her sculptors and architects, her government and
-free institutions, point backward to Marathon,
-and that their future existence seems to have been
-suspended on the contingency whether the Persian
-or the Grecian banner should wave victorious
-in the beams of that day’s setting sun. And, as
-his imagination kindles at the retrospect, he is
-transported back to the interesting moment, he
-counts the fearful odds of the contending hosts,
-his interest for the result overwhelms him, he<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_196" id="Page_196">[Pg 196]</a></span>
-trembles as if it were still uncertain, and grows
-to doubt whether he may consider Socrates and
-Plato, Demosthenes, Sophocles and Phidias, as
-secure yet to himself and the world.</p>
-
-<p>“‘If God prosper us,’ might have been the appropriate
-language of our fathers when they
-landed upon this Rock. If God prosper us, we
-shall begin a work which shall last for ages; we
-shall plant here a new society in the principles
-of the fullest liberty and the purest religion; we
-shall fill this region of the great continent, which
-stretches almost from pole to pole, with civilization
-and Christianity; the temples of the true
-God shall rise, where now ascends the smoke of
-idolatrous sacrifice; fields and gardens, the flowers
-of summer and the waving and golden harvest
-of autumn shall extend over a thousand hills and
-stretch along a thousand valleys never yet, since
-the creation, reclaimed to the use of civilized
-man.</p>
-
-<p>“We shall whiten this coast with the canvas of
-a prosperous commerce; we shall stud the long
-and winding shore with a hundred cities. That
-which we sow in weakness shall be raised in
-strength. From our sincere but houseless worship
-there shall spring splendid temples to record God’s
-goodness, and from the simplicity of our social
-unions there shall arise wise and politic constitu<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_197" id="Page_197">[Pg 197]</a></span>tions
-of government, full of the liberty which
-we ourselves bring and breathe; from our zeal
-for learning institutions shall spring which shall
-scatter the light of knowledge throughout the
-land, and, in time, paying back where they have
-borrowed, shall contribute their part to the great
-aggregate of human knowledge; and our descendants
-through all generations shall look back
-to this spot, and to this hour, with unabated
-affection and regard.”</p>
-
-<p>I close with the solemn and impressive peroration
-in which the orator addresses those who are
-to come after him.</p>
-
-<p>“Advance then, ye future generations! We
-would hail you as you rise in your long succession
-to fill the places which we now fill, and to
-taste the blessings of existence where we are
-passing, and soon shall have passed, our own
-human duration. We bid you welcome to this
-pleasant land of the fathers. We bid you welcome
-to the healthful skies and the verdant fields
-of New England. We greet your accession to
-the great inheritance which we have enjoyed.
-We welcome you to the blessings of good government
-and religious liberty. We welcome you to
-the treasures of science and the delights of learning.
-We welcome you to the transcendent sweets
-of domestic life, to the happiness of kindred and<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_198" id="Page_198">[Pg 198]</a></span>
-parents and children. We welcome you to the
-immeasurable blessings of rational existence, the
-immortal hope of Christianity, and the light of
-everlasting truth!”</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_199" id="Page_199">[Pg 199]</a></span></p>
-
-
-
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-<h2><a name="CHAPTER_XXVI" id="CHAPTER_XXVI">CHAPTER XXVI.</a><br />
-
-<small>THE BUNKER HILL ORATION.</small></h2>
-
-
-<p>The oration at Plymouth first revealed the
-power of Mr. Webster. There are some men
-who exhaust themselves in one speech, one poem,
-or one story, and never attain again the high
-level which they have once reached.</p>
-
-<p>It was not so with Daniel Webster. He had
-a fund of reserved power which great occasions
-never drew upon in vain. It might be that in
-an ordinary case in court, where his feelings
-were not aroused, and no fitting demand made
-upon his great abilities, he would disappoint
-the expectations of those who supposed that he
-must always be eloquent. I heard a gentleman
-say once, “Oh, I heard Mr. Webster speak once,
-and his speech was commonplace enough.”</p>
-
-<p>“On what occasion?”</p>
-
-<p>“In court.”</p>
-
-<p>“What was the case?”</p>
-
-<p>“Oh, I don’t remember—some mercantile
-case.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_200" id="Page_200">[Pg 200]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>It would certainly be unreasonable to expect
-any man to invest dry commercial details with
-eloquence. Certainly a lawyer always ambitious
-in his rhetoric would hardly commend himself
-to a sound, sensible client.</p>
-
-<p>But Mr. Webster always rose to the level of a
-great occasion. His occasional speeches were always
-carefully prepared and finished, and there is
-not one of them but will live. I now have to
-call special attention to the address delivered at
-the laying of the corner-stone of Bunker Hill
-Monument, at Charlestown, June 17, 1825. It
-was an occasion from which he could not help
-drawing inspiration. His father, now dead,
-whom he had loved and revered as few sons love
-and revere their parents, had been a participant,
-not indeed in the battle which the granite shaft
-was to commemorate, but in the struggle which
-the colonists waged for liberty. It may well be
-imagined that Mr. Webster gazed with no common
-emotion at the veterans who were present to
-hear their patriotism celebrated. Though the
-passages addressed to them—in part at least—are
-familiar to many of my readers, I will nevertheless
-quote them here. Apart from their subject
-they will never be forgotten by Americans.</p>
-
-<p>“Venerable men! you have come down to us
-from a former generation. Heaven has boun<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_201" id="Page_201">[Pg 201]</a></span>teously
-lengthened out your lives that you might
-behold this joyous day. You are now where you
-stood fifty years ago, this very hour, with your
-brothers and your neighbors, shoulder to shoulder
-in the strife of your country. Behold how
-altered! The same heavens are indeed over your
-heads; the same ocean rolls at your feet; but all
-else how changed! You hear now no roar of
-hostile cannon, you see now no mixed volumes of
-smoke and flame rising from burning Charlestown.
-The ground strewed with the dead and
-the dying; the impetuous charge; the steady
-and successful repulse; the loud call to repeated
-assault; the summoning of all that is manly to
-repeated resistance; a thousand bosoms freely and
-fearlessly bared in an instant to whatever of terror
-there may be in war and death—all these you have
-witnessed, but you witness them no more.</p>
-
-<p>“All is peace. The heights of yonder metropolis,
-its towers and roofs, which you then saw
-filled with wives and children and countrymen in
-distress and terror, and looking with unutterable
-emotions for the issue of the combat, have presented
-you to-day with the sight of its whole happy
-population come out to welcome and greet you
-with an universal jubilee. Yonder proud ships, by
-a felicity of position appropriately lying at the foot
-of this mound, and seeming fondly to cling around<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_202" id="Page_202">[Pg 202]</a></span>
-it, are not means of annoyance to you, but your
-country’s own means of distinction and defense.
-All is peace, and God has granted you this sight
-of your country’s happiness ere you slumber forever
-in the grave; he has allowed you to behold
-and to partake the reward of your patriotic toils;
-and he has allowed us, your sons and countrymen,
-to meet you here, and in the name of the present
-generation, in the name of your country, in the
-name of liberty, to thank you!</p>
-
-<p>“But, alas! you are not all here! Time and
-the sword have thinned your ranks. Prescott,
-Putnam, Stark, Brooks, Read, Pomeroy, Bridge!
-our eyes seek for you in vain amid this broken
-band. You are gathered to your fathers, and
-live only to your country in her grateful remembrance
-and your own bright example. But let
-us not too much grieve that you have met the
-common fate of men. You lived at least long
-enough to know that your work had been nobly
-and successfully accomplished. You lived to see
-your country’s independence established, and to
-sheathe your swords from war. On the light of
-liberty you saw arise the light of peace, like</p>
-
-<div class="poetry-container"><div class="poetry"><div class="stanza">
-<div class="verse indent6">‘another morn,</div>
-<div class="verse">Risen on mid-noon;’</div>
-</div></div></div>
-
-<p>and the sky on which you closed your eyes was
-cloudless.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_203" id="Page_203">[Pg 203]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>After a tribute to General Warren ‘the first
-great martyr in this great cause,’ Mr. Webster proceeds:</p>
-
-<p>“Veterans, you are the remnants of many a
-well-fought field. You bring with you marks of
-honor from Trenton and Monmouth, from
-Yorktown, Camden,. Bennington and Saratoga.
-Veterans of half a century, when in your youthful
-days you put everything at hazard in your
-country’s cause, good as that cause was, and sanguine
-as youth is, still your fondest hopes did not
-stretch onward to an hour like this. At a period
-to which you could not reasonably have expected
-to arrive, at a moment of national prosperity such
-as you could never have foreseen, you are now
-met here to enjoy the fellowship of old soldiers,
-and to receive the overflowings of an universal
-gratitude.</p>
-
-<p>“But your agitated countenances and your
-heaving breasts inform me that even this is not
-an unmixed joy. I perceive that a tumult of contending
-feelings rushes upon you. The images
-of the dead, as well as the persons of the living,
-throng to your embraces. The scene overwhelms
-you, and I turn from it. May the Father of all
-mercies smile upon your declining years and bless
-them! And when you shall here have exchanged
-your embraces, when you shall once more have<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_204" id="Page_204">[Pg 204]</a></span>
-pressed the hands which have been so often extended
-to give succor in adversity, or grasped in
-the exultation of victory, then look abroad into
-this lovely land which your young valor defended,
-and mark the happiness with which it is
-filled; yea, look abroad into the whole earth, and
-see what a name you have contributed to give your
-country, and what a praise you have added to
-freedom, and then rejoice in the sympathy and
-gratitude which beam upon your last days from
-the improved condition of mankind!”</p>
-
-<p>Not only were there war-scarred veterans present
-to listen entranced to the glowing periods of
-the inspired orator, but there was an eminent
-friend of America, a son of France, General
-Lafayette, who sat in a conspicuous seat and attracted
-the notice of all. To him the orator
-addressed himself in a manner no less impressive.</p>
-
-<p>“Fortunate, fortunate man! with what measure
-of devotion will you not thank God for the circumstances
-of your extraordinary life! You are
-connected with both hemispheres, and with two
-generations. Heaven saw fit to ordain that the
-electric spark of liberty should be conducted,
-through you, from the New World to the Old;
-and we, who are now here to perform this duty
-of patriotism, have all of us long ago received it
-in charge from our fathers to cherish your name<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_205" id="Page_205">[Pg 205]</a></span>
-and your virtues. You will account it an instance
-of your good fortune, sir, that you crossed the
-seas to visit us at a time which enables you to be
-present at this solemnity. You now behold the
-field, the renown of which reached you in the
-heart of France, and caused a thrill in your ardent
-bosom; you see the lines of the little redoubt
-thrown up by the incredible diligence of Prescott,
-defended to the last extremity by his lion-hearted
-valor, and within which the corner-stone of our
-monument has now taken its position. You see
-where Warren fell, and where Parker, Gardner,
-McCleary, Moore and other early patriots fell with
-him. Those who survived that day, and whose
-lives have been prolonged to the present hour, are
-now around you. Some of them you have known
-in the trying scenes of the war. Behold! They
-now stretch forth their feeble arms to embrace
-you. Behold! They raise their trembling voices
-to invoke the blessing of God on you and yours
-forever.”</p>
-
-<p>I should like to increase my quotations, but
-space will not permit. I have quoted enough to
-give my young readers an idea of this masterly
-address. When next they visit the hill where
-the monument stands complete, let them try to
-picture to themselves how it looked on that occasion
-when, from the platform where he stood<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_206" id="Page_206">[Pg 206]</a></span>
-Mr. Webster, with his clarion voice, facing the
-thousands who were seated before him on the
-rising hillside, and the other thousands who stood
-at the summit, spoke these eloquent words. Let
-them imagine the veteran soldiers, and the white-haired
-and venerable Lafayette, and they can
-better understand the effect which this address
-made on the eager and entranced listeners. They
-will not wonder at the tears which gathered in the
-eyes of the old soldiers as they bowed their heads
-to conceal their emotions. Surely there was no
-other man in America who could so admirably
-have improved the occasion.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_207" id="Page_207">[Pg 207]</a></span></p>
-
-
-
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-<h2><a name="CHAPTER_XXVII" id="CHAPTER_XXVII">CHAPTER XXVII.</a><br />
-
-<small>ADAMS AND JEFFERSON.</small></h2>
-
-
-<p>July 4, 1826, was a memorable day. It was
-the fiftieth anniversary of American Independence,
-and for that reason, if no other, it was
-likely to be a day of note. But, by a singular
-coincidence, two eminent Americans, fathers of
-the republic, both of whom had filled the Presidency,
-yielded up their lives.</p>
-
-<p>When John Adams was dying at Quincy, in
-Massachusetts, he spoke of his great countryman,
-Thomas Jefferson, who he naturally supposed
-was to survive him. But the same day,
-and that the natal day of the republic, brought
-the illustrious career of each to a close. Not
-untimely, for John Adams had passed the age of
-ninety, and Jefferson was but a few years
-younger.</p>
-
-<p>Those were not the days of telegraphs nor of
-railroads, and the news had to be conveyed by
-stage-coaches, so that it was perhaps a month
-before the country through its large extent knew<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_208" id="Page_208">[Pg 208]</a></span>
-of the double loss which it had sustained. It
-was certainly by a most remarkable coincidence
-that these two great leaders, representing the
-two political parties which divided the country,
-but one in their devotion to the common welfare,
-passed from earthly scenes on the same anniversary.
-It was no wonder that they were the
-subjects of public addresses and sermons throughout
-the United States.</p>
-
-<p>Of all those addresses but one is remembered
-to-day. It was the oration delivered by Daniel
-Webster on the 2d of August, 1826. This too
-was an anniversary, the anniversary of the day
-when the Declaration of Independence had been
-engrossed by the Revolutionary Congress.</p>
-
-<p>As the circumstances attending the delivery
-of this oration will be new to my young readers,
-I quote from Mr. Ticknor’s description, as I find
-it in Mr. Curtis’s Life of Mr. Webster. After detailing
-an interview, in which Mr. Webster read
-him in advance some portions of the oration, he
-proceeds:</p>
-
-<p>“The next day, the 2d of August, the weather
-was fine, and the concourse to hear him immense.
-It was the first time that Faneuil Hall
-had been draped in mourning. The scene was
-very solemn, though the light of day was not excluded.
-Settees had been placed over the whole<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_209" id="Page_209">[Pg 209]</a></span>
-area of the hall; the large platform was occupied
-by many of the most distinguished men in New
-England, and, as it was intended that everything
-should be conducted with as much quietness as
-possible, the doors were closed when the procession
-had entered, and every part of the hall
-and galleries was filled. This was a mistake in
-the arrangements; the crowd on the outside,
-thinking that some space must still be left within,
-became very uneasy, and finally grew so
-tumultuous and noisy that the solemnities were
-interrupted. The police in vain attempted to
-restore order. It seemed as if confusion would
-prevail. Mr. Webster perceived that there was
-but one thing to be done. He advanced to the
-front of the stage, and said in a voice easily
-heard above the noise of tumult without and of
-alarm within, ‘<em>Let those doors be opened</em>.’</p>
-
-<p>“The power and authority of his manner were
-irresistible; the doors were opened, though with
-difficulty, from the pressure of the crowd on
-the outside; but after the first rush everything
-was quiet, and the order during the rest of the
-performance was perfect.</p>
-
-<p>“Mr. Webster spoke in an orator’s gown and
-wore small-clothes. He was in the perfection of
-his manly beauty and strength, his form filled
-out to its finest proportions, and his bearing, as<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_210" id="Page_210">[Pg 210]</a></span>
-he stood before the vast multitude, that of absolute
-dignity and power. His manuscript lay on
-a small table near him, but I think he did not
-once refer to it. His manner of speaking was
-deliberate and commanding. When he came to
-the passage on eloquence, and to the words, ‘It
-is action, noble, sublime, godlike action,’ he
-stamped his foot repeatedly on the stage, his
-form seemed to dilate, and he stood, as that
-whole audience saw and felt, the personification
-of what he so perfectly described. I never saw
-him when his manner was so grand and appropriate.</p>
-
-<p>“The two speeches attributed to Mr. Adams
-and his opponent attracted great attention from
-the first. Soon they were put into school-books,
-as specimens of English, and of eloquence. In
-time men began to believe they were genuine
-speeches, made by genuine men who were in the
-Congress of ’76; and at last Mr. Webster received
-letters asking whether such was the fact
-or not. In January, 1846, he sent me from
-Washington a letter he had just received, dated
-at Auburn, begging him to solve the doubt.
-With it he sent me his answer, which is published
-in his works, saying:<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_211" id="Page_211">[Pg 211]</a></span> ‘The accompanying
-letter and copy of answer respect a question
-which has been often asked me. I place them
-in your hands, to serve if similar inquiries should
-be made of you.’ Two months after, in March
-of the same year, he sent me a letter from Bangor,
-in Maine, asking the same question, beginning
-the note which accompanied it with these
-words: ‘Here comes another; I cannot possibly
-answer all of them, one after another.’ Indeed
-he continued to receive such letters until the
-edition of his works was published in 1851,
-though the matter was repeatedly discussed and
-explained in the newspapers. The fact is, that
-the speech he wrote for John Adams has such
-an air of truth and reality about it, that only a
-genius like Mr. Webster, perfectly familiar with
-whatever relates to the Revolution, and indeed
-with its spirit, could have written it.”</p>
-
-<p>There is hardly a schoolboy who reads this
-book who has not declaimed his famous speech,
-beginning, ‘Sink or swim, live or die, survive or
-perish, I give my hand and my heart to this vote.’
-It is hard to believe that this noble and impressive
-speech, so true to the sturdy character of
-Mr. Adams, and so appropriate to the occasion,
-was written by Mr. Webster one morning, before
-breakfast, in his library. It is also surprising
-that the orator was not certain whether it really
-had merit or not, and read it to Mr. Ticknor for
-his opinion.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_212" id="Page_212">[Pg 212]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>Though parts of this speech are familiar, I
-shall nevertheless conclude my chapter with the
-exordium, since it will be read with fresh interest
-in this connection.</p>
-
-<p>“This is an unaccustomed spectacle. For the
-first time, fellow citizens, badges of mourning
-shroud the columns and overhang the arches of
-this hall. These walls, which were consecrated
-so long ago to the cause of American liberty,
-which witnessed her infant struggles, and rang
-with the shouts of her earliest victories, proclaim
-now that distinguished friends and champions
-of that great cause have fallen. It is right
-that it should be thus. The tears which flow
-and the honors which are paid when the founders
-of the republic die give hope that the republic
-itself may be immortal. It is fit that by
-public assembly and solemn observance, by anthem
-and by eulogy, we commemorate the services
-of national benefactors, extol their virtues,
-and render thanks to God for eminent blessings,
-early given and long continued, to our favored
-country.</p>
-
-<p>“Adams and Jefferson are no more, and we
-are assembled, fellow citizens, the aged, the
-middle-aged, and the young, by the spontaneous
-impulse of all, under the authority of the municipal
-government, with the presence of the chief<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_213" id="Page_213">[Pg 213]</a></span>
-magistrate of the commonwealth and others, its
-official representatives, the university, and the
-learned societies, to bear our part in the manifestations
-of respect and gratitude which universally
-pervade the land. Adams and Jefferson
-are no more. On our fiftieth anniversary, the
-great day of national jubilee, in the very hour of
-public rejoicing, in the midst of echoing and re-echoing
-voices of thanksgiving, while their own
-names were on all tongues, they took their flight
-together to the world of spirits.</p>
-
-<p>“If it be true that no one can safely be pronounced
-happy while he lives, if that event
-which terminates life can alone crown its honor
-and its glory, what felicity is here! The great
-epic of their lives how happily concluded!
-Poetry itself has hardly closed illustrious lives
-and finished the career of earthly renown by
-such a consummation. If we had the power, we
-could not wish to reverse this dispensation of
-Divine Providence. The great objects of life
-were accomplished, the drama was ready to be
-closed. It has closed; our patriots have fallen;
-but so fallen, at such age, with such coincidence,
-on such a day, that we cannot rationally lament
-that that end has come, which we know could not
-long be deferred.</p>
-
-<p>“Neither of these great men, fellow citizens,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_214" id="Page_214">[Pg 214]</a></span>
-could have died at any time without leaving an
-immense void in our American society. They
-have been so intimately, and for so long a time,
-blended with the history of the country, and
-especially so united in our thoughts and recollections
-with the events of the Revolution, that the
-death of either would have touched the strings
-of public sympathy. We should have felt that
-one great link connecting us with former times
-was broken; that we had lost something more, as
-it were, of the presence of the Revolution itself
-and of the Act of Independence, and were driven
-on by another great remove from the days of
-our country’s early distinction, to meet posterity
-and to mix with the future. Like the mariner,
-whom the ocean and the winds carry along, till
-he sees the stars which have directed his course
-and lighted his pathless way descend one by one
-beneath the rising horizon, we should have felt
-that the stream of time had borne us onward till
-another great luminary, whose light had cheered
-us and whose guidance we had followed, had
-sunk from our sight.</p>
-
-<p>“But the concurrence of their death on
-the anniversary of independence has naturally
-awakened stronger emotions. Both had been
-presidents, both were early patriots, and both
-were distinguished and ever honored by their<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_215" id="Page_215">[Pg 215]</a></span>
-immediate agency in the act of independence.
-It cannot but seem striking and extraordinary
-that these two should live to see the fiftieth year
-from the date of that act; that they should complete
-that year; and that then, on the day which
-had just linked forever their own fame with their
-country’s glory, the heavens should open to receive
-them both at once. As their lives themselves
-were the gifts of Providence, who is not
-willing to recognize in their happy termination,
-as well as in their long continuance, proofs that
-our country and its benefactors are objects of His
-care?”</p>
-
-<p>Towards the close of the oration we find a
-striking passage familiar to many, and justly admired,
-touching the duties which devolve upon
-the favored citizens of the United States.</p>
-
-<p>“This lovely land, this glorious liberty, these
-benign institutions, the dear purchase of our
-fathers, are ours; ours to enjoy, ours to preserve,
-ours to transmit. Generations past and generations
-to come hold us responsible for this
-sacred trust. Our fathers from behind admonish
-us with their anxious paternal voices;
-posterity calls out to us from the bosom of the
-future; the world turns hither its solicitous
-eyes; all, all conjure us to act wisely and faithfully
-in the relation which we sustain.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_216" id="Page_216">[Pg 216]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>“We can never, indeed, pay the debt which is
-upon us; but, by virtue, by morality, by religion,
-by the cultivation of every good principle and
-every good habit, we may hope to enjoy the
-blessing through our day, and to leave it unimpaired
-to our children. Let us feel deeply
-how much of what we are, and of what we
-possess, we owe to this liberty, and to these
-institutions of government. Nature has indeed
-given us a soil which yields bounteously to the
-hands of industry, the mighty and fruitful ocean
-is before us, and the skies over our heads shed
-health and vigor. But what are lands, and skies,
-and seas to civilized man, without society, without
-knowledge, without morals, without religious
-culture? and how can these be enjoyed, in all
-their extent and all their excellence, but under
-the protection of wise institutions and a free government?
-Fellow citizens, there is not one of
-us, there is not one of us here present, who does
-not at this moment, and every moment, experience
-in his own condition, and in the condition
-of those most near and dear to him, the influence
-and the benefits of this liberty and these institutions.
-Let us then acknowledge the blessing,
-let us feel it deeply and powerfully, let us
-cherish a strong affection for it, and resolve to
-maintain and perpetuate it. The blood of our<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_217" id="Page_217">[Pg 217]</a></span>
-fathers, let it not have been shed in vain; the
-great hope of posterity, let it not be blasted!”</p>
-
-<p>It has been said with truth that no funeral
-oration has ever been pronounced, in any age,
-and in any language, which exceeds this in eloquence
-and simple grandeur. Happy the country
-that possesses two citizens of whom such
-praises can be uttered, and happy the nation that
-can find an orator of such transcendent genius to
-pronounce their eulogies!</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_218" id="Page_218">[Pg 218]</a></span></p>
-
-
-
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-<h2><a name="CHAPTER_XXVIII" id="CHAPTER_XXVIII">CHAPTER XXVIII.</a><br />
-
-<small>HOME LIFE AND DOMESTIC SORROWS.</small></h2>
-
-
-<p>In speaking of Mr. Webster as an orator I have
-for some time neglected to speak of him in his
-domestic relations. He was blessed with a happy
-home. The wife he had chosen was fitted by
-intellect and culture to sympathize with him in
-his important work. Moreover, she had those
-sweet domestic qualities which are required to
-make home happy. Children had been born to
-them, and these were an important factor in the
-happiness of Mr. Webster’s home. He had a
-warm love for children, and was always an affectionate
-and indulgent parent, seldom chiding,
-but rebuking in love when occasion required.</p>
-
-<p>In January, 1817, came the first bereavement.
-His daughter, Grace, always precocious and delicate,
-developed lung trouble and wasted away.
-She seems to have been a remarkably bright and
-attractive child. Her heart was easily touched by
-sorrow or destitution, and she would never consent
-that applicants for relief should be sent from<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_219" id="Page_219">[Pg 219]</a></span>
-the door unsatisfied. “She would bring them
-herself into the house, see that their wants were
-supplied, comfort them with the ministration of
-her own little hands and the tender compassion
-of her large eyes. If her mother ever refused,
-those eyes would fill with tears, and she would
-urge their requests so perseveringly that there
-was no resisting her.”</p>
-
-<p>The death of this sweet child touched Mr.
-Webster nearly, and it was with a saddened heart
-that he returned to Washington to devote himself
-to his duties in the Supreme Court.</p>
-
-<p>On the 18th of December, 1824, death once
-more appeared in the little household, this time
-removing the youngest boy, Charles, then nearing
-his second birthday. This child, young as he
-was, is said to have borne a closer resemblance to
-his father than any of his other children. Both
-parents were devoted to him. Mrs. Webster
-writes to her husband just after the little boy’s
-death: “It was an inexpressible consolation to
-me, when I contemplated him in his sickness, that
-he had not one regret for the past, nor one dread
-for the future; he was as patient as a lamb during
-all his sufferings, and they were at last so
-great I was happy when they were ended. I
-shall always reflect on his brief life with mournful
-pleasure, and, I hope, remember with grati<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_220" id="Page_220">[Pg 220]</a></span>tude
-all the joy he gave me, and it has been
-great. And, oh, how fondly did I flatter myself
-it would be lasting!</p>
-
-<div class="poetry-container"><div class="poetry"><div class="stanza">
-<div class="verse">“’It was but yesterday, my child, thy little heart beat high;</div>
-<div class="verse">And I had scorned the warning voice that told me thou must die.’”</div>
-</div></div></div>
-
-<p>When Mr. Webster received the intelligence
-of his loss, he, for the first time in years, indulged
-in his early fondness for verse, and wrote
-a few stanzas which have been preserved, though
-they were intended to be seen only by those near
-and dear to him. The prevailing thought is a
-striking one. Here are the verses:</p>
-
-<div class="poetry-container"><div class="poetry"><div class="stanza">
-<div class="verse">“The staff on which my years should lean</div>
-<div class="verse indent2">Is broken ere those years come’ o’er me;</div>
-<div class="verse">My funeral rites thou shouldst have seen,</div>
-<div class="verse indent2">But thou art in the tomb before me.</div>
-</div><div class="stanza">
-<div class="verse">“Thou rear’st to me no filial stone,</div>
-<div class="verse indent2">No parent’s grave with tears beholdest;</div>
-<div class="verse">Thou art my ancestor—my son!</div>
-<div class="verse indent2">And stand’st in Heaven’s account the oldest.</div>
-</div><div class="stanza">
-<div class="verse">“On earth my lot was soonest cast,</div>
-<div class="verse indent2">Thy generation after mine;</div>
-<div class="verse">Thou hast thy predecessor passed,</div>
-<div class="verse indent2">Earlier eternity is thine.</div>
-</div><div class="stanza">
-<div class="verse">“I should have set before thine eyes</div>
-<div class="verse indent2">The road to Heaven, and showed it clear;</div>
-<div class="verse">But thou, untaught, spring’st to the skies,</div>
-<div class="verse indent2">And leav’st thy teacher lingering here.</div><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_221" id="Page_221">[Pg 221]</a></span>
-</div><div class="stanza">
-<div class="verse">“Sweet seraph, I would learn of thee,</div>
-<div class="verse indent2">And hasten to partake thy bliss!</div>
-<div class="verse">And, oh! to thy world welcome me,</div>
-<div class="verse indent2">As first I welcomed thee to this.”</div>
-</div></div></div>
-
-<p>But a still heavier bereavement was in store,
-though it was delayed for some years. In the
-summer of 1827 the health of Mrs. Webster began
-to fail, and from that time she steadily declined
-until on the 21st of January, in the following
-year she died. Of Mr. Webster’s bearing at
-the funeral, Mr. Ticknor writes: “Mr. Webster
-came to Mr. George Blake’s in Summer Street,
-where we saw him both before and after the
-funeral. He seemed completely broken-hearted.
-At the funeral, when, with Mr. Paige, I was
-making some arrangements for the ceremonies,
-we noticed that Mr. Webster was wearing shoes
-that were not fit for the wet walking of the day,
-and I went to him and asked him if he would not
-ride in one of the carriages. ‘No,’ he said, ‘my
-children and I must follow their mother to the
-grave on foot. I could swim to Charlestown.’ A
-few minutes afterwards he took Nelson and
-Daniel in either hand, and walked close to the
-hearse through the streets to the church in whose
-crypt the interment took place. It was a touching
-and solemn sight. He was excessively pale.”</p>
-
-<p>It is a striking commentary upon the emptiness<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_222" id="Page_222">[Pg 222]</a></span>
-of human honors where the heart is concerned
-that this great affliction came very soon after Mr.
-Webster’s election to the United State Senate,
-where he achieved his highest fame and gathered
-his choicest laurels. We can well imagine that
-he carried a sad heart to the halls of legislation,
-and realized how poorly the world’s honors compensate
-the heart for the wounds of bereavement.
-But Daniel Webster was not a man to suffer sorrow
-to get the mastery of him. He labored the
-harder in the service of his country, and found in
-the discharge of duty his best consolation. If I
-had room I would like to quote the tribute of
-Judge Storey to the character of Mr. Webster.
-I confine myself to one sentence: “Few persons
-have been more deservedly or more universally
-beloved; few have possessed qualities more attractive,
-more valuable or more elevating.”</p>
-
-<p>A little over a year later there was a fresh sorrow.
-Ezekiel Webster, the older brother, between
-whom and Daniel such warm and affectionate
-relations had always existed, died suddenly
-under striking circumstances. He was addressing
-a jury in the court-house at Concord, N. H.,
-speaking with full force, when, without a moment’s
-warning, “he fell backward, without bending
-a joint, and, so far as appeared, was dead
-before his head reached the floor.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_223" id="Page_223">[Pg 223]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>He was a man of large ability, though necessarily
-overshadowed by the colossal genius of his
-younger brother. It would be too much to expect
-two Daniel Websters in one family. His
-death had a depressing effect upon Daniel, for the
-two had been one in sympathy, and each had rejoiced
-in the success of the other. Together they
-had struggled up from poverty, achieved an education
-and professional distinction, and though
-laboring in different spheres, for Ezekiel kept
-aloof from politics, they continued to exchange
-views upon all subjects that interested either. It
-is not surprising, in view of his desolate household,
-and the loss of his favorite brother, that
-Daniel should write: “I confess the world, at
-present, has an aspect for me anything but cheerful.
-With a multitude of acquaintances I have
-few friends; my nearest intimacies are broken,
-and a sad void is made in the objects of affection.”
-Yet he was constrained to acknowledge that his
-life, on the whole, had been “fortunate and happy
-beyond the common lot, and it would be now
-ungrateful, as well as unavailing, to repine at
-calamities, of which, as they are human, I must
-expect to partake.”</p>
-
-<p>I have taken pains to speak of Mr. Webster’s
-home affections, because many, but only those
-who did not know him, have looked upon him as<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_224" id="Page_224">[Pg 224]</a></span>
-coldly intellectual, with a grand genius, but deficient
-in human emotions, when, as a fact, his
-heart was unusually warm and overflowing with
-tender sympathy.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_225" id="Page_225">[Pg 225]</a></span></p>
-
-
-
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-<h2><a name="CHAPTER_XXIX" id="CHAPTER_XXIX">CHAPTER XXIX.</a><br />
-
-<small>CALLED TO THE SENATE.</small></h2>
-
-
-<p>I have called this biography “From Farm-boy
-to Senator,” because it is as a senator that Daniel
-Webster especially distinguished himself. At
-different times he filled the position of Secretary
-of State, but it was in the Senate Chamber, where
-he was associated with other great leaders, in
-especial Clay, Calhoun and Hayne, that he became
-a great central object of attention and admiration.</p>
-
-<p>Mr. Webster was not elected to the Senate till
-he had reached the age of forty-five. For him it
-was a late preferment, and when it came he accepted
-it reluctantly. Mr. Clay was not yet thirty
-when he entered the Senate, and Mr. Calhoun
-was Vice-President before he attained the age of
-forty-five. But there was this advantage in Mr.
-Webster’s case, that when he joined the highest
-legislative body in the United States he joined it
-as a giant, fully armed and equipped not only by
-nature but by long experience in the lower House
-of Congress, where he was a leader.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_226" id="Page_226">[Pg 226]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>The preferment came to him unsought. Mr.
-Mills, one of the senators from Massachusetts,
-who had filled his position acceptably, was drawing
-near the close of his term, and his failing
-health rendered his re-election impolitic. Naturally
-Mr. Webster was thought of as his successor,
-but he felt that he could hardly be spared from
-the lower House, where he was the leading supporter
-of the administration of John Quincy
-Adams. Levi Lincoln was at that time Governor
-of Massachusetts, and he too had been urged to
-become a candidate. Mr. Webster wrote him an
-urgent letter, in the hope of persuading him to
-favor this step. From that letter I quote:</p>
-
-<p>“I take it for granted that Mr. E. H. Mills
-will be no longer a candidate. The question then
-will be, Who is to succeed him? I need not say
-to you that you yourself will doubtless be a prominent
-object of consideration in relation to the
-vacant place, and the purpose of this communication
-requires me also to acknowledge that I
-deem it possible that my name also should be
-mentioned, more or less generally, as one who
-may be thought of, among others, for the same
-situation.... There are many strong personal
-reasons, and, as friends think, and as I think
-too, some <em>public</em> reasons why I should decline the
-offer of a seat in the Senate if it should be made<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_227" id="Page_227">[Pg 227]</a></span>
-to me. Without entering at present into a detail
-of those reasons, I will say that the latter class of
-them grow out of the public station which I at
-present fill, and out of the necessity of increasing
-rather than of diminishing, in both branches of
-the National Legislature, the strength that may
-be reckoned on as friendly to the present administration....
-To come, therefore, to the
-main point, I beg to say that I see no way in
-which the public good can be so well promoted
-as by <em>your</em> consenting to go into the Senate.</p>
-
-<p>“This is my own clear and decided opinion;
-it is the opinion, equally clear and decided, of intelligent
-and patriotic friends here, and I am able
-to add that it is also the decided opinion of all
-those friends elsewhere whose judgment in such
-matters we should naturally regard. I believe I
-may say, without violating confidence, that it is
-the wish, entertained with some earnestness, of
-our friends at Washington that you should consent
-to be Mr. Mills’s successor.”</p>
-
-<p>No one certainly can doubt the absolute sincerity
-of these utterances. It was, and is, unusual
-for a representative to resist so earnestly
-what is considered a high promotion. Mr. Webster
-was an ambitious man, but he thought that
-the interests of the country required him to stay
-where he was, and hence his urgency.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_228" id="Page_228">[Pg 228]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>But Gov. Lincoln was no less patriotic. In
-an elaborate reply to Mr. Webster’s letter, from
-which I have quoted above, he urges that “the
-deficiency of power in the Senate is the weak
-point in the citadel” of the administration party.
-“No individual should be placed there but who
-was <em>now</em> in armor for the conflict, who understood
-the proper mode of resistance, who personally
-knew and had measured strength with the
-opposition, who was familiar with the political
-interests and foreign relations of the country,
-with the course of policy of the administration,
-and who would be prepared at once to meet and
-decide upon the charter of measures which should
-be proposed. This, I undertake to say, no <em>novice</em>
-in the national council could do. At least I
-would not promise to attempt it. I feel deeply
-that I could not do it successfully. There is no
-affectation of humility in this, and under such
-impressions I cannot suffer myself to be thought
-of in a manner which may make me responsible
-for great mischief in defeating the chance of a
-better selection.”</p>
-
-<p>I am sure my young readers will agree
-that this correspondence was highly honorable to
-both these eminent gentlemen. It is refreshing
-to turn from the self-sufficient and self-seeking
-politicians of our own day, most of whom are<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_229" id="Page_229">[Pg 229]</a></span>
-ready to undertake any responsibilities however
-large, without a doubt of their own fitness, to the
-modesty and backwardness of these really great
-men of fifty years since. In the light of Mr.
-Webster’s great career we must decide that Gov.
-Lincoln was right in deciding that he should be
-the next senator from Massachusetts.</p>
-
-<p>At any rate such was the decision arrived at,
-and in June, 1827, Mr. Webster was elected senator
-for a period of six years. In due time he
-took his seat. He was no novice, but a man
-known throughout the country, and quite the
-equal in fame of any of his compeers. I suppose
-no new senator has ever taken his seat who was
-already a man of such wide fame and national
-importance as Daniel Webster in 1827. Had
-James A. Garfield, instead of assuming the Presidency,
-taken the seat in the Senate to which he
-had been elected on the fourth of March, 1881,
-his would have been a parallel case.</p>
-
-<p>Of course there was some curiosity as to the
-opening speech of the already eminent senator.
-He soon found a fitting theme. A bill was introduced
-for the relief of the surviving officers of
-the Revolution. Such a bill was sure to win the
-active support of the orator who had delivered
-the address at Bunker Hill.</p>
-
-<p>Alluding to some objections which had been<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_230" id="Page_230">[Pg 230]</a></span>
-made to the principle of pensioning them, Mr.
-Webster said: “There is, I know, something repulsive
-and opprobrious in the name of pension.
-But God forbid that I should taunt them with
-it. With grief, heartfelt grief, do I behold the
-necessity which leads these veterans to accept the
-bounty of their country in a manner not the
-most agreeable to their feelings. Worn out and
-decrepit, represented before us by those, their
-former brothers in arms, who totter along our
-lobbies or stand leaning on their crutches, I, for
-one, would most gladly support such a measure
-as should consult at once their services, their
-years, their necessities and the delicacy of their
-sentiments. I would gladly give with promptitude
-and grace, with gratitude and delicacy, that
-which merit has earned and necessity demands.</p>
-
-<p>“It is objected that the militia have claims
-upon us; that they fought at the side of the
-regular soldiers, and ought to share in the country’s
-remembrance. But it is known to be impossible
-to carry the measure to such an extent
-as to embrace the militia, and it is plain, too, that
-the cases are different. The bill, as I have already
-said, confines itself to those who served, not occasionally,
-not temporarily, but permanently; who
-allowed themselves to be counted on as men who
-were to see the contest through, last as long as it<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_231" id="Page_231">[Pg 231]</a></span>
-might; and who have made the phrase ‘‘listing
-for the war’ a proverbial expression, signifying
-unalterable devotion to our cause, through good
-fortune and ill fortune, till it reached its close.</p>
-
-<p>“This is a plain distinction; and although,
-perhaps, I might wish to do more, I see good
-ground to stop here for the present, if we must
-stop anywhere. The militia who fought at Concord,
-at Lexington and at Bunker Hill, have
-been alluded to in the course of this debate in
-terms of well-deserved praise. Be assured, sir,
-there could with difficulty be found a man, who
-drew his sword or carried his musket at Concord,
-at Lexington or at Bunker Hill, who would wish
-you to reject this bill. They might ask you to
-do more, but never to refrain from doing this.
-Would to God they were assembled here, and
-had the fate of this bill in their own hands!
-Would to God the question of its passage were
-to be put to them! They would affirm it with a
-unity of acclamation that would rend the roof of
-the Capitol!”</p>
-
-<p>This is so much in Mr. Webster’s style that,
-had I quoted it without stating that it was his, I
-think many of my young readers would have
-been able to guess the authorship.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_232" id="Page_232">[Pg 232]</a></span></p>
-
-
-
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-<h2><a name="CHAPTER_XXX" id="CHAPTER_XXX">CHAPTER XXX.</a><br />
-
-<small>THE BEGINNING OF A GREAT BATTLE.</small></h2>
-
-
-<p>When Andrew Jackson became President Mr.
-Webster found himself an anti-administration
-leader. He was respected and feared, and a plan
-was formed to break him down and overwhelm
-him in debate. The champion who was supposed
-equal to this task was Col. Hayne, of South
-Carolina, a graceful and forcible speaker, backed
-by the party in power and by the silent influence
-of John C. Calhoun, who, as Vice-President, presided
-over the councils of the Senate.</p>
-
-<p>On the 29th day of December, 1829, an apparently
-innocent resolution was offered by Mr.
-Foote, of Connecticut, in the following terms:</p>
-
-<p>“<em>Resolved</em>, That the Committee on Public
-Lands be instructed to inquire into the expediency
-of limiting for a certain period the
-sales of the public lands to such lands only as
-have been heretofore offered for sale and are
-subject to entry at the minimum price; also,
-whether the office of Surveyor-General may not<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_233" id="Page_233">[Pg 233]</a></span>
-be abolished without detriment to the public interest.”</p>
-
-<p>This resolution called forth the celebrated
-debate in which Mr. Webster demolished the
-eloquent champion of the South in a speech
-which will live as long as American history.</p>
-
-<p>Mr. Benton, of Missouri, in an elaborate speech
-furnished the keynote of the campaign. On
-Monday, the 18th, he made a speech in which a
-violent attack was made upon New England, its
-institutions and its representatives. He was
-followed by Col. Hayne, who elaborated the
-comparison drawn between the so-called illiberal
-policy of New England and the generous policy
-of the South towards the growing West. He
-charged the East with a spirit of jealousy and
-an unwillingness that the West should be rapidly
-settled, taking the resolution of the senator of
-Connecticut as his text.</p>
-
-<p>This attack excited surprise, not only by its
-violence and injustice, but by its suddenness.
-Mr. Webster shared in the general surprise. It
-was not long before he was led to suspect that
-he was aimed at as a well-known defender of
-New England. At any rate, he rose to reply,
-but a motion for adjournment cut him off, and
-he was obliged to wait for the next day before
-he could have the opportunity. The speech he<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_234" id="Page_234">[Pg 234]</a></span>
-then made, though not his great speech, was able
-and deserves notice. He disproved in the clearest
-manner the charges which had been made against
-New England, and showed that her policy had
-been the direct reverse. He dwelt especially
-upon the part which the Eastern States had in
-settling the great State of Ohio, which even then
-contained a population of a million. Upon this
-point he spoke as follows:</p>
-
-<p>“And here, sir, at the epoch of 1794, let us
-pause and survey the scene. It is now thirty-five
-years since that scene actually existed. Let
-us, sir, look back and behold it. Over all that is
-now Ohio there then stretched one vast wilderness,
-unbroken, except by two small spots of
-civilized culture, the one at Marietta, the other
-at Cincinnati. At these little openings, hardly a
-pin’s point upon the map, the arm of the
-frontiersman had leveled the forest and let in
-the sun. These little patches of earth, themselves
-almost shadowed by the overhanging
-boughs of the wilderness, which had stood and
-perpetuated itself from century to century ever
-since the Creation, were all that had been rendered
-verdant by the hand of man. In an extent of
-hundreds and thousands of square miles no other
-surface of smiling green attested the presence of
-civilization. The hunter’s path crossed mighty<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_235" id="Page_235">[Pg 235]</a></span>
-rivers flowing in solitary grandeur, whose sources
-lay in remote and unknown regions of the wilderness.
-It struck, upon the north, on a vast inland
-sea, over which the wintry tempest raged
-as upon the ocean; all around was bare creation.</p>
-
-<p>“It was a fresh, untouched, unbounded, magnificent
-wilderness. And, sir, what is it now?
-Is it imagination only, or can it possibly be fact,
-that presents such a change as surprises and
-astonishes us when we turn our eyes to what
-Ohio now is? Is it reality or a dream that in
-so short a period as even thirty-five years there
-has sprung up on the same surface an independent
-State, with a million of people? A
-million of inhabitants! An amount of population
-greater than all the cantons of Switzerland;
-equal to one third of all the people of the United
-States when they undertook to accomplish their
-independence! If, sir, we may judge of measures
-by their results, what lessons do these facts read
-us on the policy of the government? What inferences
-do they not authorize upon the general
-question of kindness or unkindness? What convictions
-do they enforce as to the wisdom and
-ability, on the one hand, or the folly and incapacity
-on the other, of our general management
-of Western affairs? For my own part, while I
-am struck with wonder at the success, I also look<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_236" id="Page_236">[Pg 236]</a></span>
-with admiration at the wisdom and foresight
-which originally arranged and prescribed the
-system for the settlement of the public domain.”</p>
-
-<p>Mr. Webster said in conclusion: “The Senate
-will bear me witness that I am not accustomed
-to allude to local opinions, nor to compare, nor
-to contrast, different portions of the country. I
-have often suffered things to pass, which I might
-properly enough have considered as deserving a
-remark, without any observation. But I have
-felt it my duty on this occasion to vindicate the
-State which I represent from charges and imputations
-on her public character and conduct
-which I know to be undeserved and unfounded.
-If advanced elsewhere, they might be passed,
-perhaps, without notice. But whatever is said
-here is supposed to be entitled to public regard
-and to deserve public attention; it derives importance
-and dignity from the place where it is
-uttered. As a true representative of the State
-which has sent me here it is my duty, and a
-duty which I shall fulfill, to place her history
-and her conduct, her honor and her character, in
-their just and proper light.</p>
-
-<p>“While I stand here as representative of Massachusetts,
-I will be her true representative, and,
-by the blessing of God, I will vindicate her char<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_237" id="Page_237">[Pg 237]</a></span>acter,
-motives and history from every imputation
-coming from a respectable source.”</p>
-
-<p>This was the first reply of Webster to Hayne,
-and it was able and convincing. But Col. Hayne
-and his friends had no intention of leaving the
-matter there. The next day the consideration
-of the bill was renewed. Mr. Webster’s friends
-wished to have the discussion postponed as he had
-an important case pending in the Supreme Court.
-Mr. Hayne objected, saying in a theatrical tone,
-“that he saw the senator from Massachusetts in
-his seat, and presumed he could make an arrangement
-that would enable him to be present
-during the discussion. He was unwilling that
-the subject should be postponed until he had an
-opportunity of replying to some of the observations
-which had fallen from the gentleman
-yesterday. He would not deny that some things
-had fallen from the gentleman which rankled
-here [touching his breast], from which he would
-desire at once to relieve himself. The gentleman
-had discharged his fire in the face of the Senate.
-He hoped he would now afford him the opportunity
-of returning the shot.”</p>
-
-<p>“Then it was,” as a Southern member of Congress
-afterwards expressed it, “that Mr. Webster’s
-person seemed to become taller and larger. His
-chest expanded and his eyeballs dilated. Fold<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_238" id="Page_238">[Pg 238]</a></span>ing
-his arms in a composed, firm and most expressive
-manner, he exclaimed: ‘Let the discussion
-proceed. I am ready. I am ready <em>now</em> to receive
-the gentleman’s fire.’”</p>
-
-<p>Col. Hayne’s speech was the great effort of his
-life. He was a ready, accomplished and forcible
-speaker, and he vainly thought himself a match
-for the great senator from Massachusetts whose
-power he was yet to understand. He spoke as
-one who was confident of victory, with a self-confidence,
-a swagger, a violence of invective, which
-increased as he went on. He was encouraged by
-the evident delight of his friends, including the
-Vice-President. He did not finish his speech the
-first day, but closed with a hint of what he intended
-to do.</p>
-
-<p>“Sir,” he said, “the gentleman from Massachusetts
-has thought proper, for purposes best
-known to himself, to strike the South through
-me, the most unworthy of her servants. He has
-crossed the border, he has invaded the State of
-South Carolina, is making war upon her citizens,
-and endeavoring to overthrow her principles and
-institutions. Sir, when the gentleman provokes
-me to such a conflict, I meet him at the threshold,
-I will struggle while I have life for our altars
-and our firesides, and if God gives me strength
-I will drive back the invader discomfited. Nor<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_239" id="Page_239">[Pg 239]</a></span>
-shall I stop there. If the gentleman provokes
-war he shall have war. Sir, I will not stop at
-the border; I will carry the war into the enemy’s
-territory, and not consent to lay down my arms
-until I shall have obtained ‘indemnity for the
-past and security for the future.’ It is with unfeigned
-reluctance that I enter upon the performance
-of this part of my duty. I shrink, almost
-instinctively, from a course, however necessary,
-which may have a tendency to excite sectional
-feelings and sectional jealousies. But, sir,
-the task has been forced upon me, and I proceed
-right onward to the performance of my duty,
-be the consequences what they may; the responsibility
-is with those who have imposed upon me
-the necessity. The senator from Massachusetts
-has thought proper to cast the first stone, and, if
-he shall find, according to a homely adage, that
-‘he lives in a glass house,’ on his head be the
-consequences.”</p>
-
-<p>Brave words these! But brave words do not
-necessarily win the victory, and Col. Hayne
-little knew what a foe he was challenging to
-combat.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_240" id="Page_240">[Pg 240]</a></span></p>
-
-
-
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-<h2><a name="CHAPTER_XXXI" id="CHAPTER_XXXI">CHAPTER XXXI.</a><br />
-
-<small>THE REPLY TO HAYNE.</small></h2>
-
-
-<p>Before going farther I must speak of a pestilent
-doctrine then held in South Carolina, which
-underlay the whole controversy, and was the
-animating cause of the antagonism of the Southern
-leaders to the patriotic representatives of the
-North. This was known as nullification, and Mr.
-Calhoun was its sponsor. To explain: South
-Carolina claimed the right to overrule any law of
-the general government which did not please
-her, or which her courts might judge to be unconstitutional.
-If she did not see fit to pay customs,
-she claimed that the government could not
-coerce her. All power was reposed in her own
-executive, her own legislature, and her own judiciary,
-and the national power was subordinate to
-them.</p>
-
-<div class="figcenter">
-<img src="images/p240.jpg" alt="" />
-<div class="caption">COL. ROBERT G. HAYNE.</div>
-</div>
-
-<p>It will be easily seen that this was a most dangerous
-doctrine to hold, one which if allowed
-would everywhere subject the national authority
-to contempt. The United States never had an<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_241" id="Page_241">[Pg 241]</a></span>
-external foe half so insidious or half so dangerous
-as this assumption which had grown up
-within its own borders.</p>
-
-<p>To return to the great debate. When Col.
-Hayne took his seat at the close of his second
-speech his friends gathered round him in warm
-congratulation. Mr. Webster’s friends were sober.
-Much as they admired him, they did not see how
-he was going to answer that speech. They knew
-that he would have little or no time for preparation,
-and it would not do for him to make an
-ordinary or commonplace reply to such a dashing
-harangue. So on the evening of Monday
-the friends of Mr. Webster walked about the
-streets gloomy and preoccupied. They feared
-for their champion.</p>
-
-<p>But how was it with him? During Col.
-Hayne’s speech he calmly took notes. Occasionally
-there was a flash from the depths of his dark
-eyes as a hint or a suggestion occurred to him,
-but he seemed otherwise indifferent and unmoved,
-He spent the evening as usual, and enjoyed a refreshing
-night’s sleep.</p>
-
-<p>In the morning of the eventful day three
-hours before the hour of meeting crowds set their
-faces towards the Capitol. At twelve o’clock the
-Senate Chamber—its galleries, floors and even
-lobbies—was filled to overflowing. The Speaker<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_242" id="Page_242">[Pg 242]</a></span>
-retained his place unwillingly in the House, but
-hardly enough members were present to transact
-business.</p>
-
-<p>When the fitting time came Mr. Webster rose.
-He was in the full vigor of a magnificent manhood,
-the embodiment of conscious strength. He
-gazed around him, never more self-possessed than
-at that moment. He saw his adversaries with
-their complacent faces already rejoicing in his
-anticipated discomfiture; he looked in the faces
-of his friends, and he noted their looks of anxious
-solicitude; but he had full confidence in his own
-strength, and his deep cavernous eyes glowed
-with “that stern joy which warriors feel in foemen
-worthy of their steel.”</p>
-
-<p>There was a hush of expectation and a breathless
-silence as those present waited for his first
-words.</p>
-
-<p>He began thus: “Mr. President, when the
-mariner has been tossed for many days, in thick
-weather, and on an unknown sea, he naturally
-avails himself of the first pause in the storm, the
-earliest glance of the sun, to take his latitude,
-and ascertain how far the elements have driven
-him from his true course. Let us imitate this
-prudence, and before we float further on the
-waves of this debate, refer to the point from
-which we departed, that we may at least be able<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_243" id="Page_243">[Pg 243]</a></span>
-to form some conjecture where we now are. I
-ask for the reading of the resolution.”</p>
-
-<p>This was felt to be a happy exordium, and was
-sufficient to rivet the attention of the vast audience.</p>
-
-<p>After the resolution was read Mr. Webster
-continued: “We have thus heard, sir, what the
-resolution is which is actually before us for consideration;
-and it will readily occur to every one
-that it is almost the only subject about which
-something has not been said in the speech, running
-through two days, by which the Senate has
-been now entertained by the gentleman from
-South Carolina. Every topic in the wide range
-of our public affairs, whether past or present,
-everything, general or local, whether belonging
-to national politics or party politics, seems to
-have attracted more or less of the honorable
-members attention, save only the resolution
-before the Senate. He has spoken of everything
-but the public lands; they have escaped his
-notice. To that subject in all his excursions he
-has not paid even the cold respect of a passing
-glance.</p>
-
-<p>“When this debate, sir, was to be resumed on
-Thursday morning, it so happened that it would
-have been convenient for me to be elsewhere.
-The honorable member, however, did not incline<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_244" id="Page_244">[Pg 244]</a></span>
-to put off the discussion to another day. He had
-a shot, he said, to return, and he wished to discharge
-it. That shot, which it was kind thus to
-inform us was coming, that we might stand out
-of the way, or prepare ourselves to fall before it
-and die with decency, has now been received.
-Under all advantages, and with expectation awakened
-by the tone which preceded it, it has been
-discharged and has spent its force. It may become
-me to say no more of its effect than that,
-if nobody is found, after all, either killed or
-wounded by it, it is not the first time in the history
-of human affairs that the vigor and success
-of the war have not quite come up to the lofty
-and sounding phrase of the manifesto.”</p>
-
-<p>Referring to Col. Hayne’s statement that there
-was something rankling here (indicating his heart)
-which he wished to relieve, Mr. Webster said:
-“In this respect, sir, I have a great advantage
-over the honorable gentleman. There is nothing
-<em>here</em>, sir, which gives me the slightest uneasiness;
-neither fear nor anger, nor that which is sometimes
-more troublesome than either, the consciousness
-of having been in the wrong....
-I must repeat, also, that nothing has been received
-<em>here</em> which <em>rankles</em> or in any way gives me annoyance.
-I will not accuse the honorable gentleman
-of violating the rules of civilized war; I<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_245" id="Page_245">[Pg 245]</a></span>
-will not say he poisoned his arrows. But whether
-his shafts were, or were not, dipped in that
-which would have caused rankling if they had
-reached, there was not, as it happened, quite
-strength enough in the bow to bring them to
-their mark. If he wishes now to gather up these
-shafts he must look for them elsewhere; they
-will not be found fixed and quivering in the
-object at which they were aimed.”</p>
-
-<p>Col. Hayne and his friends, as they listened to
-these words, breathing a calm consciousness of
-power not unmixed with a grand disdain, must
-have realized that they had exulted too soon.
-Indeed Hayne’s friends had not all looked forward
-with confidence to his victory. Senator
-Iredell, of North Carolina, to a friend of Hayne’s
-who was praising his speech, had said the evening
-previous, “He has started the lion—but wait till
-we hear his roar, or feel his claws.”</p>
-
-<p>While I do not propose to give an abstract of
-this famous oration, I shall quote some of the
-most brilliant and effective passages, well known
-and familiar though they are, because they will
-be re-read with fresh and added interest in this
-connection. There was not a son of Massachusetts,
-nay, there was not a New Englander, whose heart
-was not thrilled by the splendid tribute to Massachusetts.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_246" id="Page_246">[Pg 246]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>“Mr. President, I shall enter upon no encomium
-on Massachusetts; she needs none.
-There she is. Behold her and judge for yourselves.
-There is her history; the world knows
-it by heart. The past, at least, is secure. There
-is Boston, and Concord, and Lexington, and
-Bunker Hill; and there they will remain forever.
-The bones of her sons, falling in the great struggle
-for independence, now lie mingled with the
-soil of every State from New England to Georgia,
-and there they will lie forever. And, sir, where
-American liberty raised its first voice, and where
-its youth was nurtured and sustained, there it
-still lives, in the strength of its manhood and
-full of its original spirit. If discord and disunion
-shall wound it, if party strife and blind ambition
-shall hawk at and tear it, if folly and madness, if
-uneasiness under salutary and necessary restraint,
-shall succeed in separating it from that union by
-which alone its existence is made sure, it will
-stand, in the end, by the side of that cradle in
-which its infancy was rocked; it will stretch
-forth its arm with whatever of vigor it may still
-retain over the friends who gather round it; and
-it will fall at last, if fall it must, amidst the
-proudest monuments of its own glory, and on
-the very spot of its origin.”</p>
-
-<p>Mr. Webster shows his magnanimity by pro<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_247" id="Page_247">[Pg 247]</a></span>nouncing,
-in like manner, an eulogium upon his
-opponent’s native State, which is in bright contrast
-with the mean and unjust attacks of Col.
-Hayne upon Massachusetts. This is what he
-says:</p>
-
-<p>“Let me observe that the eulogium pronounced
-on the character of South Carolina by the
-honorable gentleman for her Revolutionary and
-other merits meets my hearty concurrence. I
-shall not acknowledge that the honorable member
-goes before me in regard for whatever of
-distinguished talent, of distinguished character,
-South Carolina has produced. I claim part of
-the honor. I partake in the pride of her great
-names. I claim them for countrymen, one and
-all, the Laurenses, the Rutledges, the Pinkneys,
-the Sumters, the Marions, Americans all, whose
-fame is no more to be hemmed in by State lines
-than their talents and patriotism were capable of
-being circumscribed within the same narrow
-limits. In their day and generation they served
-and honored the country, and the whole country;
-and their renown is one of the treasures of the
-whole country. Him whose honored name the
-gentleman himself bears—does he esteem me less
-capable of gratitude for his patriotism, or sympathy
-for his sufferings, than if his eyes had first
-opened upon the light of Massachusetts instead<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_248" id="Page_248">[Pg 248]</a></span>
-of South Carolina? Sir, does he suppose it in
-his power to exhibit a Carolina name so bright
-as to produce envy in my bosom? No, sir; increased
-gratification rather. I thank God that,
-if I am gifted with little of the spirit which is
-able to raise mortals to the skies, I have yet
-none, as I trust, of that other spirit which
-would drag angels down. When I shall be found,
-sir, in my place here in the Senate, or elsewhere,
-to sneer at public merit because it happens to
-spring up beyond the little limits of my own
-State or neighborhood; when I refuse, for any
-such cause, or for any cause, the homage due to
-American talent, to elevated patriotism, to sincere
-devotion to liberty and the country; or, if I see
-an uncommon endowment of Heaven, if I see extraordinary
-capacity and virtue in any son of the
-South, and if, moved by local prejudice or gangrened
-by State jealousy, I get up here to abate
-the tithe of a hair from his just character and
-just fame, may my tongue cleave to the roof of
-my mouth!”</p>
-
-<p>It must not be supposed that Mr. Webster’s
-speech was merely of a personal character. In a
-sound and logical manner he discussed the limits
-of constitutional authority, and combated the
-pernicious doctrine of State supremacy, which
-thirty years later was to kindle a civil war of vast<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_249" id="Page_249">[Pg 249]</a></span>
-proportions, the starting-point being South Carolina.
-At the risk of quoting paragraphs which
-my young readers may skip, I proceed to introduce
-an extract which may give an idea of this
-part of the oration.</p>
-
-<p>“We approach at length, sir, to a more important
-part of the honorable gentleman’s observations.
-Since it does not accord with my views
-of justice and policy to give away the public lands
-altogether, as mere matter of gratuity, I am asked
-by the honorable gentleman on what ground
-it is that I consent to vote them away in particular
-instances. How, he inquires, do I reconcile
-with these profound sentiments my support of
-measures appropriating portions of the land to
-particular roads, particular canals, particular rivers,
-and particular institutions of education in the
-West? This leads, sir, to the real and wide difference
-in political opinion between the honorable
-gentleman and myself. On my part, I look
-upon all these objects as connected with the
-common good, fairly embraced in its object and
-terms; he, on the contrary, deems them all, if
-good at all, only local good.</p>
-
-<p>“This is our difference.</p>
-
-<p>“The interrogatory which he proceeded to put
-at once explains this difference. ‘What interest,’
-asks he,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_250" id="Page_250">[Pg 250]</a></span> ‘has South Carolina in a canal in Ohio?’
-Sir, this very question is full of significance. It
-develops the gentleman’s whole political system,
-and its answer expounds mine. Here we differ.
-I look upon a road over the Alleghanies, a canal
-round the Falls of the Ohio, or a canal or railway
-from the Atlantic to the Western waters, as being
-an object large and extensive enough to be fairly
-said to be for the common benefit. The gentleman
-thinks otherwise, and this is the key to his
-construction of the powers of the government.
-He may well ask what interest has South Carolina
-in a canal in Ohio. On his system, it is
-true, she has no interest. On that system, Ohio
-and South Carolina are different governments
-and different countries; connected here, it is true,
-by some slight and ill-defined bond of union, but
-in all main respects separate and diverse. On
-that system South Carolina has no more interest in
-a canal in Ohio than in Mexico. The gentleman,
-therefore, only follows out his own principles;
-he does no more than arrive at the natural conclusions
-of his own doctrines; he only announces
-the true results of that creed which he has
-adopted himself, and would persuade others to
-adopt, when he thus declares that South Carolina
-has no interest in a public work in Ohio.</p>
-
-<p>“Sir, we narrow-minded people of New
-England do not reason thus. Our notion of<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_251" id="Page_251">[Pg 251]</a></span>
-things is entirely different. We look upon the
-States not as separated but united. We love to
-dwell on that union, and on the mutual happiness
-which it has so much promoted, and the common
-renown which it has so greatly contributed to acquire.
-In our contemplation South Carolina and
-Ohio are parts of the same country, States united
-under the same general government, having interests
-common, associated, intermingled. In whatever
-is within the proper sphere of the constitutional
-power of this government we look upon the
-States as one. We do not impose geographical
-limits to our patriotic feelings or regard; we do
-not follow rivers and mountains and lines of latitude
-to find boundaries beyond which public improvements
-do not benefit us.</p>
-
-<p>“We who come here, as agents and representatives
-of these narrow-minded and selfish men of
-New England, consider ourselves as bound to regard
-with an equal eye the good of the whole in
-whatever is within our power of legislation. Sir,
-if a railroad or canal, beginning in South Carolina
-and ending in South Carolina, appeared to
-me to be of national importance and national
-magnitude, believing, as I do, that the power of
-government extends the encouragement of works
-of that description, if I were to stand up here
-and ask, What interest has Massachusetts in a rail<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_252" id="Page_252">[Pg 252]</a></span>road
-in South Carolina? I should not be willing
-to face my constituents. These same narrow-minded
-men would tell me that they had sent me
-to act for the whole country, and that one who
-possessed too little comprehension either of intellect
-or feeling, one who was not large enough
-both in mind and in heart to embrace the whole,
-was not fit to be intrusted with the interests of
-our part.”</p>
-
-<p>This will give an idea of the broad national
-sentiments entertained and expressed by the
-senator from Massachusetts. It is certainly in
-strong contrast to the narrow sectional views of
-Col. Hayne and John C. Calhoun.</p>
-
-<p>Towards the close of his speech Mr. Webster
-describes in an amusing way a supposed conflict
-in South Carolina between the customs officers of
-the government and a local force led by his opponent.
-It was playful, but Col. Hayne was
-moved by the ridicule with which it covered him
-more than by any of Mr. Webster’s arguments.</p>
-
-<p>It need hardly be said that the entire address
-was listened to with rapt attention. As it proceeded
-those friends of Mr. Webster who doubted
-his ability to cope with the Southern champion,
-and who had listened to his first words with feelings
-of anxious solicitude, became cheerful and
-even jubilant. In fact they changed aspects with<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_253" id="Page_253">[Pg 253]</a></span>
-Hayne’s friends who had awaited the opening of
-the speech with supercilious disdain. The calm
-power, the humorous contempt, with which Mr.
-Webster handled the doughty champion annoyed
-them not a little.</p>
-
-<p>I do not mean to underrate the ability or eloquence
-of Col. Hayne. Upon this point it is
-sufficient to quote the opinion of Mr. Everett, the
-tried and intimate friend of Daniel Webster, who
-says: “It is unnecessary to state, except to those
-who have come forward quite recently, that Col.
-Hayne was a gentleman of ability very far above
-the average, a highly accomplished debater, an
-experienced politician, a person possessing the
-full confidence of his friends, and entirely familiar
-with the argument on which the theory controverted
-in Mr. Webster’s speech rests.”</p>
-
-<p>Mr. March, in his “Reminiscences of Congress,”
-a book from which I have received valuable
-help in the composition of this chapter, describes
-Hayne’s oratory in these terms:</p>
-
-<p>“Hayne dashed into debate like the Mameluke
-cavalry upon a charge. There was a gallant air
-about him that could not but win admiration.
-He never provided for retreat; he never imagined
-it. He had an invincible confidence in
-himself, which arose partly from constitutional
-temperament, partly from previous success. His<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_254" id="Page_254">[Pg 254]</a></span>
-was the Napoleonic warfare: to strike at once
-for the capital of the enemy, heedless of danger
-or cost to his own forces. Not doubting to overcome
-all odds, he feared none, however seemingly
-superior. Of great fluency and no little force of
-expression, his speech never halted, and seldom
-fatigued.”</p>
-
-<p>Mr. Webster swept on to the close of his speech
-with power unabated. Some of his friends had
-feared he could not sustain his elevated flight,
-that he would mar the effect of his great passages
-by dropping to the commonplace. They had no
-need to fear. He thoroughly understood his own
-powers. At length he reached the peroration—that
-famous peroration, so well known, yet, in
-spite of its familiarity, so impossible to omit here.</p>
-
-<p>“When my eyes shall be turned to behold for
-the last time the sun in heaven, may I not see
-him shining on the broken and dishonored fragments
-of a once glorious Union; on States dissevered,
-discordant, belligerent; on a land rent
-with civil feuds, or drenched, it may be, in fraternal
-blood! Let their last feeble and lingering
-glance rather behold the gorgeous ensign of the
-republic, now known and honored throughout
-the earth, still full high advanced, its arms and
-trophies streaming in their original luster, not a
-stripe erased or polluted, not a single star ob<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_255" id="Page_255">[Pg 255]</a></span>scured,
-bearing for its motto no such miserable
-interrogatory, ‘What is all this worth?’ nor those
-other words of delusion and folly, ‘Liberty first
-and Union afterwards:’ but everywhere, spread
-all over in characters of living light, blazing on
-all its ample folds, as they float over the seas and
-over the land, and in every wind under the whole
-heavens, that other sentiment, dear to every
-American heart—Liberty and Union, now and
-forever, one and inseparable!”</p>
-
-<p>Hayne attempted a reply to this speech, but it
-had little effect. It was followed by a telling
-<i lang="fr">résumé</i> of his positions by Mr. Webster, and so
-far as these two speakers were concerned the discussion
-closed.</p>
-
-<p>It is remarkable how little effort this famous
-oration cost it author. The constitutional argument,
-to be sure, was familiar to him, and he
-had but to state it, but for the great passages, including
-the exordium, the peroration, the encomium
-upon Massachusetts, the speaker was indebted
-to the inspiration of the moment; yet they
-are so compact, so fitly expressed, so elegantly
-worded, that he would be a bold man who should
-suggest even a verbal change.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_256" id="Page_256">[Pg 256]</a></span></p>
-
-
-
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-<h2><a name="CHAPTER_XXXII" id="CHAPTER_XXXII">CHAPTER XXXII.</a><br />
-
-<small>THE SECRET OF WEBSTER’S POWER.</small></h2>
-
-
-<p>It is hardly necessary to say that when Mr.
-Webster’s speech in reply to Hayne was published
-and read by the country at large it made
-a profound impression. Doubtless it kindled
-afresh in many wavering hearts a love for that
-Union the claims of which upon the American
-citizen the orator so strongly urged. It is interesting
-to know that Hayne himself, while he essayed
-to answer it, appreciated its power.</p>
-
-<p>Mr. Harvey relates, upon Mr. Webster’s authority,
-that when he had finished his speech
-some Southern members approached him cordially
-and said, “Mr. Webster, I think you had
-better die now and rest your fame on that speech.”</p>
-
-<p>Mr. Hayne, who was standing near by, and
-heard the remark, said, “You ought not to die;
-a man who can make such speeches as that ought
-never to die.”</p>
-
-<p>It is related that Mr. Webster, meeting his
-opponent at the President’s reception the same<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_257" id="Page_257">[Pg 257]</a></span>
-evening, went up to him and remarked, pleasantly,</p>
-
-<p>“How are you to-night?”</p>
-
-<p>“None the better for you, sir,” answered
-Hayne, humorously.</p>
-
-<p>Henry Clay wrote later: “I congratulate you
-on the very great addition which you have
-made during the session to your previous high
-reputation. Your speeches, and particularly in
-reply to Mr. Hayne, are the theme of praise
-from every tongue, and I have shared in the delight
-which all have felt.”</p>
-
-<p>In its powerful defense of the Constitution
-Mr. Webster carried with him patriotic men all
-over the country. Hon. William Gaston, of
-North Carolina, wrote thus: “The ability with
-which the great argument is treated, the patriotic
-fervor with which the Union is asserted,
-give you claim to the gratitude of every one
-who loves his country and regards the Constitution
-as its best hope and surest stay. My engrossing
-occupations leave me little leisure for
-any correspondence except on business, but I
-have resolved to seize a moment to let you know
-that with us there is scarcely a division of opinion
-among the intelligent portion of the community.
-All of them whose understanding
-or whose conscience is not surrendered to the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_258" id="Page_258">[Pg 258]</a></span>
-servitude of faction, greet your eloquent efforts
-with unmixed gratification.”</p>
-
-<p>It is an interesting question how far Mr. Webster
-prepared himself for this his greatest, or, at
-any rate, his most effective parliamentary speech.</p>
-
-<p>Upon this point let us read the statement of
-Mr. Webster himself, as given to his tried friend,
-Mr. Harvey.</p>
-
-<p>In reference to the remark that he had made
-no preparation for the Hayne speech, he said:
-“That was not quite so. If it was meant that
-I took notes and studied with a view to a reply,
-that was not true; but that I was thoroughly
-conversant with the subject of debate, from
-having made preparation for a totally different
-purpose than that speech, is true. The preparation
-for my reply to Hayne was made upon the
-occasion of Mr. Foote’s resolution to sell the public
-lands. Some years before that, Mr. McKinley,
-a senator from Alabama, introduced a resolution
-into the Senate, proposing to cede the public
-domains to the States in which they were situated.
-It struck me at that time as being so unfair
-and improper that I immediately prepared an
-argument to resist it. My argument embraced
-the whole history of the public lands, and the
-government’s action in regard to them. Then
-there was another question involved in the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_259" id="Page_259">[Pg 259]</a></span>
-Hayne debate. It was as to the right and practice
-of petition. Mr. Calhoun had denied the
-right of petition on the subject of slavery. In
-other words, he claimed that, if the petition was
-for some subject which the Senate had no right
-to grant, then there was no right of petition. If
-the Senate had no such right, then the petitioners
-had no right to come there. Calhoun’s doctrine
-seemed to be accepted, and I made preparation to
-answer his proposition. It so happened that the
-debate did not take place, because the matter
-never was pressed. I had my notes tucked away
-in a pigeon-hole, and when Hayne made that
-attack upon me and upon New England I was
-already posted, and only had to take down
-my notes and refresh my memory. In other
-words, if he had tried to make a speech to fit
-my notes he could not have hit it better. No
-man is inspired with the occasion; I never was.”</p>
-
-<p>Mr. Webster was too great a man to wish for
-praise which he did not deserve. That is for
-men of inferior ability, who are glad to have it
-believed that their most elaborate utterances are
-“thrown off upon the spur of the moment.”
-Indeed he does not claim enough when he disclaims
-being inspired by the occasion. His encomium
-upon New England, his glowing peroration,
-were fused and put into enduring form<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_260" id="Page_260">[Pg 260]</a></span>
-under the pressure of strong emotion, which
-may well be termed inspiration. Yet it was
-always his habit to ascribe his great efforts to
-hard labor rather than to genius, and he remarked
-to a young clergyman on one occasion, who had
-questioned him in regard to some of his speeches,
-“Young man, there is no such thing as extemporaneous
-acquisition.”</p>
-
-<p>If a man like Daniel Webster felt constrained
-to say this, how much more ought labor to be
-held necessary by the ordinary mind. My young
-readers may be assured that diligent and uncomplaining
-toil are the secret springs in most
-cases of worldly success. So, if they chance to
-dash off a smooth essay in a mood of inspiration,
-they may have good cause to doubt whether it
-has any solid value. I recall a certain school
-where a prize was offered for an essay on a subject
-requiring a certain amount of thought and
-research. The leading contestants were two
-boys, one quick and brilliant, the other slow and
-plodding, but sound. Both were anxious to succeed.
-The second began in due time and worked
-steadily, not allowing himself to be unduly hurried.
-The first waited till within two days of
-the date at which the essays were to be submitted,
-and then dashed off an essay which was
-very creditable under the circumstances. But<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_261" id="Page_261">[Pg 261]</a></span>
-it did not win. It was slow and sure that won the
-prize, then, as in so many other cases. I am glad
-to have the potent example of Daniel Webster to
-help me in enforcing a lesson so valuable to youth.</p>
-
-<p>Yet Mr. Webster was always ready of speech.
-He could make a great speech upon any occasion,
-and upon any subject, however slight. An
-illustration of this is given by Hon. John Wentworth,
-of Illinois, in a letter from which I proceed
-to quote:</p>
-
-<p>“Mr. Webster won my lasting gratitude by
-his assistance in the passage of the River and
-Harbor bill, in 1846. The bill had passed the
-House and been referred to the Committee on
-Commerce, a majority of whom were of the
-‘strict construction’ school, believing that Congress
-could improve a natural harbor, but could
-not make one. I went before the committee to
-defend the appropriation for a harbor at Little
-Fort, now called Waukegan. I found I had no
-friends there but Senator Reverdy Johnson, of
-Maryland. The committee recommended that
-the appropriation be struck out. Senator John
-A. Dix, of New York, led the opposition. He
-had been a graduate of West Point, was a good
-engineer, had brought the map of survey into
-the Senate, and was having great influence
-against it. I was seated in the lobby directly<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_262" id="Page_262">[Pg 262]</a></span>
-behind Col. Thomas H. Benton, and Webster
-was upon his usual walk. He gave me a nod of
-recognition and passed on. Gen. Dix kept up
-his fire and I felt it. Our senators, Sidney
-Breese and James Semple, were both from the
-southern part of our State, and had no personal
-knowledge of the merits of the case. The Indiana
-senators were similarly situated. Wisconsin
-had no senators. And the Michigan
-senators lived at Detroit, and they had only a
-general knowledge of Lake Michigan.</p>
-
-<p>“As Webster was traveling to and fro past
-me, the thought occurred to me that, as he was
-‘a liberal constructionist,’ he was just the man
-to rectify all the damage that Gen. Dix was doing.
-But it was a small matter for so great a
-man. Besides, I knew that his colleague, Senator
-John Davis, was taking the side of Gen.
-Dix. As Webster would pass me I would resolve
-that the next time he would come I would
-speak to him. But my courage would forsake
-me when I reflected that he was a Whig and I
-was a Democrat. I wanted some excuse to speak
-to him. He had known my father. He was a
-son of New Hampshire, and a graduate of the
-same college with myself. But my heart failed
-me; and yet it was all the while sighing,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_263" id="Page_263">[Pg 263]</a></span> ‘Webster,
-Webster, do but speak to me.’</p>
-
-<p>“At length came his voice, in deep, sepulchral
-tone, ‘Wentworth, what is Dix making all this
-ado about?’</p>
-
-<p>“Promptly the answer came: ‘Mr. Webster,
-since your trip around the lakes from Chicago,
-in 1837, we have had but few appropriations for
-old harbors and none for new ones. This place
-is half way between Chicago and Milwaukee, and
-we want a harbor of refuge there.’</p>
-
-<p>“‘I see the point, I see the point,’ says Webster,
-and at once went to his seat upon the Senate
-floor.</p>
-
-<p>“When Gen. Dix had concluded, Mr. Webster
-observed that he could add nothing to the conclusive
-argument of the senator from New York
-in favor of the appropriation. He thought he
-had satisfied all the senators that there was no
-harbor at the place, and so the House must have
-thought when it made the appropriation to construct
-one there. Upon what did the senator
-from New York found his doctrine that, when
-God created the world, or even Lake Michigan,
-He left nothing for man to do? The curse pronounced
-upon our first parents for their transgression
-was in entire conflict with any such
-doctrine. He did not believe that the Constitution
-of the United States was such a narrowly
-contracted instrument that it would not permit<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_264" id="Page_264">[Pg 264]</a></span>
-the construction of a harbor where the necessities
-of commerce required it. He then foreshadowed
-the growth of the West, its abundant products,
-its gigantic commerce, its numerous people.
-He started a steamer from Chicago laden to the
-guards with freight and passengers. He then
-described a storm in a manner that no man but
-Webster could describe. His flight of eloquence
-equaled his best at Bunker Hill or Plymouth
-Rock. You could hear the dashing waves, the
-whistling winds, the creaking timbers, and the
-shrieking passengers, and, as he sent the vessel
-to the bottom with all on board, he exclaimed:
-‘What but a merciful Providence saved me from
-such a catastrophe when I passed over Lake Michigan
-in 1837?’ At such a dire disaster could the
-senator from New York derive any consolation
-from the reflection that his narrow interpretation
-of the Constitution had been maintained?</p>
-
-<p>“As Webster closed Col. Benton turned to
-me and said, ‘That is the greatest speech upon
-so small a matter that I ever heard.’ Reverdy
-Johnson came up and said, ‘Now, don’t you
-abuse the Whigs any more.’ And Senator Breese
-said, ‘Now you can go back to the House. That
-speech saves us.’</p>
-
-<p>“The bill passed without amendment. But
-alas! President Polk vetoed it. And out of his<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_265" id="Page_265">[Pg 265]</a></span>
-veto grew that wonderful event in the history
-of Chicago, the river and harbor convention of
-1847, a vast assemblage, composed of the most
-talented, enterprising, wealthy and influential
-men of all parts of the country. At the laying
-of the corner-stone of the Douglas Monument,
-Gen. Dix was here as the principal orator.
-While others were speaking I called his attention
-to our magnificent harbor works. After complimenting
-them highly he said, ‘They ought to
-protect you from any storm—even from such a
-one as Webster manufactured for you in the
-Senate in 1846.’”</p>
-
-<p>It must be remembered that this readiness of
-Mr. Webster arose not wholly from his great
-powers, but largely from the fact that all his
-life long he had been a diligent and faithful student.
-Hence it was that his mind was a vast
-reservoir of acquisition from which he could at
-will draw out what was most fitting upon any
-subject. So Sir Walter Scott, browsing in his
-boyhood among the treasures of legendary lore
-and feudal traditions, was unconsciously preparing
-himself for the novels and poetical romances
-with which many years afterwards he delighted
-the world, and made his native land famous.</p>
-
-<p>Recurring to the subject of nullification, at
-which Mr. Webster had aimed so powerful a<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_266" id="Page_266">[Pg 266]</a></span>
-blow, it may be said that it was scotched but not
-killed. Col. Hayne was overwhelmed, but he
-was not convinced. Neither was John C. Calhoun,
-the greater representative of the same State,
-who entirely accorded with Hayne in his extreme
-views of the rights and powers of the separate
-States. Not long afterwards Col. Hayne resigned
-his seat in the Senate, in order to be
-elected Governor of South Carolina, and lead at
-home the opponents of the government, while Mr.
-Calhoun, resigning his place as Vice-President,
-was elected senator in the place of Hayne, to
-lead the forces of nullification on the floor of
-the Senate. Through the firmness of President
-Jackson their schemes came to naught, but were
-revived, as we know, thirty years later by the
-citizens of the same State, and the Civil War was
-the result.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_267" id="Page_267">[Pg 267]</a></span></p>
-
-
-
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-<h2><a name="CHAPTER_XXXIII" id="CHAPTER_XXXIII">CHAPTER XXXIII.</a><br />
-
-<small>HONORS RECEIVED IN ENGLAND.</small></h2>
-
-
-<p>It would require a volume far larger than the
-present to speak in detail of Mr. Webster’s public
-life, to point out his public services, to enumerate
-the occasions on which he took a distinguished
-part in debate. But this does not come within
-my plan. Fortunately there are other works in
-which such as desire it can gain all the information
-they desire upon these points. They will
-find how closely Mr. Webster was identified with
-the history of the nation, and what a powerful
-influence he exerted upon all public measures.
-And all the while he was making an equally
-brilliant reputation at the bar. He was employed
-in numerous “great cases,” and in none was he
-found unequal to his opportunity.</p>
-
-<p>The result of his multifarious and exhausting
-labors was a determination to make a tour of recreation,
-and not unnaturally he decided to visit
-England, a country which to every American of
-Anglo-Saxon race must possess a first attraction.
-His second wife, who died but a few weeks since,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_268" id="Page_268">[Pg 268]</a></span>
-his daughter, and Mrs. Page, the wife of his
-brother-in-law, were of the party. His youngest
-son, Edward, then a Dartmouth student, joined
-them later.</p>
-
-<p>Mr. Webster’s fame had preceded him, and he
-received unusual honors. One paper in announcing
-his arrival said, “We cordially welcome to
-our shores this great and good man, and accept
-him as a fit representative of all the great and
-good qualities of our transatlantic brethren.”
-So great was the curiosity to see him that the
-press of carriages about the door of his hotel was
-almost unprecedented. He was invited everywhere,
-and was cordially received by the most
-prominent men. In fact, he was a “lion,” and
-that in a marked sense.</p>
-
-<p>Among others he met that eccentric and craggy
-genius, Thomas Carlyle, and I am sure my readers
-young and old will like to know what impression
-the great senator made upon the Scotch philosopher.</p>
-
-<p>This is what Carlyle writes:</p>
-
-<p>“American notabilities are daily becoming notable
-among us, the ties of the two parishes,
-mother and daughter, getting closer and closer
-knit. Indissoluble ties!</p>
-
-<p>“I reckon that this huge smoky wen may for
-some centuries yet be the best Mycale for our<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_269" id="Page_269">[Pg 269]</a></span>
-Saxon Panionium, a yearly meeting-place of ‘all
-the Saxons’ from beyond the Atlantic, from the
-antipodes, or wherever the restless wanderers
-dwell and toil. After centuries, if Boston, if
-New York, have become the most convenient
-‘All-Saxondom,’ we will right cheerfully go
-thither to hold such festival and leave the wen.</p>
-
-<p>“Not many days ago I saw at breakfast the
-notablest of all your notabilities, Daniel Webster.
-He is a magnificent specimen. You might say
-to all the world, ‘This is our Yankee Englishman;
-such limbs we make in Yankee-land!’ As
-a logic-fencer, advocate or parliamentary Hercules,
-one would incline to back him at first sight
-against the extant world. The tanned complexion,
-that amorphous crag-like face, the dull black
-eyes under the precipice of brows [I am sure no
-one ever called Mr. Webster’s eyes dull before or
-since], like dull anthracite furnaces only waiting
-to be <em>blown</em>, the mastiff mouth accurately closed—I
-have not traced so much of <em>silent Berseker’s
-rage</em> that I remember of in any other man. ‘I
-guess I should not like to be your nigger.’ Webster
-is not loquacious, but he is pertinent, conclusive,
-a dignified, perfectly-bred man, though not
-English in breeding, a man worthy of the best
-reception among us, and meeting such, I understand.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_270" id="Page_270">[Pg 270]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>In a letter to Mr. Ticknor, John Kenyon indulges
-in some reminiscences of Mr. Webster,
-whom he met intimately, having traveled with
-him and his family party during four days.</p>
-
-<p>“Coleridge used to say that he had seldom
-known or heard of any great man who had not
-‘much of the woman in him.’ Even so, that large
-intellect of Daniel Webster seemed to be coupled
-with all softer feelings, and his countenance and
-bearing at the very first impressed me with this.</p>
-
-<p>“All men, without having studied either science,
-are, we all know, more or less phrenologists
-and physiognomists. Right or wrong, I had
-found as I thought much sensibility in Webster’s
-countenance. A few weeks afterwards I had an
-opportunity of learning that it was not there
-<em>only</em>. We were in a hackney coach, driving
-along the New Road to Baring’s in the City. It
-was a longish drive, and we had time to get into
-a train of talk, also we were by that time what I
-may presume to call ‘intimate.’ I said, ‘Mr.
-Webster, you once, I believe, had a brother?’
-’Yes,’ he kindly said, ‘when I see you and your
-brother together I often think of him,’ and—I
-speak the fact as it was—I saw, after a little more
-talk on the subject of his brother, the tears begin
-to trickle down his cheek till he said to me, ‘I’ll
-give you an account of my early life,’ and he be<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_271" id="Page_271">[Pg 271]</a></span>gan
-with his father, and the farm in New Hampshire,
-and his own early education, and that of
-his brother, the details of his courtship and first
-marriage, and his no property at the time, but of
-his hopes in his profession and of his success, as
-he spoke showing much emotion. How could
-one help loving a man at once so powerful and so
-tender?”</p>
-
-<p>The opinions of those who are themselves eminent
-are of interest. Let us see, therefore, what
-Hallam, the historian, says of our subject.</p>
-
-<p>“I have had more than one opportunity,” he
-writes to Mr. Ticknor, “of hearing of you, especially
-from your very distinguished countryman,
-Mr. Webster, with whom I had the pleasure of
-becoming acquainted last summer. It is but an
-echo of the common voice here to say that I was
-extremely struck by his appearance, deportment
-and conversation. Mr. Webster approaches as
-nearly to the <i lang="fr">beau ideal</i> of a republican senator
-as any man that I have ever seen in the course of
-my life, worthy of Rome, or Venice, rather than
-of our noisy and wrangling generation. I wish
-that some of our public men here would take example
-from his grave and prudent manner of
-speaking on political subjects, which seemed to
-me neither too incautious nor too strikingly reserved.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_272" id="Page_272">[Pg 272]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>It is seldom that a man’s personal appearance
-is so impressive as that of Daniel Webster, seldom
-that his greatness is so visibly stamped upon his
-face and figure. An admirer of Mr. Webster
-was once shocked by hearing him called “a hum-bug.”
-“What do you mean?” he demanded
-angrily. “I mean this,” was the reply, “that no
-man can possibly be as great as he looks.”</p>
-
-<p>I have said that Mr. Webster was the recipient
-of attentions from all classes, I may add, from the
-highest in the land. Mr. and Mrs. Webster dined
-privately with Queen Victoria by special invitation,
-and it is recorded that the young Queen,
-for she was then young, was much impressed by
-the majestic demeanor of the great American.
-Even the Eton boys, who are wont to chaff all
-visitors, forgot their propensity in the presence of
-Mr. Webster. As Mr. Kenyon, already quoted,
-writes: “Not one look of unseemly curiosity,
-much less of the quizzing which I had rather
-anticipated, had we to undergo. Webster was
-not merely gratified, he was visibly touched by
-the sight. You remember that Charles Lamb
-said at Eton—I do not pretend to quote his exact
-words—‘What a pity that these fine youths
-should grow up into paltry members of Parliament!’
-For myself, when I saw them so cheerful
-and yet so civilized and well-conditioned, I<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_273" id="Page_273">[Pg 273]</a></span>
-remember thinking to myself at the moment,
-’Well, if I had a boy I should send him to
-Eton.’”</p>
-
-<p>While at the Castle Inn, in Windsor, Mr.
-Webster wrote the following autograph, by request,
-for Mr. Kenyon:</p>
-
-<div class="poetry-container"><div class="poetry"><div class="stanza">
-<div class="verse">“When you and I are dead and gone</div>
-<div class="verse">This busy world will still jog on,</div>
-<div class="verse">And laugh and sing and be as hearty</div>
-<div class="verse">As if we still were of the party.”</div>
-</div></div></div>
-
-<p>There is no doubt that Mr. Webster enjoyed
-heartily his well-earned recreation. He had good
-cause. Never certainly up to that time had an
-American been received in England with such
-distinguished honors. I will close by his own
-account of the way in which he was received.</p>
-
-<p>“I must say that the good people have treated
-me with great kindness. Their hospitality is unbounded,
-and I find nothing cold or stiff in their
-manners, at least not more than is observed among
-ourselves. There may be exceptions, but I think
-I may say this as a general truth. The thing
-in England most prejudiced against the United
-States is the press. Its ignorance of us is shocking,
-and it is increased by such absurdities as the
-travelers publish, to which stock of absurdities
-I am sorry to say Captain Marryatt is making<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_274" id="Page_274">[Pg 274]</a></span>
-an abundant addition. In general the Whigs
-know more and think better of America than
-the Tories. This is undeniable. Yet my intercourse
-I think is as much with the Conservatives
-as the Whigs. I have several invitations to pass
-time in the country after Parliament is prorogued.
-Two or three of them I have agreed to
-accept. Lord Lansdowne and the Earl of Radnor
-have invited us, who live in the south, the Duke
-of Rutland, Sir Henry Halford, Earl Fitzwilliam,
-Lord Lonsdale, etc., who live in the north.”</p>
-
-<p>Of one thing my young reader may be assured,
-that no attentions, however elevated the source,
-had any effect upon the simple dignity of a typical
-American citizen, or influenced him when a
-few years later, as Secretary of State, it became
-his duty to deal with our relations with England.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_275" id="Page_275">[Pg 275]</a></span></p>
-
-
-
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-<h2><a name="CHAPTER_XXXIV" id="CHAPTER_XXXIV">CHAPTER XXXIV.</a><br />
-
-<small>CALLED TO THE CABINET.</small></h2>
-
-
-<p>In the Presidential campaign of 1840, General
-Harrison, the nominee of the Whig party,
-swept the country, and was elected amid demonstrations
-of popular enthusiasm till then unprecedented.
-As we look back upon this time, uninfluenced
-by passion, we can only wonder how
-a man so moderately fitted for the position should
-have aroused such a furor. That he should have
-been nominated, while such born leaders and
-accomplished statesmen as Mr. Webster were
-passed over, need excite no surprise. In an ideal
-republic the best man and the wisest statesman
-would be selected, but there are no ideal statesmen,
-and are not likely to be. General Harrison
-was available, and therefore was put forward as
-the standard-bearer.</p>
-
-<p>I do not mean to say that our nominees have
-always been mediocre men. James A. Garfield
-was a trained and experienced statesman, so was
-James Buchanan (his faults were of a different
-order), so were the early Presidents, and so have<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_276" id="Page_276">[Pg 276]</a></span>
-been occasional nominees of both great parties;
-but, as a rule, public men of the first rank have
-been passed by for candidates more available.</p>
-
-<p>General Harrison showed this evidence of fitness
-for his high station, that almost immediately
-after his election, he indicated a strong desire that
-Mr. Webster should enter his Cabinet. Modestly
-distrustful of his own abilities, he wished to
-strengthen his administration by calling to his
-councils Mr. Webster and Mr. Clay. He writes
-thus to Mr. Webster, Dec. 1, 1840:</p>
-
-<p>“Since I was first a candidate for the Presidency,
-I had determined, if successful, to solicit
-your able assistance in conducting the administration,
-and I now ask you to accept the State or
-Treasury Department. I have myself no preference
-of either for you, but it may perhaps be
-more difficult to fill the latter than the former, if
-you should decline it. It was the first designed for
-you, in the supposition that you had given more
-attention to the subject of the finances than Mr.
-Clay, to whom I intended to have offered the
-State Department. This, as well as any other
-post in the Cabinet, I understood, before my arrival
-here, from an intimate friend of that gentleman,
-he would decline. This he has since done
-personally to me.”</p>
-
-<p>Mr. Webster replied that “for the daily details<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_277" id="Page_277">[Pg 277]</a></span>
-of the Treasury, the matters of account, and the
-supervision of subordinate officers employed in the
-collection and disbursement of public moneys,”
-he did not think himself to be particularly well
-qualified. He indicated that he would accept
-the office of Secretary of State.</p>
-
-<p>Mr. Webster no doubt accurately gauged his
-own abilities. No one could be better fitted for
-the premiership and the conduct of our foreign
-relations, as the event proved. At this time especially
-a strong, judicious statesman of the first
-rank was required, for the relations between the
-United States and Great Britain were very delicate
-and even critical, and a rash hand might
-easily have plunged the two countries into war.
-One vexed question related to the boundary
-between this country and the provinces of Nova
-Scotia and Canada. This question was complicated
-by others of a still more irritating character,
-which space will not allow me to particularize.
-There was another question also, the long-standing
-claim of England to impress her own seamen,
-and to take them out of American vessels sailing
-on the high seas in time of war, rendering necessary
-the odious “right of search.”</p>
-
-<p>Mr. Webster was influenced to accept the post
-of Secretary of State, because he knew these
-questions ought to be settled, and he felt confi<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_278" id="Page_278">[Pg 278]</a></span>dent
-of his ability to settle them. With this view
-the people cordially agreed, and Gen. Harrison’s
-choice of the great statesman of New England
-to take charge of our foreign relations was a
-very popular one.</p>
-
-<p>Mr. Webster’s retirement from the Senate, and
-the necessary choice of a successor, gave occasion
-for a display of magnanimity. His relations with
-Ex-President John Quincy Adams were not
-friendly—he felt that he had been very badly
-treated by Mr. Adams on one occasion—but Mr.
-Adams, from his prominent position, was likely
-to be thought of as his successor in the Senate.
-Upon this subject Mr. Webster writes to a friend:
-“Some years ago, as you well know, an incident
-occurred which interrupted intercourse between
-Mr. Adams and myself for several years, and
-wounded the feelings of many of my friends as
-well as my own. With me that occurrence is
-overlooked and forgotten. I bury all remembrance
-of it under my regard for Mr. Adams’s
-talents, character, and public services....
-Mr. Adams’s great knowledge and ability, his experience,
-and especially his thorough acquaintance
-with the foreign relations of the country, will
-undoubtedly make him prominent as a candidate;
-and I wish it to be understood that his election
-would be altogether agreeable to me.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_279" id="Page_279">[Pg 279]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>Mr. Adams, however, remained in the House
-of Representatives, and Rufus Choate was selected
-to succeed Mr. Webster. Massachusetts
-was fortunate in having three citizens so eminently
-fitted to do her honor in the national
-councils.</p>
-
-<p>When the letter announcing Mr. Webster’s
-resignation of his seat was read in the Senate, Mr.
-Clay took occasion to pay a glowing tribute to
-his great eloquence and ability, referring to him
-as “one of the noblest specimens of American
-eloquence; one of the brightest ornaments of
-these halls, of this country, and of our common
-nature.”</p>
-
-<p>The lamented death of General Harrison, on
-the 5th of April, after but a single month in
-office, interrupted official business, and made Mr.
-Webster’s position still more difficult. John
-Tyler, Vice-President, succeeding, soon made
-himself obnoxious to the party that had elected
-him. All the members of the Cabinet, except
-Mr. Webster, resigned. Mr. Webster perceived
-that he could not do so without serious detriment
-to the national interests, and he remained steadfast,
-thereby incurring the censure of many, who
-did not appreciate the patriotism and self-sacrifice
-that actuated him. The Secretary of State was
-too astute a politician not to understand that he<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_280" id="Page_280">[Pg 280]</a></span>
-was periling his own political fortunes, that he
-was raising up for himself enemies in his own
-State, and that his adherence to the administration
-might cost him the promotion which he
-ardently desired, for he had already fixed his
-eyes upon the Presidency as an object to which
-he might legitimately aspire. Nevertheless he
-adhered and kept his post till his work was done,
-and he had accomplished for this country what
-no other hand could probably have done, the
-peaceful adjustment of her foreign differences.</p>
-
-<p>In the midst of the dissatisfaction a great
-meeting was held at Faneuil Hall, and Mr. Webster
-determined to go there and face the anger of
-his former friends. Whatever might have been
-the feelings of the packed audience when Mr.
-Webster rose before them in his magnificent
-manhood, and his deep, calm eyes fell upon the
-audience, every head was instantly uncovered in
-involuntary homage.</p>
-
-<p>In the course of his speech Mr. Webster said:
-“There are always delicacy and regret when one
-feels obliged to differ from his friends, but there
-is no embarrassment. There is no embarrassment,
-because, if I see the path of duty before me, I
-have that within me which will enable me to
-pursue it, and throw all embarrassment to the
-winds. A public man has no occasion to be em<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_281" id="Page_281">[Pg 281]</a></span>barrassed
-if he is honest. Himself and his feelings
-should be to him as nobody and as nothing;
-the interest of his country must be to him as
-everything; he must sink what is personal to himself,
-making exertions for his country, and it is his
-ability and readiness to do this which are to mark
-him as a great or as a little man in time to come.</p>
-
-<p>“There were many persons in September, 1841,
-who found great fault with my remaining in the
-President’s Cabinet. You know, gentlemen, that
-twenty years of honest and not altogether undistinguished
-service in the Whig cause did not
-save me from an outpouring of wrath which
-seldom proceeds from Whig pens and Whig
-tongues against anybody. I am, gentlemen, a
-little hard to coax, but as to being driven, this is
-out of the question. I chose to trust my own
-judgment; and thinking I was at a post where I
-was in the service of the country, and could do
-it good, I stayed there, and I leave it to you to-day
-to say, I leave it to my countrymen to say,
-whether the country would have been better off
-if I had left also. I have no attachment to office.
-I have tasted of its sweets, but I have tasted of
-its bitterness. I am content with what I have
-achieved; I am ready to rest satisfied with what
-is gained rather than to run the risk of doubtful
-efforts for new acquisitions.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_282" id="Page_282">[Pg 282]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>This is the speech of a strong man—a man not
-to be turned by obloquy from any step which he
-has made up his mind to take. I think to-day
-few would question the good judgment which he
-displayed in retaining his seat in the Cabinet.
-He was enabled to negotiate a treaty with Great
-Britain—known as the Ashburton treaty—which,
-if not wholly satisfactory to the United States,
-at any rate harmonized differences to a large extent,
-and removed any immediate danger of hostilities.</p>
-
-<p>When Mr. Webster felt that his work was
-fully accomplished, on the 8th of May, 1843, he
-resigned the premiership, and hastened to his
-seaside home at Marshfield, there to enjoy the
-rest which he needed and craved.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_283" id="Page_283">[Pg 283]</a></span></p>
-
-
-
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-<h2><a name="CHAPTER_XXXV" id="CHAPTER_XXXV">CHAPTER XXXV.</a><br />
-
-<small>LIFE AT MARSHFIELD.</small></h2>
-
-
-<p>The town of Marshfield is as intimately associated
-with the name of Daniel Webster as is
-Abbotsford with Sir Walter Scott. It is a sparsely
-settled town on the south-eastern shore of Massachusetts.
-Mr. Webster’s first acquaintance with
-it dates from 1824. Both Mr. and Mrs. Webster
-were charmed with the situation of the Thomas
-Farm, as it was then called, and the grand views
-which it afforded of the ocean. For several summers
-the Websters were boarders in the family
-of Captain Thomas, and finally, in 1831, he became
-the owner of the farm by purchase. Then
-he began to make improvements, and by the
-lavish expenditure of money converted it from a
-homely farm to a fitting residence for a famous
-lawyer.</p>
-
-<p>Henceforth this was the home to which the
-thoughts of the great statesman turned when,
-weary and exhausted with his labors in the courts,
-the Cabinet or the Senate, he felt the need of
-rest. He delighted to array himself in a farmer’s<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_284" id="Page_284">[Pg 284]</a></span>
-rough garb, to stride over his own fields, and look
-after his cattle. He had not forgotten his early
-tastes, and reveled in the free and unconventional
-life of this seaside farm. He drank in health
-from the invigorating sea breezes, and always
-bore more easily the burden of public cares after
-a few days at Marshfield.</p>
-
-<p>“I had rather be here than in the Senate,” he
-said on one occasion to his son, while amusing
-himself with feeding his cattle with ears of corn
-from an unhusked pile lying upon the barn floor.</p>
-
-<p>Mr. Webster was a keen disciple of Isaac Walton,
-and spent many an hour with rod and line,
-when perhaps his thoughts were busy with some
-intricate political problem, or his mind was occupied
-with the composition of some speech now
-famous.</p>
-
-<p>To Mr. Harvey’s “Reminiscences” I am indebted
-for the following anecdote of Mr. Webster,
-and indeed for most that I have said about
-his country life:</p>
-
-<p>“Soon after Mr. Webster went to Marshfield
-he was one day out on the marshes shooting
-birds. It was in the month of August, when the
-farmers were securing their salt hay. He came,
-in the course of his rambles, to the Green Harbor
-River, which he wished to cross. He beckoned
-to one of the men on the opposite bank to take<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_285" id="Page_285">[Pg 285]</a></span>
-him over in his boat, which lay moored in sight.
-The man at once left his work, came over and
-paddled Mr. Webster across the stream. He declined
-the payment offered him, but lingered a
-moment, with Yankee curiosity, to question the
-stranger. He surmised who Mr. Webster was,
-and with some hesitation remarked:</p>
-
-<p>“‘This is Daniel Webster, I believe?’</p>
-
-<p>“‘That is my name,’ replied the sportsman.</p>
-
-<p>“‘Well, now,’ said the farmer, ‘I am told
-that you can make from three to five dollars a
-day pleadin’ cases up in Boston.’</p>
-
-<p>“Mr. Webster replied that he was sometimes
-so fortunate as to receive that amount for his
-services.</p>
-
-<p>“‘Well, now,’ returned the rustic; ‘it seems
-to me, I declare, if I could get as much in the
-city pleadin’ law cases, I would not be a wadin’
-over these marshes this hot weather shootin’ little
-birds.’”</p>
-
-<p>Had the simple countryman been told that his
-companion, who was dressed but little better than
-himself, was making from thirty to forty thousand
-dollars annually by these same “law cases,”
-we can hardly imagine the extent of his amazement,
-or perhaps incredulity.</p>
-
-<p>There is a tradition, and Mr. Webster has confirmed
-it, that he was one day out on the marsh<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_286" id="Page_286">[Pg 286]</a></span>
-when his attention was drawn to two young men,
-evidently from the city, who were standing on
-one side of a creek which it seemed necessary to
-cross. They were nicely dressed, and evidently
-dismayed by the apparent necessity of spoiling
-their fine clothes in the passage. Seeing a large
-rough-looking man, with his pants tucked in his
-boots, approaching them, their faces brightened
-as they saw a way out of their dilemma.</p>
-
-<p>“My good man,” said one, in an eager but
-patronizing way, “we are in trouble. Can you
-help us?”</p>
-
-<p>Mr. Webster looked at the young men and appreciated
-the situation.</p>
-
-<p>He answered gravely, “What is your difficulty?”</p>
-
-<p>“We want to get across this creek, but you see
-we might spoil our clothes if we undertook to
-wade.”</p>
-
-<p>Mr. Webster nodded.</p>
-
-<p>“You look like a good, strong fellow, and it
-won’t hurt your clothes. Will you carry us
-across on your back?”</p>
-
-<p>Mr. Webster’s eyes twinkled, but he did not
-suffer the young men to see it. They were
-lightly made, and no great burden to one of his
-herculean frame.</p>
-
-<p>“Yes,” he answered; “I will oblige you.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_287" id="Page_287">[Pg 287]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>So he took the two over in turn, and deposited
-them, greatly to their satisfaction, safe and sound
-on the opposite shore.</p>
-
-<p>“I’m ever so much obliged,” said the first.
-“Here, my man, take this,” and he drew half a
-dollar from his pocket.</p>
-
-<p>The second made the same tender.</p>
-
-<p>“You are quite welcome, young gentlemen,”
-said Mr. Webster, “but I can’t think of accepting
-any recompense.”</p>
-
-<p>“Really, though, it’s worth it; isn’t it, Jones?”
-said the first young man, addressing his companion.</p>
-
-<p>“Of course it is. Better take the money, sir.”</p>
-
-<p>“I must decline,” said Mr. Webster, smiling.</p>
-
-<p>“Ever so much obliged. Really it’s very kind
-of you. By the way, doesn’t Daniel Webster
-live round here somewhere?”</p>
-
-<p>“Yes; you are on his land now,” said the
-rough-looking countryman.</p>
-
-<p>“You don’t say so. Is there any chance of
-seeing him, do you think?”</p>
-
-<p>“A very good chance. <em>You have only to take
-a good look at me.</em>”</p>
-
-<p>“Are—you—Mr.—Webster?” faltered the
-young men simultaneously.</p>
-
-<p>“Men call me so,” answered the statesman, enjoying
-the confusion of the young men.</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_288" id="Page_288">[Pg 288]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>They attempted to apologize for the liberty
-they had taken, and the great mistake they had
-made, but without much success, and notwithstanding
-the good-natured manner in which their
-excuses were received by Mr. Webster, were glad
-when they were out of his presence.</p>
-
-<p>I cannot resist the temptation to record another
-amusing incident in the summer life of Mr. Webster.
-One day he had gone to Chelsea Beach to
-shoot wild fowl. While lying among the tall
-grass he watched from his concealment the flocks
-of birds as they flew over the beach and adjacent
-waters. A flock appeared flying quite low, and he
-lowered the muzzle of his gun below the horizontal
-range to bring the birds before his eye. He
-fired, and instantly there was a loud cry proceeding
-from the beach below. In alarm Mr. Webster
-rushed down the bank, and descried a stranger
-rubbing his face and shoulder ruefully. The
-sportsman himself was not looking his best. His
-raiment was disordered and his face was begrimed
-with powder.</p>
-
-<p>“My dear sir,” he inquired anxiously, “did I
-hit you?”</p>
-
-<p>The man answered resentfully, “Yes, you did
-hit me; <em>and, from your looks, I should think
-that I am not the first man you have shot,
-either</em>.”</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_289" id="Page_289">[Pg 289]</a></span></p>
-
-
-
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-<h2><a name="CHAPTER_XXXVI" id="CHAPTER_XXXVI">CHAPTER XXXVI.</a><br />
-
-<small>THE SEVENTH OF MARCH SPEECH.</small></h2>
-
-
-<p>Were I to undertake a complete account of
-Mr. Webster’s public acts during the last ten
-years of his life, I should require to write a volume
-upon this part of his life alone. This does
-not enter into my plan. I aim only to give my
-young readers a general idea of the public and
-private life of the great statesman, and must refer
-them for particulars to the valuable Life by
-George Ticknor Curtis, already more than once
-referred to.</p>
-
-<p>Mr. Webster was strongly opposed to the annexation
-of Texas, foreseeing that it would justly
-be resented by the people of the North as tending
-to increase “the obvious inequality which
-exists in the representation of the people in Congress
-by extending slavery and slave representation.”</p>
-
-<p>Slavery was the one great flaw in our otherwise
-glorious system of government. It was a standing
-reproach among the European nations that a
-government which claimed to be free held in<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_290" id="Page_290">[Pg 290]</a></span>
-forcible subjection three million slaves. It sowed
-dissension between the North and the South, and
-seemed to be the entering wedge destined ere
-long to split asunder the great republic. There
-were men on both sides of Mason and Dixon’s
-line who openly favored separation, but Mr. Webster
-was not one of these. His ardent devotion
-to the Union we have already seen in the glowing
-peroration to his memorable speech against
-Hayne. He watched with an anxiety which he
-did not attempt to conceal the growing exasperation
-of feeling between the two sections. Though
-he took the Northern view, he saw that there
-must be mutual concessions or the Union would
-be dissolved. He did not wish that event to come
-in his time, and it was in this frame of mind that
-he made his last great speech in the Senate—what
-is known as the seventh of March speech.</p>
-
-<p>It was a strong and temperate statement of the
-existing condition of affairs, and of the necessity
-of compromise. In making this speech Mr. Webster
-was fully aware that he was hazarding his
-popularity—nay, was sure to lose it—that he
-would grieve his best friends, and excite a storm
-of indignation at the North. He was not mistaken.
-The minds of men were in no mood for
-temperate counsels. They were in no mood to
-appreciate the patriotic motives which actuated<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_291" id="Page_291">[Pg 291]</a></span>
-the great statesman. He was charged with falling
-from honor and making undue concessions to
-slavery. Upon this last point I shall express no
-opinion. I only claim that Mr. Webster’s motives
-were pure, and that though he may have gone
-too far in his concessions, he was influenced
-thereto by the depth of his devotion to the
-Union. There were not wanting those who
-charged him with making in his speech a bid for
-the Presidency, forgetting that he could not have
-injured his chances more effectually than by stirring
-up against himself his warmest political
-friends.</p>
-
-<p>That Mr. Webster had an honorable ambition to
-serve his country in that great office—the greatest
-in its gift—no one will dispute. He knew his
-own fitness, and would have rejoiced to crown a
-life of high service with this elevated trust. But
-I have said elsewhere that it is only in an ideal
-republic that the greatest citizens reach the
-highest posts, and our republic is not an ideal one.</p>
-
-<p>In the light of our present experience we can
-see that Mr. Webster was wrong in supposing
-that the republic could go on indefinitely with
-slavery as its corner-stone. Any compromise
-could be only for a time. But he was an old
-man—sixty-eight years of age—grown cautious
-and conservative with advancing years, and he<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_292" id="Page_292">[Pg 292]</a></span>
-could not see through the clouds that gathered
-before him.</p>
-
-<p>With this brief vindication of his motives I
-proceed to give an extract from his last great
-speech:</p>
-
-<p>“Secession! Peaceable secession! Sir, your
-eyes and mine are never destined to see that
-miracle. The dismemberment of this vast country
-without convulsion! The breaking up of the
-fountains of the great deep without ruffling the
-surface! Who is so foolish—I beg everybody’s
-pardon—as to expect any such thing? Sir, he
-who sees these States now revolving in harmony
-around a common center, and expects to see them
-quit their places and fly off without convulsion,
-may look the next moment to see the heavenly
-bodies rush from their spheres and jostle against
-each other in the realms of space, without causing
-the wreck of the universe! There can be no
-such thing as a peaceable secession. Peaceable
-secession is an impossibility. Is the great Constitution
-under which we live, covering this
-whole country, is it to be thawed and melted away
-by secession, as the snows on the mountain melt
-under the influence of a vernal sun, disappear
-and run off? No, sir! No, sir! I will not
-state what might produce the disruption of the
-Union; but, sir, I see as plainly as I see the sun
-in heaven what that disruption must produce;<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_293" id="Page_293">[Pg 293]</a></span>
-I see that it must produce war, and such a war
-as I will not describe in its two-fold character.</p>
-
-<p>“Peaceable secession! Peaceable secession!
-The concurrent agreement of all the members of
-this great government to separate! A voluntary
-separation with alimony on one side, and on the
-other! Why, what would be the result? Where
-is the line to be drawn? What States are to
-secede? What is to remain America? What
-am I to be? An American no longer? Am I
-to become a sectional man, a local man, a separatist,
-with no country in common with the gentlemen
-who sit around me here, or who fill the
-other House of Congress? Heaven forbid!
-Where is the flag of the republic to remain?
-Where is the eagle still to tower? or is he to
-cower, and shrink, and fall to the ground? Why,
-sir, our ancestors, our fathers, and our grandfathers,
-those of them who are still living among
-us with prolonged lives, would rebuke and reproach
-us; and our children and our grandchildren
-would cry out shame upon us, if we of this
-generation should dishonor these ensigns of the
-power of the government and the harmony of
-the union which is every day felt among us with
-so much joy and gratitude. What is to become
-of the army? What is to become of the navy?
-What is to become of the public lands? How
-is each of the thirty States to defend itself?</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_294" id="Page_294">[Pg 294]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>“I know, although the idea has not been stated
-distinctly, there is to be, or it is supposed possible
-that there will be, a Southern confederacy. I
-do not mean, when I allude to this statement, that
-any one seriously contemplates such a state of
-things. I do not mean to say that it is true, but
-I have heard it suggested elsewhere that the idea
-has been entertained that, after the dissolution of
-this Union a Southern Confederacy might be
-formed. I am sorry, sir, that it has ever been
-thought of, talked of or dreamed of, in the wildest
-flights of human imagination. But the idea, so
-far as it exists, must be of a separation, assigning
-the slave States to one side, and the free States to
-the other. Sir, I may express myself too strongly,
-perhaps, but there are impossibilities in the moral
-as well as in the physical world, and I hold the
-idea of a separation of these States, those that
-are free to form one government, and those that
-are slaveholding to form another, as such an impossibility.
-We could not separate the States by
-any such line if we were to draw it. We could
-not sit down here to-day and draw a line of separation
-that would satisfy any five men in the
-country. There are natural causes that would
-keep and tie us together, and there are social and
-domestic relations which we could not break if
-we would, and which we should not if we could.”</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_295" id="Page_295">[Pg 295]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>In describing the consequences of secession it
-must be admitted that Mr. Webster spoke like a
-true prophet. All the evils that he predicted—the
-war such as the world had never seen—came
-to pass, but out of it the Union emerged stronger
-than ever, with its chief burden and reproach
-thrown overboard. Much as the war cost, we
-feel to-day that we are the better off that it was
-fought. Let us not blame Mr. Webster that
-he could not penetrate the future, and strove so
-hard to avert it. Probably his speech postponed
-it, but nothing could avert it. Can we doubt
-that if the great statesman were living to-day
-he would thank God that He had solved the
-great problem that had baffled the wisdom of the
-wisest, and brought substantial good from fratricidal
-strife?</p>
-
-<p>Among those who listened with rapt attention
-to Mr. Webster was John C. Calhoun, his great
-compeer, who had risen with difficulty from the
-bed where he lay fatally sick, to hear the senator
-from Massachusetts. “A tall, gaunt figure,
-wrapped in a long black cloak, with deep, cavernous
-black eyes, and a thick mass of snow-white hair
-brushed back from the large brow,” he seemed like
-a visitant from the next world. It was his last
-appearance in the Senate. Before March was
-over he had gone to his rest!</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_296" id="Page_296">[Pg 296]</a></span></p>
-
-
-
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-<h2><a name="CHAPTER_XXXVII" id="CHAPTER_XXXVII">CHAPTER XXXVII.</a><br />
-
-<small>CLOSING SCENES.</small></h2>
-
-
-<p>Mr. Webster’s public life was drawing to a
-close. After the death of Gen. Taylor he accepted
-for a second time the post of Secretary of
-State, but there is nothing in his official work
-that calls for our special attention. Important
-questions came up and were satisfactorily disposed
-of. There was a strong hand at the helm.</p>
-
-<p>June, 1852, brought him a great disappointment.
-The Whig Convention assembled in Baltimore
-to nominate a candidate for the Presidency.
-Mr. Webster was by all means the leader of that
-party, and was one of the three candidates balloted
-for. But in the end the successful man was Gen.
-Winfield Scott. It was a nomination like that of
-Harrison and Taylor, dictated solely by what was
-thought to be availability. In this case a mistake
-was made. Gen. Scott was disastrously defeated
-by Gen. Franklin Pierce, the nominee of
-the Democracy.</p>
-
-<p>Gen. Pierce, though parted by politics, was a devoted
-friend of Mr. Webster, and the reader may<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_297" id="Page_297">[Pg 297]</a></span>
-be interested to know that on hearing of his nomination,
-he spoke thus: “Well, all I can say is, and
-I say it in sincerity, if the people of the United
-States were to repudiate caucuses, conventions,
-politicians and tricksters, and rise in the glory
-of their strength and might, without waiting for
-any convention to designate a candidate, but bent
-on placing in the Presidential chair the first citizen
-and statesman, the first patriot and man,
-Daniel Webster, it would do for republican
-government more than any event which has
-taken place in the history of the world. These
-are my sentiments, democracy or no democracy.”</p>
-
-<p>This is certainly a remarkable tribute from the
-nominee of one party to an unsuccessful candidate
-of another, but Gen. Pierce had shown on many
-occasions his warm friendship and admiration for
-Mr. Webster.</p>
-
-<p>At Mr. Webster’s age it was not likely that he
-would ever again be a candidate for the Presidency.
-His last chance had slipped away, and
-the disappointment was keen. He was already in
-declining health, induced partly by a severe accident
-which befell him in May, 1852, when he was
-thrown headlong to the earth while riding behind
-a span of horses to Plymouth. Probably the
-injury was greater than appeared. Towards the
-end of September, while at Marshfield, alarming<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_298" id="Page_298">[Pg 298]</a></span>
-symptoms were developed, and his grand physical
-system was evidently giving way. That month
-was to be his last. His earthly work was done,
-and he was never again to resume his work at
-Washington. The closing scenes are thus described
-by Mr. Curtis:</p>
-
-<p>“It was past midnight, when, awaking from
-one of the slumbers that he had at intervals, he
-seemed not to know whether he had not already
-passed from his earthly existence. He made a
-strong effort to ascertain what the consciousness
-that he could still perceive actually was, and then
-uttered those well-known words, ‘I still live!’
-as if he had satisfied himself of the fact that
-he was striving to know. They were his last
-coherent utterance. A good deal later he said
-something in which the word ‘poetry’ was distinctly
-heard. His son immediately repeated to
-him one of the stanzas of Gray’s ‘Elegy.’ He
-heard it and smiled. After this respiration became
-more difficult, and at length it went on with
-perceptible intervals. All was now hushed within
-the chamber; and to us who stood waiting
-there were but three sounds in nature: the sighing
-of the autumn wind in the trees, the slow
-ticking of the clock in the hall below, and the
-deep breathing of our dying friend. Moments
-that seemed hours flowed on. Still the measured<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_299" id="Page_299">[Pg 299]</a></span>
-beat of time fell painfully distinct upon our ears;
-still the gentle moaning of the wind mingled
-with the only sound that arose within the room;
-for there were no sobs of women, no movements
-of men. So grand, and yet so calm and simple,
-had been his approach to the moment when he
-must know that he was with us no more, that he
-had lifted us into a composure which, but for
-his great example, we could not have felt. At
-twenty-three minutes before three o’clock his
-breathing ceased; the features settled into a
-superb repose; and Dr. Jeffries, who still held
-the pulse, after waiting a few seconds, gently laid
-down the arm, and amid a breathless silence, pronounced
-the single word, ‘Dead.’ The eyes were
-then closed, the remains were removed from the
-position in which death came, and all but those
-who had been appointed to wait and watch slowly
-and mournfully walked away.”</p>
-
-<p>Thus died a man whom all generations will
-agree in pronouncing great; a man not without
-faults, for he was human, but one to whom his
-country may point with pride as a sincere patriot,
-a devoted son, who, in eloquence at the bar and
-in the Senate, is worthy of a place beside the
-greatest orators of any nation, or any epoch. He
-has invested the name of an American citizen
-with added glory, for he was a typical American,<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_300" id="Page_300">[Pg 300]</a></span>
-the genuine product of our republican institutions.
-No poor boy who reads his life need despair
-of becoming eminent, for he can hardly
-have more obstacles to overcome than the farmers’
-boy, who grew up on the sterile soil of New
-Hampshire, and fought his way upward with unfailing
-courage and pluck. Not once in a century
-is such a man born into the world—a man so
-amply endowed by his Creator—but he did not
-rely upon his natural talents, but was a firm
-believer in hard work. With all his marvelous
-ability he would not otherwise have left behind
-him such a name and fame.</p>
-
-<hr class="chap" />
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_301" id="Page_301">[Pg 301]</a></span></p>
-
-
-
-<div class="chapter"></div>
-<h2><a name="CHAPTER_XXXVIII" id="CHAPTER_XXXVIII">CHAPTER XXXVIII.</a><br />
-
-<small>CENTENNIAL TRIBUTES.</small></h2>
-
-
-<p>On the 18th of January, 1882, the hundredth
-birthday of Daniel Webster, the Marshfield Club
-assembled at the Parker House, in Boston, to
-take suitable notice of the anniversary. Though
-thirty years had elapsed since his death there was
-one at least present, Hon. Robert C. Winthrop,
-who had been intimately associated with him in
-public life, having been his successor in the
-Senate, and a warm personal friend. Most notable
-among the addresses was that of Gov. Long,
-of Massachusetts, which I shall venture to insert
-here, as containing in brief compass a fitting estimate
-of the great statesman whom the company
-had assembled to honor.</p>
-
-
-<p class="center">GOVERNOR LONG’S ADDRESS.</p>
-
-<p>“It is but a poor tribute that even the most eloquent
-voice, least of all mine, can pay for Massachusetts
-to the memory of her greatest statesman,
-her mightiest intellect and her most powerful
-orator. Among her sons he towers like the lonely<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_302" id="Page_302">[Pg 302]</a></span>
-and massive shaft on Bunker Hill, upon the base
-and the crest of which his name is emblazoned
-clearer than if chiseled deep in its granite cubes.
-For years he was her synonym. Among the
-States he sustained her at that proud height
-which Winthrop and Sam Adams gave her in
-the colonial and provincial days. With what
-matchless grandeur he defended her! With
-what overwhelming power he impressed her convictions
-upon the national life! God seems to
-appoint men to special work, and, that done, the
-very effort of its achievement exhausts them, and
-they rise not again to the summit of their meridian.
-So it was with Webster. He knows little
-even of written constitutions and frames of government
-who does not know that they exist almost
-less in the letter than in the interpretation
-and construction of the letter. In this light it is
-not too much to say that the Constitution of the
-United States, as it existed when it carried our
-country through the greatest peril that ever tested
-it, was the crystallization of the mind of Webster
-as well as of its original framers. It came from
-them and was only accepted by some of our own
-as a compact of States, sovereign in all but certain
-enumerated powers delegated to a central
-government. He made it the crucible of a welded
-Union—the charter of one great country, the<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_303" id="Page_303">[Pg 303]</a></span>
-United States of America. He made the States
-a nation and enfolded them in its single banner.
-It was the overwhelming logic of his discussion,
-the household familiarity of his simple but irresistible
-statement, that gave us munition to fight
-the war for the preservation of the Union and
-the abolition of slavery. It was his eloquence,
-clear as crystal and precipitating itself in the
-school-books and literature of a people, which had
-trained up the generation of twenty years ago to
-regard this nation as one, to love its flag with a
-patriotism that knew no faction or section, to be
-loyal to the whole country, and to find in its Constitution
-power to suppress any hand or combination
-raised against it. The great Rebellion of
-1861 went down hardly more before the cannon
-of Grant and Farragut than the thunder of Webster’s
-reply to Hayne. He knew not the extent
-of his own achievement. His greatest failure
-was that he rose not to the height and actual
-stroke of his own resistless argument, and that
-he lacked the sublime inspiration, the disentanglement
-and the courage to let the giant he
-had created go upon his errand, first of force, and
-then, through that, of surer peace. He had put
-the work and genius of more than an ordinary
-lifetime of service into the arching and knitting
-of the Union, and this he could not bear to put<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_304" id="Page_304">[Pg 304]</a></span>
-to the final test; his great heart was sincere in
-the prayer that his eyes might not behold the
-earthquake that would shake it to those foundations
-which, though he knew it not, he had made
-so strong that a succeeding generation saw them
-stand the shock as the oak withstands the storm.
-Men are not gods, and it needed in him that he
-should rise to a moral sublimity and daring as
-lofty as the intellectual heights above which he
-soared with unequaled strength. So had he been
-godlike.</p>
-
-<p>“A great man touches the heart of the people
-as well as their intelligence. They not only admire,
-they also love him. It sometimes seems as
-if they sought in him some weakness of our common
-human nature, that they may chide him for
-it, forgive it, and so endear him to themselves
-the more. Massachusetts had her friction with
-the younger Adams, only to lay him away with
-profounder honor, and to remember him devotedly
-as the defender of the right of petition and
-‘the old man eloquent.’ She forgave the overweening
-conceit of Sumner, she revoked her unjust
-censure of him, and now points her youth to
-him in his high niche as the unsullied patriot,
-without fear and without reproach, who stood and
-spoke for equal rights, and whose last great service
-was to demand and enforce his country’s just<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_305" id="Page_305">[Pg 305]</a></span>
-claims against the dishonorable trespass of the
-cruisers of that England he had so much admired.
-Massachusetts smote, too, and broke the heart of
-Webster, her idol, and then broke her own above
-his grave, and to-day writes his name highest upon
-her roll of statesmen. It seems disjointed to say
-that, with such might as his, the impression that
-comes from his face upon the wall, as from his
-silhouette upon the background of our history, is
-that of sadness—the sadness of the great deep
-eyes, the sadness of the lonely shore he loved,
-and by which he sleeps. The story of Webster
-from the beginning is the very pathos of romance.
-A minor chord runs through it like the tenderest
-note in a song. What eloquence of tears is in
-that narrative, which reveals in this giant of intellectual
-strength the heart, the single loving
-heart, of a child, and in which he describes
-the winter sleighride up the New Hampshire
-hills when his father told him that, at whatever
-cost, he should have a college education, and he,
-too full to speak, while a warm glow ran all over
-him, laid his head upon his father’s shoulder and
-wept!</p>
-
-<p>“The greatness of Webster and his title to
-enduring gratitude have two illustrations. He
-taught the people of the United States, in the
-simplicity of common understanding, the princi<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_306" id="Page_306">[Pg 306]</a></span>ples
-of the Constitution and government of the
-country, and he wrought for them, in a style of
-matchless strength and beauty, the literature of
-statesmanship. From his lips flowed the discussion
-of constitutional law, of economic philosophy,
-of finance, of international right, of national
-grandeur and of the whole range of high public
-themes, so clear and judicial that it was no longer
-discussion, but judgment. To-day—and so it will
-be while the republic endures—the student and
-the legislator turn to the full fountain of his
-statement for the enunciation of these principles.
-What other authority is quoted, or holds even the
-second or third place? Even his words have imbedded
-themselves in the common phraseology,
-and come to the tongue like passages from the
-Psalms or the poets. I do not know that a sentence
-or a word of Sumner’s repeats itself in our
-every-day parlance. The exquisite periods of
-Everett are recalled like the consummate work
-of some master of music, but no note or refrain
-sings itself over and over again to our ears. The
-brilliant eloquence of Choate is like the flash of a
-bursting rocket, lingering upon the retina indeed
-after it has faded from the wings of the night,
-but as elusive of our grasp as spray-drops that
-glisten in the sun. The fiery enthusiasm of
-Andrews did, indeed, burn some of his heart-beats<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_307" id="Page_307">[Pg 307]</a></span>
-forever into the sentiment of Massachusetts; but
-Webster made his language the very household
-words of a nation. They are the library of a
-people. They inspired and still inspire patriotism.
-They taught and still teach loyalty. They are
-the school-book of the citizen. They are the inwrought
-and accepted fiber of American politics.
-If the temple of our republic shall ever fall, they
-will ‘still live’ above the ground like those great
-foundation stones in ancient ruins, which remain
-in lonely grandeur, unburied in the dust that
-springs to turf over all else, and making men
-wonder from what rare quarry and by what
-mighty force they came. To Webster, as to few
-other men, is it due that to-day, wherever a son
-of the United States, at home or abroad, ‘beholds
-the gorgeous ensign of the republic, now known
-and honored throughout the earth, still full high
-advanced, its arms and trophies streaming in their
-original luster, not a stripe erased or polluted, nor
-a single star obscured,’ he can utter a prouder
-boast than, <i lang="la">Civis Romanus sum</i>. For he can
-say, I am an American citizen.”</p>
-
-<p>As a fitting pendant to this eloquent tribute
-I quote a portion of the address of Mr. Winthrop,
-whose name, personally and by inheritance, makes
-him one of the most eminent sons of Massachusetts:</p>
-
-<p><span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_308" id="Page_308">[Pg 308]</a></span></p>
-
-<p>“And, after all, Mr. President, what are all the
-fine things which have ever been said of him, or
-which ever can be said of him, to-night or a hundred
-years hence, compared with the splendid
-record which he has left of himself as an advocate
-in the courts, as a debater in the Senate, as an
-orator before the people? We do not search out
-for what was said about Pericles or Demosthenes
-or Cicero or Burke. It is enough for us to read
-their orations. There are those, indeed, who may
-justly desire to be measured by the momentary
-opinions which others have formed and expressed
-about them. There are not a few who may well
-be content to live on the applauses and praises
-which their efforts have called forth from immediate
-hearers and admirers. They will enjoy at
-least a reflected and traditional fame. But Webster
-will always stand safest and strongest on his
-own showing. His fame will be independent of
-praise or dispraise from other men’s lips. He can
-be measured to his full altitude, as a thinker, a
-writer, a speaker, only by the standard of his own
-immortal productions. That masterly style, that
-pure Saxon English, that clear and cogent statement,
-that close and clinching logic, that power
-of going down to the depths and up to the heights
-of any great argument, letting the immaterial or
-incidental look out for itself, those vivid descrip<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_309" id="Page_309">[Pg 309]</a></span>tions,
-those magnificent metaphors, those thrilling
-appeals—not introduced as mere ornaments
-wrought out in advance, and stored up for an
-opportunity of display, but sparkling and blazing
-out in the very heat of an effort, like gems uncovering
-themselves in the working of a mine—these
-are some of the characteristics which will
-secure for Webster a fame altogether his own,
-and will make his works a model and a study,
-long after most of those who have praised him,
-or who have censured him, shall be forgotten.</p>
-
-<p>“What if those six noble volumes of his were
-obliterated from the roll of American literature
-and American eloquence! What if those great
-speeches, recently issued in a single compendious
-volume, had no existence! What if those consummate
-defenses of the Constitution and the
-Union had never been uttered, and their instruction
-and inspiration had been lost to us during
-the fearful ordeal to which that Constitution and
-that Union have since been subjected? Are we
-quite sure that we should have had that Constitution
-as it was, and the Union as it is, to be fought
-for, if the birth we are commemorating had never
-occurred—if that bright Northern Star had never
-gleamed above the hills of New Hampshire?
-Let it be, if you please, that its light was not
-always serene and steady. Let it be that mist<span class="pagenum"><a name="Page_310" id="Page_310">[Pg 310]</a></span>
-and clouds sometimes gathered over its disk, and
-hid its guiding rays from many a wistful eye.
-Say even, if you will, that to some eyes it seemed
-once to be shooting madly from its sphere.
-Make every deduction which his bitterest enemies
-have ever made for any alleged deviation
-from the course which he had marked out for it
-by others, or which it seemed to have marked out
-for itself, in its path across the sky. Still, still
-there is radiance and glory enough left, as we
-contemplate its whole golden track, to make us
-feel and acknowledge that it had no fellow in our
-firmament.”</p>
-
-
-<p class="center space-above">THE END.</p>
-
-<div class="transnote">
-<h3>Transcriber's Notes</h3>
-
-<p>Obvious typographical errors have been silently corrected. All other
-spelling and punctuation remains unchanged.</p>
-</div>
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-<pre>
-
-
-
-
-
-End of Project Gutenberg's From Farm Boy to Senator, by Horatio Alger Jr.
-
-*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK FROM FARM BOY TO SENATOR ***
-
-***** This file should be named 53382-h.htm or 53382-h.zip *****
-This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
- http://www.gutenberg.org/5/3/3/8/53382/
-
-Produced by David Edwards, Les Galloway and the Online
-Distributed Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net (This
-file was produced from images generously made available
-by The Internet Archive)
-
-
-Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions will
-be renamed.
-
-Creating the works from print editions not protected by U.S. copyright
-law means that no one owns a United States copyright in these works,
-so the Foundation (and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United
-States without permission and without paying copyright
-royalties. Special rules, set forth in the General Terms of Use part
-of this license, apply to copying and distributing Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works to protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm
-concept and trademark. Project Gutenberg is a registered trademark,
-and may not be used if you charge for the eBooks, unless you receive
-specific permission. If you do not charge anything for copies of this
-eBook, complying with the rules is very easy. You may use this eBook
-for nearly any purpose such as creation of derivative works, reports,
-performances and research. They may be modified and printed and given
-away--you may do practically ANYTHING in the United States with eBooks
-not protected by U.S. copyright law. Redistribution is subject to the
-trademark license, especially commercial redistribution.
-
-START: FULL LICENSE
-
-THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
-PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
-
-To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
-distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
-(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full
-Project Gutenberg-tm License available with this file or online at
-www.gutenberg.org/license.
-
-Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-
-1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
-and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
-(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
-the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or
-destroy all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your
-possession. If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a
-Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound
-by the terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the
-person or entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph
-1.E.8.
-
-1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
-used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
-agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
-things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
-paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this
-agreement and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works. See paragraph 1.E below.
-
-1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the
-Foundation" or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection
-of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual
-works in the collection are in the public domain in the United
-States. If an individual work is unprotected by copyright law in the
-United States and you are located in the United States, we do not
-claim a right to prevent you from copying, distributing, performing,
-displaying or creating derivative works based on the work as long as
-all references to Project Gutenberg are removed. Of course, we hope
-that you will support the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting
-free access to electronic works by freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm
-works in compliance with the terms of this agreement for keeping the
-Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with the work. You can easily
-comply with the terms of this agreement by keeping this work in the
-same format with its attached full Project Gutenberg-tm License when
-you share it without charge with others.
-
-1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
-what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are
-in a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States,
-check the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this
-agreement before downloading, copying, displaying, performing,
-distributing or creating derivative works based on this work or any
-other Project Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no
-representations concerning the copyright status of any work in any
-country outside the United States.
-
-1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
-
-1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other
-immediate access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear
-prominently whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work
-on which the phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the
-phrase "Project Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed,
-performed, viewed, copied or distributed:
-
- This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere in the United States and
- most other parts of the world at no cost and with almost no
- restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or re-use it
- under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included with this
- eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org. If you are not located in the
- United States, you'll have to check the laws of the country where you
- are located before using this ebook.
-
-1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is
-derived from texts not protected by U.S. copyright law (does not
-contain a notice indicating that it is posted with permission of the
-copyright holder), the work can be copied and distributed to anyone in
-the United States without paying any fees or charges. If you are
-redistributing or providing access to a work with the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the work, you must comply
-either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 or
-obtain permission for the use of the work and the Project Gutenberg-tm
-trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
-
-1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
-with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
-must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any
-additional terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms
-will be linked to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works
-posted with the permission of the copyright holder found at the
-beginning of this work.
-
-1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
-License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
-work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
-
-1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
-electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
-prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
-active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm License.
-
-1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
-compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including
-any word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access
-to or distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format
-other than "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official
-version posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site
-(www.gutenberg.org), you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense
-to the user, provide a copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means
-of obtaining a copy upon request, of the work in its original "Plain
-Vanilla ASCII" or other form. Any alternate format must include the
-full Project Gutenberg-tm License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
-
-1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
-performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
-unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
-
-1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
-access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-provided that
-
-* You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
- the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
- you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is owed
- to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he has
- agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the Project
- Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments must be paid
- within 60 days following each date on which you prepare (or are
- legally required to prepare) your periodic tax returns. Royalty
- payments should be clearly marked as such and sent to the Project
- Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the address specified in
- Section 4, "Information about donations to the Project Gutenberg
- Literary Archive Foundation."
-
-* You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
- you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
- does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
- License. You must require such a user to return or destroy all
- copies of the works possessed in a physical medium and discontinue
- all use of and all access to other copies of Project Gutenberg-tm
- works.
-
-* You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of
- any money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
- electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days of
- receipt of the work.
-
-* You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
- distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
-
-1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work or group of works on different terms than
-are set forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing
-from both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and The
-Project Gutenberg Trademark LLC, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm
-trademark. Contact the Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
-
-1.F.
-
-1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
-effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
-works not protected by U.S. copyright law in creating the Project
-Gutenberg-tm collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may
-contain "Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate
-or corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other
-intellectual property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or
-other medium, a computer virus, or computer codes that damage or
-cannot be read by your equipment.
-
-1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
-of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
-liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
-fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
-LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
-PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
-TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
-LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
-INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
-DAMAGE.
-
-1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
-defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
-receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
-written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
-received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium
-with your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you
-with the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in
-lieu of a refund. If you received the work electronically, the person
-or entity providing it to you may choose to give you a second
-opportunity to receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If
-the second copy is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing
-without further opportunities to fix the problem.
-
-1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
-in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS', WITH NO
-OTHER WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT
-LIMITED TO WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
-
-1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
-warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of
-damages. If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement
-violates the law of the state applicable to this agreement, the
-agreement shall be interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or
-limitation permitted by the applicable state law. The invalidity or
-unenforceability of any provision of this agreement shall not void the
-remaining provisions.
-
-1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
-trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
-providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in
-accordance with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the
-production, promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works, harmless from all liability, costs and expenses,
-including legal fees, that arise directly or indirectly from any of
-the following which you do or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this
-or any Project Gutenberg-tm work, (b) alteration, modification, or
-additions or deletions to any Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any
-Defect you cause.
-
-Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
-electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of
-computers including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It
-exists because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations
-from people in all walks of life.
-
-Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
-assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
-goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
-remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
-and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future
-generations. To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation and how your efforts and donations can help, see
-Sections 3 and 4 and the Foundation information page at
-www.gutenberg.org Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg
-Literary Archive Foundation
-
-The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
-501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
-state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
-Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
-number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent permitted by
-U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
-
-The Foundation's principal office is in Fairbanks, Alaska, with the
-mailing address: PO Box 750175, Fairbanks, AK 99775, but its
-volunteers and employees are scattered throughout numerous
-locations. Its business office is located at 809 North 1500 West, Salt
-Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887. Email contact links and up to
-date contact information can be found at the Foundation's web site and
-official page at www.gutenberg.org/contact
-
-For additional contact information:
-
- Dr. Gregory B. Newby
- Chief Executive and Director
- gbnewby@pglaf.org
-
-Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
-Literary Archive Foundation
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
-spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
-increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
-freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
-array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
-($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
-status with the IRS.
-
-The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
-charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
-States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
-considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
-with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
-where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To SEND
-DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any particular
-state visit www.gutenberg.org/donate
-
-While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
-have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
-against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
-approach us with offers to donate.
-
-International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
-any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
-outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
-
-Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
-methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
-ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations. To
-donate, please visit: www.gutenberg.org/donate
-
-Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works.
-
-Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm concept of a library of electronic works that could be
-freely shared with anyone. For forty years, he produced and
-distributed Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of
-volunteer support.
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
-editions, all of which are confirmed as not protected by copyright in
-the U.S. unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not
-necessarily keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper
-edition.
-
-Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search
-facility: www.gutenberg.org
-
-This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
-including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
-subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
-
-
-
-</pre>
-
-</body>
-</html>
diff --git a/old/53382-h/images/cover.jpg b/old/53382-h/images/cover.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 97fe86d..0000000
--- a/old/53382-h/images/cover.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/53382-h/images/frontis.jpg b/old/53382-h/images/frontis.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 1f55d60..0000000
--- a/old/53382-h/images/frontis.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/53382-h/images/p008.jpg b/old/53382-h/images/p008.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index b14aaea..0000000
--- a/old/53382-h/images/p008.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/53382-h/images/p122.jpg b/old/53382-h/images/p122.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index a9a6522..0000000
--- a/old/53382-h/images/p122.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ
diff --git a/old/53382-h/images/p240.jpg b/old/53382-h/images/p240.jpg
deleted file mode 100644
index 78a3d6c..0000000
--- a/old/53382-h/images/p240.jpg
+++ /dev/null
Binary files differ